GDB: Document the unix::/path/to/socket of remote connection.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1274 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1275 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1276 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3877 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3878 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3879 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3880 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3881 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3882
3883 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3884 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3885 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3886 classes.
3887
3888 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3889 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3890 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3891
3892 @smallexample
3893 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3894 @end smallexample
3895
3896 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3897 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3898 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3899 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3900 every function in a given file:
3901
3902 @smallexample
3903 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3904 @end smallexample
3905
3906 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3907 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3908
3909 @kindex info breakpoints
3910 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3911 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3912 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3913 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3914 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3915 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3916 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3917
3918 @table @emph
3919 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3920 @item Type
3921 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3922 @item Disposition
3923 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3924 @item Enabled or Disabled
3925 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3926 that are not enabled.
3927 @item Address
3928 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3929 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3930 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3931 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3932 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3933 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3934 @item What
3935 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3936 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3937 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3938 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3939 @end table
3940
3941 @noindent
3942 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3943 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3944 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3945 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3946 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3947 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3948
3949 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3950 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3951 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3952 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3953
3954 @noindent
3955 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3956 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3957 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3958 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3959 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3963 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3964 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3965 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3966 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3967 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3968
3969 @noindent
3970 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3971 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3972
3973 @end table
3974
3975 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3976 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3977 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3978 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3979
3980 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3981 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3982 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3983 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3984
3985 @itemize @bullet
3986 @item
3987 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3988
3989 @item
3990 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3991 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3992
3993 @item
3994 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3995 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3996
3997 @item
3998 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3999 several places where that function is inlined.
4000 @end itemize
4001
4002 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4003 the relevant locations.
4004
4005 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4006 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4007 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4008 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4009 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4010 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4011 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4012
4013 For example:
4014
4015 @smallexample
4016 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4017 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4018 stop only if i==1
4019 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4020 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4021 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4025 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4026 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4027 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4028 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4029 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4030 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4031 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4032 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4033 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4034 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4035
4036 @cindex pending breakpoints
4037 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4038 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4039 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4040 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4041 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4042 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4043 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4044 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4045 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4046 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4047 is not yet resolved.
4048
4049 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4050 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4051 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4052 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4053 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4054 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4055
4056 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4057 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4058 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4059 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4060
4061 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4062 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4063 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4064
4065 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4066 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4067 address specification to an address:
4068
4069 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4070 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4071 @table @code
4072 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4073 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4074 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4075
4076 @item set breakpoint pending on
4077 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4078 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4079
4080 @item set breakpoint pending off
4081 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4082 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4083 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4084
4085 @item show breakpoint pending
4086 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4087 @end table
4088
4089 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4090 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4091 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4092
4093 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4094 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4095 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4096 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4097 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4098 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4099 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4100 breakpoints.
4101
4102 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4103
4104 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4105 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4106 @table @code
4107 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4108 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4109 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4110 breakpoint must be used.
4111
4112 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4113 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4114 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4115 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4116 @end table
4117
4118 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4119 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4120 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4121 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4122 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4123 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4124 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4125 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4126 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4127
4128 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4129 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4130 @table @code
4131 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4132 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4133 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4134 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4135
4136 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4137 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4138 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4139 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4140 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4141 @end table
4142
4143 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4144 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4145 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4146
4147 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4148 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4149
4150 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4151
4152 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4153 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4154 @table @code
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4157 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4158 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4159 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4160
4161 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4162 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4163 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4164 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4165 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4166 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4167 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4168 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4169 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4170 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4171 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4172 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4173 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4174
4175 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4176 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4177 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4178 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4179 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4180 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4181 @end table
4182
4183
4184 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4185 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4186 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4187 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4188 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4189 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4190 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4191 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4192
4193
4194 @node Set Watchpoints
4195 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4196
4197 @cindex setting watchpoints
4198 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4199 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4200 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4201 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4202 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4203
4204 @itemize @bullet
4205 @item
4206 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4207
4208 @item
4209 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4210 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4211 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4212
4213 @item
4214 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4215 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4216 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4217 @end itemize
4218
4219 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4220 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4221 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4222 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4223 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4224 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4225 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4226 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4227 the expression changes.
4228
4229 @cindex software watchpoints
4230 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4231 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4232 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4233 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4234 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4235 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4236 culprit.)
4237
4238 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4239 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4240 slow down the running of your program.
4241
4242 @table @code
4243 @kindex watch
4244 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4245 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4246 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4247 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4248 to watch the value of a single variable:
4249
4250 @smallexample
4251 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4252 @end smallexample
4253
4254 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4255 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4256 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4257 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4258 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4259 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4260
4261 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4262 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4263 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4264 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4265 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4266 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4267 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4268 error.
4269
4270 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4271 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4272 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4273 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4274 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4275 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4276 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4277 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4278 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4279 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4280 Examples:
4281
4282 @smallexample
4283 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4284 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4285 @end smallexample
4286
4287 @kindex rwatch
4288 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4289 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4290 by the program.
4291
4292 @kindex awatch
4293 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4294 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4295 or written into by the program.
4296
4297 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4298 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4299 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4300 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4301 @end table
4302
4303 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4304 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4305 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4306 a never-changing value:
4307
4308 @smallexample
4309 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4310 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4311 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4312 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4313 @end smallexample
4314
4315 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4316 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4317 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4318 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4319 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4320 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4321
4322 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4323 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4324 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4325 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4326 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4327 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4328 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4329 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4330
4331 @table @code
4332 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4333 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4334 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4335
4336 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4337 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4338 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4339 @end table
4340
4341 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4342 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4343 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4344
4345 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4346
4347 @smallexample
4348 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4349 @end smallexample
4350
4351 @noindent
4352 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4353
4354 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4355 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4356 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4357 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4358 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4359 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4360 will print a message like this:
4361
4362 @smallexample
4363 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4364 @end smallexample
4365
4366 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4367 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4368 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4369 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4370 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4371 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4372 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4373 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4374
4375 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4376 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4377 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4378 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4379 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4380 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4381
4382 @smallexample
4383 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4384 @end smallexample
4385
4386 @noindent
4387 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4388
4389 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4390 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4391 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4392 expression with separately allocated resources.
4393
4394 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4395 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4396 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4397
4398 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4399 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4400 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4401 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4402 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4403 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4404 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4405 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4406 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4407
4408 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4409 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4410 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4411 watched expression from every thread.
4412
4413 @quotation
4414 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4415 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4416 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4417 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4418 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4419 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4420 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4421 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4422 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4423 @end quotation
4424
4425 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4426
4427 @node Set Catchpoints
4428 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4429 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4430 @cindex exception handlers
4431 @cindex event handling
4432
4433 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4434 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4435 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4436
4437 @table @code
4438 @kindex catch
4439 @item catch @var{event}
4440 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4441
4442 @table @code
4443 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4444 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4445 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4446 @kindex catch throw
4447 @kindex catch rethrow
4448 @kindex catch catch
4449 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4450 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4451
4452 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4453 regular expression will be caught.
4454
4455 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4456 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4457 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4458 exception being thrown.
4459
4460 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4461 @value{GDBN}:
4462
4463 @itemize @bullet
4464 @item
4465 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4466 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4467 supported.
4468
4469 @item
4470 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4471 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4472 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4473 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4474 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4475 built.
4476
4477 @item
4478 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4479 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4480
4481 @item
4482 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4483 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4484 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4485 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4486
4487 @item
4488 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4489 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4490 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4491 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4492 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4493 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4494 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4495 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4496 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4497
4498 @item
4499 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4500
4501 @item
4502 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4503 @end itemize
4504
4505 @item exception
4506 @kindex catch exception
4507 @cindex Ada exception catching
4508 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4509 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4510 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4511 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4512 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4513
4514 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4515 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4516 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4517 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4518 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4519 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4520 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4521 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4522
4523 @item handlers
4524 @kindex catch handlers
4525 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4526 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4527 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4528 specified at the end of the command
4529 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4530 only when this specific exception is handled.
4531 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4532
4533 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4534 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4535 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4536 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4537 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4538 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4539 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4540 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4541 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4542
4543 @item exception unhandled
4544 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4545 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4546
4547 @item assert
4548 @kindex catch assert
4549 A failed Ada assertion.
4550
4551 @item exec
4552 @kindex catch exec
4553 @cindex break on fork/exec
4554 A call to @code{exec}.
4555
4556 @item syscall
4557 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4558 @kindex catch syscall
4559 @cindex break on a system call.
4560 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4561 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4562 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4563 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4564 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4565 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4566 will be caught.
4567
4568 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4569 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4570 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4571 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4572
4573 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4574 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4575 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4576 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4577
4578 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4579 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4580 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4581 available choices.
4582
4583 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4584 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4585 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4586 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4587 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4588 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4589 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4590 behind the OS upgrades).
4591
4592 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4593 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4594 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4595 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4596 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4597 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4598 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4599 syscall groups available on your environment.
4600
4601 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4602 arguments to it:
4603
4604 @smallexample
4605 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4606 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4607 (@value{GDBP}) r
4608 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4609
4610 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4611 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4612 (@value{GDBP}) c
4613 Continuing.
4614
4615 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4616 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4617 (@value{GDBP})
4618 @end smallexample
4619
4620 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4621
4622 @smallexample
4623 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4624 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4625 (@value{GDBP}) r
4626 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4627
4628 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4629 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4630 (@value{GDBP}) c
4631 Continuing.
4632
4633 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4634 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4635 (@value{GDBP})
4636 @end smallexample
4637
4638 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4639 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4640 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4641
4642 @smallexample
4643 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4644 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4645 (@value{GDBP}) r
4646 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4647
4648 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4649 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4650 (@value{GDBP}) c
4651 Continuing.
4652
4653 Program exited normally.
4654 (@value{GDBP})
4655 @end smallexample
4656
4657 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4658
4659 @smallexample
4660 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4661 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4662 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4663 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4664 (@value{GDBP}) r
4665 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4666
4667 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4668 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4669
4670 (@value{GDBP}) c
4671 Continuing.
4672 @end smallexample
4673
4674 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4675 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4676 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4677 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4678
4679 @smallexample
4680 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4681 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4682 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4683 (@value{GDBP})
4684 @end smallexample
4685
4686 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4687 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4688 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4689 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4690 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4691 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4692
4693 @smallexample
4694 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4695 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4696 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4697 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4698 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4699 (@value{GDBP})
4700 @end smallexample
4701
4702 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4703
4704 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4705 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4709 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4710 @end smallexample
4711
4712 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4713
4714 @item fork
4715 @kindex catch fork
4716 A call to @code{fork}.
4717
4718 @item vfork
4719 @kindex catch vfork
4720 A call to @code{vfork}.
4721
4722 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4723 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4724 @kindex catch load
4725 @kindex catch unload
4726 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4727 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4728 matches one of the affected libraries.
4729
4730 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4731 @kindex catch signal
4732 The delivery of a signal.
4733
4734 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4735 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4736 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4737
4738 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4739 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4740 signal names.
4741
4742 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4743 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4744 will be caught.
4745
4746 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4747 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4748 catchpoint.
4749
4750 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4751 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4752 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4753 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4754 commands.
4755
4756 @end table
4757
4758 @item tcatch @var{event}
4759 @kindex tcatch
4760 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4761 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4762
4763 @end table
4764
4765 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4766
4767
4768 @node Delete Breaks
4769 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4770
4771 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4772 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4773 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4774 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4775 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4776 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4777
4778 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4779 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4780 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4781 their breakpoint numbers.
4782
4783 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4784 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4785 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4786
4787 @table @code
4788 @kindex clear
4789 @item clear
4790 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4791 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4792 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4793 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4794
4795 @item clear @var{location}
4796 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4797 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4798 most useful ones are listed below:
4799
4800 @table @code
4801 @item clear @var{function}
4802 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4803 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4804
4805 @item clear @var{linenum}
4806 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4807 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4808 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4809 @end table
4810
4811 @cindex delete breakpoints
4812 @kindex delete
4813 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4814 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4815 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4816 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4817 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4818 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4819 @end table
4820
4821 @node Disabling
4822 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4823
4824 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4825 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4826 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4827 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4828 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4829
4830 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4831 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4832 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4833 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4834 do not know which numbers to use.
4835
4836 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4837 affects all of its locations.
4838
4839 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4840 different states of enablement:
4841
4842 @itemize @bullet
4843 @item
4844 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4845 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4846 @item
4847 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4850 disabled.
4851 @item
4852 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4853 N times, then becomes disabled.
4854 @item
4855 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4856 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4857 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4858 @end itemize
4859
4860 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4861 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4862
4863 @table @code
4864 @kindex disable
4865 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4866 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4867 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4868 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4869 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4870 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4871 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4872
4873 @kindex enable
4874 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4876 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4877
4878 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4879 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4880 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4881
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4884 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4885 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4886 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4887 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4888 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4892 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4893 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4894 @end table
4895
4896 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4897 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4898 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4899 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4900 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4901 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4902 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4903 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4904 Stepping}.)
4905
4906 @node Conditions
4907 @subsection Break Conditions
4908 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4909 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4910
4911 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4912 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4913 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4914 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4915 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4916 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4917 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4918 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4919
4920 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4921 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4922 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4923 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4924 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4925
4926 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4927 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4928 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4929 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4930 one.
4931
4932 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4933 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4934 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4935 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4936 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4937 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4938 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4939 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4940 conditions for the
4941 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4942 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4943
4944 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4945 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4946 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4947 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4948 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4949 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4950
4951 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4952 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4953 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4954 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4955 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4956
4957 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4958 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4959 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4960 with the @code{condition} command.
4961
4962 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4963 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4964 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4965 catchpoint.
4966
4967 @table @code
4968 @kindex condition
4969 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4970 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4971 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4972 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4973 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4974 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4975 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4976 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4977 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4978 prints an error message:
4979
4980 @smallexample
4981 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4982 @end smallexample
4983
4984 @noindent
4985 @value{GDBN} does
4986 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4987 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4988 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4989
4990 @item condition @var{bnum}
4991 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4992 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4993 @end table
4994
4995 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4996 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4997 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4998 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4999 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5000 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5001 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5002 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5003 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5004 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5005 your program reaches it.
5006
5007 @table @code
5008 @kindex ignore
5009 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5010 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5011 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5012 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5013 takes no action.
5014
5015 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5016 a count of zero.
5017
5018 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5019 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5020 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5021 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5022
5023 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5024 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5025 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5026
5027 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5028 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5029 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5030 Variables}.
5031 @end table
5032
5033 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5034
5035
5036 @node Break Commands
5037 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5038
5039 @cindex breakpoint commands
5040 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5041 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5042 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5043 enable other breakpoints.
5044
5045 @table @code
5046 @kindex commands
5047 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5048 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5049 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5050 @itemx end
5051 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5052 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5053 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5054
5055 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5056 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5057
5058 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5059 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5060 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5061 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5062 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5063 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5064 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5065 Expressions}).
5066 @end table
5067
5068 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5069 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5070
5071 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5072 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5073 that resumes execution.
5074
5075 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5076 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5077 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5078 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5079 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5080
5081 @kindex silent
5082 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5083 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5084 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5085 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5086 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5087 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5088
5089 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5090 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5091 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5092
5093 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5094 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5095
5096 @smallexample
5097 break foo if x>0
5098 commands
5099 silent
5100 printf "x is %d\n",x
5101 cont
5102 end
5103 @end smallexample
5104
5105 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5106 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5107 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5108 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5109 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5110 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5111 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5112
5113 @smallexample
5114 break 403
5115 commands
5116 silent
5117 set x = y + 4
5118 cont
5119 end
5120 @end smallexample
5121
5122 @node Dynamic Printf
5123 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5124
5125 @cindex dynamic printf
5126 @cindex dprintf
5127 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5128 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5129 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5130 having to recompile it.
5131
5132 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5133 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5134 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5135 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5136 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5137 redirects to files and so forth.
5138
5139 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5140 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5141 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5142 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5143 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5144 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5145 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5146
5147 @table @code
5148 @kindex dprintf
5149 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5150 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5151 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5152 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5153
5154 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5155 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5156 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5157 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5158 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5159 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5160
5161 @table @code
5162 @item gdb
5163 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5164 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5165
5166 @item call
5167 @kindex dprintf-style call
5168 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5169 @code{printf}).
5170
5171 @item agent
5172 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5173 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5174 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5175 support running commands on the target.
5176 @end table
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5179 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5180 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5181 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5182 command.
5183
5184 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5185 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5186 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5187 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5188 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5189 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5190
5191 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5192 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5193 you could do the following:
5194
5195 @example
5196 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5197 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5198 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5199 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5200 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5201 (gdb) info break
5202 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5203 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5204 continue
5205 (gdb)
5206 @end example
5207
5208 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5209 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5210 the variable settings.
5211
5212 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5213 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5215 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5216 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5217 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5218
5219 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5220 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5221 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5222
5223 @end table
5224
5225 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5226 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5227 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5228 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5229 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5230 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5231
5232 @node Save Breakpoints
5233 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5234
5235 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5236 breakpoints}} command.
5237
5238 @table @code
5239 @kindex save breakpoints
5240 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5241 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5242 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5243 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5244 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5245 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5246 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5247 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5248 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5249 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5250 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5251 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5252 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5253 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5254 that can no longer be recreated.
5255 @end table
5256
5257 @node Static Probe Points
5258 @subsection Static Probe Points
5259
5260 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5261 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5262 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5263 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5264 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5265
5266 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5267 ELF-compatible systems:
5268
5269 @itemize @bullet
5270
5271 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5272 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5273 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5274 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5275 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5276 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5277 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5278 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5279
5280 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5281 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5282 C@t{++} languages.
5283 @end itemize
5284
5285 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5286 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5287 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5288 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5289 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5290 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5291 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5292 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5293 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5294
5295 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5296 probes}, with optional arguments:
5297
5298 @table @code
5299 @kindex info probes
5300 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5301 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5302 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5303 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5304
5305 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5306 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5307 probes from all providers are listed.
5308
5309 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5310 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5311 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5312
5313 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5314 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5315 given, all object files are considered.
5316
5317 @item info probes all
5318 List the available static probes, from all types.
5319 @end table
5320
5321 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5322 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5323 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5324 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5325 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5326
5327 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5328 commands, with optional arguments:
5329
5330 @table @code
5331 @kindex enable probes
5332 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5333 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5334 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5335 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5336
5337 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5338 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5339 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5340
5341 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5342 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5343 given, all object files are considered.
5344
5345 @kindex disable probes
5346 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5347 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5348 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5349 @end table
5350
5351 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5352 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5353 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5354 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5355 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5356 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5357 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5358 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5359 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5360 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5361 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5362 at the current probe point.
5363
5364 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5365 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5366 an error message.
5367
5368
5369 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5370 @node Error in Breakpoints
5371 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5372
5373 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5374 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5375
5376 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5377 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5378 @smallexample
5379 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5380 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5381 @end smallexample
5382
5383 @noindent
5384 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5385 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5386 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5387
5388 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5389 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5390
5391 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5392 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5393 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5394
5395 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5396 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5397 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5398 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5399
5400 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5401 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5402 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5403 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5404 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5405 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5406 first in the bundle.
5407
5408 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5409 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5410 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5411 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5412 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5413 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5414 is hit.
5415
5416 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5417 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5418
5419 @smallexample
5420 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5424 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5425 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5426 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5427 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5428 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5429 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5430 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5431
5432 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5433 adjusted breakpoints:
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5437 to 0x00010410.
5438 @end smallexample
5439
5440 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5441 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5442 frequently than expected.
5443
5444 @node Continuing and Stepping
5445 @section Continuing and Stepping
5446
5447 @cindex stepping
5448 @cindex continuing
5449 @cindex resuming execution
5450 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5451 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5452 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5453 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5454 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5455 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5456 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5457 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5458 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5459 handlers}).)
5460
5461 @table @code
5462 @kindex continue
5463 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5464 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5465 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5466 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5467 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5468 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5469 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5470 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5471 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5472 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5473
5474 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5475 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5476 @code{continue} is ignored.
5477
5478 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5479 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5480 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5481 @code{continue}.
5482 @end table
5483
5484 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5485 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5486 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5487 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5488
5489 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5490 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5491 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5492 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5493 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5494 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5495
5496 @table @code
5497 @kindex step
5498 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5499 @item step
5500 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5501 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5502 abbreviated @code{s}.
5503
5504 @quotation
5505 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5506 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5507 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5508 @c distinction here.
5509 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5510 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5511 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5512 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5513 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5514 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5515 below.
5516 @end quotation
5517
5518 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5519 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5520 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5521 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5522 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5523 called within the line.
5524
5525 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5526 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5527 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5528 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5529 was any debugging information about the routine.
5530
5531 @item step @var{count}
5532 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5533 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5534 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5535
5536 @kindex next
5537 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5538 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5539 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5540 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5541 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5542 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5543 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5544 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5545
5546 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5547
5548
5549 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5550 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5551 @c
5552 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5553 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5554 @c function are executed without stopping.
5555
5556 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5557 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5558 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5559
5560 @kindex set step-mode
5561 @item set step-mode
5562 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5563 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5564 @itemx set step-mode on
5565 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5566 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5567 information rather than stepping over it.
5568
5569 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5570 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5571 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5572
5573 @item set step-mode off
5574 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5575 debug information. This is the default.
5576
5577 @item show step-mode
5578 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5579 source line debug information.
5580
5581 @kindex finish
5582 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5583 @item finish
5584 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5585 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5586 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5587
5588 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5589 ,Returning from a Function}).
5590
5591 @kindex until
5592 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5593 @cindex run until specified location
5594 @item until
5595 @itemx u
5596 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5597 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5598 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5599 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5600 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5601 than the address of the jump.
5602
5603 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5604 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5605 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5606 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5607 through the next iteration.
5608
5609 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5610 stack frame.
5611
5612 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5613 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5614 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5615 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5616 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5617
5618 @smallexample
5619 (@value{GDBP}) f
5620 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5621 206 expand_input();
5622 (@value{GDBP}) until
5623 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5624 @end smallexample
5625
5626 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5627 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5628 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5629 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5630 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5631 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5632 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5633
5634 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5635 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5636 argument.
5637
5638 @item until @var{location}
5639 @itemx u @var{location}
5640 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5641 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5642 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5643 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5644 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5645 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5646 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5647 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5648 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5649 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5650 invocations have returned.
5651
5652 @smallexample
5653 94 int factorial (int value)
5654 95 @{
5655 96 if (value > 1) @{
5656 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5657 98 @}
5658 99 return (value);
5659 100 @}
5660 @end smallexample
5661
5662
5663 @kindex advance @var{location}
5664 @item advance @var{location}
5665 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5666 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5667 @ref{Specify Location}.
5668 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5669 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5670 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5671 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5672
5673
5674 @kindex stepi
5675 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5676 @item stepi
5677 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5678 @itemx si
5679 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5680
5681 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5682 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5683 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5684 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5685
5686 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5687
5688 @need 750
5689 @kindex nexti
5690 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5691 @item nexti
5692 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5693 @itemx ni
5694 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5695 proceed until the function returns.
5696
5697 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5698
5699 @end table
5700
5701 @anchor{range stepping}
5702 @cindex range stepping
5703 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5704 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5705 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5706 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5707 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5708 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5709 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5710 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5711 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5712 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5713 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5714 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5715 if necessary:
5716
5717 @table @code
5718 @kindex set range-stepping
5719 @kindex show range-stepping
5720 @item set range-stepping
5721 @itemx show range-stepping
5722 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5723
5724 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5725 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5726 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5727 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5728 default is @code{on}.
5729
5730 @end table
5731
5732 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5733 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5734 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5735
5736 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5737 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5738 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5739 a particular file when stepping.
5740
5741 For example, consider the following C function:
5742
5743 @smallexample
5744 101 int func()
5745 102 @{
5746 103 foo(boring());
5747 104 bar(boring());
5748 105 @}
5749 @end smallexample
5750
5751 @noindent
5752 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5753 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5754 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5755 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5756
5757 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5758 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5759 is called from many places.
5760
5761 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5762 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5763 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5764 @code{foo}.
5765
5766 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5767 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5768 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5769
5770 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5771 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5772 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5773 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5774 the underlying system.
5775 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5776 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5777
5778 @table @code
5779 @kindex skip
5780 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5781 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5782 that specify what to skip.
5783 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5784
5785 @table @code
5786 @item -file @var{file}
5787 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5788 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5789
5790 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5791 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5792 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5793 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5794 over when stepping.
5795
5796 @smallexample
5797 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5798 @end smallexample
5799
5800 @item -function @var{linespec}
5801 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5802 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5803 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804 @xref{Specify Location}.
5805
5806 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5807 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5808 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5809 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5810
5811 This form is useful for complex function names.
5812 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5813 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5814 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5815 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5816 regular expression makes this easier.
5817
5818 @smallexample
5819 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5820 @end smallexample
5821
5822 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5823 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5827 @end smallexample
5828 @end table
5829
5830 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5831 will be skipped.
5832
5833 @kindex skip function
5834 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5835 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5836 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5837 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5838
5839 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5840 will be skipped.
5841
5842 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5843 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5844
5845 @kindex skip file
5846 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5847 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5848 will be skipped over when stepping.
5849
5850 @smallexample
5851 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5852 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5853 @end smallexample
5854
5855 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5856 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5857 @end table
5858
5859 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5860 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5861
5862 @table @code
5863 @kindex info skip
5864 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5865 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5866 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5867 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5868
5869 @table @emph
5870 @item Identifier
5871 A number identifying this skip.
5872 @item Enabled or Disabled
5873 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5874 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5875 @item Glob
5876 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item File
5879 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5880 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @item RE
5882 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5883 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5884 @item Function
5885 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5886 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5887 @end table
5888
5889 @kindex skip delete
5890 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5891 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5892 skips.
5893
5894 @kindex skip enable
5895 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5896 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5897 skips.
5898
5899 @kindex skip disable
5900 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5901 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5902 skips.
5903
5904 @kindex set debug skip
5905 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5906 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5907
5908 @kindex show debug skip
5909 @item show debug skip
5910 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5911
5912 @end table
5913
5914 @node Signals
5915 @section Signals
5916 @cindex signals
5917
5918 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5919 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5920 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5921 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5922 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5923 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5924 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5925 requested an alarm).
5926
5927 @cindex fatal signals
5928 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5929 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5930 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5931 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5932 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5933 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5934
5935 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5936 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5937 signal.
5938
5939 @cindex handling signals
5940 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5941 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5942 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5943 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5944 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5945
5946 @table @code
5947 @kindex info signals
5948 @kindex info handle
5949 @item info signals
5950 @itemx info handle
5951 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5952 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5953 the defined types of signals.
5954
5955 @item info signals @var{sig}
5956 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5957
5958 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5959
5960 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5961 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5962 for details about this command.
5963
5964 @kindex handle
5965 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5966 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5967 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5968 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5969 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5970 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5971 say what change to make.
5972 @end table
5973
5974 @c @group
5975 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5976 Their full names are:
5977
5978 @table @code
5979 @item nostop
5980 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5981 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5982
5983 @item stop
5984 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5985 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5986
5987 @item print
5988 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5989
5990 @item noprint
5991 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5992 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5993
5994 @item pass
5995 @itemx noignore
5996 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5997 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5998 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5999
6000 @item nopass
6001 @itemx ignore
6002 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6003 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6004 @end table
6005 @c @end group
6006
6007 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6008 program until you
6009 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6010 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6011 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6012 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6013 program sees that signal when you continue.
6014
6015 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6016 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6017 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6018 erroneous signals.
6019
6020 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6021 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6022 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6023 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6024 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6025 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6026 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6027 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6028 Program a Signal}.
6029
6030 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6031 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6032
6033 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6034 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6035 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6036 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6037 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6038 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6039 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6040 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6041 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6042 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6043 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6044 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6045 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6046
6047 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6048
6049 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6050 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6051 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6052 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6053
6054 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6055 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6056 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6057 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6058
6059 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6060 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6061
6062 @smallexample
6063 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6064 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6065 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6066 (@value{GDBP}) c
6067 Continuing.
6068
6069 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6070 main () sigusr1.c:28
6071 28 p = 0;
6072 (@value{GDBP}) si
6073 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6074 9 @{
6075 @end smallexample
6076
6077 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6078 program to receive the signal first:
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 (@value{GDBP}) n
6082 28 p = 0;
6083 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6084 (@value{GDBP}) si
6085 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6086 9 @{
6087 (@value{GDBP})
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 @cindex extra signal information
6091 @anchor{extra signal information}
6092
6093 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6094 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6095 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6096 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6097 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6098 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6099 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6100 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6101 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6102 system header.
6103
6104 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6105 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6106
6107 @smallexample
6108 @group
6109 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6110 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6111 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6112 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6113 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6114 type = struct @{
6115 int si_signo;
6116 int si_errno;
6117 int si_code;
6118 union @{
6119 int _pad[28];
6120 struct @{...@} _kill;
6121 struct @{...@} _timer;
6122 struct @{...@} _rt;
6123 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6124 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6125 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6126 @} _sifields;
6127 @}
6128 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6129 type = struct @{
6130 void *si_addr;
6131 @}
6132 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6133 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6134 @end group
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6138
6139 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6140 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6141 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6142 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6143 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6144 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6145 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6146 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6147 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6148 information is displayed.
6149
6150 The usual output of a segfault is:
6151 @smallexample
6152 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6153 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6154 68 value = *(p + len);
6155 @end smallexample
6156
6157 While a bound violation is presented as:
6158 @smallexample
6159 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6160 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6161 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6162 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6163 68 value = *(p + len);
6164 @end smallexample
6165
6166 @node Thread Stops
6167 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6168
6169 @cindex stopped threads
6170 @cindex threads, stopped
6171
6172 @cindex continuing threads
6173 @cindex threads, continuing
6174
6175 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6176 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6177 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6178 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6179 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6180 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6181 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6182 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6183 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6184
6185 @menu
6186 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6187 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6188 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6189 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6190 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6191 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6192 @end menu
6193
6194 @node All-Stop Mode
6195 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6196
6197 @cindex all-stop mode
6198
6199 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6200 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6201 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6202 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6203 underfoot.
6204
6205 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6206 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6207 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6208
6209 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6210 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6211 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6212 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6213 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6214 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6215 stops.
6216
6217 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6218 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6219 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6220 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6221
6222 @cindex automatic thread selection
6223 @cindex switching threads automatically
6224 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6225 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6226 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6227 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6228 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6229 thread.
6230
6231 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6232 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6233
6234 @table @code
6235 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6236 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6237 @cindex lock scheduler
6238 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6239 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6240 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6241 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6242 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6243 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6244 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6245 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6246 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6247 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6248 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6249 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6250 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6251 @code{on} in replay mode.
6252
6253 @item show scheduler-locking
6254 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6255 @end table
6256
6257 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6258 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6259 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6260 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6261 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6262 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6263 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6264 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6265 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6266 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6267 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6268 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6269 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6270 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6271
6272 @table @code
6273 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6274 @item set schedule-multiple
6275 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6276 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6277 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6278 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6279 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6280 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6281
6282 @item show schedule-multiple
6283 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6284 multiple processes.
6285 @end table
6286
6287 @node Non-Stop Mode
6288 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6289
6290 @cindex non-stop mode
6291
6292 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6293 @c with more details.
6294
6295 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6296 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6297 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6298 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6299 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6300 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6301
6302 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6303 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6304 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6305 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6306 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6307 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6308 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6309 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6310 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6311 independently and simultaneously.
6312
6313 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6314 or attach to your program:
6315
6316 @smallexample
6317 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6318 set pagination off
6319
6320 # Finally, turn it on!
6321 set non-stop on
6322 @end smallexample
6323
6324 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6325
6326 @table @code
6327 @kindex set non-stop
6328 @item set non-stop on
6329 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6330 @item set non-stop off
6331 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6332 @kindex show non-stop
6333 @item show non-stop
6334 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6335 @end table
6336
6337 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6338 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6339 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6340 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6341 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6342 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6343 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6344 default.
6345
6346 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6347 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6348 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6349
6350 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6351 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6352 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6353 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6354 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6355
6356 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6357 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6358 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6359 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6360 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6361
6362 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6363
6364 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6365 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6366 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6367 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6368 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6369 previously current thread.
6370
6371 @node Background Execution
6372 @subsection Background Execution
6373
6374 @cindex foreground execution
6375 @cindex background execution
6376 @cindex asynchronous execution
6377 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6378
6379 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6380 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6381 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6382 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6383 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6384 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6385
6386 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6387 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6388
6389 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6390 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6391 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6392 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6393 are:
6394
6395 @table @code
6396 @kindex run&
6397 @item run
6398 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6399
6400 @item attach
6401 @kindex attach&
6402 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6403
6404 @item step
6405 @kindex step&
6406 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6407
6408 @item stepi
6409 @kindex stepi&
6410 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6411
6412 @item next
6413 @kindex next&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6415
6416 @item nexti
6417 @kindex nexti&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6419
6420 @item continue
6421 @kindex continue&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6423
6424 @item finish
6425 @kindex finish&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6427
6428 @item until
6429 @kindex until&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6431
6432 @end table
6433
6434 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6435 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6436 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6437 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6438 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6439 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6440
6441 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6442 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6443
6444 @table @code
6445 @kindex interrupt
6446 @item interrupt
6447 @itemx interrupt -a
6448
6449 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6450 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6451 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6452 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6453 @end table
6454
6455 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6456 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6457
6458 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6459 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6460 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6461
6462 @table @code
6463 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6464 @cindex thread breakpoints
6465 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6466 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6467 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6468 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6469 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6470 specify some source line.
6471
6472 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6473 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6474 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6475 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6476 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6477
6478 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6479 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6480 program.
6481
6482 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6483 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6484 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6485
6486 @smallexample
6487 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6488 @end smallexample
6489
6490 @end table
6491
6492 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6493 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6494 thread list. For example:
6495
6496 @smallexample
6497 (@value{GDBP}) c
6498 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6499 @end smallexample
6500
6501 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6502 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6503 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6504 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6505 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6506 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6507 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6508 command.
6509
6510 @node Interrupted System Calls
6511 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6512
6513 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6514 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6515 @cindex premature return from system calls
6516 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6517 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6518 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6519 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6520 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6521 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6522 stop execution.
6523
6524 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6525 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6526 style anyways.
6527
6528 For example, do not write code like this:
6529
6530 @smallexample
6531 sleep (10);
6532 @end smallexample
6533
6534 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6535 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6536
6537 Instead, write this:
6538
6539 @smallexample
6540 int unslept = 10;
6541 while (unslept > 0)
6542 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6543 @end smallexample
6544
6545 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6546 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6547 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6548 @value{GDBN}.
6549
6550 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6551 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6552 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6553 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6554
6555 @node Observer Mode
6556 @subsection Observer Mode
6557
6558 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6559 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6560 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6561 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6562 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6563
6564 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6565 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6566 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6567 mode.
6568
6569 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6570 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6571 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6572 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6573 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6574
6575 @table @code
6576
6577 @kindex observer
6578 @item set observer on
6579 @itemx set observer off
6580 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6581 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6582 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6583 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6584
6585 @item show observer
6586 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6587
6588 @kindex may-write-registers
6589 @item set may-write-registers on
6590 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6591 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6592 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6593 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6594
6595 @item show may-write-registers
6596 Show the current permission to write registers.
6597
6598 @kindex may-write-memory
6599 @item set may-write-memory on
6600 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6601 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6602 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6603 defaults to @code{on}.
6604
6605 @item show may-write-memory
6606 Show the current permission to write memory.
6607
6608 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6609 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6610 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6611 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6612 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6613 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6614
6615 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6616 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6617
6618 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6619 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6620 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6621 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6622 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6623 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6624 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6625
6626 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6627 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6628
6629 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6630 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6631 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6632 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6633 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6634 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6635 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6636
6637 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6639
6640 @kindex may-interrupt
6641 @item set may-interrupt on
6642 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6643 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6644 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6645 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6646 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6647
6648 @item show may-interrupt
6649 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6650
6651 @end table
6652
6653 @node Reverse Execution
6654 @chapter Running programs backward
6655 @cindex reverse execution
6656 @cindex running programs backward
6657
6658 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6659 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6660 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6661 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6662
6663 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6664 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6665 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6666 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6667 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6668 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6669
6670 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6671 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6672 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6673 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6674 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6675 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6676 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6677 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6678 prior values@footnote{
6679 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6680 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6681 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6682
6683 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6684 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6685 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6686 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6687 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6688 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6689 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6690 }.
6691
6692 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6693 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6694
6695 @table @code
6696 @kindex reverse-continue
6697 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6698 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6699 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6700 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6701 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6702 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6703 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6704
6705 @kindex reverse-step
6706 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6707 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6708 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6709 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6710
6711 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6712 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6713 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6714 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6715 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6716 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6717
6718 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6719 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6720
6721 @kindex reverse-stepi
6722 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6723 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6724 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6725 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6726 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6727 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6728 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6729
6730 @kindex reverse-next
6731 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6732 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6733 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6734 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6735 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6736 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6737 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6738 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6739 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6740 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6741
6742 @kindex reverse-nexti
6743 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6744 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6745 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6746 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6747 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6748 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6749 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6750 frame) is reached.
6751
6752 @kindex reverse-finish
6753 @item reverse-finish
6754 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6755 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6756 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6757 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6758
6759 @kindex set exec-direction
6760 @item set exec-direction
6761 Set the direction of target execution.
6762 @item set exec-direction reverse
6763 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6764 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6765 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6766 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6767 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6768 @item set exec-direction forward
6769 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6770 This is the default.
6771 @end table
6772
6773
6774 @node Process Record and Replay
6775 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6776 @cindex process record and replay
6777 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6778
6779 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6780 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6781 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6782
6783 @cindex replay mode
6784 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6785 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6786 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6787 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6788 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6789 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6790 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6791 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6792 execution log.
6793
6794 @cindex record mode
6795 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6796 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6797 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6798 for future replay.
6799
6800 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6801 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6802 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6803 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6804 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6805 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6806
6807 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6808 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6809 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6810 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6811
6812 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6813 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6814
6815 @table @code
6816 @kindex target record
6817 @kindex target record-full
6818 @kindex target record-btrace
6819 @kindex record
6820 @kindex record full
6821 @kindex record btrace
6822 @kindex record btrace bts
6823 @kindex record btrace pt
6824 @kindex record bts
6825 @kindex record pt
6826 @kindex rec
6827 @kindex rec full
6828 @kindex rec btrace
6829 @kindex rec btrace bts
6830 @kindex rec btrace pt
6831 @kindex rec bts
6832 @kindex rec pt
6833 @item record @var{method}
6834 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6835 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6836 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6837 recording methods are available:
6838
6839 @table @code
6840 @item full
6841 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6842 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6843 execution.
6844
6845 @item btrace @var{format}
6846 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6847 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6848 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6849 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6850 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6851 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6852 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6853
6854 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6855 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6856 formats are available:
6857
6858 @table @code
6859 @item bts
6860 @cindex branch trace store
6861 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6862 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6863 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6864
6865 @item pt
6866 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6867 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6868 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6869 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6870
6871 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6872 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6873 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6874
6875 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6876 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6877 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6878 buffer-size with care.
6879 @end table
6880
6881 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6882 @end table
6883
6884 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6885 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6886 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6887 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6888
6889 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6890 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6891 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6892 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6893 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6894
6895 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6896 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6897 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6898 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6899 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6900 does not support these two modes.
6901
6902 @kindex record stop
6903 @kindex rec s
6904 @item record stop
6905 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6906 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6907 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6908
6909 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6910 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6911 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6912 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6913 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6914
6915 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6916 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6917 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6918 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6919 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6920
6921 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6922 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6923
6924 @kindex record goto
6925 @item record goto
6926 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6927 ways to specify the location to go to:
6928
6929 @table @code
6930 @item record goto begin
6931 @itemx record goto start
6932 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6933
6934 @item record goto end
6935 Go to the end of the execution log.
6936
6937 @item record goto @var{n}
6938 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6939 @end table
6940
6941 @kindex record save
6942 @item record save @var{filename}
6943 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6944 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6945 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6946
6947 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6948
6949 @kindex record restore
6950 @item record restore @var{filename}
6951 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6952 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6953
6954 @kindex set record full
6955 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6956 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6957 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6958 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6959
6960 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6961 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6962 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6963 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6964 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6965 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6966 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6967 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6968
6969 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6970 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6971 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6972
6973 @kindex show record full
6974 @item show record full insn-number-max
6975 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6976 recording method.
6977
6978 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6979 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6980 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6981 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6982 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6983 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6984 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6985 oldest one to be deleted.
6986
6987 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6988 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6989
6990 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6991 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6992
6993 @item set record full memory-query
6994 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6995 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6996 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6997 case.
6998
6999 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7000 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7001 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7002 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7003 results.
7004
7005 @item show record full memory-query
7006 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7007
7008 @kindex set record btrace
7009 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7010 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7011 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7012 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7013 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7014 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7015 You can use the following command for that:
7016
7017 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7018 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7019 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7020 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7021 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7022 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7023 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7024 position.
7025
7026 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7027 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7028 errata when decoding the trace.
7029
7030 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7031 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7032 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7033 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7034 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7035 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7036 which the trace was recorded.
7037
7038 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7039 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7040 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7041 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7042 disable the workarounds.
7043
7044 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7045 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7046 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7047 (default).
7048
7049 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7050 identifiers are currently supported:
7051
7052 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7053
7054 @item @code{intel}
7055 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7056
7057 @end multitable
7058
7059 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7060 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7061
7062 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7063 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7064 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7065
7066 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7067 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7068 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7069 supports.
7070
7071 @smallexample
7072 (gdb) info record
7073 Active record target: record-btrace
7074 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7075 Buffer size: 16kB.
7076 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7077 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7078 (gdb) info record
7079 Active record target: record-btrace
7080 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7081 Buffer size: 16kB.
7082 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7083 @end smallexample
7084
7085 @kindex show record btrace
7086 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7087 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7088
7089 @item show record btrace cpu
7090 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7091 workarounds.
7092
7093 @kindex set record btrace bts
7094 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7095 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7096 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7097 format. Default is 64KB.
7098
7099 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7100 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7101 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7102 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7103 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7104 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7105 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7106
7107 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7108 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7109
7110 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7111 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7112
7113 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7114 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7115 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7116
7117 @kindex set record btrace pt
7118 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7119 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7120 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7121 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7122
7123 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7124 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7125 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7126 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7127 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7128 actual buffer size for each thread.
7129
7130 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7131 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7132
7133 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7134 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7135
7136 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7137 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7138 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7139
7140 @kindex info record
7141 @item info record
7142 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7143 method:
7144
7145 @table @code
7146 @item full
7147 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7148 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7149
7150 @itemize @bullet
7151 @item
7152 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7153 @item
7154 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7155 @item
7156 Highest recorded instruction number.
7157 @item
7158 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7159 @item
7160 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7161 @item
7162 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7163 @end itemize
7164
7165 @item btrace
7166 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7167
7168 @itemize @bullet
7169 @item
7170 Recording format.
7171 @item
7172 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7173 @item
7174 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7175 instructions.
7176 @item
7177 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7181 @itemize @bullet
7182 @item
7183 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7184 @end itemize
7185
7186 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7187 @itemize @bullet
7188 @item
7189 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7190 @end itemize
7191 @end table
7192
7193 @kindex record delete
7194 @kindex rec del
7195 @item record delete
7196 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7197 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7198 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7199 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7200
7201 @kindex record instruction-history
7202 @kindex rec instruction-history
7203 @item record instruction-history
7204 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7205 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7206 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7207 are printed in execution order.
7208
7209 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7210 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7211 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7212
7213 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7214 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7215 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7216 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7217 @code{/p} modifier.
7218
7219 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7220 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7221 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7222
7223 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7224 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7225
7226 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7227 disassemble:
7228
7229 @table @code
7230 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7231 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7232 @var{insn}.
7233
7234 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7235 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7236 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7237 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7238 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7239 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7240
7241 @item record instruction-history
7242 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7243
7244 @item record instruction-history -
7245 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7246
7247 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7248 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7249 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7250 number @var{end} is included.
7251 @end table
7252
7253 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7254
7255 @kindex set record
7256 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7257 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7258 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7259 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7260 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7261
7262 @kindex show record
7263 @item show record instruction-history-size
7264 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7265 instruction-history} command.
7266
7267 @kindex record function-call-history
7268 @kindex rec function-call-history
7269 @item record function-call-history
7270 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7271 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7272 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7273 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7274 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7275 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7276 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7277 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7278 given together.
7279
7280 @smallexample
7281 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7282 1 void foo (void)
7283 2 @{
7284 3 @}
7285 4
7286 5 void bar (void)
7287 6 @{
7288 7 ...
7289 8 foo ();
7290 9 ...
7291 10 @}
7292 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7293 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7294 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7295 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7299 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7300 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7301 to print:
7302
7303 @table @code
7304 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7305 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7306
7307 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7308 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7309 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7310 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7311 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7312
7313 @item record function-call-history
7314 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7315
7316 @item record function-call-history -
7317 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7318
7319 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7320 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7321 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7322 @end table
7323
7324 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7325
7326 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7327 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7328 Define how many lines to print in the
7329 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7330 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7331
7332 @item show record function-call-history-size
7333 Show how many lines to print in the
7334 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7335 @end table
7336
7337
7338 @node Stack
7339 @chapter Examining the Stack
7340
7341 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7342 stopped and how it got there.
7343
7344 @cindex call stack
7345 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7346 is generated.
7347 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7348 the arguments of the call,
7349 and the local variables of the function being called.
7350 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7351 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7352 stack}.
7353
7354 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7355 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7356
7357 @cindex selected frame
7358 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7359 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7360 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7361 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7362 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7363 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7364
7365 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7366 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7367 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7368
7369 @menu
7370 * Frames:: Stack frames
7371 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7372 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7373 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7374 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7375 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7376
7377 @end menu
7378
7379 @node Frames
7380 @section Stack Frames
7381
7382 @cindex frame, definition
7383 @cindex stack frame
7384 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7385 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7386 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7387 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7388 which the function is executing.
7389
7390 @cindex initial frame
7391 @cindex outermost frame
7392 @cindex innermost frame
7393 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7394 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7395 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7396 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7397 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7398 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7399 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7400 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7401
7402 @cindex frame pointer
7403 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7404 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7405 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7406 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7407 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7408 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7409
7410 @cindex frame level
7411 @cindex frame number
7412 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7413 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7414 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7415 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7416 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7417 describe this number.
7418
7419 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7420 @c underflow problems.
7421 @cindex frameless execution
7422 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7423 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7424 @smallexample
7425 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7426 @end smallexample
7427 generates functions without a frame.)
7428 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7429 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7430 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7431 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7432 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7433 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7434 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7435
7436 @node Backtrace
7437 @section Backtraces
7438
7439 @cindex traceback
7440 @cindex call stack traces
7441 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7442 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7443 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7444 stack.
7445
7446 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7447 @kindex backtrace
7448 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7449 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7450 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7451 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7452 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7453 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7454
7455 @table @code
7456 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7457 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7458 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7459 be one of the following:
7460
7461 @table @code
7462 @item @var{n}
7463 @itemx @var{n}
7464 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7465 number.
7466
7467 @item -@var{n}
7468 @itemx -@var{n}
7469 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7470 number.
7471
7472 @item full
7473 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7474 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7475
7476 @item no-filters
7477 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7478 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7479 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7480 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7481 support.
7482
7483 @item hide
7484 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7485 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7486 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7487 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7488 @end table
7489 @end table
7490
7491 @kindex where
7492 @kindex info stack
7493 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7494 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7495
7496 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7497 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7498 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7499 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7500 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7501 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7502 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7503 multi-threaded program.
7504
7505 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7506 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7507 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7508 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7509 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7510 line number.
7511
7512 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7513 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7514
7515 @smallexample
7516 @group
7517 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7518 at builtin.c:993
7519 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7520 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7521 at macro.c:71
7522 (More stack frames follow...)
7523 @end group
7524 @end smallexample
7525
7526 @noindent
7527 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7528 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7529 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7530
7531 @noindent
7532 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7533 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7534 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7535 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7536 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7537
7538 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7539 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7540 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7541 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7542 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7543 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7544 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7545 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7546 such a backtrace might look like:
7547
7548 @smallexample
7549 @group
7550 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7551 at builtin.c:993
7552 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7553 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7554 at macro.c:71
7555 (More stack frames follow...)
7556 @end group
7557 @end smallexample
7558
7559 @noindent
7560 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7561 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7562
7563 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7564 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7565 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7566
7567 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7568 @cindex program entry point
7569 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7570 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7571 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7572 @code{main}@footnote{
7573 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7574 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7575 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7576 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7577 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7578 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7579
7580 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7581 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7582
7583 @table @code
7584 @item set backtrace past-main
7585 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7586 @kindex set backtrace
7587 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7588
7589 @item set backtrace past-main off
7590 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7591 default.
7592
7593 @item show backtrace past-main
7594 @kindex show backtrace
7595 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-entry
7598 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7599 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7600 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7601 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7602
7603 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7604 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7605 application. This is the default.
7606
7607 @item show backtrace past-entry
7608 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7609
7610 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7611 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7612 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7613 @cindex backtrace limit
7614 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7615 or zero means unlimited levels.
7616
7617 @item show backtrace limit
7618 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7619 @end table
7620
7621 You can control how file names are displayed.
7622
7623 @table @code
7624 @item set filename-display
7625 @itemx set filename-display relative
7626 @cindex filename-display
7627 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7628
7629 @item set filename-display basename
7630 Display only basename of a filename.
7631
7632 @item set filename-display absolute
7633 Display an absolute filename.
7634
7635 @item show filename-display
7636 Show the current way to display filenames.
7637 @end table
7638
7639 @node Selection
7640 @section Selecting a Frame
7641
7642 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7643 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7644 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7645 of the stack frame just selected.
7646
7647 @table @code
7648 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7649 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7650 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7651 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7652 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7653 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7654
7655 @table @code
7656 @kindex frame level
7657 @item @var{num}
7658 @item level @var{num}
7659 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7660 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7661 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7662 for @code{main}.
7663
7664 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7665 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7666 commands are equivalent:
7667
7668 @smallexample
7669 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7670 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7671 @end smallexample
7672
7673 @kindex frame address
7674 @item address @var{stack-address}
7675 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7676 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7677 @command{info frame}, for example:
7678
7679 @smallexample
7680 (gdb) info frame
7681 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7682 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7683 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7684 source language c++.
7685 Arglist at unknown address.
7686 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7687 @end smallexample
7688
7689 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7690 indicated by the line:
7691
7692 @smallexample
7693 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7694 @end smallexample
7695
7696 @kindex frame function
7697 @item function @var{function-name}
7698 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7699 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7700 most stack frame is selected.
7701
7702 @kindex frame view
7703 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7704 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7705 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7706 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7707
7708 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7709 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7710 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7711 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7712
7713 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7714 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7715 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7716 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7717
7718 @end table
7719
7720 @kindex up
7721 @item up @var{n}
7722 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7723 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7724 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7725
7726 @kindex down
7727 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7728 @item down @var{n}
7729 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7730 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7731 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7732 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7733 @end table
7734
7735 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7736 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7737 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7738 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7739
7740 @need 1000
7741 For example:
7742
7743 @smallexample
7744 @group
7745 (@value{GDBP}) up
7746 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7747 at env.c:10
7748 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7749 @end group
7750 @end smallexample
7751
7752 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7753 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7754 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7755 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7756 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7757 for details.
7758
7759 @table @code
7760 @kindex select-frame
7761 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7762 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7763 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7764 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7765 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7766 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7767 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7768
7769 @kindex down-silently
7770 @kindex up-silently
7771 @item up-silently @var{n}
7772 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7773 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7774 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7775 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7776 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7777 distracting.
7778 @end table
7779
7780 @node Frame Info
7781 @section Information About a Frame
7782
7783 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7784 stack frame.
7785
7786 @table @code
7787 @item frame
7788 @itemx f
7789 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7790 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7791 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7792 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7793 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7794
7795 @kindex info frame
7796 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7797 @item info frame
7798 @itemx info f
7799 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7800 including:
7801
7802 @itemize @bullet
7803 @item
7804 the address of the frame
7805 @item
7806 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7807 @item
7808 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7809 @item
7810 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7811 @item
7812 the address of the frame's arguments
7813 @item
7814 the address of the frame's local variables
7815 @item
7816 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7817 @item
7818 which registers were saved in the frame
7819 @end itemize
7820
7821 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7822 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7823 the usual conventions.
7824
7825 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7826 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7827 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7828 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7829 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7830 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7831
7832 @kindex info args
7833 @item info args
7834 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7835
7836 @item info locals
7837 @kindex info locals
7838 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7839 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7840 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7841
7842 @end table
7843
7844 @node Frame Apply
7845 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7846 @kindex frame apply
7847 @cindex apply command to several frames
7848 @table @code
7849 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7850 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7851 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7852
7853 @table @code
7854 @item @code{all}
7855 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7856
7857 @item @var{count}
7858 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7859 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7860
7861 @item @var{-count}
7862 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7863 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7864
7865 @item @code{level}
7866 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7867 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7868 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7869 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7870 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7871 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7872
7873 @end table
7874
7875 @end table
7876
7877 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7878 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7879 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7880 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7881
7882 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7883 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7884 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7885 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7886 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7887
7888 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7889 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7890 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7891 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7892
7893 @table @code
7894 @item -c
7895 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7896 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7897 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7898 @item -s
7899 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7900 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7901 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7902 are not printed.
7903 @item -q
7904 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7905 information.
7906 @end table
7907
7908 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7909 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7910 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7911 @code{#1 main} frame.
7912
7913 @smallexample
7914 @group
7915 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7916 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7917 No symbol "j" in current context.
7918 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7919 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7920 No symbol "j" in current context.
7921 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7922 $1 = 5
7923 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7924 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7925 $2 = 5
7926 (gdb)
7927 @end group
7928 @end smallexample
7929
7930 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7931 information before the command output:
7932
7933 @smallexample
7934 @group
7935 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7936 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7937 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7938 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7939 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7940 (gdb)
7941 @end group
7942 @end smallexample
7943
7944 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
7945 @smallexample
7946 @group
7947 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
7948 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7949 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7950 (gdb)
7951 @end group
7952 @end smallexample
7953
7954 @table @code
7955
7956 @kindex faas
7957 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
7958 @item faas @var{command}
7959 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
7960 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
7961
7962 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
7963 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
7964 is, using:
7965 @smallexample
7966 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
7967 @end smallexample
7968
7969 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
7970 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
7971 @end table
7972
7973
7974 @node Frame Filter Management
7975 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7976 @cindex managing frame filters
7977
7978 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7979 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7980
7981 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7982 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7983
7984 @table @code
7985 @kindex info frame-filter
7986 @item info frame-filter
7987 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7988 their name, priority and enabled status.
7989
7990 @kindex disable frame-filter
7991 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7992 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7993 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7994 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7995 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7996 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7997 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7998 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7999 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8000 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8001 may be enabled again later.
8002
8003 @kindex enable frame-filter
8004 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8005 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8006 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8007 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8008 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8009 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8010 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8011 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8012 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8013
8014 Example:
8015
8016 @smallexample
8017 (gdb) info frame-filter
8018
8019 global frame-filters:
8020 Priority Enabled Name
8021 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8022 100 Yes Reverse
8023
8024 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8025 Priority Enabled Name
8026 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8027
8028 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8029 Priority Enabled Name
8030 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8031
8032 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8033 (gdb) info frame-filter
8034
8035 global frame-filters:
8036 Priority Enabled Name
8037 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8038 100 Yes Reverse
8039
8040 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8041 Priority Enabled Name
8042 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8043
8044 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8045 Priority Enabled Name
8046 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8047
8048 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8049 (gdb) info frame-filter
8050
8051 global frame-filters:
8052 Priority Enabled Name
8053 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8054 100 Yes Reverse
8055
8056 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8057 Priority Enabled Name
8058 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8059
8060 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8061 Priority Enabled Name
8062 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8063 @end smallexample
8064
8065 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8066 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8067 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8068 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8069 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8070 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8071 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8072
8073 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8074 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8075 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8076 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8077 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8078 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8079 dictionary resides.
8080
8081 Example:
8082
8083 @smallexample
8084 (gdb) info frame-filter
8085
8086 global frame-filters:
8087 Priority Enabled Name
8088 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8089 100 Yes Reverse
8090
8091 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8092 Priority Enabled Name
8093 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8094
8095 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8096 Priority Enabled Name
8097 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8098
8099 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8100 (gdb) info frame-filter
8101
8102 global frame-filters:
8103 Priority Enabled Name
8104 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8105 50 Yes Reverse
8106
8107 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8108 Priority Enabled Name
8109 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8110
8111 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8112 Priority Enabled Name
8113 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8114 @end smallexample
8115 @end table
8116
8117 @node Source
8118 @chapter Examining Source Files
8119
8120 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8121 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8122 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8123 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8124 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8125 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8126 source files by explicit command.
8127
8128 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8129 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8130 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8131
8132 @menu
8133 * List:: Printing source lines
8134 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8135 * Edit:: Editing source files
8136 * Search:: Searching source files
8137 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8138 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8139 @end menu
8140
8141 @node List
8142 @section Printing Source Lines
8143
8144 @kindex list
8145 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8146 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8147 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8148 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8149 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8150
8151 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8152
8153 @table @code
8154 @item list @var{linenum}
8155 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8156 current source file.
8157
8158 @item list @var{function}
8159 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8160 @var{function}.
8161
8162 @item list
8163 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8164 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8165 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8166 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8167 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8168
8169 @item list -
8170 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8171 @end table
8172
8173 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8174 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8175 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8176
8177 @table @code
8178 @kindex set listsize
8179 @item set listsize @var{count}
8180 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8181 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8182 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8183 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8184
8185 @kindex show listsize
8186 @item show listsize
8187 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8188 @end table
8189
8190 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8191 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8192 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8193 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8194 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8195
8196 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8197 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8198 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8199 to specify some source line.
8200
8201 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8202
8203 @table @code
8204 @item list @var{location}
8205 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8206
8207 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8208 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8209 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8210 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8211 the same source file as the first location.
8212
8213 @item list ,@var{last}
8214 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8215
8216 @item list @var{first},
8217 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8218
8219 @item list +
8220 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8221
8222 @item list -
8223 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8224
8225 @item list
8226 As described in the preceding table.
8227 @end table
8228
8229 @node Specify Location
8230 @section Specifying a Location
8231 @cindex specifying location
8232 @cindex location
8233 @cindex source location
8234
8235 @menu
8236 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8237 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8238 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8239 @end menu
8240
8241 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8242 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8243 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8244 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8245 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8246
8247 @node Linespec Locations
8248 @subsection Linespec Locations
8249 @cindex linespec locations
8250
8251 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8252 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8253 specifying a linespec:
8254
8255 @table @code
8256 @item @var{linenum}
8257 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8258
8259 @item -@var{offset}
8260 @itemx +@var{offset}
8261 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8262 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8263 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8264 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8265 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8266 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8267 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8268 linespec.
8269
8270 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8271 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8272 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8273 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8274 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8275 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8276 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8277
8278 @item @var{function}
8279 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8280 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8281
8282 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8283 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8284 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8285 means in all packages.
8286
8287 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8288 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8289 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8290
8291 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8292 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8293 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8294 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8295
8296 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8297
8298 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8299 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8300
8301 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8302 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8303 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8304 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8305 functions in different source files.
8306
8307 @item @var{label}
8308 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8309 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8310 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8311 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8312
8313 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8314 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8315 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8316 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8317 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8318 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8319
8320 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8321 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8322 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8323 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8324 each one of those probes.
8325 @end table
8326
8327 @node Explicit Locations
8328 @subsection Explicit Locations
8329 @cindex explicit locations
8330
8331 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8332 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8333
8334 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8335 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8336 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8337 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8338 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8339
8340 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8341 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8342 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8343 the symbol table to know.
8344
8345 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8346 following table:
8347
8348 @table @code
8349 @item -source @var{filename}
8350 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8351 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8352 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8353 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8354 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8355
8356 @item -function @var{function}
8357 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8358 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8359 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8360 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8361
8362 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8363 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8364 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8365 means in all packages.
8366
8367 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8368 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8369 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8370 breakpoint on both symbols.
8371
8372 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8373
8374 @item -qualified
8375
8376 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8377 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8378
8379 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8380 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8381 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8382
8383 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8384 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8385 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8386
8387 @item -label @var{label}
8388 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8389 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8390 selected stack frame.
8391
8392 @item -line @var{number}
8393 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8394 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8395 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8396 relative to the current line.
8397 @end table
8398
8399 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8400 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8401
8402 @node Address Locations
8403 @subsection Address Locations
8404 @cindex address locations
8405
8406 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8407 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8408
8409 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8410 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8411 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8412 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8413 source files.
8414
8415 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8416 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8417 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8418 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8419 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8420 of @var{address}:
8421
8422 @table @code
8423 @item @var{expression}
8424 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8425
8426 @item @var{funcaddr}
8427 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8428 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8429 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8430 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8431 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8432 (although the Pascal form also works).
8433
8434 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8435 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8436
8437 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8438 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8439 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8440 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8441 functions with identical names in different source files.
8442 @end table
8443
8444 @node Edit
8445 @section Editing Source Files
8446 @cindex editing source files
8447
8448 @kindex edit
8449 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8450 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8451 The editing program of your choice
8452 is invoked with the current line set to
8453 the active line in the program.
8454 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8455 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8456
8457 @table @code
8458 @item edit @var{location}
8459 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8460 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8461 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8462 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8463 command most commonly used:
8464
8465 @table @code
8466 @item edit @var{number}
8467 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8468
8469 @item edit @var{function}
8470 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8471 @end table
8472
8473 @end table
8474
8475 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8476 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8477 @footnote{
8478 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8479 following command-line syntax:
8480 @smallexample
8481 ex +@var{number} file
8482 @end smallexample
8483 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8484 the file where to start editing.}.
8485 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8486 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8487 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8488 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8489 @smallexample
8490 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8491 export EDITOR
8492 gdb @dots{}
8493 @end smallexample
8494 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8495 @smallexample
8496 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8497 gdb @dots{}
8498 @end smallexample
8499
8500 @node Search
8501 @section Searching Source Files
8502 @cindex searching source files
8503
8504 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8505 regular expression.
8506
8507 @table @code
8508 @kindex search
8509 @kindex forward-search
8510 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8511 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8512 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8513 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8514 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8515 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8516 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8517 @code{fo}.
8518
8519 @kindex reverse-search
8520 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8521 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8522 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8523 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8524 this command as @code{rev}.
8525 @end table
8526
8527 @node Source Path
8528 @section Specifying Source Directories
8529
8530 @cindex source path
8531 @cindex directories for source files
8532 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8533 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8534 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8535 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8536 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8537 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8538 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8539
8540 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8541 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8542 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8543 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8544 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8545 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8546 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8547 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8548 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8549 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8550 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8551
8552 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8553 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8554 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8555 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8556 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8557 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8558
8559 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8560 source files.
8561
8562 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8563 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8564 each line is in the file.
8565
8566 @kindex directory
8567 @kindex dir
8568 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8569 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8570 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8571
8572 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8573 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8574
8575 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8576 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8577 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8578 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8579 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8580 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8581 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8582 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8583 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8584 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8585 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8586 name to look up the sources.
8587
8588 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8589 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8590 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8591 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8592 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8593 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8594 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8595 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8596
8597 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8598 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8599 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8600 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8601 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8602 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8603 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8604
8605 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8606 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8607 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8608 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8609 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8610 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8611 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8612 command.
8613
8614 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8615 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8616 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8617 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8618 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8619 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8620 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8621
8622 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8623 @cindex default source path substitution
8624 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8625 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8626 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8627 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8628 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8629 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8630 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8631 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8632 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8633 together.
8634
8635 @table @code
8636 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8637 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8638 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8639 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8640 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8641 part of absolute file names) or
8642 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8643 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8644
8645 @kindex cdir
8646 @kindex cwd
8647 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8648 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8649 @cindex compilation directory
8650 @cindex current directory
8651 @cindex working directory
8652 @cindex directory, current
8653 @cindex directory, compilation
8654 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8655 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8656 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8657 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8658 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8659 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8660
8661 @item directory
8662 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8663
8664 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8665 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8666
8667 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8668 @kindex set directories
8669 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8670 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8671
8672 @item show directories
8673 @kindex show directories
8674 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8675
8676 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8677 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8678 @kindex set substitute-path
8679 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8680 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8681 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8682
8683 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8684 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8688 @end smallexample
8689
8690 @noindent
8691 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8692 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8693 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8694
8695 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8696 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8697 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8698 the substitution.
8699
8700 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8701
8702 @smallexample
8703 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8704 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8705 @end smallexample
8706
8707 @noindent
8708 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8709 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8710 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8711 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8712
8713
8714 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8715 @kindex unset substitute-path
8716 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8717 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8718 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8719
8720 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8721
8722 @item show substitute-path [path]
8723 @kindex show substitute-path
8724 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8725 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8726
8727 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8728 rules.
8729
8730 @end table
8731
8732 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8733 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8734 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8735
8736 @enumerate
8737 @item
8738 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8739
8740 @item
8741 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8742 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8743 directories in one command.
8744 @end enumerate
8745
8746 @node Machine Code
8747 @section Source and Machine Code
8748 @cindex source line and its code address
8749
8750 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8751 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8752 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8753 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8754 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8755 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8756 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8757 well as hex.
8758
8759 @table @code
8760 @kindex info line
8761 @item info line
8762 @itemx info line @var{location}
8763 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8764 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8765 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8766 information about the current source line is printed.
8767 @end table
8768
8769 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8770 the object code for the first line of function
8771 @code{m4_changequote}:
8772
8773 @smallexample
8774 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8775 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8776 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8777 @end smallexample
8778
8779 @noindent
8780 @cindex code address and its source line
8781 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8782 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8783 @smallexample
8784 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8785 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8786 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8787 @end smallexample
8788
8789 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8790 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8791 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8792 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8793 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8794 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8795 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8796 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8797 Variables}).
8798
8799 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8800 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8801 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8802 line.
8803
8804 @table @code
8805 @kindex disassemble
8806 @cindex assembly instructions
8807 @cindex instructions, assembly
8808 @cindex machine instructions
8809 @cindex listing machine instructions
8810 @item disassemble
8811 @itemx disassemble /m
8812 @itemx disassemble /s
8813 @itemx disassemble /r
8814 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8815 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8816 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8817 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8818 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8819 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8820 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8821 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8822 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8823 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8824
8825 @table @code
8826 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8827 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8828 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8829 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8830 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8831 @end table
8832
8833 @noindent
8834 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8835 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8836
8837 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8838 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8839
8840 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8841 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8842 @end table
8843
8844 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8845 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8846
8847 @smallexample
8848 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8849 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8850 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8851 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8852 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8853 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8854 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8855 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8856 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8857 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8858 End of assembler dump.
8859 @end smallexample
8860
8861 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8862 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8863 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8864
8865 @smallexample
8866 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8867 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8868 5 @{
8869 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8870 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8871 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8872 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8873 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8874
8875 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8876 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8877 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8878
8879 7 return 0;
8880 8 @}
8881 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8882 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8883 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8884
8885 End of assembler dump.
8886 @end smallexample
8887
8888 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8889 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8890 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8891 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8892 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8893 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8894 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8895 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8896 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8897
8898 @file{foo.h}:
8899
8900 @smallexample
8901 int
8902 foo (int a)
8903 @{
8904 if (a < 0)
8905 return a * 2;
8906 if (a == 0)
8907 return 1;
8908 return a + 10;
8909 @}
8910 @end smallexample
8911
8912 @file{foo.c}:
8913
8914 @smallexample
8915 #include "foo.h"
8916 volatile int x, y;
8917 int
8918 main ()
8919 @{
8920 x = foo (y);
8921 return 0;
8922 @}
8923 @end smallexample
8924
8925 @smallexample
8926 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8927 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8928 5 @{
8929
8930 6 x = foo (y);
8931 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8932 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8933
8934 7 return 0;
8935 8 @}
8936 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8937 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8938 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8939 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8940
8941 End of assembler dump.
8942 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8943 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8944 foo.c:
8945 5 @{
8946 6 x = foo (y);
8947 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8948
8949 foo.h:
8950 4 if (a < 0)
8951 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8952 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8953
8954 6 if (a == 0)
8955 7 return 1;
8956 8 return a + 10;
8957 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8958 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8959 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8960 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8961
8962 foo.c:
8963 6 x = foo (y);
8964 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8965
8966 7 return 0;
8967 8 @}
8968 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8969 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8970
8971 foo.h:
8972 5 return a * 2;
8973 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8974 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8975 End of assembler dump.
8976 @end smallexample
8977
8978 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8979
8980 @smallexample
8981 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8982 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8983 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8984 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8985 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8986 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8987 End of assembler dump.
8988 @end smallexample
8989
8990 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8991 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8992 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8993 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8994
8995 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8996 mnemonics or other syntax.
8997
8998 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8999 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9000 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9001 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9002 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9003
9004 @table @code
9005 @kindex set disassembler-options
9006 @cindex disassembler options
9007 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9008 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9009 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9010 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9011 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9012 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9013 The default value is the empty string.
9014
9015 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9016 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9017 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9018 and S/390.
9019
9020 @kindex show disassembler-options
9021 @item show disassembler-options
9022 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9023 @end table
9024
9025 @table @code
9026 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9027 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9028 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9029 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9030 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9031 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9032
9033 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9034 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9035 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9036 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9037
9038 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9039 @item show disassembly-flavor
9040 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9041 @end table
9042
9043 @table @code
9044 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9045 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9046 @item set disassemble-next-line
9047 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9048 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9049 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9050 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9051 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9052 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9053 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9054 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9055 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9056 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9057 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9058 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9059 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9060 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9061 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9062 instruction.
9063 @end table
9064
9065
9066 @node Data
9067 @chapter Examining Data
9068
9069 @cindex printing data
9070 @cindex examining data
9071 @kindex print
9072 @kindex inspect
9073 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9074 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9075 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9076 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9077 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9078 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9079
9080 @table @code
9081 @item print @var{expr}
9082 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9083 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9084 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9085 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9086 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9087 Formats}.
9088
9089 @item print
9090 @itemx print /@var{f}
9091 @cindex reprint the last value
9092 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9093 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9094 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9095 @end table
9096
9097 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9098 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9099 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9100
9101 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9102 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9103 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9104 Table}.
9105
9106 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9107 @kindex explore
9108 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9109 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9110 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9111 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9112 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9113 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9114 embedded in the higher level data types.
9115
9116 @table @code
9117 @item explore @var{arg}
9118 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9119 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9120 @end table
9121
9122 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9123 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9124 C program as
9125
9126 @smallexample
9127 struct SimpleStruct
9128 @{
9129 int i;
9130 double d;
9131 @};
9132
9133 struct ComplexStruct
9134 @{
9135 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9136 int arr[10];
9137 @};
9138 @end smallexample
9139
9140 @noindent
9141 followed by variable declarations as
9142
9143 @smallexample
9144 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9145 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9146 @end smallexample
9147
9148 @noindent
9149 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9150 @code{explore} command as follows.
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 (gdb) explore cs
9154 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9155 the following fields:
9156
9157 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9158 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9159
9160 Enter the field number of choice:
9161 @end smallexample
9162
9163 @noindent
9164 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9165 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9166 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9167 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9168 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9169 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9170 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9171 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9172
9173 @smallexample
9174 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9175 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9176 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9177 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9178
9179 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9180 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9181
9182 Press enter to return to parent value:
9183 @end smallexample
9184
9185 @noindent
9186 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9187 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9188 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9189 to explore.
9190
9191 @smallexample
9192 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9193 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9194
9195 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9196
9197 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9198
9199 Press enter to return to parent value:
9200 @end smallexample
9201
9202 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9203 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9204 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9205 level data structure).
9206
9207 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9208 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9209 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9210 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9211 same example as above, your can explore the type
9212 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9213 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9214
9215 @smallexample
9216 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9217 @end smallexample
9218
9219 @noindent
9220 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9221 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9222 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9223 example.
9224
9225 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9226 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9227 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9228 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9229 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9230
9231 @table @code
9232 @item explore value @var{expr}
9233 @cindex explore value
9234 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9235 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9236 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9237 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9238 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9239
9240 @item explore type @var{arg}
9241 @cindex explore type
9242 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9243 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9244 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9245 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9246 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9247 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9248 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9249 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9250 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9251 @end table
9252
9253 @menu
9254 * Expressions:: Expressions
9255 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9256 * Variables:: Program variables
9257 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9258 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9259 * Memory:: Examining memory
9260 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9261 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9262 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9263 * Value History:: Value history
9264 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9265 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9266 * Registers:: Registers
9267 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9268 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9269 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9270 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9271 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9272 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9273 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9274 character set than GDB does
9275 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9276 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9277 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9278 @end menu
9279
9280 @node Expressions
9281 @section Expressions
9282
9283 @cindex expressions
9284 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9285 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9286 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9287 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9288 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9289 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9290 @ref{Compilation}.
9291
9292 @cindex arrays in expressions
9293 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9294 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9295 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9296 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9297 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9298 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9299
9300 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9301 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9302 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9303 languages.
9304
9305 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9306 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9307
9308 @cindex casts, in expressions
9309 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9310 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9311 at that address in memory.
9312 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9313
9314 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9315 to programming languages:
9316
9317 @table @code
9318 @item @@
9319 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9320 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9321
9322 @item ::
9323 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9324 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9325
9326 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9327 @cindex type casting memory
9328 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9329 @cindex casts, to view memory
9330 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9331 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9332 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9333 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9334 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9335 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9336 @end table
9337
9338 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9339 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9340 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9341
9342 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9343 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9344 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9345 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9346 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9347 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9348 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9349
9350 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9351 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9352 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9353 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9354 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9355 as well.
9356
9357 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9358 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9359 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9360 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9361 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9362 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9363 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9364 choices.
9365
9366 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9367 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9368 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9369
9370 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9371 @smallexample
9372 @group
9373 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9374 [0] cancel
9375 [1] all
9376 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9377 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9378 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9379 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9380 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9381 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9382 > 2 4 6
9383 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9384 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9385 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9386 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9387 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9388 breakpoints.
9389 (@value{GDBP})
9390 @end group
9391 @end smallexample
9392
9393 @table @code
9394 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9395 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9396 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9397
9398 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9399 is ambiguous.
9400
9401 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9402 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9403 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9404 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9405 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9406 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9407 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9408 in the use of the menu.
9409
9410 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9411 when an ambiguity is detected.
9412
9413 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9414 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9415
9416 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9417 @item show multiple-symbols
9418 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9419 @end table
9420
9421 @node Variables
9422 @section Program Variables
9423
9424 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9425 in your program.
9426
9427 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9428 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9429
9430 @itemize @bullet
9431 @item
9432 global (or file-static)
9433 @end itemize
9434
9435 @noindent or
9436
9437 @itemize @bullet
9438 @item
9439 visible according to the scope rules of the
9440 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9441 @end itemize
9442
9443 @noindent This means that in the function
9444
9445 @smallexample
9446 foo (a)
9447 int a;
9448 @{
9449 bar (a);
9450 @{
9451 int b = test ();
9452 bar (b);
9453 @}
9454 @}
9455 @end smallexample
9456
9457 @noindent
9458 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9459 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9460 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9461 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9462
9463 @cindex variable name conflict
9464 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9465 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9466 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9467 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9468 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9469 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9470 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9471
9472 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9473 @ifnotinfo
9474 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9475 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9476 @end ifnotinfo
9477 @smallexample
9478 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9479 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9480 @end smallexample
9481
9482 @noindent
9483 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9484 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9485 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9486 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9487
9488 @smallexample
9489 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9493 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9494 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9495 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9496 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9497
9498 @smallexample
9499 void
9500 foo (int a)
9501 @{
9502 if (a < 10)
9503 bar (a);
9504 else
9505 process (a); /* Stop here */
9506 @}
9507
9508 int
9509 bar (int a)
9510 @{
9511 foo (a + 5);
9512 @}
9513 @end smallexample
9514
9515 @noindent
9516 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9517 here is what you might see
9518 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9519
9520 @smallexample
9521 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9522 $1 = 10
9523 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9524 $2 = 5
9525 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9526 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9527 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9528 $3 = 5
9529 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9530 $4 = 0
9531 @end smallexample
9532
9533 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9534 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9535 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9536 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9537 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9538
9539 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9540 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9541 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9542 @code{some_global}.
9543
9544 @smallexample
9545 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9546 $1 = 23
9547 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9548 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9549 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9550 $2 = 27
9551 @end smallexample
9552
9553 @cindex wrong values
9554 @cindex variable values, wrong
9555 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9556 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9557 @quotation
9558 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9559 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9560 scope, and just before exit.
9561 @end quotation
9562 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9563 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9564 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9565 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9566 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9567 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9568 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9569 variable definitions may be gone.
9570
9571 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9572 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9573 when compiling.
9574
9575 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9576 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9577 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9578 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9579 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9580 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9581 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9582
9583 @smallexample
9584 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9585 @end smallexample
9586
9587 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9588 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9589 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9590 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9591 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9592
9593 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9594 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9595 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9596 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9597
9598 @cindex no debug info variables
9599 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9600 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9601 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9602 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9603 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9604 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9605 example, in a C program:
9606
9607 @smallexample
9608 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9609 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9610 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9611 $1 = 3.14
9612 @end smallexample
9613
9614 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9615 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9616 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9617 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9618 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9619
9620 @smallexample
9621 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9622 29 i++;
9623 (gdb) next
9624 30 e (i);
9625 (gdb) print i
9626 $1 = 31
9627 (gdb) print i@@entry
9628 $2 = 30
9629 @end smallexample
9630
9631 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9632 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9633 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9634 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9635 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9636 For program code
9637
9638 @smallexample
9639 char var0[] = "A";
9640 signed char var1[] = "A";
9641 @end smallexample
9642
9643 You get during debugging
9644 @smallexample
9645 (gdb) print var0
9646 $1 = "A"
9647 (gdb) print var1
9648 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9649 @end smallexample
9650
9651 @node Arrays
9652 @section Artificial Arrays
9653
9654 @cindex artificial array
9655 @cindex arrays
9656 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9657 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9658 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9659 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9660 program.
9661
9662 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9663 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9664 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9665 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9666 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9667 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9668 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9669 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9670 example. If a program says
9671
9672 @smallexample
9673 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9674 @end smallexample
9675
9676 @noindent
9677 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9678
9679 @smallexample
9680 p *array@@len
9681 @end smallexample
9682
9683 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9684 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9685 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9686 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9687 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9688
9689 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9690 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9691 The value need not be in memory:
9692 @smallexample
9693 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9694 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9695 @end smallexample
9696
9697 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9698 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9699 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9700 @smallexample
9701 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9702 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9703 @end smallexample
9704
9705 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9706 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9707 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9708 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9709 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9710 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9711 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9712 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9713 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9714 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9715
9716 @smallexample
9717 set $i = 0
9718 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9719 @key{RET}
9720 @key{RET}
9721 @dots{}
9722 @end smallexample
9723
9724 @node Output Formats
9725 @section Output Formats
9726
9727 @cindex formatted output
9728 @cindex output formats
9729 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9730 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9731 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9732 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9733 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9734
9735 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9736 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9737 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9738 letters supported are:
9739
9740 @table @code
9741 @item x
9742 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9743 hexadecimal.
9744
9745 @item d
9746 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9747
9748 @item u
9749 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9750
9751 @item o
9752 Print as integer in octal.
9753
9754 @item t
9755 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9756 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9757 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9758 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9759
9760 @item a
9761 @cindex unknown address, locating
9762 @cindex locate address
9763 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9764 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9765 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9766
9767 @smallexample
9768 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9769 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9770 @end smallexample
9771
9772 @noindent
9773 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9774 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9775
9776 @item c
9777 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9778 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9779 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9780 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9781
9782 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9783 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9784 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9785 data.
9786
9787 @item f
9788 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9789 using typical floating point syntax.
9790
9791 @item s
9792 @cindex printing strings
9793 @cindex printing byte arrays
9794 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9795 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9796 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9797 natural types.
9798
9799 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9800 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9801 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9802 array.
9803
9804 @item z
9805 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9806 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9807 to the size of the integer type.
9808
9809 @item r
9810 @cindex raw printing
9811 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9812 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9813 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9814 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9815 pretty-printer which might exist.
9816 @end table
9817
9818 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9819
9820 @smallexample
9821 p/x $pc
9822 @end smallexample
9823
9824 @noindent
9825 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9826 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9827
9828 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9829 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9830 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9831
9832 @node Memory
9833 @section Examining Memory
9834
9835 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9836 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9837
9838 @cindex examining memory
9839 @table @code
9840 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9841 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9842 @itemx x @var{addr}
9843 @itemx x
9844 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9845 @end table
9846
9847 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9848 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9849 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9850 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9851 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9852
9853 @table @r
9854 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9855 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9856 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9857 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9858 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9859 @c 4.1.2.
9860
9861 @item @var{f}, the display format
9862 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9863 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9864 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9865 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9866 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9867
9868 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9869 The unit size is any of
9870
9871 @table @code
9872 @item b
9873 Bytes.
9874 @item h
9875 Halfwords (two bytes).
9876 @item w
9877 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9878 @item g
9879 Giant words (eight bytes).
9880 @end table
9881
9882 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9883 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9884 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9885 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9886 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9887 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9888 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9889 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9890 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9891 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9892 be altered.
9893
9894 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9895 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9896 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9897 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9898 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9899 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9900 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9901 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9902 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9903 a value from memory).
9904 @end table
9905
9906 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9907 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9908 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9909 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9910 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9911
9912 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9913 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9914 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9915
9916 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9917 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9918 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9919 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9920 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9921
9922 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9923 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9924 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9925 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9926 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9927 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9928 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9929 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9930 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9931
9932 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9933 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9934 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9935 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9936 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9937 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9938
9939 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9940 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9941 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9942 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9943 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9944 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9945 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9946
9947 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9948 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9949
9950 @smallexample
9951 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9952 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9953 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9954 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9955 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9956 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9957 @end smallexample
9958
9959 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9960 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9961 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9962 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9963 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9964 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9965 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9966 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9967 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9968
9969 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9970 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9971 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9972
9973 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9974 @cindex addressable memory unit
9975 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9976 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9977 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9978 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9979 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9980 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9981 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9982 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9983 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9984
9985 @cindex remote memory comparison
9986 @cindex target memory comparison
9987 @cindex verify remote memory image
9988 @cindex verify target memory image
9989 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9990 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9991 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9992 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9993 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9994 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9995
9996 @table @code
9997 @kindex compare-sections
9998 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9999 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10000 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10001 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10002 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10003 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10004
10005 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10006 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10007 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10008 @end table
10009
10010 @node Auto Display
10011 @section Automatic Display
10012 @cindex automatic display
10013 @cindex display of expressions
10014
10015 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10016 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10017 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10018 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10019 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10020 The automatic display looks like this:
10021
10022 @smallexample
10023 2: foo = 38
10024 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @noindent
10028 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10029 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10030 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10031 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10032 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10033 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10034
10035 @table @code
10036 @kindex display
10037 @item display @var{expr}
10038 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10039 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10040
10041 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10042
10043 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10044 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10045 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10046 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10047 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10048
10049 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10050 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10051 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10052 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10053 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10054 @end table
10055
10056 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10057 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10058 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10059
10060 @table @code
10061 @kindex delete display
10062 @kindex undisplay
10063 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10064 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10065 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10066 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10067 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10068 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10069 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10070
10071 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10072 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10073
10074 @kindex disable display
10075 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10076 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10077 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10078 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10079 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10080 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10081 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10082 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10083
10084 @kindex enable display
10085 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10086 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10087 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10088 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10089 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10090 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10091 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10092
10093 @item display
10094 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10095 done when your program stops.
10096
10097 @kindex info display
10098 @item info display
10099 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10100 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10101 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10102 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10103 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10104 @end table
10105
10106 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10107 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10108 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10109 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10110 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10111 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10112 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10113 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10114 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10115 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10116 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10117
10118 @node Print Settings
10119 @section Print Settings
10120
10121 @cindex format options
10122 @cindex print settings
10123 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10124 and symbols are printed.
10125
10126 @noindent
10127 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10128
10129 @table @code
10130 @kindex set print
10131 @item set print address
10132 @itemx set print address on
10133 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10134 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10135 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10136 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10137 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10138 @code{set print address on}:
10139
10140 @smallexample
10141 @group
10142 (@value{GDBP}) f
10143 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10144 at input.c:530
10145 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10146 @end group
10147 @end smallexample
10148
10149 @item set print address off
10150 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10151 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10152
10153 @smallexample
10154 @group
10155 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10156 (@value{GDBP}) f
10157 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10158 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10159 @end group
10160 @end smallexample
10161
10162 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10163 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10164 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10165 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10166
10167 @kindex show print
10168 @item show print address
10169 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10170 @end table
10171
10172 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10173 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10174 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10175 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10176 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10177 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10178 it prints a symbolic address:
10179
10180 @table @code
10181 @item set print symbol-filename on
10182 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10183 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10184 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10185 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10186
10187 @item set print symbol-filename off
10188 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10189 default.
10190
10191 @item show print symbol-filename
10192 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10193 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10194 @end table
10195
10196 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10197 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10198 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10199
10200 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10201 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10202
10203 @table @code
10204 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10205 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10206 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10207 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10208 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10209 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10210 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10211 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10212
10213 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10214 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10215 symbolic address.
10216 @end table
10217
10218 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10219 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10220 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10221 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10222 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10223 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10224 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10225 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10226
10227 @smallexample
10228 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10229 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10230 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10231 @end smallexample
10232
10233 @quotation
10234 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10235 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10236 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10237 @end quotation
10238
10239 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10240 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10241
10242 @table @code
10243 @item set print symbol on
10244 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10245 one exists.
10246
10247 @item set print symbol off
10248 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10249 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10250 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10251
10252 @item show print symbol
10253 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10254 address.
10255 @end table
10256
10257 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10258
10259 @table @code
10260 @item set print array
10261 @itemx set print array on
10262 @cindex pretty print arrays
10263 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10264 but uses more space. The default is off.
10265
10266 @item set print array off
10267 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10268
10269 @item show print array
10270 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10271 arrays.
10272
10273 @cindex print array indexes
10274 @item set print array-indexes
10275 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10276 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10277 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10278 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10279
10280 @item set print array-indexes off
10281 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10282
10283 @item show print array-indexes
10284 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10285 arrays.
10286
10287 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10288 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10289 @cindex number of array elements to print
10290 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10291 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10292 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10293 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10294 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10295 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10296 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10297 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10298
10299 @item show print elements
10300 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10301 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10302
10303 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10304 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10305 @cindex printing frame argument values
10306 @cindex print all frame argument values
10307 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10308 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10309 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10310 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10311 values are:
10312
10313 @table @code
10314 @item all
10315 The values of all arguments are printed.
10316
10317 @item scalars
10318 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10319 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10320 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10321 only scalar arguments are shown:
10322
10323 @smallexample
10324 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10325 at frame-args.c:23
10326 @end smallexample
10327
10328 @item none
10329 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10330 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10331
10332 @smallexample
10333 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10334 at frame-args.c:23
10335 @end smallexample
10336 @end table
10337
10338 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10339 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10340 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10341 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10342 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10343 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10344 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10345 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10346 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10347 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10348
10349 @item show print frame-arguments
10350 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10351
10352 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10353 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10354
10355 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10356 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10357 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10358 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10359 This is the default.
10360
10361 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10362 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10363
10364 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10365 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10366 @kindex set print entry-values
10367 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10368 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10369 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10370 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10371 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10372
10373 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10374 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10375 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10376 @code{no} setting.
10377
10378 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10379 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10380 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10381 this information.
10382
10383 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10384
10385 @table @code
10386 @item no
10387 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10388 point.
10389 @smallexample
10390 #0 equal (val=5)
10391 #0 different (val=6)
10392 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10393 #0 born (val=10)
10394 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10395 @end smallexample
10396
10397 @item only
10398 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10399 values are never printed.
10400 @smallexample
10401 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10402 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10403 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10404 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10405 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10406 @end smallexample
10407
10408 @item preferred
10409 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10410 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10411 value for such parameter.
10412 @smallexample
10413 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10414 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10415 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10416 #0 born (val=10)
10417 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10418 @end smallexample
10419
10420 @item if-needed
10421 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10422 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10423 parameter.
10424 @smallexample
10425 #0 equal (val=5)
10426 #0 different (val=6)
10427 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10428 #0 born (val=10)
10429 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10430 @end smallexample
10431
10432 @item both
10433 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10434 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10435 optimizations.
10436 @smallexample
10437 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10438 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10439 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10440 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10441 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10442 @end smallexample
10443
10444 @item compact
10445 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10446 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10447 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10448 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10449 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10450 @smallexample
10451 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10452 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10453 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10454 #0 born (val=10)
10455 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10456 @end smallexample
10457
10458 @item default
10459 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10460 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10461 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10462 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10463 @smallexample
10464 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10465 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10466 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10467 #0 born (val=10)
10468 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10469 @end smallexample
10470 @end table
10471
10472 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10473 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10474
10475 @item show print entry-values
10476 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10477 entry.
10478
10479 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10480 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10481 @cindex repeated array elements
10482 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10483 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10484 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10485 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10486 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10487 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10488 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10489 is 10.
10490
10491 @item show print repeats
10492 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10493 elements.
10494
10495 @item set print null-stop
10496 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10497 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10498 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10499 contain only short strings.
10500 The default is off.
10501
10502 @item show print null-stop
10503 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10504 @sc{null} character.
10505
10506 @item set print pretty on
10507 @cindex print structures in indented form
10508 @cindex indentation in structure display
10509 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10510 per line, like this:
10511
10512 @smallexample
10513 @group
10514 $1 = @{
10515 next = 0x0,
10516 flags = @{
10517 sweet = 1,
10518 sour = 1
10519 @},
10520 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10521 @}
10522 @end group
10523 @end smallexample
10524
10525 @item set print pretty off
10526 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10527
10528 @smallexample
10529 @group
10530 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10531 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10532 @end group
10533 @end smallexample
10534
10535 @noindent
10536 This is the default format.
10537
10538 @item show print pretty
10539 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10540
10541 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10542 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10543 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10544 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10545 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10546 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10547 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10548 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10549
10550 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10551 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10552 international character sets, and is the default.
10553
10554 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10555 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10556
10557 @item set print union on
10558 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10559 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10560 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10561
10562 @item set print union off
10563 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10564 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10565 instead.
10566
10567 @item show print union
10568 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10569 structures and other unions.
10570
10571 For example, given the declarations
10572
10573 @smallexample
10574 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10575 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10576 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10577 Bug_forms;
10578
10579 struct thing @{
10580 Species it;
10581 union @{
10582 Tree_forms tree;
10583 Bug_forms bug;
10584 @} form;
10585 @};
10586
10587 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10588 @end smallexample
10589
10590 @noindent
10591 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10592
10593 @smallexample
10594 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10595 @end smallexample
10596
10597 @noindent
10598 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10599
10600 @smallexample
10601 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10602 @end smallexample
10603
10604 @noindent
10605 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10606 and in Pascal.
10607 @end table
10608
10609 @need 1000
10610 @noindent
10611 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10612
10613 @table @code
10614 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10615 @item set print demangle
10616 @itemx set print demangle on
10617 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10618 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10619 linkage. The default is on.
10620
10621 @item show print demangle
10622 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10623
10624 @item set print asm-demangle
10625 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10626 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10627 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10628 The default is off.
10629
10630 @item show print asm-demangle
10631 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10632 or demangled form.
10633
10634 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10635 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10636 @kindex set demangle-style
10637 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10638 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10639 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10640
10641 @table @code
10642 @item auto
10643 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10644 This is the default.
10645
10646 @item gnu
10647 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10648
10649 @item hp
10650 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10651
10652 @item lucid
10653 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10654
10655 @item arm
10656 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10657 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10658 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10659 require further enhancement to permit that.
10660
10661 @end table
10662 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10663
10664 @item show demangle-style
10665 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10666
10667 @item set print object
10668 @itemx set print object on
10669 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10670 @cindex display derived types
10671 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10672 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10673 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10674 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10675 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10676 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10677 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10678
10679 @item set print object off
10680 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10681 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10682
10683 @item show print object
10684 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10685
10686 @item set print static-members
10687 @itemx set print static-members on
10688 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10689 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10690
10691 @item set print static-members off
10692 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10693
10694 @item show print static-members
10695 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10696
10697 @item set print pascal_static-members
10698 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10699 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10700 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10701 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10702
10703 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10704 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10705
10706 @item show print pascal_static-members
10707 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10708
10709 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10710 @item set print vtbl
10711 @itemx set print vtbl on
10712 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10713 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10714 @cindex VTBL display
10715 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10716 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10717 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10718
10719 @item set print vtbl off
10720 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10721
10722 @item show print vtbl
10723 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10724 @end table
10725
10726 @node Pretty Printing
10727 @section Pretty Printing
10728
10729 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10730 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10731 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10732
10733 @menu
10734 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10735 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10736 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10737 @end menu
10738
10739 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10740 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10741
10742 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10743 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10744 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10745
10746 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10747 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10748 pretty-printers with their names.
10749 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10750 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10751 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10752 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10753
10754 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10755 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10756 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10757 do anything special.
10758
10759 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10760
10761 @itemize @bullet
10762 @item
10763 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10764 all inferiors.
10765
10766 @item
10767 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10768 when debugging that program.
10769 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10770
10771 @item
10772 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10773 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10774 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10775 @end itemize
10776
10777 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10778 pretty-printers are selected,
10779
10780 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10781 for new types.
10782
10783 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10784 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10785
10786 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10787
10788 @smallexample
10789 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10790 $1 = @{
10791 static npos = 4294967295,
10792 _M_dataplus = @{
10793 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10794 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10795 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10796 @},
10797 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10798 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10799 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10800 @}
10801 @}
10802 @end smallexample
10803
10804 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10805
10806 @smallexample
10807 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10808 $2 = "abcd"
10809 @end smallexample
10810
10811 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10812 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10813 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10814
10815 @table @code
10816 @kindex info pretty-printer
10817 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10818 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10819 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10820
10821 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10822 whose pretty-printers to list.
10823 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10824 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10825 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10826 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10827 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10828
10829 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10830 to list.
10831
10832 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10833 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10834 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10835 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10836
10837 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10838 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10839 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10840 @end table
10841
10842 Example:
10843
10844 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10845 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10846 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10847 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10848
10849 @smallexample
10850 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10851 library1.so:
10852 foo
10853 library2.so:
10854 bar
10855 bar1
10856 bar2
10857 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10858 library2.so:
10859 bar
10860 bar1
10861 bar2
10862 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10863 1 printer disabled
10864 2 of 3 printers enabled
10865 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10866 library1.so:
10867 foo [disabled]
10868 library2.so:
10869 bar
10870 bar1
10871 bar2
10872 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10873 1 printer disabled
10874 1 of 3 printers enabled
10875 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10876 library1.so:
10877 foo [disabled]
10878 library2.so:
10879 bar
10880 bar1 [disabled]
10881 bar2
10882 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10883 1 printer disabled
10884 0 of 3 printers enabled
10885 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10886 library1.so:
10887 foo [disabled]
10888 library2.so:
10889 bar [disabled]
10890 bar1 [disabled]
10891 bar2
10892 @end smallexample
10893
10894 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10895 as can each individual subprinter.
10896
10897 @node Value History
10898 @section Value History
10899
10900 @cindex value history
10901 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10902 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10903 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10904 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10905 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10906 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10907 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10908 symbol table.
10909
10910 @cindex @code{$}
10911 @cindex @code{$$}
10912 @cindex history number
10913 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10914 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10915 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10916 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10917 history number.
10918
10919 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10920 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10921 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10922 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10923 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10924 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10925 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10926
10927 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10928 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 p *$
10932 @end smallexample
10933
10934 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10935 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10936
10937 @smallexample
10938 p *$.next
10939 @end smallexample
10940
10941 @noindent
10942 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10943 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10944
10945 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10946 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10947
10948 @smallexample
10949 print x
10950 set x=5
10951 @end smallexample
10952
10953 @noindent
10954 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10955 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10956
10957 @table @code
10958 @kindex show values
10959 @item show values
10960 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10961 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10962 values} does not change the history.
10963
10964 @item show values @var{n}
10965 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10966
10967 @item show values +
10968 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10969 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10970 @end table
10971
10972 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10973 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10974
10975 @node Convenience Vars
10976 @section Convenience Variables
10977
10978 @cindex convenience variables
10979 @cindex user-defined variables
10980 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10981 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10982 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10983 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10984 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10985
10986 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10987 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10988 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10989 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10990 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10991
10992 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10993 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10994 For example:
10995
10996 @smallexample
10997 set $foo = *object_ptr
10998 @end smallexample
10999
11000 @noindent
11001 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11002 @code{object_ptr}.
11003
11004 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11005 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11006 value with another assignment at any time.
11007
11008 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11009 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11010 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11011 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11012
11013 @table @code
11014 @kindex show convenience
11015 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11016 @item show convenience
11017 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11018 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11019 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11020
11021 @kindex init-if-undefined
11022 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11023 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11024 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11025 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11026 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11027 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11028 override default values used in a command script.
11029
11030 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11031 any side-effects do not occur.
11032 @end table
11033
11034 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11035 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11036 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11037
11038 @smallexample
11039 set $i = 0
11040 print bar[$i++]->contents
11041 @end smallexample
11042
11043 @noindent
11044 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11045
11046 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11047 values likely to be useful.
11048
11049 @table @code
11050 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11051 @item $_
11052 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11053 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11054 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11055 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11056 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11057 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11058 to the type of @code{$__}.
11059
11060 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11061 @item $__
11062 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11063 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11064 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11065
11066 @item $_exitcode
11067 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11068 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11069 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11070 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11071
11072 @item $_exitsignal
11073 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11074 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11075 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11076 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11077
11078 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11079 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11080 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11081 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11082 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11083
11084 @smallexample
11085 #include <signal.h>
11086
11087 int
11088 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11089 @{
11090 raise (SIGALRM);
11091 return 0;
11092 @}
11093 @end smallexample
11094
11095 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11096 or signalled would be:
11097
11098 @smallexample
11099 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11100 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11101 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11102 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11103 >echo The program has exited\n
11104 >else
11105 >echo The program has signalled\n
11106 >end
11107 >end
11108 (@value{GDBP}) run
11109 Starting program:
11110
11111 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11112 The program no longer exists.
11113 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11114 The program has signalled
11115 @end smallexample
11116
11117 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11118 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11119 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11120 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11121
11122 @smallexample
11123 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11124 The program has exited
11125 @end smallexample
11126
11127 @item $_exception
11128 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11129 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11130
11131 @item $_probe_argc
11132 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11133 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11134
11135 @item $_sdata
11136 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11137 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11138 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11139 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11140 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11141
11142 @item $_siginfo
11143 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11144 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11145 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11146 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11147 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11148
11149 @item $_tlb
11150 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11151 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11152 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11153 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11154 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11155 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11156
11157 @item $_inferior
11158 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11159 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11160
11161 @item $_thread
11162 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11163
11164 @item $_gthread
11165 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11166
11167 @end table
11168
11169 @node Convenience Funs
11170 @section Convenience Functions
11171
11172 @cindex convenience functions
11173 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11174 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11175 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11176 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11177 @value{GDBN}.
11178
11179 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11180 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11181
11182 @table @code
11183
11184 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11185 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11186 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11187 returns zero.
11188
11189 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11190 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11191 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11192 it is @code{void}:
11193
11194 @smallexample
11195 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11196 $1 = void
11197 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11198 $2 = 1
11199 (@value{GDBP}) run
11200 Starting program: ./a.out
11201 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11202 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11203 $3 = 0
11204 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11205 $4 = 0
11206 @end smallexample
11207
11208 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11209 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11210 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11211 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11212 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11213 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11214 anymore.
11215
11216 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11217 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11218
11219 @smallexample
11220 void
11221 foo (void)
11222 @{
11223 @}
11224 @end smallexample
11225
11226 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11227
11228 @smallexample
11229 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11230 $1 = void
11231 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11232 $2 = 1
11233 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11234 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11235 $3 = void
11236 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11237 $4 = 1
11238 @end smallexample
11239
11240 @end table
11241
11242 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11243 @code{Python} support.
11244
11245 @table @code
11246
11247 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11248 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11249 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11250 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11251 Otherwise it returns zero.
11252
11253 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11254 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11255 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11256 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11257 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11258 regular expression support.
11259
11260 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11261 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11262 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11263 Otherwise it returns zero.
11264
11265 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11266 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11267 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11268
11269 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11270 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11271 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11272 Otherwise it returns zero.
11273
11274 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11275 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11276 The default is 1.
11277
11278 Example:
11279
11280 @smallexample
11281 (gdb) backtrace
11282 #0 bottom_func ()
11283 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11284 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11285 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11286 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11287 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11288 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11289 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11290 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11291 $1 = 1
11292 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11293 $1 = 1
11294 @end smallexample
11295
11296 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11297 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11298 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11299 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11300
11301 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11302 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11303 The default is 1.
11304
11305 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11306 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11307 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11308 Otherwise it returns zero.
11309
11310 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11311 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11312 The default is 1.
11313
11314 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11315 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11316 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11317 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11318
11319 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11320 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11321 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11322 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11323
11324 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11325 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11326 The default is 1.
11327
11328 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11329 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11330 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11331 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11332
11333 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11334 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11335 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11336
11337 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11338 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11339 an enumerated type:
11340
11341 @smallexample
11342 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11343 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11344 @end smallexample
11345
11346 @end table
11347
11348 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11349 convenience functions.
11350
11351 @table @code
11352 @item help function
11353 @kindex help function
11354 @cindex show all convenience functions
11355 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11356 @end table
11357
11358 @node Registers
11359 @section Registers
11360
11361 @cindex registers
11362 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11363 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11364 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11365 your machine.
11366
11367 @table @code
11368 @kindex info registers
11369 @item info registers
11370 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11371 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11372
11373 @kindex info all-registers
11374 @cindex floating point registers
11375 @item info all-registers
11376 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11377 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11378
11379 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11380 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11381 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11382 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11383
11384 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11385 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11386 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11387 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11388 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11389 @end table
11390
11391 @anchor{standard registers}
11392 @cindex stack pointer register
11393 @cindex program counter register
11394 @cindex process status register
11395 @cindex frame pointer register
11396 @cindex standard registers
11397 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11398 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11399 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11400 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11401 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11402 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11403 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11404 you could print the program counter in hex with
11405
11406 @smallexample
11407 p/x $pc
11408 @end smallexample
11409
11410 @noindent
11411 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11412
11413 @smallexample
11414 x/i $pc
11415 @end smallexample
11416
11417 @noindent
11418 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11419 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11420 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11421 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11422 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11423 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11424 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11425
11426 @smallexample
11427 set $sp += 4
11428 @end smallexample
11429
11430 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11431 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11432 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11433 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11434 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11435 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11436 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11437
11438 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11439 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11440 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11441 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11442 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11443 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11444 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11445
11446 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11447 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11448 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11449 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11450 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11451 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11452 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11453 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11454 prints the data in both formats.
11455
11456 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11457 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11458 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11459 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11460 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11461 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11462 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11463
11464 @smallexample
11465 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11466 $1 = @{
11467 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11468 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11469 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11470 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11471 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11472 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11473 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11474 @}
11475 @end smallexample
11476
11477 @noindent
11478 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11479 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11480 value to a @code{struct} member:
11481
11482 @smallexample
11483 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11484 @end smallexample
11485
11486 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11487 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11488 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11489 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11490 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11491 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11492
11493 @cindex caller-saved registers
11494 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11495 @cindex volatile registers
11496 @cindex <not saved> values
11497 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11498 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11499 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11500 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11501 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11502 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11503 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11504 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11505 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11506 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11507 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11508 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11509 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11510 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11511 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11512 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11513 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11514 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11515 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11516 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11517 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11518 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11519 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11520
11521 @node Floating Point Hardware
11522 @section Floating Point Hardware
11523 @cindex floating point
11524
11525 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11526 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11527
11528 @table @code
11529 @kindex info float
11530 @item info float
11531 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11532 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11533 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11534 the ARM and x86 machines.
11535 @end table
11536
11537 @node Vector Unit
11538 @section Vector Unit
11539 @cindex vector unit
11540
11541 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11542 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11543
11544 @table @code
11545 @kindex info vector
11546 @item info vector
11547 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11548 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11549 @end table
11550
11551 @node OS Information
11552 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11553 @cindex OS information
11554
11555 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11556 you debug your program.
11557
11558 @cindex auxiliary vector
11559 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11560 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11561 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11562 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11563 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11564 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11565 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11566 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11567 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11568 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11569 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11570 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11571
11572 @table @code
11573 @kindex info auxv
11574 @item info auxv
11575 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11576 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11577 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11578 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11579 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11580 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11581 an unrecognized tag.
11582 @end table
11583
11584 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11585 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11586 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11587 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11588 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11589 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11590 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11591
11592 @table @code
11593 @kindex info os
11594 @item info os @var{infotype}
11595
11596 Display OS information of the requested type.
11597
11598 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11599
11600 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11601 @table @code
11602 @kindex info os cpus
11603 @item cpus
11604 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11605 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11606 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11607 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11608 kernel initialization.
11609
11610 @kindex info os files
11611 @item files
11612 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11613 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11614 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11615 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11616
11617 @kindex info os modules
11618 @item modules
11619 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11620 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11621 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11622 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11623 in memory.
11624
11625 @kindex info os msg
11626 @item msg
11627 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11628 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11629 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11630 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11631 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11632 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11633 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11634 the message queue was last changed.
11635
11636 @kindex info os processes
11637 @item processes
11638 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11639 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11640 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11641 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11642 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11643 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11644
11645 @kindex info os procgroups
11646 @item procgroups
11647 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11648 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11649 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11650 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11651 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11652 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11653 and the process group leader is listed first.
11654
11655 @kindex info os semaphores
11656 @item semaphores
11657 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11658 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11659 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11660 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11661 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11662
11663 @kindex info os shm
11664 @item shm
11665 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11666 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11667 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11668 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11669 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11670 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11671 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11672
11673 @kindex info os sockets
11674 @item sockets
11675 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11676 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11677 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11678 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11679 connection.
11680
11681 @kindex info os threads
11682 @item threads
11683 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11684 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11685 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11686 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11687 process is not listed.
11688 @end table
11689
11690 @item info os
11691 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11692 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11693 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11694 types, this command will report an error.
11695 @end table
11696
11697 @node Memory Region Attributes
11698 @section Memory Region Attributes
11699 @cindex memory region attributes
11700
11701 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11702 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11703 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11704 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11705 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11706 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11707 user can override the fetched regions.
11708
11709 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11710 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11711 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11712 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11713 all memory.
11714
11715 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11716 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11717
11718 @table @code
11719 @kindex mem
11720 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11721 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11722 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11723 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11724 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11725 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11726
11727 @item mem auto
11728 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11729 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11730
11731 @kindex delete mem
11732 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11733 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11734 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11735
11736 @kindex disable mem
11737 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11738 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11739 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11740 It may be enabled again later.
11741
11742 @kindex enable mem
11743 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11744 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11745
11746 @kindex info mem
11747 @item info mem
11748 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11749 for each region:
11750
11751 @table @emph
11752 @item Memory Region Number
11753 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11754 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11755 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11756
11757 @item Lo Address
11758 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11759
11760 @item Hi Address
11761 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11762
11763 @item Attributes
11764 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11765 @end table
11766 @end table
11767
11768
11769 @subsection Attributes
11770
11771 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11772 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11773 write accesses to a memory region.
11774
11775 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11776 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11777 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11778
11779 @table @code
11780 @item ro
11781 Memory is read only.
11782 @item wo
11783 Memory is write only.
11784 @item rw
11785 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11786 @end table
11787
11788 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11789 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11790 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11791 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11792 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11793
11794 @table @code
11795 @item 8
11796 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11797 @item 16
11798 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11799 @item 32
11800 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11801 @item 64
11802 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11803 @end table
11804
11805 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11806 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11807 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11808 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11809 @c
11810 @c @table @code
11811 @c @item hwbreak
11812 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11813 @c @item swbreak (default)
11814 @c @end table
11815
11816 @subsubsection Data Cache
11817 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11818 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11819 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11820 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11821 registers.
11822
11823 @table @code
11824 @item cache
11825 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11826 @item nocache
11827 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11828 @end table
11829
11830 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11831 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11832 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11833 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11834 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11835
11836 @table @code
11837 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11838 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11839 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11840 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11841 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11842 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11843 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11844 The default value is @code{on}.
11845 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11846 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11847 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11848 @end table
11849
11850
11851 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11852 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11853 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11854 @c
11855 @c @table @code
11856 @c @item verify
11857 @c @item noverify (default)
11858 @c @end table
11859
11860 @node Dump/Restore Files
11861 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11862 @cindex dump/restore files
11863 @cindex append data to a file
11864 @cindex dump data to a file
11865 @cindex restore data from a file
11866
11867 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11868 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11869 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11870 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11871 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11872 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11873 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11874
11875 @table @code
11876
11877 @kindex dump
11878 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11879 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11880 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11881 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11882
11883 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11884 @table @code
11885 @item binary
11886 Raw binary form.
11887 @item ihex
11888 Intel hex format.
11889 @item srec
11890 Motorola S-record format.
11891 @item tekhex
11892 Tektronix Hex format.
11893 @item verilog
11894 Verilog Hex format.
11895 @end table
11896
11897 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11898 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11899 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11900 form.
11901
11902 @kindex append
11903 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11904 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11905 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11906 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11907 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11908
11909 @kindex restore
11910 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11911 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11912 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11913 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11914 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11915
11916 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11917 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11918 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11919 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11920 from that location.
11921
11922 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11923 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11924 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11925 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11926
11927 @end table
11928
11929 @node Core File Generation
11930 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11931 @cindex dump core from inferior
11932
11933 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11934 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11935 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11936 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11937 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11938 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11939 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11940
11941 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11942 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11943 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11944
11945 @table @code
11946 @kindex gcore
11947 @kindex generate-core-file
11948 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11949 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11950 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11951 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11952 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11953 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11954
11955 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11956 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11957
11958 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11959 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11960 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11961 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11962 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11963
11964 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11965 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11966 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11967 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11968 Enable or disable the use of the file
11969 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11970 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11971 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11972 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11973
11974 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11975 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11976 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11977 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11978 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11979 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11980 about the bits that can be set in the
11981 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11982 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11983
11984 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11985 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11986 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11987 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11988 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11989 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11990 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11991 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11992
11993 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11994 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11995 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11996 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11997 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11998 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11999 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12000
12001 The default value is @code{off}.
12002 @end table
12003
12004 @node Character Sets
12005 @section Character Sets
12006 @cindex character sets
12007 @cindex charset
12008 @cindex translating between character sets
12009 @cindex host character set
12010 @cindex target character set
12011
12012 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12013 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12014 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12015 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12016 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12017 @dfn{target character set}.
12018
12019 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12020 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12021 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12022 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12023 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12024 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12025 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12026 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12027 character and string literals in expressions.
12028
12029 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12030 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12031 target-charset} command, described below.
12032
12033 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12034 support:
12035
12036 @table @code
12037 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12038 @kindex set target-charset
12039 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12040 list of supported target character sets, type
12041 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12042
12043 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12044 @kindex set host-charset
12045 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12046
12047 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12048 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12049 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12050 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12051 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12052
12053 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12054 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12055 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12056
12057 @item set charset @var{charset}
12058 @kindex set charset
12059 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12060 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12061 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12062 for both host and target.
12063
12064 @item show charset
12065 @kindex show charset
12066 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12067
12068 @item show host-charset
12069 @kindex show host-charset
12070 Show the name of the current host character set.
12071
12072 @item show target-charset
12073 @kindex show target-charset
12074 Show the name of the current target character set.
12075
12076 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12077 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12078 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12079 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12080 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12081 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12082
12083 @item show target-wide-charset
12084 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12085 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12086 @end table
12087
12088 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12089 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12090 @file{charset-test.c}:
12091
12092 @smallexample
12093 #include <stdio.h>
12094
12095 char ascii_hello[]
12096 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12097 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12098 char ibm1047_hello[]
12099 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12100 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12101
12102 main ()
12103 @{
12104 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12105 @}
12106 @end smallexample
12107
12108 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12109 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12110 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12111
12112 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12113
12114 @smallexample
12115 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12116 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12117 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12118 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12119 @dots{}
12120 (@value{GDBP})
12121 @end smallexample
12122
12123 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12124 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12125 strings:
12126
12127 @smallexample
12128 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12129 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12130 (@value{GDBP})
12131 @end smallexample
12132
12133 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12134 initial character set:
12135 @smallexample
12136 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12137 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12138 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12139 (@value{GDBP})
12140 @end smallexample
12141
12142 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12143 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12144 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12145 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12146 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12147
12148 @smallexample
12149 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12150 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12151 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12152 $2 = 72 'H'
12153 (@value{GDBP})
12154 @end smallexample
12155
12156 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12157 literals you use in expressions:
12158
12159 @smallexample
12160 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12161 $3 = 43 '+'
12162 (@value{GDBP})
12163 @end smallexample
12164
12165 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12166 character.
12167
12168 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12169 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12170 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12171
12172 @smallexample
12173 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12174 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12175 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12176 $5 = 200 '\310'
12177 (@value{GDBP})
12178 @end smallexample
12179
12180 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12181 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12182
12183 @smallexample
12184 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12185 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12186 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12187 @end smallexample
12188
12189 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12190 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12191 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12192 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12193 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12194
12195 @smallexample
12196 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12197 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12198 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12199 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12200 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12201 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12202 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12203 $7 = 72 '\110'
12204 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12205 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12206 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12207 $9 = 200 'H'
12208 (@value{GDBP})
12209 @end smallexample
12210
12211 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12212 string literals you use in expressions:
12213
12214 @smallexample
12215 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12216 $10 = 78 '+'
12217 (@value{GDBP})
12218 @end smallexample
12219
12220 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12221 character.
12222
12223 @node Caching Target Data
12224 @section Caching Data of Targets
12225 @cindex caching data of targets
12226
12227 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12228 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12229 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12230 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12231 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12232 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12233 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12234 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12235 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12236 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12237 is executing.
12238 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12239 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12240 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12241 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12242 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12243 in the code segment.
12244 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12245 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12246
12247 @table @code
12248 @kindex set remotecache
12249 @item set remotecache on
12250 @itemx set remotecache off
12251 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12252 with old scripts.
12253
12254 @kindex show remotecache
12255 @item show remotecache
12256 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12257
12258 @kindex set stack-cache
12259 @item set stack-cache on
12260 @itemx set stack-cache off
12261 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12262 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12263
12264 @kindex show stack-cache
12265 @item show stack-cache
12266 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12267
12268 @kindex set code-cache
12269 @item set code-cache on
12270 @itemx set code-cache off
12271 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12272 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12273 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12274
12275 @kindex show code-cache
12276 @item show code-cache
12277 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12278 accesses.
12279
12280 @kindex info dcache
12281 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12282 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12283 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12284 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12285 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12286 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12287
12288 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12289 printed in hex.
12290
12291 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12292 @cindex dcache size
12293 @kindex set dcache size
12294 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12295
12296 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12297 @cindex dcache line-size
12298 @kindex set dcache line-size
12299 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12300 Must be a power of 2.
12301
12302 @item show dcache size
12303 @kindex show dcache size
12304 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12305
12306 @item show dcache line-size
12307 @kindex show dcache line-size
12308 Show default size of dcache lines.
12309
12310 @end table
12311
12312 @node Searching Memory
12313 @section Search Memory
12314 @cindex searching memory
12315
12316 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12317 @code{find} command.
12318
12319 @table @code
12320 @kindex find
12321 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12322 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12323 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12324 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12325 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12326 @end table
12327
12328 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12329 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12330
12331 @table @r
12332 @item @var{s}, search query size
12333 The size of each search query value.
12334
12335 @table @code
12336 @item b
12337 bytes
12338 @item h
12339 halfwords (two bytes)
12340 @item w
12341 words (four bytes)
12342 @item g
12343 giant words (eight bytes)
12344 @end table
12345
12346 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12347 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12348 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12349 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12350 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12351
12352 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12353 value's type in the current language.
12354 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12355 pattern as a mixture of types.
12356 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12357 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12358 which is typically four bytes.
12359
12360 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12361 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12362 @end table
12363
12364 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12365 (@code{"}).
12366 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12367 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12368
12369 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12370 number of matches found.
12371
12372 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12373 @samp{$_}.
12374 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12375
12376 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12377
12378 @smallexample
12379 void
12380 hello ()
12381 @{
12382 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12383 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12384 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12385 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12386 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12387 @}
12388 @end smallexample
12389
12390 @noindent
12391 you get during debugging:
12392
12393 @smallexample
12394 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12395 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12396 1 pattern found
12397 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12398 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12399 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12400 2 patterns found.
12401 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12402 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12403 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12404 2 patterns found.
12405 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12406 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12407 1 pattern found
12408 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12409 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12410 1 pattern found
12411 (gdb) print $numfound
12412 $1 = 1
12413 (gdb) print $_
12414 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12415 @end smallexample
12416
12417 @node Value Sizes
12418 @section Value Sizes
12419
12420 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12421 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12422 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12423 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12424 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12425
12426 @table @code
12427 @kindex set max-value-size
12428 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12429 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12430 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12431 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12432 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12433
12434 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12435 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12436
12437 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12438 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12439 currently 16 bytes.
12440
12441 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12442 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12443 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12444 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12445 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12446 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12447 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12448 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12449
12450 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12451
12452 @kindex show max-value-size
12453 @item show max-value-size
12454 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12455 allocate for the contents of a value.
12456 @end table
12457
12458 @node Optimized Code
12459 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12460 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12461 @cindex debugging optimized code
12462
12463 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12464 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12465 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12466 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12467 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12468 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12469 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12470
12471 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12472 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12473 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12474 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12475
12476 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12477 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12478 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12479 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12480 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12481 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12482
12483 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12484 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12485 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12486 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12487 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12488
12489 @menu
12490 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12491 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12492 @end menu
12493
12494 @node Inline Functions
12495 @section Inline Functions
12496 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12497
12498 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12499 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12500 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12501 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12502 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12503 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12504 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12505 @code{info frame} command.
12506
12507 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12508 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12509 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12510 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12511 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12512 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12513 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12514 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12515 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12516 local variables in the caller.
12517
12518 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12519 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12520 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12521 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12522 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12523 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12524 instructions are executed.
12525
12526 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12527 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12528 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12529 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12530
12531 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12532 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12533
12534 @itemize @bullet
12535 @item
12536 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12537 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12538 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12539 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12540 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12541 or inside the inlined function instead.
12542
12543 @item
12544 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12545 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12546 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12547 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12548
12549 @end itemize
12550
12551 @node Tail Call Frames
12552 @section Tail Call Frames
12553 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12554
12555 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12556 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12557 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12558 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12559 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12560
12561 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12562 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12563 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12564 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12565 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12566 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12567 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12568
12569 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12570 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12571 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12572 this information.
12573
12574 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12575 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12576
12577 @smallexample
12578 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12579 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12580 (gdb) info frame
12581 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12582 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12583 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12584 source language c++.
12585 Arglist at unknown address.
12586 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12587 @end smallexample
12588
12589 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12590 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12591 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12592 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12593 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12594 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12595
12596 @table @code
12597 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12598 @item set debug entry-values
12599 @kindex set debug entry-values
12600 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12601 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12602 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12603 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12604 result.
12605
12606 @item show debug entry-values
12607 @kindex show debug entry-values
12608 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12609 values at function entry and tail calls.
12610 @end table
12611
12612 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12613 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12614 reference by variable @code{x}):
12615
12616 @smallexample
12617 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12618 void (*x) (void) = c;
12619 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12620 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12621 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12622
12623 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12624 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12625 a () at t.c:3
12626 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12627 (gdb) bt
12628 #0 a () at t.c:3
12629 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12630 @end smallexample
12631
12632 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12633
12634 @smallexample
12635 int i;
12636 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12637 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12638 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12639 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12640 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12641 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12642 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12643 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12644
12645 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12646 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12647 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12648 (gdb) bt
12649 #0 f () at t.c:2
12650 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12651 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12652 @end smallexample
12653
12654 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12655 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12656
12657 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12658 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12659 @set ARROW @click{}
12660 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12661 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12662 @end ifset
12663 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12664 @set ARROW ->
12665 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12666 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12667 @end ifclear
12668
12669 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12670 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12671 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12672
12673 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12674 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12675 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12676 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12677 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12678 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12679
12680 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12681 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12682 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12683 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12684 omitted.
12685
12686 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12687 entry may fail:
12688
12689 @smallexample
12690 int v;
12691 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12692 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12693 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12694 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12695 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12696 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12697
12698 (gdb) bt
12699 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12700 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12701 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12702 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12703 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12704 @end smallexample
12705
12706 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12707 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12708 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12709 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12710 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12711
12712 @node Macros
12713 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12714
12715 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12716 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12717 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12718 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12719 where it was defined.
12720
12721 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12722 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12723 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12724 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12725
12726 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12727 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12728 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12729 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12730 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12731 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12732 see @ref{List}.
12733
12734 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12735 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12736 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12737
12738 @table @code
12739
12740 @kindex macro expand
12741 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12742 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12743 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12744 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12745 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12746 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12747 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12748 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12749 it can be any string of tokens.
12750
12751 @kindex macro exp1
12752 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12753 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12754 @cindex expand macro once
12755 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12756 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12757 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12758 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12759 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12760 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12761 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12762 can be any string of tokens.
12763
12764 @kindex info macro
12765 @cindex macro definition, showing
12766 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12767 @cindex macros, from debug info
12768 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12769 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12770 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12771 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12772 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12773 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12774
12775 @kindex info macros
12776 @item info macros @var{location}
12777 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12778 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12779 command-line where those definitions were established.
12780
12781 @kindex macro define
12782 @cindex user-defined macros
12783 @cindex defining macros interactively
12784 @cindex macros, user-defined
12785 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12786 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12787 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12788 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12789 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12790 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12791 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12792 @var{arglist}.
12793
12794 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12795 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12796 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12797 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12798 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12799
12800 @kindex macro undef
12801 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12802 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12803 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12804 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12805 in the program being debugged.
12806
12807 @kindex macro list
12808 @item macro list
12809 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12810 @end table
12811
12812 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12813 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12814 show our source files:
12815
12816 @smallexample
12817 $ cat sample.c
12818 #include <stdio.h>
12819 #include "sample.h"
12820
12821 #define M 42
12822 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12823
12824 main ()
12825 @{
12826 #define N 28
12827 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12828 #undef N
12829 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12830 #define N 1729
12831 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12832 @}
12833 $ cat sample.h
12834 #define Q <
12835 $
12836 @end smallexample
12837
12838 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12839 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12840 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12841 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12842 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12843 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12844 information.
12845
12846 @smallexample
12847 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12848 $
12849 @end smallexample
12850
12851 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12852
12853 @smallexample
12854 $ gdb -nw sample
12855 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12856 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12857 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12858 (@value{GDBP})
12859 @end smallexample
12860
12861 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12862 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12863 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12864
12865 @smallexample
12866 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12867 3
12868 4 #define M 42
12869 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12870 6
12871 7 main ()
12872 8 @{
12873 9 #define N 28
12874 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12875 11 #undef N
12876 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12877 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12878 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12879 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12880 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12881 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12882 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12883 #define Q <
12884 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12885 expands to: (42 + 1)
12886 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12887 expands to: once (M + 1)
12888 (@value{GDBP})
12889 @end smallexample
12890
12891 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12892 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12893 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12894 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12895
12896 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12897 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12898
12899 @smallexample
12900 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12901 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12902 (@value{GDBP}) run
12903 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12904
12905 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12906 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12907 (@value{GDBP})
12908 @end smallexample
12909
12910 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12911
12912 @smallexample
12913 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12914 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12915 #define N 28
12916 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12917 expands to: 28 < 42
12918 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12919 $1 = 1
12920 (@value{GDBP})
12921 @end smallexample
12922
12923 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12924 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12925 thereof) in force at each point:
12926
12927 @smallexample
12928 (@value{GDBP}) next
12929 Hello, world!
12930 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12931 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12932 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12933 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12934 (@value{GDBP}) next
12935 We're so creative.
12936 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12937 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12938 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12939 #define N 1729
12940 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12941 expands to: 1729 < 42
12942 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12943 $2 = 0
12944 (@value{GDBP})
12945 @end smallexample
12946
12947 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12948 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12949 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12950 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12951
12952 @smallexample
12953 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12954 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12955 -D__STDC__=1
12956 (@value{GDBP})
12957 @end smallexample
12958
12959
12960 @node Tracepoints
12961 @chapter Tracepoints
12962 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12963 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12964
12965 @cindex tracepoints
12966 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12967 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12968 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12969 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12970 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12971 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12972 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12973
12974 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12975 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12976 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12977 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12978 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12979 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12980 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12981 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12982 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12983 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12984 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12985
12986 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12987 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12988 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12989 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12990 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12991 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12992 Packets}.
12993
12994 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12995 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12996 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12997
12998 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12999
13000 @menu
13001 * Set Tracepoints::
13002 * Analyze Collected Data::
13003 * Tracepoint Variables::
13004 * Trace Files::
13005 @end menu
13006
13007 @node Set Tracepoints
13008 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13009
13010 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13011 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13012 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13013 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13014 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13015 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13016 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13017
13018 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13019 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13020 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13021 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13022 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13023 tracepoint was hit.
13024
13025 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13026 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13027 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13028 either.
13029
13030 @cindex fast tracepoints
13031 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13032 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13033 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13034
13035 @cindex static tracepoints
13036 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13037 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13038 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13039 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13040 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13041 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13042 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13043 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13044 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13045 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13046 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13047 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13048 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13049 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13050 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13051 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13052 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13053 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13054 static tracepoint marker.
13055
13056 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13057 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13058
13059 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13060 conditions and actions.
13061
13062 @menu
13063 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13064 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13065 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13066 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13067 * Trace State Variables::
13068 * Tracepoint Actions::
13069 * Listing Tracepoints::
13070 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13071 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13072 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13073 @end menu
13074
13075 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13076 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13077
13078 @table @code
13079 @cindex set tracepoint
13080 @kindex trace
13081 @item trace @var{location}
13082 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13083 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13084 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13085 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13086 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13087 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13088 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13089 in tracing}).
13090 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13091 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13092 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13093 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13094 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13095 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13096 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13097 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13098 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13099 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13100 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13101 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13102
13103 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13104
13105 @smallexample
13106 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13107
13108 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13109
13110 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13111
13112 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13113
13114 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13115 @end smallexample
13116
13117 @noindent
13118 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13119
13120 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13121 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13122 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13123 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13124 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13125 information on tracepoint conditions.
13126
13127 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13128 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13129 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13130 @kindex ftrace
13131 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13132 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13133 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13134 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13135 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13136 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13137 message.
13138
13139 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13140 @code{trace}.
13141
13142 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13143 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13144 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13145 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13146 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13147 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13148 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13149 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13150
13151 @example
13152 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13153 @end example
13154
13155 @noindent
13156 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13157 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13158
13159 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13160 @cindex set static tracepoint
13161 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13162 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13163 @kindex strace
13164 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13165 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13166 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13167 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13168 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13169
13170 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13171 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13172 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13173 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13174 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13175 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13176 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13177 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13178 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13179 tracing engine:
13180
13181 @smallexample
13182 main ()
13183 @{
13184 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13185 @}
13186 @end smallexample
13187
13188 @noindent
13189 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13190 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13191
13192 @smallexample
13193 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13194 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13195 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13196 Data: "str %s"
13197 [etc...]
13198 @end smallexample
13199
13200 @noindent
13201 so you may probe the marker above with:
13202
13203 @smallexample
13204 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13205 @end smallexample
13206
13207 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13208 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13209 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13210 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13211 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13212 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13213 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13214 the @samp{Data:} field.
13215
13216 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13217 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13218 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13219
13220 @vindex $tpnum
13221 @cindex last tracepoint number
13222 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13223 @cindex tracepoint number
13224 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13225 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13226
13227 @kindex delete tracepoint
13228 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13229 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13230 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13231 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13232 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13233
13234 Examples:
13235
13236 @smallexample
13237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13238
13239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13240 @end smallexample
13241
13242 @noindent
13243 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13244 @end table
13245
13246 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13247 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13248
13249 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13250
13251 @table @code
13252 @kindex disable tracepoint
13253 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13254 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13255 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13256 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13257 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13258 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13259 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13260 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13261 next trace experiment.
13262
13263 @kindex enable tracepoint
13264 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13265 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13266 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13267 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13268 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13269 next time a trace experiment is run.
13270 @end table
13271
13272 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13273 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13274
13275 @table @code
13276 @kindex passcount
13277 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13278 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13279 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13280 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13281 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13282 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13283 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13284 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13285 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13286 user.
13287
13288 Examples:
13289
13290 @smallexample
13291 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13292 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13293
13294 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13295 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13296 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13301 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13302 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13303 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13304 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13305 @end smallexample
13306 @end table
13307
13308 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13309 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13310 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13311 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13312
13313 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13314 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13315 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13316 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13317 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13318 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13319 is true.
13320
13321 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13322 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13323 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13324 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13325 just as with breakpoints.
13326
13327 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13328 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13329 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13330 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13331 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13332 accesses, and so forth.
13333
13334 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13335 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13336 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13337 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13338 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13339 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13340 search through.
13341
13342 @smallexample
13343 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13344 @end smallexample
13345
13346 @node Trace State Variables
13347 @subsection Trace State Variables
13348 @cindex trace state variables
13349
13350 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13351 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13352 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13353 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13354 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13355 integers.
13356
13357 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13358 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13359 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13360 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13361
13362 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13363 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13364 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13365 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13366 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13367 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13368 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13369 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13370 variable with the same name.
13371
13372 @table @code
13373
13374 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13375 @kindex tvariable
13376 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13377 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13378 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13379 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13380 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13381 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13382 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13383 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13384 value. The default initial value is 0.
13385
13386 @item info tvariables
13387 @kindex info tvariables
13388 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13389 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13390 currently running.
13391
13392 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13393 @kindex delete tvariable
13394 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13395 are specified.
13396
13397 @end table
13398
13399 @node Tracepoint Actions
13400 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13401
13402 @table @code
13403 @kindex actions
13404 @cindex tracepoint actions
13405 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13406 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13407 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13408 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13409 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13410 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13411 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13412 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13413 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13414 @code{while-stepping}.
13415
13416 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13417 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13418 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13419
13420 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13421 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13422 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13423
13424 @smallexample
13425 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13426
13427 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13428
13429 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13430 @end smallexample
13431
13432 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13433 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13434 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13435 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13436 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13437 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13438 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13439 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13440
13441 @smallexample
13442 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13444 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13445 > collect bar,baz
13446 > collect $regs
13447 > while-stepping 12
13448 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13449 > end
13450 end
13451 @end smallexample
13452
13453 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13454 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13455 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13456 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13457 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13458 special arguments are supported:
13459
13460 @table @code
13461 @item $regs
13462 Collect all registers.
13463
13464 @item $args
13465 Collect all function arguments.
13466
13467 @item $locals
13468 Collect all local variables.
13469
13470 @item $_ret
13471 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13472 of a backtrace.
13473
13474 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13475 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13476 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13477 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13478 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13479 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13480
13481 @item $_probe_argc
13482 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13483 tracepoint is located.
13484 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13485
13486 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13487 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13488 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13489 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13490
13491 @item $_sdata
13492 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13493 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13494 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13495 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13496 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13497 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13498 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13499 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13500 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13501
13502 @smallexample
13503 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13504 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13505 @end smallexample
13506
13507 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13508 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13509 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13510 @value{GDBN}.
13511 @end table
13512
13513 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13514 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13515 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13516
13517 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13518 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13519 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13520 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13521 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13522 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13523 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13524 @samp{mystr}.
13525
13526 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13527 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13528
13529 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13530 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13531 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13532 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13533 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13534 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13535 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13536 action were used.
13537
13538 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13539 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13540 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13541 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13542 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13543 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13544
13545 @smallexample
13546 > while-stepping 12
13547 > collect $regs, myglobal
13548 > end
13549 >
13550 @end smallexample
13551
13552 @noindent
13553 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13554 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13555 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13556 @code{stepping}.
13557
13558 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13559 @kindex set default-collect
13560 @cindex default collection action
13561 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13562 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13563 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13564 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13565 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13566 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13567
13568 @item show default-collect
13569 @kindex show default-collect
13570 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13571 tracepoint hit.
13572
13573 @end table
13574
13575 @node Listing Tracepoints
13576 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13577
13578 @table @code
13579 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13580 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13581 @cindex information about tracepoints
13582 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13583 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13584 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13585 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13586 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13587 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13588
13589 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13590 tracing:
13591
13592 @itemize @bullet
13593 @item
13594 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13595
13596 @item
13597 the state about installed on target of each location
13598 @end itemize
13599
13600 @smallexample
13601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13602 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13603 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13604 while-stepping 20
13605 collect globfoo, $regs
13606 end
13607 collect globfoo2
13608 end
13609 pass count 1200
13610 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13611 collect $eip
13612 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13613 installed on target
13614 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13615 installed on target
13616 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13617 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13618 not installed on target
13619 (@value{GDBP})
13620 @end smallexample
13621
13622 @noindent
13623 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13624 @end table
13625
13626 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13627 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13628
13629 @table @code
13630 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13631 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13632 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13633 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13634 program.
13635
13636 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13637
13638 @table @emph
13639 @item Count
13640 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13641 stable identifier.
13642 @item ID
13643 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13644 @item Enabled or Disabled
13645 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13646 that are not enabled.
13647 @item Address
13648 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13649 @item What
13650 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13651 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13652 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13653 will be left blank.
13654 @end table
13655
13656 @noindent
13657 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13658
13659 @table @emph
13660 @item Data
13661 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13662 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13663 marker call.
13664 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13665 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13666 @end table
13667
13668 @smallexample
13669 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13670 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13671 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13672 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13673 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13674 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13675 Data: str %s
13676 (@value{GDBP})
13677 @end smallexample
13678 @end table
13679
13680 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13681 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13682
13683 @table @code
13684 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13685 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13686 @cindex collected data discarded
13687 @item tstart
13688 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13689 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13690 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13691 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13692 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13693 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13694 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13695 information, and so forth.
13696
13697 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13698 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13699 @item tstop
13700 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13701 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13702 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13703 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13704 needs to be stopped quickly.
13705
13706 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13707 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13708 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13709
13710 @kindex tstatus
13711 @cindex status of trace data collection
13712 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13713 @item tstatus
13714 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13715 collection.
13716 @end table
13717
13718 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13719
13720 @smallexample
13721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13723 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13724 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13725 > while-stepping 11
13726 > collect $regs
13727 > end
13728 > end
13729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13730 [time passes @dots{}]
13731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13732 @end smallexample
13733
13734 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13735 @cindex disconnected tracing
13736 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13737 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13738 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13739 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13740 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13741 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13742 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13743 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13744
13745 @table @code
13746 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13747 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13748 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13749 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13750 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13751 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13752 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13753 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13754
13755 @item show disconnected-tracing
13756 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13757 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13758
13759 @end table
13760
13761 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13762 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13763 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13764 it will continue after reconnection.
13765
13766 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13767 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13768 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13769 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13770 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13771 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13772 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13773 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13774 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13775 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13776
13777 @cindex circular trace buffer
13778 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13779 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13780 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13781 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13782 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13783 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13784 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13785 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13786 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13787 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13788 the next run.
13789
13790 @table @code
13791 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13792 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13793 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13794 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13795 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13796 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13797 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13798
13799 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13800 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13801 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13802 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13803 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13804 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13805
13806 @end table
13807
13808 @table @code
13809 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13810 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13811 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13812 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13813 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13814 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13815 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13816 likes. This is also the default.
13817
13818 @item show trace-buffer-size
13819 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13820 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13821 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13822 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13823 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13824 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13825 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13826 @end table
13827
13828 @table @code
13829 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13830 @kindex set trace-user
13831
13832 @item show trace-user
13833 @kindex show trace-user
13834
13835 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13836 @kindex set trace-notes
13837 Set the trace run's notes.
13838
13839 @item show trace-notes
13840 @kindex show trace-notes
13841 Show the trace run's notes.
13842
13843 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13844 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13845 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13846 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13847 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13848
13849 @item show trace-stop-notes
13850 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13851 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13852
13853 @end table
13854
13855 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13856 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13857
13858 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13859 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13860 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13861 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13862 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13863 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13864 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13865 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13866 mentioned here.
13867
13868 @itemize @bullet
13869
13870 @item
13871 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13872 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13873 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13874 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13875 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13876 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13877 cannot be collected either.
13878
13879 @item
13880 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13881 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13882 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13883 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13884 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13885 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13886 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13887 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13888 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13889 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13890
13891 @item
13892 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13893 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13894 in a misleading way.
13895
13896 @item
13897 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13898 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13899 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13900 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13901 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13902 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13903 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13904 by @code{ptr}.
13905
13906 @item
13907 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13908 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13909 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13910 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13911 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13912 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13913 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13914 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13915 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13916 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13917 invalid address.
13918
13919 @item
13920 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13921 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13922 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13923 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13924 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13925 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13926 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13927 it to zero.
13928
13929 @end itemize
13930
13931 @node Analyze Collected Data
13932 @section Using the Collected Data
13933
13934 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13935 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13936 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13937 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13938 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13939 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13940 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13941 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13942 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13943 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13944 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13945 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13946 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13947 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13948 the buffer will fail.
13949
13950 @menu
13951 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13952 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13953 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13954 @end menu
13955
13956 @node tfind
13957 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13958
13959 @kindex tfind
13960 @cindex select trace snapshot
13961 @cindex find trace snapshot
13962 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13963 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13964 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13965 snapshot is selected.
13966
13967 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13968
13969 @table @code
13970 @item tfind start
13971 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13972 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13973
13974 @item tfind none
13975 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13976
13977 @item tfind end
13978 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13979
13980 @item tfind
13981 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13982 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13983
13984 @item tfind -
13985 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13986 retracing earlier steps.
13987
13988 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13989 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13990 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13991 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13992 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13993
13994 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13995 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13996 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13997 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13998 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13999
14000 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14001 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14002 addresses (exclusive).
14003
14004 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14005 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14006 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14007
14008 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14009 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14010 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14011 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14012 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14013 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14014 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14015 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14016 @end table
14017
14018 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14019 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14020 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14021 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14022 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14023 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14024 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14025 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14026 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14027 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14028 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14029 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14030 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14031 tracepoint as the current one.
14032
14033 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14034 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14035 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14036 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14037 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14038
14039 @smallexample
14040 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14041 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14042 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14043 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14044 > tfind
14045 > end
14046
14047 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14048 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14049 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14050 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14051 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14052 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14053 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14054 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14055 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14056 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14057 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14058 @end smallexample
14059
14060 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14061 the buffer:
14062
14063 @smallexample
14064 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14065 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14066 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14067 > tfind line
14068 > end
14069
14070 Frame 0, X = 1
14071 Frame 7, X = 2
14072 Frame 13, X = 255
14073 @end smallexample
14074
14075 @node tdump
14076 @subsection @code{tdump}
14077 @kindex tdump
14078 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14079 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14080
14081 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14082 the current trace snapshot.
14083
14084 @smallexample
14085 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14086 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14087 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14088 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14089 > end
14090
14091 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14092
14093 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14094 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14095 at gdb_test.c:444
14096 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14097
14098 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14099 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14100 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14101 d1 0x18 24
14102 d2 0x80 128
14103 d3 0x33 51
14104 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14105 d5 0x22 34
14106 d6 0xe0 224
14107 d7 0x380035 3670069
14108 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14109 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14110 a2 0x100 256
14111 a3 0x322000 3284992
14112 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14113 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14114 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14115 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14116 ps 0x0 0
14117 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14118 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14119 fpstatus 0x0 0
14120 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14121 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14122 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14123 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14124 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14125 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14126 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14127 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14128 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14129
14130 (@value{GDBP})
14131 @end smallexample
14132
14133 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14134 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14135 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14136 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14137
14138 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14139 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14140 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14141 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14142 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14143 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14144 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14145 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14146 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14147 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14148
14149 @node save tracepoints
14150 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14151 @kindex save tracepoints
14152 @kindex save-tracepoints
14153 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14154
14155 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14156 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14157 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14158 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14159 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14160 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14161
14162 @node Tracepoint Variables
14163 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14164 @cindex tracepoint variables
14165 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14166
14167 @table @code
14168 @vindex $trace_frame
14169 @item (int) $trace_frame
14170 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14171 snapshot is selected.
14172
14173 @vindex $tracepoint
14174 @item (int) $tracepoint
14175 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14176
14177 @vindex $trace_line
14178 @item (int) $trace_line
14179 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14180
14181 @vindex $trace_file
14182 @item (char []) $trace_file
14183 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14184
14185 @vindex $trace_func
14186 @item (char []) $trace_func
14187 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14188 @end table
14189
14190 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14191 use @code{output} instead.
14192
14193 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14194 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14195 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14196 which are managed by the target.
14197
14198 @smallexample
14199 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14200
14201 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14202 > output $trace_file
14203 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14204 > tfind
14205 > end
14206 @end smallexample
14207
14208 @node Trace Files
14209 @section Using Trace Files
14210 @cindex trace files
14211
14212 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14213 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14214 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14215 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14216 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14217
14218 @table @code
14219
14220 @kindex tsave
14221 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14222 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14223 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14224 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14225 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14226 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14227 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14228 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14229 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14230 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14231 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14232 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14233 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14234 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14235 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14236
14237 @kindex target tfile
14238 @kindex tfile
14239 @kindex target ctf
14240 @kindex ctf
14241 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14242 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14243 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14244 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14245 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14246 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14247 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14248 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14249 the host.
14250
14251 @smallexample
14252 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14253 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14254 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14255 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14256 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14257 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14258 i = 0
14259 a = 0
14260 b = 1 '\001'
14261 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14262 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14263 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14264 $1 = 1
14265 @end smallexample
14266
14267 @end table
14268
14269 @node Overlays
14270 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14271 @cindex overlays
14272
14273 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14274 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14275 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14276 use overlays.
14277
14278 @menu
14279 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14280 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14281 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14282 mapped by asking the inferior.
14283 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14284 @end menu
14285
14286 @node How Overlays Work
14287 @section How Overlays Work
14288 @cindex mapped overlays
14289 @cindex unmapped overlays
14290 @cindex load address, overlay's
14291 @cindex mapped address
14292 @cindex overlay area
14293
14294 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14295 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14296 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14297 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14298 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14299
14300 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14301 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14302 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14303 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14304 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14305 largest overlay as well.
14306
14307 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14308 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14309 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14310 there.
14311
14312 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14313 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14314 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14315
14316 @smallexample
14317 @group
14318 Data Instruction Larger
14319 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14320 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14321 | | | | | |
14322 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14323 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14324 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14325 | and heap | | | | | |
14326 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14327 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14328 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14329 | | | | | |
14330 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14331 address | | | | | |
14332 | overlay | <-' | | |
14333 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14334 | | <---. | | load address
14335 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14336 | | | |
14337 +-----------+ | |
14338 +-----------+
14339 | |
14340 +-----------+
14341
14342 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14343 @end group
14344 @end smallexample
14345
14346 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14347 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14348 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14349 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14350 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14351 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14352 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14353 program and the overlay area.
14354
14355 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14356 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14357 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14358 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14359 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14360 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14361 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14362
14363 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14364 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14365 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14366
14367 @itemize @bullet
14368
14369 @item
14370 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14371 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14372 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14373 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14374
14375 @item
14376 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14377 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14378 your program's performance.
14379
14380 @item
14381 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14382 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14383 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14384 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14385 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14386 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14387 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14388
14389 @item
14390 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14391 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14392 instruction and data spaces.
14393
14394 @end itemize
14395
14396 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14397 improved in many ways:
14398
14399 @itemize @bullet
14400
14401 @item
14402 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14403 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14404 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14405 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14406 area in the usual way.
14407
14408 @item
14409 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14410 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14411
14412 @item
14413 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14414 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14415 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14416 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14417 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14418 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14419 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14420
14421 @end itemize
14422
14423
14424 @node Overlay Commands
14425 @section Overlay Commands
14426
14427 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14428 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14429 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14430 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14431 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14432 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14433
14434 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14435 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14436
14437 @table @code
14438 @item overlay off
14439 @kindex overlay
14440 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14441 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14442 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14443 overlay support is disabled.
14444
14445 @item overlay manual
14446 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14447 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14448 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14449 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14450 commands described below.
14451
14452 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14453 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14454 @cindex map an overlay
14455 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14456 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14457 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14458 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14459 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14460 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14461
14462 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14463 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14464 @cindex unmap an overlay
14465 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14466 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14467 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14468 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14469
14470 @item overlay auto
14471 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14472 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14473 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14474 Overlay Debugging}.
14475
14476 @item overlay load-target
14477 @itemx overlay load
14478 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14479 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14480 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14481 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14482 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14483 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14484
14485 @item overlay list-overlays
14486 @itemx overlay list
14487 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14488 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14489 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14490
14491 @end table
14492
14493 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14494 of the function the address falls in:
14495
14496 @smallexample
14497 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14498 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14499 @end smallexample
14500 @noindent
14501 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14502 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14503 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14504 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14505
14506 @smallexample
14507 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14508 No sections are mapped.
14509 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14510 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14511 @end smallexample
14512 @noindent
14513 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14514 name normally:
14515
14516 @smallexample
14517 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14518 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14519 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14520 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14521 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14522 @end smallexample
14523
14524 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14525 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14526 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14527 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14528 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14529
14530 @itemize @bullet
14531 @item
14532 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14533 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14534 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14535 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14536 @item
14537 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14538 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14539 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14540 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14541 breakpoints properly.
14542 @end itemize
14543
14544
14545 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14546 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14547 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14548
14549 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14550 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14551 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14552 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14553 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14554 current state of the overlays.
14555
14556 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14557 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14558
14559 @table @asis
14560
14561 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14562 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14563
14564 @smallexample
14565 struct
14566 @{
14567 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14568 unsigned long vma;
14569
14570 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14571 unsigned long size;
14572
14573 /* The overlay's load address. */
14574 unsigned long lma;
14575
14576 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14577 zero otherwise. */
14578 unsigned long mapped;
14579 @}
14580 @end smallexample
14581
14582 @item @code{_novlys}:
14583 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14584 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14585
14586 @end table
14587
14588 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14589 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14590 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14591 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14592 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14593 currently mapped.
14594
14595 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14596 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14597 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14598 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14599 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14600 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14601 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14602 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14603 are not being executed.
14604
14605 @node Overlay Sample Program
14606 @section Overlay Sample Program
14607 @cindex overlay example program
14608
14609 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14610 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14611 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14612 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14613 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14614 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14615 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14616
14617 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14618 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14619 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14620 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14621
14622 @table @file
14623 @item overlays.c
14624 The main program file.
14625 @item ovlymgr.c
14626 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14627 @item foo.c
14628 @itemx bar.c
14629 @itemx baz.c
14630 @itemx grbx.c
14631 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14632 @item d10v.ld
14633 @itemx m32r.ld
14634 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14635 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14636 @end table
14637
14638 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14639 cross-compiler like this:
14640
14641 @smallexample
14642 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14643 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14644 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14645 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14646 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14647 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14648 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14649 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14650 @end smallexample
14651
14652 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14653 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14654 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14655
14656
14657 @node Languages
14658 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14659 @cindex languages
14660
14661 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14662 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14663 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14664 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14665 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14666 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14667
14668 @cindex working language
14669 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14670 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14671 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14672 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14673 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14674 language}.
14675
14676 @menu
14677 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14678 * Show:: Displaying the language
14679 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14680 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14681 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14682 @end menu
14683
14684 @node Setting
14685 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14686
14687 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14688 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14689 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14690 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14691 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14692 are printed, etc.
14693
14694 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14695 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14696 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14697 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14698 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14699 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14700 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14701 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14702 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14703 Displaying the Language}.
14704
14705 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14706 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14707 another language. In that case, make the
14708 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14709 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14710 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14711
14712 @menu
14713 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14714 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14715 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14716 @end menu
14717
14718 @node Filenames
14719 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14720
14721 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14722 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14723
14724 @table @file
14725 @item .ada
14726 @itemx .ads
14727 @itemx .adb
14728 @itemx .a
14729 Ada source file.
14730
14731 @item .c
14732 C source file
14733
14734 @item .C
14735 @itemx .cc
14736 @itemx .cp
14737 @itemx .cpp
14738 @itemx .cxx
14739 @itemx .c++
14740 C@t{++} source file
14741
14742 @item .d
14743 D source file
14744
14745 @item .m
14746 Objective-C source file
14747
14748 @item .f
14749 @itemx .F
14750 Fortran source file
14751
14752 @item .mod
14753 Modula-2 source file
14754
14755 @item .s
14756 @itemx .S
14757 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14758 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14759 @end table
14760
14761 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14762 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14763
14764 @node Manually
14765 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14766
14767 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14768 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14769 your program.
14770
14771 @kindex set language
14772 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14773 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14774 a language, such as
14775 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14776 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14777
14778 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14779 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14780 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14781 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14782 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14783 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14784 command such as:
14785
14786 @smallexample
14787 print a = b + c
14788 @end smallexample
14789
14790 @noindent
14791 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14792 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14793 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14794 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14795
14796 @node Automatically
14797 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14798
14799 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14800 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14801 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14802 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14803 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14804 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14805 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14806 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14807 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14808
14809 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14810 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14811 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14812 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14813 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14814
14815 @node Show
14816 @section Displaying the Language
14817
14818 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14819 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14820
14821 @table @code
14822 @item show language
14823 @anchor{show language}
14824 @kindex show language
14825 Display the current working language. This is the
14826 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14827 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14828
14829 @item info frame
14830 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14831 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14832 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14833 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14834 information listed here.
14835
14836 @item info source
14837 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14838 Display the source language of this source file.
14839 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14840 information listed here.
14841 @end table
14842
14843 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14844 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14845 with a language explicitly:
14846
14847 @table @code
14848 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14849 @kindex set extension-language
14850 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14851 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14852
14853 @item info extensions
14854 @kindex info extensions
14855 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14856 @end table
14857
14858 @node Checks
14859 @section Type and Range Checking
14860
14861 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14862 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14863 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14864 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14865 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14866 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14867 errors when your program is running.
14868
14869 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14870 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14871 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14872 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14873
14874 @menu
14875 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14876 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14877 @end menu
14878
14879 @cindex type checking
14880 @cindex checks, type
14881 @node Type Checking
14882 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14883
14884 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14885 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14886 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14887 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14888
14889 @smallexample
14890 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14891
14892 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14893 $1 = 2
14894 @exdent but
14895 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14896 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14897 @end smallexample
14898
14899 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14900 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14901
14902 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14903 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14904 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14905 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14906 expressions like the second example above.
14907
14908 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14909 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14910 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14911 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14912 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14913 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14914
14915 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14916
14917 @kindex set check type
14918 @kindex show check type
14919 @table @code
14920 @item set check type on
14921 @itemx set check type off
14922 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14923 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14924 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14925
14926 @item show check type
14927 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14928 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14929 @end table
14930
14931 @cindex range checking
14932 @cindex checks, range
14933 @node Range Checking
14934 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14935
14936 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14937 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14938 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14939 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14940 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14941
14942 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14943 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14944 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14945 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14946
14947 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14948 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14949 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14950 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14951 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14952 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14953
14954 @smallexample
14955 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14956 @end smallexample
14957
14958 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14959 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14960 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14961
14962 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14963
14964 @kindex set check range
14965 @kindex show check range
14966 @table @code
14967 @item set check range auto
14968 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14969 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14970 each language.
14971
14972 @item set check range on
14973 @itemx set check range off
14974 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14975 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14976 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14977 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14978
14979 @item set check range warn
14980 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14981 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14982 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14983 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14984 systems).
14985
14986 @item show range
14987 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14988 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14989 @end table
14990
14991 @node Supported Languages
14992 @section Supported Languages
14993
14994 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14995 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14996 @c This is false ...
14997 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14998 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14999 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15000 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15001 language.
15002
15003 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15004 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15005 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15006 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15007 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15008 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15009 language reference or tutorial.
15010
15011 @menu
15012 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15013 * D:: D
15014 * Go:: Go
15015 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15016 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15017 * Fortran:: Fortran
15018 * Pascal:: Pascal
15019 * Rust:: Rust
15020 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15021 * Ada:: Ada
15022 @end menu
15023
15024 @node C
15025 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15026
15027 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15028 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15029
15030 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15031 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15032 together.
15033
15034 @cindex C@t{++}
15035 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15036 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15037 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15038 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15039 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15040 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15041 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15042
15043 @menu
15044 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15045 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15046 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15047 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15048 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15049 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15050 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15051 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15052 @end menu
15053
15054 @node C Operators
15055 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15056
15057 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15058
15059 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15060 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15061 often defined on groups of types.
15062
15063 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15064
15065 @itemize @bullet
15066
15067 @item
15068 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15069 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15070
15071 @item
15072 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15073 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15074
15075 @item
15076 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15077
15078 @item
15079 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15080
15081 @end itemize
15082
15083 @noindent
15084 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15085 in order of increasing precedence:
15086
15087 @table @code
15088 @item ,
15089 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15090 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15091 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15092
15093 @item =
15094 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15095 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15096
15097 @item @var{op}=
15098 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15099 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15100 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15101 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15102 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15103
15104 @item ?:
15105 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15106 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15107 should be of an integral type.
15108
15109 @item ||
15110 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15111
15112 @item &&
15113 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15114
15115 @item |
15116 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15117
15118 @item ^
15119 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15120
15121 @item &
15122 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15123
15124 @item ==@r{, }!=
15125 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15126 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15127
15128 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15129 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15130 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15131 and non-zero for true.
15132
15133 @item <<@r{, }>>
15134 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15135
15136 @item @@
15137 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15138
15139 @item +@r{, }-
15140 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15141 pointer types.
15142
15143 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15144 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15145 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15146 integral types.
15147
15148 @item ++@r{, }--
15149 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15150 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15151 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15152 operation takes place.
15153
15154 @item *
15155 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15156 @code{++}.
15157
15158 @item &
15159 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15160
15161 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15162 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15163 to examine the address
15164 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15165 stored.
15166
15167 @item -
15168 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15169 precedence as @code{++}.
15170
15171 @item !
15172 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15173 @code{++}.
15174
15175 @item ~
15176 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15177 @code{++}.
15178
15179
15180 @item .@r{, }->
15181 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15182 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15183 pointer based on the stored type information.
15184 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15185
15186 @item .*@r{, }->*
15187 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15188
15189 @item []
15190 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15191 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15192
15193 @item ()
15194 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15195
15196 @item ::
15197 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15198 and @code{class} types.
15199
15200 @item ::
15201 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15202 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15203 above.
15204 @end table
15205
15206 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15207 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15208 predefined meaning.
15209
15210 @node C Constants
15211 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15212
15213 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15214
15215 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15216 following ways:
15217
15218 @itemize @bullet
15219 @item
15220 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15221 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15222 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15223 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15224 @code{long} value.
15225
15226 @item
15227 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15228 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15229 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15230 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15231 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15232 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15233 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15234 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15235 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15236 constant.
15237
15238 @item
15239 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15240 integral equivalents.
15241
15242 @item
15243 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15244 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15245 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15246 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15247 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15248 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15249 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15250 @samp{\n} for newline.
15251
15252 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15253 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15254 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15255 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15256
15257 @item
15258 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15259 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15260 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15261 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15262 characters.
15263
15264 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15265 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15266 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15267
15268 @item
15269 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15270 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15271
15272 @item
15273 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15274 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15275 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15276 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15277 @end itemize
15278
15279 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15280 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15281
15282 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15283 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15284
15285 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15286 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15287 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15288 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15289 @quotation
15290 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15291 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15292 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15293 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15294 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15295 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15296 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15297 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15298 @end quotation
15299
15300 @enumerate
15301
15302 @cindex member functions
15303 @item
15304 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15305
15306 @smallexample
15307 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15308 @end smallexample
15309
15310 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15311 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15312 @item
15313 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15314 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15315 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15316 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15317 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15318
15319 @cindex call overloaded functions
15320 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15321 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15322 @item
15323 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15324 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15325 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15326 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15327 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15328 default arguments.
15329
15330 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15331 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15332 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15333 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15334 number of function arguments.
15335
15336 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15337 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15338 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15339
15340 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15341 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15342 @smallexample
15343 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15344 @end smallexample
15345
15346 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15347 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15348
15349 @cindex reference declarations
15350 @item
15351 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15352 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15353 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15354
15355 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15356 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15357 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15358 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15359 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15360
15361 @item
15362 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15363 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15364 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15365 necessary, for example in an expression like
15366 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15367 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15368 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15369
15370 @item
15371 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15372 specification.
15373 @end enumerate
15374
15375 @node C Defaults
15376 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15377
15378 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15379
15380 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15381 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15382 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15383 selects the working language.
15384
15385 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15386 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15387 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15388 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15389 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15390 for further details.
15391
15392 @node C Checks
15393 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15394
15395 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15396
15397 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15398 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15399 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15400 constants to pointers.
15401
15402 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15403 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15404 that is not itself an array.
15405
15406 @node Debugging C
15407 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15408
15409 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15410 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15411 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15412 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15413
15414 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15415 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15416 ,Expressions}.
15417
15418 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15419 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15420
15421 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15422
15423 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15424 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15425
15426 @table @code
15427 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15428 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15429 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15430 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15431 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15432 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15433
15434 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15435 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15436 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15437 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15438 classes.
15439 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15440
15441 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15442 @item catch throw
15443 @itemx catch rethrow
15444 @itemx catch catch
15445 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15446 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15447
15448 @cindex inheritance
15449 @item ptype @var{typename}
15450 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15451 @var{typename}.
15452 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15453
15454 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15455 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15456 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15457 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15458 multiple inheritance is in use.
15459
15460 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15461 @item demangle @var{name}
15462 Demangle @var{name}.
15463 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15464
15465 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15466 @item set print demangle
15467 @itemx show print demangle
15468 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15469 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15470 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15471 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15472 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15473
15474 @item set print object
15475 @itemx show print object
15476 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15477 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15478
15479 @item set print vtbl
15480 @itemx show print vtbl
15481 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15482 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15483 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15484 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15485
15486 @kindex set overload-resolution
15487 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15488 @item set overload-resolution on
15489 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15490 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15491 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15492 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15493 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15494 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15495
15496 @item set overload-resolution off
15497 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15498 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15499 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15500 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15501 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15502 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15503 argument types.
15504
15505 @kindex show overload-resolution
15506 @item show overload-resolution
15507 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15508
15509 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15510 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15511 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15512 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15513 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15514 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15515 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15516
15517 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15518
15519 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15520 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15521 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15522 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15523 for more detail.
15524
15525 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15526 function that returns a std::string:
15527
15528 @smallexample
15529 std::string function(int);
15530 @end smallexample
15531
15532 @noindent
15533 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15534 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15535
15536 @smallexample
15537 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15538 @end smallexample
15539
15540 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15541 tag. For example:
15542
15543 @smallexample
15544 (gdb) b function(int)
15545 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15546 (gdb) info breakpoints
15547 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15548 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15549 at main.cc:10
15550 @end smallexample
15551
15552 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15553 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15554 name, like:
15555
15556 @smallexample
15557 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15558 @end smallexample
15559 @end table
15560
15561 @node Decimal Floating Point
15562 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15563 @cindex decimal floating point format
15564
15565 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15566 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15567 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15568 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15569
15570 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15571 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15572 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15573 configured target.
15574
15575 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15576 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15577 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15578
15579 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15580 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15581 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15582
15583 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15584 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15585 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15586
15587 @node D
15588 @subsection D
15589
15590 @cindex D
15591 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15592 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15593 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15594
15595 @node Go
15596 @subsection Go
15597
15598 @cindex Go (programming language)
15599 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15600 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15601
15602 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15603
15604 @table @code
15605 @cindex current Go package
15606 @item The current Go package
15607 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15608 specifying global variables and functions.
15609
15610 For example, given the program:
15611
15612 @example
15613 package main
15614 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15615 func main () @{
15616 // ...
15617 @}
15618 @end example
15619
15620 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15621
15622 @example
15623 (gdb) p myglob
15624 (gdb) p main.myglob
15625 @end example
15626
15627 @cindex builtin Go types
15628 @item Builtin Go types
15629 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15630 as a string.
15631
15632 @cindex builtin Go functions
15633 @item Builtin Go functions
15634 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15635 function and handles it internally.
15636
15637 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15638 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15639 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15640 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15641 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15642 @end table
15643
15644 @node Objective-C
15645 @subsection Objective-C
15646
15647 @cindex Objective-C
15648 This section provides information about some commands and command
15649 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15650 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15651 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15652
15653 @menu
15654 * Method Names in Commands::
15655 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15656 @end menu
15657
15658 @node Method Names in Commands
15659 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15660
15661 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15662 names as line specifications:
15663
15664 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15665 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15666 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15667 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15668 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15669 @itemize
15670 @item @code{clear}
15671 @item @code{break}
15672 @item @code{info line}
15673 @item @code{jump}
15674 @item @code{list}
15675 @end itemize
15676
15677 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15678
15679 @smallexample
15680 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15681 @end smallexample
15682
15683 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15684 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15685 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15686 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15687 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15688 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15689 debugged, enter:
15690
15691 @smallexample
15692 break -[Fruit create]
15693 @end smallexample
15694
15695 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15696 enter:
15697
15698 @smallexample
15699 list +[NSText initialize]
15700 @end smallexample
15701
15702 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15703 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15704 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15705 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15706
15707 @smallexample
15708 break create
15709 @end smallexample
15710
15711 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15712 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15713 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15714 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15715 none apply.
15716
15717 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15718 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15719
15720 @smallexample
15721 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15722 @end smallexample
15723
15724 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15725 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15726 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15727 @kindex print-object
15728 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15729
15730 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15731
15732 @smallexample
15733 print -[@var{object} hash]
15734 @end smallexample
15735
15736 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15737 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15738 @noindent
15739 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15740 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15741 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15742 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15743 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15744 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15745
15746 @node OpenCL C
15747 @subsection OpenCL C
15748
15749 @cindex OpenCL C
15750 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15751
15752 @menu
15753 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15754 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15755 * OpenCL C Operators::
15756 @end menu
15757
15758 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15759 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15760
15761 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15762 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15763 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15764 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15765 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15766
15767 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15768 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15769
15770 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15771 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15772 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15773 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15774
15775 @node OpenCL C Operators
15776 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15777
15778 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15779 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15780 vector data types.
15781
15782 @node Fortran
15783 @subsection Fortran
15784 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15785
15786 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15787 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15788
15789 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15790 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15791 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15792 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15793 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15794 underscore.
15795
15796 @menu
15797 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15798 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15799 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15800 @end menu
15801
15802 @node Fortran Operators
15803 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15804
15805 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15806
15807 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15808 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15809 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15810
15811 @table @code
15812 @item **
15813 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15814 of the second one.
15815
15816 @item :
15817 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15818 represent a section of array.
15819
15820 @item %
15821 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15822 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15823 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15824 union type.
15825 @end table
15826
15827 @node Fortran Defaults
15828 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15829
15830 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15831
15832 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15833 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15834 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15835 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15836
15837 @node Special Fortran Commands
15838 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15839
15840 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15841
15842 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15843 such as displaying common blocks.
15844
15845 @table @code
15846 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15847 @kindex info common
15848 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15849 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15850 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15851 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15852 printed.
15853 @end table
15854
15855 @node Pascal
15856 @subsection Pascal
15857
15858 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15859 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15860 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15861 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15862 syntax.
15863
15864 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15865 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15866 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15867
15868 @node Rust
15869 @subsection Rust
15870
15871 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15872 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15873 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15874 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15875
15876 @itemize @bullet
15877 @item
15878 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15879 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15880 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15881
15882 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15883 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15884 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15885 @samp{B}.
15886
15887 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15888 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15889
15890 @item
15891 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15892 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15893 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15894 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15895 @samp{K::x::y}.
15896
15897 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15898 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15899 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15900 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15901 scope.
15902
15903 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15904 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15905
15906 @item
15907 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15908 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15909
15910 @item
15911 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15912
15913 @item
15914 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15915 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15916 never be destroyed.
15917
15918 @item
15919 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15920 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15921 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15922
15923 @item
15924 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15925 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15926 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15927 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15928 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15929 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15930 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15931 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15932
15933 @item
15934 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15935 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15936 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15937 @itemize @bullet
15938
15939 @item
15940 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15941
15942 @item
15943 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15944
15945 @item
15946 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15947 type names.
15948
15949 @item
15950 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15951
15952 @item
15953 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15954 available in the crate.
15955 @end itemize
15956 @end itemize
15957
15958 @node Modula-2
15959 @subsection Modula-2
15960
15961 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15962
15963 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15964 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15965 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15966 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15967 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15968 table.
15969
15970 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15971 @menu
15972 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15973 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15974 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15975 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15976 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15977 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15978 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15979 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15980 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15981 @end menu
15982
15983 @node M2 Operators
15984 @subsubsection Operators
15985 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15986
15987 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15988 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15989 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15990 following definitions hold:
15991
15992 @itemize @bullet
15993
15994 @item
15995 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15996 their subranges.
15997
15998 @item
15999 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16000
16001 @item
16002 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16003
16004 @item
16005 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16006 @var{type}}.
16007
16008 @item
16009 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16010
16011 @item
16012 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16013
16014 @item
16015 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16016 @end itemize
16017
16018 @noindent
16019 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16020 increasing precedence:
16021
16022 @table @code
16023 @item ,
16024 Function argument or array index separator.
16025
16026 @item :=
16027 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16028 @var{value}.
16029
16030 @item <@r{, }>
16031 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16032 types.
16033
16034 @item <=@r{, }>=
16035 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16036 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16037 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16038
16039 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16040 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16041 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16042 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16043 comment character.
16044
16045 @item IN
16046 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16047 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16048
16049 @item OR
16050 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16051
16052 @item AND@r{, }&
16053 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16054
16055 @item @@
16056 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16057
16058 @item +@r{, }-
16059 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16060 and difference on set types.
16061
16062 @item *
16063 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16064 on set types.
16065
16066 @item /
16067 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16068 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16069
16070 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16071 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16072 precedence as @code{*}.
16073
16074 @item -
16075 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16076
16077 @item ^
16078 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16079
16080 @item NOT
16081 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16082 @code{^}.
16083
16084 @item .
16085 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16086 precedence as @code{^}.
16087
16088 @item []
16089 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16090
16091 @item ()
16092 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16093 as @code{^}.
16094
16095 @item ::@r{, }.
16096 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16097 @end table
16098
16099 @quotation
16100 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16101 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16102 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16103 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16104 @end quotation
16105
16106
16107 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16108 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16109 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16110
16111 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16112 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16113
16114 @table @var
16115
16116 @item a
16117 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16118
16119 @item c
16120 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16121
16122 @item i
16123 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16124
16125 @item m
16126 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16127 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16128 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16129
16130 @item n
16131 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16132
16133 @item r
16134 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16135
16136 @item t
16137 represents a type.
16138
16139 @item v
16140 represents a variable.
16141
16142 @item x
16143 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16144 explanation of the function for details.
16145 @end table
16146
16147 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16148
16149 @table @code
16150 @item ABS(@var{n})
16151 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16152
16153 @item CAP(@var{c})
16154 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16155 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16156
16157 @item CHR(@var{i})
16158 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16159
16160 @item DEC(@var{v})
16161 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16162
16163 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16164 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16165 new value.
16166
16167 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16168 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16169 set.
16170
16171 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16172 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16173
16174 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16175 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16176
16177 @item INC(@var{v})
16178 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16179
16180 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16181 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16182 new value.
16183
16184 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16185 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16186 there. Returns the new set.
16187
16188 @item MAX(@var{t})
16189 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16190
16191 @item MIN(@var{t})
16192 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16193
16194 @item ODD(@var{i})
16195 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16196
16197 @item ORD(@var{x})
16198 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16199 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16200 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16201 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16202
16203 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16204 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16205 variable or a type.
16206
16207 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16208 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16209
16210 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16211 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16212 variable or a type.
16213
16214 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16215 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16216 @end table
16217
16218 @quotation
16219 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16220 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16221 an error.
16222 @end quotation
16223
16224 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16225 @node M2 Constants
16226 @subsubsection Constants
16227
16228 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16229 ways:
16230
16231 @itemize @bullet
16232
16233 @item
16234 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16235 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16236 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16237 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16238
16239 @item
16240 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16241 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16242 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16243 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16244 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16245 digits.
16246
16247 @item
16248 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16249 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16250 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16251 followed by a @samp{C}.
16252
16253 @item
16254 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16255 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16256 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16257 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16258 sequences.
16259
16260 @item
16261 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16262
16263 @item
16264 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16265 @code{FALSE}.
16266
16267 @item
16268 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16269
16270 @item
16271 Set constants are not yet supported.
16272 @end itemize
16273
16274 @node M2 Types
16275 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16276 @cindex Modula-2 types
16277
16278 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16279 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16280 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16281 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16282 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16283 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16284
16285 The first example contains the following section of code:
16286
16287 @smallexample
16288 VAR
16289 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16290 r: [20..40] ;
16291 @end smallexample
16292
16293 @noindent
16294 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16295 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16296
16297 @smallexample
16298 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16299 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16300 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16301 SET OF CHAR
16302 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16303 21
16304 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16305 [20..40]
16306 @end smallexample
16307
16308 @noindent
16309 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16310
16311 @smallexample
16312 VAR
16313 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16314 @end smallexample
16315
16316 @noindent
16317 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16318
16319 @smallexample
16320 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16321 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16322 @end smallexample
16323
16324 @noindent
16325 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16326 expressions using the debugger.
16327
16328 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16329 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16330
16331 @smallexample
16332 VAR
16333 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16334 @end smallexample
16335
16336 @smallexample
16337 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16338 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16339 @end smallexample
16340
16341 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16342 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16343 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16344 above.
16345
16346 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16347
16348 @smallexample
16349 TYPE
16350 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16351 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16352 VAR
16353 s: t ;
16354 BEGIN
16355 s := blue ;
16356 @end smallexample
16357
16358 @noindent
16359 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16360 and value of a variable.
16361
16362 @smallexample
16363 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16364 $1 = blue
16365 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16366 type = [blue..yellow]
16367 @end smallexample
16368
16369 @noindent
16370 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16371 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16372 their @code{C} counterparts.
16373
16374 @smallexample
16375 VAR
16376 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16377 BEGIN
16378 s[1] := 1 ;
16379 @end smallexample
16380
16381 @smallexample
16382 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16383 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16384 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16385 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16386 @end smallexample
16387
16388 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16389 pointer types as shown in this example:
16390
16391 @smallexample
16392 VAR
16393 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16394 BEGIN
16395 NEW(s) ;
16396 s^[1] := 1 ;
16397 @end smallexample
16398
16399 @noindent
16400 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16401
16402 @smallexample
16403 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16404 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16405 @end smallexample
16406
16407 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16408 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16409 types:
16410
16411 @smallexample
16412 TYPE
16413 foo = RECORD
16414 f1: CARDINAL ;
16415 f2: CHAR ;
16416 f3: myarray ;
16417 END ;
16418
16419 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16420 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16421 VAR
16422 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16423 @end smallexample
16424
16425 @noindent
16426 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16427 below.
16428
16429 @smallexample
16430 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16431 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16432 f1 : CARDINAL;
16433 f2 : CHAR;
16434 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16435 END
16436 @end smallexample
16437
16438 @node M2 Defaults
16439 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16440 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16441
16442 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16443 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16444 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16445 selected the working language.
16446
16447 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16448 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16449 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16450 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16451
16452 @node Deviations
16453 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16454 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16455
16456 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16457 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16458
16459 @itemize @bullet
16460 @item
16461 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16462 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16463 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16464 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16465 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16466 returned a pointer.)
16467
16468 @item
16469 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16470 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16471 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16472 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16473
16474 @item
16475 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16476 argument.
16477
16478 @item
16479 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16480 @end itemize
16481
16482 @node M2 Checks
16483 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16484 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16485
16486 @quotation
16487 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16488 range checking.
16489 @end quotation
16490 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16491
16492 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16493
16494 @itemize @bullet
16495 @item
16496 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16497 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16498
16499 @item
16500 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16501 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16502 @end itemize
16503
16504 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16505 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16506
16507 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16508 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16509
16510 @node M2 Scope
16511 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16512 @cindex scope
16513 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16514 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16515 @ifinfo
16516 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16517 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16518 @end ifinfo
16519 @ifnotinfo
16520 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16521 @end ifnotinfo
16522
16523 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16524 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16525 similar syntax:
16526
16527 @smallexample
16528
16529 @var{module} . @var{id}
16530 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16531 @end smallexample
16532
16533 @noindent
16534 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16535 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16536 identifier within your program, except another module.
16537
16538 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16539 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16540 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16541 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16542
16543 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16544 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16545 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16546 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16547 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16548 @var{module}.
16549
16550 @node GDB/M2
16551 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16552
16553 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16554 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16555 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16556 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16557 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16558 analogue in Modula-2.
16559
16560 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16561 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16562 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16563 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16564 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16565 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16566
16567 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16568 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16569 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16570
16571 @node Ada
16572 @subsection Ada
16573 @cindex Ada
16574
16575 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16576 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16577 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16578 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16579 to be difficult.
16580
16581
16582 @cindex expressions in Ada
16583 @menu
16584 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16585 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16586 in @value{GDBN}.
16587 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16588 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16589 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16590 subprograms.
16591 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16592 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16593 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16594 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16595 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16596 Profile
16597 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16598 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16599 @end menu
16600
16601 @node Ada Mode Intro
16602 @subsubsection Introduction
16603 @cindex Ada mode, general
16604
16605 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16606 syntax, with some extensions.
16607 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16608
16609 @itemize @bullet
16610 @item
16611 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16612 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16613 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16614 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16615
16616 @item
16617 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16618 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16619
16620 @item
16621 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16622 @end itemize
16623
16624 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16625 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16626 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16627 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16628 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16629
16630 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16631 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16632 was translated from an Ada source file.
16633
16634 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16635 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16636 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16637 middle (to allow based literals).
16638
16639 @node Omissions from Ada
16640 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16641 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16642
16643 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16644
16645 @itemize @bullet
16646 @item
16647 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16648
16649 @itemize @minus
16650 @item
16651 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16652 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16653
16654 @item
16655 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16656
16657 @item
16658 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16659
16660 @item
16661 @t{'Tag}.
16662
16663 @item
16664 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16665 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16666
16667 @item
16668 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16669 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16670
16671 @item
16672 @t{'Address}.
16673 @end itemize
16674
16675 @item
16676 The names in
16677 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16678 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16679 not currently available.
16680
16681 @item
16682 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16683 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16684 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16685 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16686 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16687 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16688 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16689 indeterminate values.
16690
16691 @item
16692 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16693 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16694 are not implemented.
16695
16696 @item
16697 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16698 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16699 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16700 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16701 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16702
16703 @smallexample
16704 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16705 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16706 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16707 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16708 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16709 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16710 @end smallexample
16711
16712 Changing a
16713 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16714 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16715 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16716 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16717 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16718 declared to have a type such as:
16719
16720 @smallexample
16721 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16722 Id : Integer;
16723 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16724 end record;
16725 @end smallexample
16726
16727 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16728 assignments:
16729
16730 @smallexample
16731 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16732 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16733 @end smallexample
16734
16735 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16736 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16737 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16738 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16739 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16740 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16741 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16742 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16743
16744 @item
16745 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16746
16747 @item
16748 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16749 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16750 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16751 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16752 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16753 the proper resolution.
16754
16755 @item
16756 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16757
16758 @item
16759 Entry calls are not implemented.
16760
16761 @item
16762 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16763 formats are not supported.
16764
16765 @item
16766 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16767
16768 @item
16769 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16770 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16771 context.
16772 Should your program
16773 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16774 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16775 @end itemize
16776
16777 @node Additions to Ada
16778 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16779 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16780
16781 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16782 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16783
16784 @itemize @bullet
16785 @item
16786 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16787 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16788 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16789 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16790 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16791 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16792 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16793 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16794
16795 @item
16796 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16797 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16798 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16799
16800 @item
16801 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16802 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16803
16804 @item
16805 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16806 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16807 @end itemize
16808
16809 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16810 additions specific to Ada:
16811
16812 @itemize @bullet
16813 @item
16814 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16815 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16816
16817 @smallexample
16818 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16819 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16820 @end smallexample
16821
16822 @item
16823 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16824 the value of its right-hand operand.
16825 This allows, for example,
16826 complex conditional breaks:
16827
16828 @smallexample
16829 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16830 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16831 @end smallexample
16832
16833 @item
16834 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16835 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16836 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16837 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16838 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16839 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16840 in strings. For example,
16841 @smallexample
16842 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16843 @end smallexample
16844 @noindent
16845 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16846 after each period.
16847
16848 @item
16849 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16850 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16851 to write
16852
16853 @smallexample
16854 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16855 @end smallexample
16856
16857 @item
16858 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16859 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16860 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16861 of 3 might print as
16862
16863 @smallexample
16864 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16865 @end smallexample
16866
16867 @noindent
16868 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16869 clause.
16870
16871 @item
16872 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16873 multi-character subsequence of
16874 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16875 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16876 in place of @t{a'length}.
16877
16878 @item
16879 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16880 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16881 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16882 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16883 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16884 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16885 For example,
16886 @smallexample
16887 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16888 @end smallexample
16889
16890 @item
16891 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16892 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16893 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16894 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16895 object.
16896
16897 @end itemize
16898
16899 @node Overloading support for Ada
16900 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16901 @cindex overloading, Ada
16902
16903 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16904 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16905 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16906 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16907 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16908 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16909
16910 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16911 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16912 use, for instance:
16913
16914 @smallexample
16915 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16916 Multiple matches for f
16917 [0] cancel
16918 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16919 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16920 >
16921 @end smallexample
16922
16923 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16924 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16925 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16926
16927 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16928 case:
16929
16930 @table @code
16931
16932 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16933 @item set ada print-signatures
16934 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16935 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16936 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16937
16938 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16939 @item show ada print-signatures
16940 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16941 overloads selection menu.
16942 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16943
16944 @end table
16945
16946 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16947 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16948
16949 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16950 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16951 before reaching the main procedure.
16952 As defined in the Ada Reference
16953 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16954 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16955 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16956 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16957
16958 @node Ada Exceptions
16959 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16960
16961 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16962
16963 @table @code
16964 @kindex info exceptions
16965 @item info exceptions
16966 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16967 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16968 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16969 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16970 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16971 @end table
16972
16973 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16974 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16975 argument.
16976
16977 @smallexample
16978 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16979 All defined Ada exceptions:
16980 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16981 program_error: 0x613d20
16982 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16983 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16984 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16985 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16986 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16987 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16988 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16989 @end smallexample
16990
16991 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16992 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16993
16994 @node Ada Tasks
16995 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16996 @cindex Ada, tasking
16997
16998 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16999 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17000
17001 @table @code
17002 @kindex info tasks
17003 @item info tasks
17004 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17005
17006
17007 @smallexample
17008 @iftex
17009 @leftskip=0.5cm
17010 @end iftex
17011 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17012 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17013 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17014 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17015 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17016 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17017
17018 @end smallexample
17019
17020 @noindent
17021 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17022 task currently being inspected.
17023
17024 @table @asis
17025 @item ID
17026 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17027
17028 @item TID
17029 The Ada task ID.
17030
17031 @item P-ID
17032 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17033
17034 @item Pri
17035 The base priority of the task.
17036
17037 @item State
17038 Current state of the task.
17039
17040 @table @code
17041 @item Unactivated
17042 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17043 executing.
17044
17045 @item Runnable
17046 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17047 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17048
17049 @item Terminated
17050 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17051 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17052 terminated themselves.
17053
17054 @item Child Activation Wait
17055 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17056
17057 @item Accept Statement
17058 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17059
17060 @item Waiting on entry call
17061 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17062
17063 @item Async Select Wait
17064 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17065 select statement.
17066
17067 @item Delay Sleep
17068 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17069 alternative open.
17070
17071 @item Child Termination Wait
17072 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17073 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17074 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17075
17076 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17077 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17078 finish terminating.
17079
17080 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17081 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17082 @end table
17083
17084 @item Name
17085 Name of the task in the program.
17086
17087 @end table
17088
17089 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17090 @item info task @var{taskno}
17091 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17092 the following example:
17093 @smallexample
17094 @iftex
17095 @leftskip=0.5cm
17096 @end iftex
17097 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17098 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17099 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17100 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17101 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17102 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17103 Name: task_1
17104 Thread: 0x807f378
17105 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17106 Base Priority: 15
17107 State: Runnable
17108 @end smallexample
17109
17110 @item task
17111 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17112 @cindex current Ada task ID
17113 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17114
17115 @smallexample
17116 @iftex
17117 @leftskip=0.5cm
17118 @end iftex
17119 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17120 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17121 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17122 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17123 (@value{GDBP}) task
17124 [Current task is 2]
17125 @end smallexample
17126
17127 @item task @var{taskno}
17128 @cindex Ada task switching
17129 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17130 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17131 from the current task to the given task.
17132
17133 @smallexample
17134 @iftex
17135 @leftskip=0.5cm
17136 @end iftex
17137 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17138 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17139 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17140 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17141 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17142 [Switching to task 1]
17143 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17144 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17145 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17146 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17147 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17148 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17149 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17150 @end smallexample
17151
17152 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17153 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17154 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17155 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17156 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17157 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17158 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17159 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17160 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17161
17162 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17163 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17164 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17165 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17166 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17167
17168 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17169 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17170 program.
17171
17172 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17173 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17174 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17175
17176 For example,
17177
17178 @smallexample
17179 @iftex
17180 @leftskip=0.5cm
17181 @end iftex
17182 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17183 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17184 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17185 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17186 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17187 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17188 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17189 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17190 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17191 Continuing.
17192 task # 1 running
17193 task # 2 running
17194
17195 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17196 15 flush;
17197 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17198 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17199 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17200 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17201 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17202 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17203 @end smallexample
17204 @end table
17205
17206 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17207 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17208 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17209
17210 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17211 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17212 the platform being used.
17213 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17214 switching is not supported.
17215
17216 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17217 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17218 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17219 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17220 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17221 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17222
17223 @node Ravenscar Profile
17224 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17225 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17226
17227 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17228 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17229 requirements.
17230
17231 @table @code
17232 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17233 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17234 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17235 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17236 Profile. This is the default.
17237
17238 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17239 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17240 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17241 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17242 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17243 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17244 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17245
17246 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17247 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17248 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17249 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17250
17251 @end table
17252
17253 @node Ada Settings
17254 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17255 @cindex Ada settings
17256
17257 @table @code
17258 @kindex set varsize-limit
17259 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17260 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17261 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17262 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17263 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17264 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17265 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17266
17267 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17268 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17269 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17270 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17271 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17272 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17273 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17274 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17275 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17276 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17277 size is less than @var{size}.
17278
17279 @kindex show varsize-limit
17280 @item show varsize-limit
17281 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17282 @end table
17283
17284 @node Ada Glitches
17285 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17286 @cindex Ada, problems
17287
17288 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17289 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17290 @value{GDBN},
17291 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17292 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17293
17294 @itemize @bullet
17295 @item
17296 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17297 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17298
17299 @item
17300 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17301 argument lists are treated as positional).
17302
17303 @item
17304 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17305
17306 @item
17307 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17308 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17309 the host machine.
17310
17311 @item
17312 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17313 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17314 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17315 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17316 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17317 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17318 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17319 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17320 you can usually resolve the confusion
17321 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17322 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17323 @end itemize
17324
17325 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17326 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17327 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17328 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17329 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17330 enabled.
17331
17332 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17333 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17334 @table @code
17335
17336 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17337 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17338 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17339 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17340 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17341 This is the default.
17342
17343 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17344 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17345 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17346 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17347 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17348 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17349 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17350
17351 @end table
17352
17353 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17354 @cindex GNAT encoding
17355 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17356 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17357 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17358 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17359 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17360 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17361
17362 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17363 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17364 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17365 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17366 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17367 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17368 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17369 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17370
17371 @table @code
17372
17373 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17374 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17375 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17376 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17377
17378 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17379 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17380 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17381
17382 @end table
17383
17384 @node Unsupported Languages
17385 @section Unsupported Languages
17386
17387 @cindex unsupported languages
17388 @cindex minimal language
17389 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17390 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17391 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17392 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17393 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17394 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17395
17396 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17397 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17398 language.
17399
17400 @node Symbols
17401 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17402
17403 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17404 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17405 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17406 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17407 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17408 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17409 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17410
17411 @cindex symbol names
17412 @cindex names of symbols
17413 @cindex quoting names
17414 @anchor{quoting names}
17415 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17416 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17417 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17418 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17419 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17420 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17421 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17422 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17423
17424 @smallexample
17425 p 'foo.c'::x
17426 @end smallexample
17427
17428 @noindent
17429 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17430
17431 @table @code
17432 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17433 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17434 @kindex set case-sensitive
17435 @item set case-sensitive on
17436 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17437 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17438 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17439 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17440 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17441 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17442 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17443 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17444 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17445 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17446 case-insensitive matches.
17447
17448 @kindex show case-sensitive
17449 @item show case-sensitive
17450 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17451 lookups.
17452
17453 @kindex set print type methods
17454 @item set print type methods
17455 @itemx set print type methods on
17456 @itemx set print type methods off
17457 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17458 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17459 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17460 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17461 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17462 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17463
17464 @kindex show print type methods
17465 @item show print type methods
17466 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17467 classes.
17468
17469 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17470 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17471 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17472 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17473 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17474 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17475 types defined in classes.
17476
17477 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17478 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17479 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17480 printing classes.
17481
17482 @kindex set print type typedefs
17483 @item set print type typedefs
17484 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17485 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17486
17487 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17488 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17489 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17490 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17491 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17492 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17493 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17494 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17495 types.
17496
17497 @kindex show print type typedefs
17498 @item show print type typedefs
17499 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17500 printing classes.
17501
17502 @kindex info address
17503 @cindex address of a symbol
17504 @item info address @var{symbol}
17505 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17506 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17507 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17508 is always stored.
17509
17510 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17511 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17512 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17513
17514 @kindex info symbol
17515 @cindex symbol from address
17516 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17517 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17518 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17519 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17520 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17521
17522 @smallexample
17523 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17524 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17525 @end smallexample
17526
17527 @noindent
17528 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17529 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17530
17531 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17532 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17533
17534 @smallexample
17535 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17536 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17537 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17538 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17539 @end smallexample
17540
17541 @kindex demangle
17542 @cindex demangle
17543 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17544 Demangle @var{name}.
17545 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17546 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17547
17548 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17549 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17550
17551 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17552 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17553
17554 @kindex whatis
17555 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17556 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17557 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17558 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17559
17560 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17561 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17562 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17563
17564 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17565 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17566 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17567 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17568 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17569 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17570 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17571 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17572 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17573
17574 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17575 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17576 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17577 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17578 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17579 unroll it.
17580
17581 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17582 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17583 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17584
17585 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17586 Available flags are:
17587
17588 @table @code
17589 @item r
17590 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17591 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17592 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17593
17594 @item m
17595 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17596
17597 @item M
17598 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17599 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17600
17601 @item t
17602 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17603 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17604 names are substituted when printing other types.
17605
17606 @item T
17607 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17608 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17609
17610 @item o
17611 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17612 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17613
17614 For example, given the following declarations:
17615
17616 @smallexample
17617 struct tuv
17618 @{
17619 int a1;
17620 char *a2;
17621 int a3;
17622 @};
17623
17624 struct xyz
17625 @{
17626 int f1;
17627 char f2;
17628 void *f3;
17629 struct tuv f4;
17630 @};
17631
17632 union qwe
17633 @{
17634 struct tuv fff1;
17635 struct xyz fff2;
17636 @};
17637
17638 struct tyu
17639 @{
17640 int a1 : 1;
17641 int a2 : 3;
17642 int a3 : 23;
17643 char a4 : 2;
17644 int64_t a5;
17645 int a6 : 5;
17646 int64_t a7 : 3;
17647 @};
17648 @end smallexample
17649
17650 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17651
17652 @smallexample
17653 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17654 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17655 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17656 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17657 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17658 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17659
17660 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17661 @}
17662 @end smallexample
17663
17664 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17665 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17666 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17667 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17668 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17669 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17670 its fields.
17671
17672 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17673
17674 @smallexample
17675 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17676 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17677 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17678 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17679 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17680 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17681 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17682
17683 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17684 @} fff1;
17685 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17686 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17687 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17688 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17689 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17690 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17691 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17692 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17693 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17694 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17695
17696 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17697 @} f4;
17698
17699 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17700 @} fff2;
17701
17702 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17703 @}
17704 @end smallexample
17705
17706 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17707 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17708 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17709 of these structures' fields.
17710
17711 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17712 bitfields:
17713
17714 @smallexample
17715 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17716 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17717 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17718 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17719 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17720 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17721 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17722 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17723 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17724 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17725 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17726
17727 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17728 @}
17729 @end smallexample
17730
17731 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17732 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17733 @end table
17734
17735 @kindex ptype
17736 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17737 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17738 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17739 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17740
17741 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17742 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17743 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17744 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17745 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17746 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17747 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17748 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17749
17750 For example, for this variable declaration:
17751
17752 @smallexample
17753 typedef double real_t;
17754 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17755 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17756 complex_t var;
17757 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17758 @end smallexample
17759
17760 @noindent
17761 the two commands give this output:
17762
17763 @smallexample
17764 @group
17765 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17766 type = complex_t
17767 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17768 type = struct complex @{
17769 real_t real;
17770 double imag;
17771 @}
17772 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17773 type = struct complex
17774 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17775 type = struct complex
17776 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17777 type = struct complex @{
17778 real_t real;
17779 double imag;
17780 @}
17781 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17782 type = real_t *
17783 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17784 type = double *
17785 @end group
17786 @end smallexample
17787
17788 @noindent
17789 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17790 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17791
17792 @cindex incomplete type
17793 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17794 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17795 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17796 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17797 given these declarations:
17798
17799 @smallexample
17800 struct foo;
17801 struct foo *fooptr;
17802 @end smallexample
17803
17804 @noindent
17805 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17806
17807 @smallexample
17808 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17809 $1 = <incomplete type>
17810 @end smallexample
17811
17812 @noindent
17813 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17814 completely specified.
17815
17816 @cindex unknown type
17817 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17818 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17819 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17820 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17821 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17822 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17823 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17824 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17825
17826 @smallexample
17827 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17828 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17829 @end smallexample
17830
17831 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17832 of such variables.
17833
17834 @kindex info types
17835 @item info types @var{regexp}
17836 @itemx info types
17837 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17838 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17839 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17840 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17841 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17842 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17843 name is @code{value}.
17844
17845 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17846 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17847 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17848
17849 @kindex info type-printers
17850 @item info type-printers
17851 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17852 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17853 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17854 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17855 type printers.
17856
17857 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17858
17859 @kindex enable type-printer
17860 @kindex disable type-printer
17861 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17862 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17863 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17864
17865 @kindex info scope
17866 @cindex local variables
17867 @item info scope @var{location}
17868 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17869 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17870 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17871 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17872 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17873
17874 @smallexample
17875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17876 Scope for command_line_handler:
17877 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17878 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17879 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17880 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17881 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17882 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17883 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17884 @end smallexample
17885
17886 @noindent
17887 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17888 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17889 collect}.
17890
17891 @kindex info source
17892 @item info source
17893 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17894 the function containing the current point of execution:
17895 @itemize @bullet
17896 @item
17897 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17898 @item
17899 the directory it was compiled in,
17900 @item
17901 its length, in lines,
17902 @item
17903 which programming language it is written in,
17904 @item
17905 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17906 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17907 @item
17908 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17909 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17910 @item
17911 whether the debugging information includes information about
17912 preprocessor macros.
17913 @end itemize
17914
17915
17916 @kindex info sources
17917 @item info sources
17918 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17919 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17920 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17921
17922 @kindex info functions
17923 @item info functions
17924 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17925 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17926 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17927 number.
17928
17929 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17930 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types of
17931 functions whose names contain a match for regular expression
17932 @var{regexp}. Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
17933 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17934 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
17935 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17936 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17937
17938 @kindex info variables
17939 @item info variables
17940 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17941 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17942 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
17943 their respective source line numbers.
17944
17945 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17946 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the names and data types of
17947 non-local variables whose names contain a match for regular expression
17948 @var{regexp}.
17949
17950 @kindex info classes
17951 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17952 @item info classes
17953 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17954 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17955 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17956 expression.
17957
17958 @kindex info selectors
17959 @item info selectors
17960 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17961 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17962 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17963 expression.
17964
17965 @ignore
17966 This was never implemented.
17967 @kindex info methods
17968 @item info methods
17969 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17970 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17971 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17972 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17973 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17974 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17975 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17976 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17977 @end ignore
17978
17979 @cindex opaque data types
17980 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17981 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17982 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17983 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17984 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17985 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17986 another source file. The default is on.
17987
17988 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17989 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17990
17991 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17992 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17993 is printed as follows:
17994 @smallexample
17995 @{<no data fields>@}
17996 @end smallexample
17997
17998 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17999 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18000 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18001
18002 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18003 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18004 @item set print symbol-loading
18005 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18006 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18007 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18008 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18009 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18010 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18011 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18012 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18013 can be annoying.
18014 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18015 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18016 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18017 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18018
18019 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18020 @item show print symbol-loading
18021 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18022 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18023
18024 @kindex maint print symbols
18025 @cindex symbol dump
18026 @kindex maint print psymbols
18027 @cindex partial symbol dump
18028 @kindex maint print msymbols
18029 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18030 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18031 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18032 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18033 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18034 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18035 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18036 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18037 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18038 that objfile.
18039 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18040 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18041 @code{main}.
18042 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18043 source file.
18044
18045 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18046 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18047 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18048 tables.
18049 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18050 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18051 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18052 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18053 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18054 ``ELF symbols''.
18055
18056 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18057 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18058
18059 @kindex maint info symtabs
18060 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18061 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18062 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18063 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18064 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18065 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18066 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18067
18068 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18069 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18070 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18071 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18072 structure in more detail. For example:
18073
18074 @smallexample
18075 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18076 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18077 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18078 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18079 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18080 readin no
18081 fullname (null)
18082 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18083 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18084 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18085 dependencies (none)
18086 @}
18087 @}
18088 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18089 (@value{GDBP})
18090 @end smallexample
18091 @noindent
18092 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18093 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18094 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18095 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18096 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18097
18098 @smallexample
18099 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18100 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18101 line 1574.
18102 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18103 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18104 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18105 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18106 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18107 dirname (null)
18108 fullname (null)
18109 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18110 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18111 debugformat DWARF 2
18112 @}
18113 @}
18114 (@value{GDBP})
18115 @end smallexample
18116
18117 @kindex maint info line-table
18118 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18119 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18120 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18121
18122 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18123 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18124 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18125
18126 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18127 @cindex symbol cache size
18128 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18129 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18130 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18131 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18132 with different sizes.
18133
18134 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18135 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18136 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18137
18138 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18139 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18140 @item maint print symbol-cache
18141 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18142 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18143
18144 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18145 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18146 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18147 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18148 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18149
18150 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18151 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18152 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18153 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18154 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18155 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18156
18157 @end table
18158
18159 @node Altering
18160 @chapter Altering Execution
18161
18162 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18163 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18164 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18165 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18166 program.
18167
18168 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18169 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18170 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18171
18172 @menu
18173 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18174 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18175 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18176 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18177 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18178 * Patching:: Patching your program
18179 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18180 @end menu
18181
18182 @node Assignment
18183 @section Assignment to Variables
18184
18185 @cindex assignment
18186 @cindex setting variables
18187 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18188 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18189
18190 @smallexample
18191 print x=4
18192 @end smallexample
18193
18194 @noindent
18195 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18196 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18197 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18198 information on operators in supported languages.
18199
18200 @kindex set variable
18201 @cindex variables, setting
18202 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18203 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18204 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18205 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18206 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18207
18208 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18209 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18210 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18211 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18212 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18213 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18214 command @code{set width}:
18215
18216 @smallexample
18217 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18218 type = double
18219 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18220 $4 = 13
18221 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18222 Invalid syntax in expression.
18223 @end smallexample
18224
18225 @noindent
18226 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18227 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18228
18229 @smallexample
18230 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18231 @end smallexample
18232
18233 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18234 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18235 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18236 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18237 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18238 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18239
18240 @smallexample
18241 @group
18242 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18243 type = double
18244 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18245 $1 = 1
18246 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18247 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18248 $2 = 1
18249 (@value{GDBP}) r
18250 The program being debugged has been started already.
18251 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18252 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18253 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18254 Invalid bfd target.
18255 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18256 The current BFD target is "=4".
18257 @end group
18258 @end smallexample
18259
18260 @noindent
18261 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18262 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18263 @code{g}, use
18264
18265 @smallexample
18266 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18267 @end smallexample
18268
18269 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18270 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18271 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18272 same length or shorter.
18273 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18274 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18275
18276 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18277 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18278 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18279 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18280 and representation in memory), and
18281
18282 @smallexample
18283 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18284 @end smallexample
18285
18286 @noindent
18287 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18288
18289 @node Jumping
18290 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18291
18292 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18293 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18294 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18295
18296 @table @code
18297 @kindex jump
18298 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18299 @item jump @var{location}
18300 @itemx j @var{location}
18301 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18302 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18303 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18304 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18305 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18306
18307 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18308 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18309 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18310 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18311 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18312 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18313 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18314 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18315 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18316 @end table
18317
18318 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18319 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18320 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18321 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18322 example,
18323
18324 @smallexample
18325 set $pc = 0x485
18326 @end smallexample
18327
18328 @noindent
18329 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18330 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18331 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18332
18333 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18334 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18335 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18336 detail.
18337
18338 @c @group
18339 @node Signaling
18340 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18341 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18342
18343 @table @code
18344 @kindex signal
18345 @item signal @var{signal}
18346 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18347 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18348 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18349 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18350
18351 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18352 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18353 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18354 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18355 signal.
18356
18357 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18358 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18359 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18360 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18361 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18362 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18363 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18364 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18365
18366 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18367 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18368 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18369 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18370 passes the signal directly to your program.
18371
18372 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18373 after executing the command.
18374
18375 @kindex queue-signal
18376 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18377 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18378 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18379 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18380 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18381 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18382 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18383 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18384 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18385
18386 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18387 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18388 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18389 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18390 @code{continue} command.
18391
18392 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18393 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18394 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18395 (@pxref{Signals}).
18396 @end table
18397 @c @end group
18398
18399 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18400 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18401
18402 @node Returning
18403 @section Returning from a Function
18404
18405 @table @code
18406 @cindex returning from a function
18407 @kindex return
18408 @item return
18409 @itemx return @var{expression}
18410 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18411 command. If you give an
18412 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18413 value.
18414 @end table
18415
18416 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18417 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18418 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18419 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18420
18421 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18422 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18423 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18424 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18425 of functions.
18426
18427 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18428 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18429 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18430 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18431 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18432
18433 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18434 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18435 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18436 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18437 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18438 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18439 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18440 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18441 assignment into the right register(s).
18442
18443 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18444 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18445 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18446 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18447 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18448 into a @code{long long int}:
18449
18450 @smallexample
18451 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18452 29 return 31;
18453 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18454 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18455 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18456 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18457 (@value{GDBP})
18458 @end smallexample
18459
18460 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18461 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18462 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18463 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18464 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18465 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18466 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18467 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18468
18469 @smallexample
18470 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18471 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18472 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18473 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18474 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18475 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18476 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18477 (@value{GDBP})
18478 @end smallexample
18479
18480 @node Calling
18481 @section Calling Program Functions
18482
18483 @table @code
18484 @cindex calling functions
18485 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18486 @item print @var{expr}
18487 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18488 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18489 debugged.
18490
18491 @kindex call
18492 @item call @var{expr}
18493 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18494 returned values.
18495
18496 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18497 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18498 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18499 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18500 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18501 value history.
18502 @end table
18503
18504 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18505 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18506 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18507 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18508
18509 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18510 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18511 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18512 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18513 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18514 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18515 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18516 in that case is controlled by the
18517 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18518
18519 @table @code
18520 @item set unwindonsignal
18521 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18522 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18523 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18524 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18525 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18526 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18527 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18528 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18529 received.
18530
18531 @item show unwindonsignal
18532 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18533 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18534 @value{GDBN}.
18535
18536 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18537 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18538 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18539 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18540 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18541 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18542 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18543 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18544 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18545 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18546
18547 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18548 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18549 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18550 @value{GDBN}.
18551
18552 @end table
18553
18554 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18555
18556 @cindex no debug info functions
18557 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18558 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18559 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18560 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18561 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18562 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18563
18564 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18565 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18566 declared return type. For example:
18567
18568 @smallexample
18569 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18570 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18571 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18572 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18573 @end smallexample
18574
18575 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18576 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18577 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18578 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18579
18580 @smallexample
18581 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18582 @end smallexample
18583
18584 @noindent
18585 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18586
18587 @smallexample
18588 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18589 @end smallexample
18590
18591 @noindent
18592 these calls are equivalent:
18593
18594 @smallexample
18595 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18596 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18597 @end smallexample
18598
18599 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18600 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18601 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18602 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18603 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18604 float parameters, and no debug info:
18605
18606 @smallexample
18607 float
18608 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18609 float v1, v2;
18610 @{
18611 return v1 * v2;
18612 @}
18613 @end smallexample
18614
18615 @noindent
18616 you call it like this:
18617
18618 @smallexample
18619 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18620 @end smallexample
18621
18622 @node Patching
18623 @section Patching Programs
18624
18625 @cindex patching binaries
18626 @cindex writing into executables
18627 @cindex writing into corefiles
18628
18629 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18630 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18631 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18632 patching your program's binary.
18633
18634 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18635 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18636 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18637 repairs.
18638
18639 @table @code
18640 @kindex set write
18641 @item set write on
18642 @itemx set write off
18643 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18644 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18645 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18646
18647 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18648 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18649 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18650
18651 @item show write
18652 @kindex show write
18653 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18654 as well as reading.
18655 @end table
18656
18657 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18658 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18659 @cindex injecting code
18660 @cindex writing into executables
18661 @cindex compiling code
18662
18663 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18664 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18665 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18666 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18667
18668 @table @code
18669 @kindex compile code
18670 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18671 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18672 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18673 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18674 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18675 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18676 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18677 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18678 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18679 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18680 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18681 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18682
18683 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18684 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18685 E.g.:
18686
18687 @smallexample
18688 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18689 @end smallexample
18690
18691 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18692 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18693 from actual source code. E.g.:
18694
18695 @smallexample
18696 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18697 @end smallexample
18698
18699 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18700 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18701 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18702 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18703 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18704 editor.
18705
18706 @smallexample
18707 compile code
18708 >printf ("hello\n");
18709 >printf ("world\n");
18710 >end
18711 @end smallexample
18712
18713 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18714 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18715 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18716 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18717 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18718 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18719 inferior symbols otherwise.
18720
18721 @kindex compile file
18722 @item compile file @var{filename}
18723 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18724 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18725
18726 @smallexample
18727 compile file /home/user/example.c
18728 @end smallexample
18729 @end table
18730
18731 @table @code
18732 @item compile print @var{expr}
18733 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18734 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18735 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18736 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18737 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18738 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18739 Formats}.
18740
18741 @item compile print
18742 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18743 @cindex reprint the last value
18744 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18745 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18746 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18747 multiple-line editor.
18748 @end table
18749
18750 @noindent
18751 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18752
18753 @table @code
18754 @anchor{set debug compile}
18755 @item set debug compile
18756 @cindex compile command debugging info
18757 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18758 injecting the code. The default is off.
18759
18760 @item show debug compile
18761 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18762 compiling and injecting the code.
18763
18764 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18765 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18766 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18767 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18768 The default is off.
18769
18770 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18771 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18772 C@t{++} type conversion.
18773 @end table
18774
18775 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18776
18777 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18778 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18779 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18780 injecting process.
18781
18782 @noindent
18783 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18784
18785 @table @asis
18786 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18787 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18788 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18789 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18790
18791 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18792 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18793 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18794 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18795 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18796 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18797 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18798 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18799
18800 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18801 @end table
18802
18803 @noindent
18804 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18805
18806 @table @code
18807 @item set compile-args
18808 @cindex compile command options override
18809 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18810 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18811 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18812 compilation.
18813
18814 @item show compile-args
18815 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18816 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18817 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18818 @end table
18819
18820 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18821
18822 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18823 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18824 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18825
18826 @table @asis
18827 @item C code examples and caveats
18828 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18829 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18830 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18831 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18832 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18833
18834 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18835 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18836 much like any other normal debugging session.
18837
18838 @smallexample
18839 void function1 (void)
18840 @{
18841 int i = 42;
18842 printf ("function 1\n");
18843 @}
18844
18845 void function2 (void)
18846 @{
18847 int j = 12;
18848 function1 ();
18849 @}
18850
18851 int main(void)
18852 @{
18853 int k = 6;
18854 int *p;
18855 function2 ();
18856 return 0;
18857 @}
18858 @end smallexample
18859
18860 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18861 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18862 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18863
18864 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18865 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18866 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18867 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18868 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18869
18870 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18871 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18872 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18873 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18874 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18875 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18876 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18877 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18878 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18879 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18880
18881 @smallexample
18882 compile code k = 3;
18883 @end smallexample
18884
18885 @noindent
18886 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18887 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18888 @code{compile} command changes it.
18889
18890 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18891 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18892 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18893 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18894 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18895
18896 @smallexample
18897 compile code j = 3;
18898 @end smallexample
18899
18900 @noindent
18901 will result in a compilation error message.
18902
18903 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18904 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18905 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18906
18907 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18908 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18909 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18910 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18911
18912 @smallexample
18913 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18914 @end smallexample
18915
18916 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18917 command has completed:
18918
18919 @smallexample
18920 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18921 @end smallexample
18922
18923 @noindent
18924 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18925 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18926 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18927 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18928 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18929
18930 @smallexample
18931 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18932 @end smallexample
18933
18934 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18935 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18936 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18937 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18938 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18939 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18940 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18941 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18942
18943 @smallexample
18944 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18945 @end smallexample
18946
18947 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18948 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18949 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18950 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18951 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18952 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18953 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18954
18955 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18956 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18957 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18958 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18959 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18960 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18961
18962 @smallexample
18963 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18964 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18965 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18966 Compilation failed.
18967 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18968 42
18969 @end smallexample
18970
18971 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18972 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18973 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18974 will print to the console.
18975 @end table
18976
18977 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18978
18979 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18980 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18981 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18982 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18983 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18984 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18985 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18986 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18987
18988
18989 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18990 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18991 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18992 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18993 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18994 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18995 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18996
18997 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18998 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18999 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19000 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19001 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19002 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19003 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19004
19005 @table @code
19006 @item set compile-gcc
19007 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19008 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19009 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19010 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19011 default.
19012
19013 @item show compile-gcc
19014 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19015 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19016 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19017 @end table
19018
19019 @node GDB Files
19020 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19021
19022 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19023 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19024 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19025 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19026
19027 @menu
19028 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19029 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19030 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19031 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19032 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19033 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19034 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19035 @end menu
19036
19037 @node Files
19038 @section Commands to Specify Files
19039
19040 @cindex symbol table
19041 @cindex core dump file
19042
19043 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19044 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19045 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19046 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19047
19048 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19049 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19050 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19051 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19052 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19053 new files are useful.
19054
19055 @table @code
19056 @cindex executable file
19057 @kindex file
19058 @item file @var{filename}
19059 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19060 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19061 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19062 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19063 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19064 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19065 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19066 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19067
19068 @cindex unlinked object files
19069 @cindex patching object files
19070 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19071 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19072 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19073 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19074 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19075 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19076 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19077 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19078
19079 @item file
19080 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19081 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19082
19083 @kindex exec-file
19084 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19085 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19086 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19087 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19088 discard information on the executable file.
19089
19090 @kindex symbol-file
19091 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19092 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19093 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19094 table and program to run from the same file.
19095
19096 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19097 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19098 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19099 enabled.
19100
19101 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19102 program's symbol table.
19103
19104 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19105 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19106 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19107 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19108 @value{GDBN}.
19109
19110 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19111 executing it once.
19112
19113 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19114 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19115 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19116 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19117 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19118 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19119 optimized code.
19120
19121 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19122 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19123 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19124 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19125 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19126
19127 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19128 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19129 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19130 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19131 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19132 Warnings and Messages}.)
19133
19134 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19135 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19136 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19137 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19138 in stabs format.
19139
19140 @kindex readnow
19141 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19142 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19143 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19144 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19145 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19146 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19147 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19148 entire symbol table available.
19149
19150 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19151 @cindex never read symbols
19152 @cindex symbols, never read
19153 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19154 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19155 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19156 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19157 @xref{--readnever}.
19158
19159 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19160 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19161 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19162 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19163 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19164 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19165 @c files.
19166
19167 @kindex core-file
19168 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19169 @itemx core
19170 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19171 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19172 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19173 executable file itself for other parts.
19174
19175 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19176 to be used.
19177
19178 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19179 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19180 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19181 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19182 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19183
19184 @kindex add-symbol-file
19185 @cindex dynamic linking
19186 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19187 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19188 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19189 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19190 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19191 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19192 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19193 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19194 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19195 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19196 can be given as an expression.
19197
19198 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19199 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19200 specified explicitly.
19201
19202 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19203 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19204 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19205 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19206
19207 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19208
19209 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19210 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19211 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19212 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19213 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19214 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19215 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19216 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19217 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19218
19219 @itemize @bullet
19220 @item
19221 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19222 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19223 @item
19224 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19225 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19226 @item
19227 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19228 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19229 @end itemize
19230
19231 @noindent
19232 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19233 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19234 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19235 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19236 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19237 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19238 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19239 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19240 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19241 way.
19242
19243 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19244
19245 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19246 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19247 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19248 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19249 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19250 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19251
19252 @smallexample
19253 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19254 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19255 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19256 (y or n) y
19257 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19258 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19259 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19260 (gdb)
19261 @end smallexample
19262
19263
19264 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19265
19266 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19267 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19268 @cindex load symbols from memory
19269 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19270 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19271 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19272 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19273 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19274 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19275 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19276 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19277 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19278
19279 @kindex section
19280 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19281 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19282 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19283 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19284 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19285 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19286 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19287 their addresses.
19288
19289 @kindex info files
19290 @kindex info target
19291 @item info files
19292 @itemx info target
19293 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19294 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19295 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19296 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19297 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19298 current ones.
19299
19300 @kindex maint info sections
19301 @item maint info sections
19302 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19303 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19304 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19305 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19306 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19307 may be arbitrarily combined):
19308
19309 @table @code
19310 @item ALLOBJ
19311 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19312 @item @var{sections}
19313 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19314 @item @var{section-flags}
19315 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19316 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19317 @table @code
19318 @item ALLOC
19319 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19320 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19321 @item LOAD
19322 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19323 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19324 @item RELOC
19325 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19326 @item READONLY
19327 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19328 @item CODE
19329 Section contains executable code only.
19330 @item DATA
19331 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19332 @item ROM
19333 Section will reside in ROM.
19334 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19335 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19336 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19337 Section is not empty.
19338 @item NEVER_LOAD
19339 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19340 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19341 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19342 COFF shared library information.
19343 @item IS_COMMON
19344 Section contains common symbols.
19345 @end table
19346 @end table
19347 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19348 @cindex read-only sections
19349 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19350 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19351 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19352 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19353 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19354 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19355 enhancement to debugging performance.
19356
19357 The default is off.
19358
19359 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19360 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19361 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19362 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19363
19364 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19365 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19366 @end table
19367
19368 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19369 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19370 name and remembers it that way.
19371
19372 @cindex shared libraries
19373 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19374 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19375 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19376 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19377
19378 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19379 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19380
19381 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19382 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19383 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19384 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19385 debugging a core file).
19386
19387 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19388 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19389 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19390
19391 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19392 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19393 particularly large or there are many of them.
19394
19395 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19396 commands:
19397
19398 @table @code
19399 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19400 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19401 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19402 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19403 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19404 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19405 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19406 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19407
19408 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19409 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19410 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19411 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19412 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19413 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19414 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19415 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19416 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19417
19418 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19419 @item show auto-solib-add
19420 Display the current autoloading mode.
19421 @end table
19422
19423 @cindex load shared library
19424 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19425 command:
19426
19427 @table @code
19428 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19429 @kindex info share
19430 @item info share @var{regex}
19431 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19432 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19433 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19434 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19435
19436 @kindex info dll
19437 @item info dll @var{regex}
19438 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19439
19440 @kindex sharedlibrary
19441 @kindex share
19442 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19443 @itemx share @var{regex}
19444 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19445 Unix regular expression.
19446 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19447 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19448 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19449 loaded.
19450
19451 @item nosharedlibrary
19452 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19453 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19454 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19455 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19456 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19457 discarded.
19458 @end table
19459
19460 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19461 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19462 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19463 Catchpoints}).
19464
19465 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19466 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19467 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19468 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19469
19470 @table @code
19471 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19472 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19473 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19474 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19475 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19476 shared library.
19477
19478 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19479 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19480 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19481 library events happen.
19482 @end table
19483
19484 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19485 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19486 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19487 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19488 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19489 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19490 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19491 not.
19492
19493 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19494 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19495 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19496 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19497 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19498
19499 @table @code
19500 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19501 @cindex system root, alternate
19502 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19503 @kindex set sysroot
19504 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19505 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19506 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19507 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19508 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19509 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19510 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19511 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19512 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19513 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19514 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19515 @var{path}.
19516
19517 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19518 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19519 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19520 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19521 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19522 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19523 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19524 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19525 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19526 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19527 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19528 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19529 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19530 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19531
19532 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19533 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19534 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19535 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19536 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19537
19538 @smallexample
19539 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19540 @end smallexample
19541
19542 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19543 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19544 system:
19545
19546 @smallexample
19547 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19548 @end smallexample
19549
19550 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19551 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19552 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19553 colons:
19554
19555 @smallexample
19556 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19557 @end smallexample
19558
19559 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19560 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19561 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19562 @samp{z}):
19563
19564 @smallexample
19565 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19566 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19567 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19568 @end smallexample
19569
19570 @noindent
19571 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19572 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19573 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19574
19575 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19576 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19577
19578 @smallexample
19579 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19580 @end smallexample
19581
19582 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19583 if you don't want or need to.
19584
19585 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19586 sysroot}.
19587
19588 @cindex default system root
19589 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19590 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19591 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19592 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19593 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19594 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19595 location.
19596
19597 @kindex show sysroot
19598 @item show sysroot
19599 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19600
19601 @kindex set solib-search-path
19602 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19603 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19604 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19605 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19606 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19607 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19608 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19609 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19610 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19611 of shared library symbols.
19612
19613 @kindex show solib-search-path
19614 @item show solib-search-path
19615 Display the current shared library search path.
19616
19617 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19618 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19619 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19620 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19621 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19622
19623 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19624 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19625 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19626 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19627 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19628 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19629 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19630 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19631 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19632 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19633 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19634 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19635 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19636 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19637 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19638 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19639 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19640 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19641 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19642 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19643 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19644 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19645
19646 @table @code
19647 @item unix
19648 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19649 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19650 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19651 the forward slash.
19652
19653 @item dos-based
19654 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19655 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19656 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19657 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19658 considered directory separators.
19659
19660 @item auto
19661 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19662 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19663 This is the default.
19664 @end table
19665 @end table
19666
19667 @cindex file name canonicalization
19668 @cindex base name differences
19669 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19670 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19671 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19672 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19673 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19674 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19675 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19676 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19677 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19678 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19679 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19680 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19681 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19682 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19683 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19684
19685 @table @code
19686 @item set basenames-may-differ
19687 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19688 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19689
19690 @item show basenames-may-differ
19691 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19692 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19693 @end table
19694
19695 @node File Caching
19696 @section File Caching
19697 @cindex caching of opened files
19698 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19699
19700 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19701 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19702 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19703 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19704
19705 @table @code
19706 @kindex maint info bfds
19707 @item maint info bfds
19708 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19709 @value{GDBN}.
19710
19711 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19712 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19713 @kindex bfd caching
19714 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19715 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19716 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19717 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19718 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19719 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19720 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19721 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19722 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19723
19724 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19725 @kindex bfd caching
19726 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19727 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19728
19729 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19730 @kindex bfd caching
19731 @item show debug bfd-cache
19732 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19733 @end table
19734
19735 @node Separate Debug Files
19736 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19737 @cindex separate debugging information files
19738 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19739 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19740 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19741 @cindex global debugging information directories
19742 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19743 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19744
19745 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19746 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19747 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19748 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19749 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19750 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19751 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19752
19753 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19754 file:
19755
19756 @itemize @bullet
19757 @item
19758 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19759 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19760 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19761 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19762 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19763 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19764 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19765 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19766
19767 @item
19768 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19769 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19770 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19771 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19772 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19773 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19774 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19775 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19776 below.
19777 @end itemize
19778
19779 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19780 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19781
19782 @itemize @bullet
19783 @item
19784 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19785 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19786 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19787 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19788 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19789
19790 @item
19791 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19792 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19793 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19794 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19795 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19796 hex characters, not 10.)
19797 @end itemize
19798
19799 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19800 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19801 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19802 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19803 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19804 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19805
19806 @itemize @minus
19807 @item
19808 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19809 @item
19810 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19811 @item
19812 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19813 @item
19814 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19815 @end itemize
19816
19817 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19818 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19819 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19820 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19821 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19822
19823 @table @code
19824
19825 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19826 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19827 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19828 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19829 concatenating them by a path separator.
19830
19831 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19832 @item show debug-file-directory
19833 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19834 information files.
19835
19836 @end table
19837
19838 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19839 @cindex debug link sections
19840 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19841 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19842
19843 @itemize
19844 @item
19845 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19846 a zero byte,
19847 @item
19848 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19849 boundary within the section, and
19850 @item
19851 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19852 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19853 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19854 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19855 @end itemize
19856
19857 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19858 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19859 described above.
19860
19861 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19862 @cindex build ID sections
19863 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19864 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19865 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19866 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19867 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19868 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19869 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19870 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19871 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19872
19873 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19874 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19875 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19876 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19877 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19878 in an ordinary executable.
19879
19880 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19881 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19882 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19883 following commands:
19884
19885 @smallexample
19886 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19887 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19888 @end smallexample
19889
19890 @noindent
19891 These commands remove the debugging
19892 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19893 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19894 two files:
19895
19896 @itemize @bullet
19897 @item
19898 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19899 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19900
19901 @smallexample
19902 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19903 @end smallexample
19904
19905 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19906 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19907 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19908 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19909
19910 @item
19911 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19912 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19913 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19914 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19915 @end itemize
19916
19917 @noindent
19918
19919 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19920 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19921 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19922
19923 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19924 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19925 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19926 @c different ways!
19927 @ifhtml
19928 @display
19929 @html
19930 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19931 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19932 @end html
19933 @end display
19934 @end ifhtml
19935 @ifnothtml
19936 @display
19937 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19938 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19939 @end display
19940 @end ifnothtml
19941
19942 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19943 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19944 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19945 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19946 CRC.
19947
19948 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19949 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19950 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19951 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19952 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19953
19954 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19955 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19956 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19957 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19958 @code{0xffffffff}.
19959
19960 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19961 @smallexample
19962 unsigned long
19963 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19964 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19965 @{
19966 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19967 @{
19968 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19969 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19970 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19971 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19972 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19973 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19974 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19975 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19976 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19977 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19978 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19979 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19980 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19981 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19982 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19983 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19984 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19985 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19986 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19987 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19988 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19989 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19990 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19991 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19992 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19993 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19994 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19995 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19996 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19997 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19998 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19999 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20000 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20001 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20002 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20003 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20004 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20005 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20006 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20007 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20008 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20009 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20010 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20011 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20012 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20013 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20014 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20015 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20016 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20017 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20018 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20019 0x2d02ef8d
20020 @};
20021 unsigned char *end;
20022
20023 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20024 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20025 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20026 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20027 @}
20028 @end smallexample
20029
20030 @noindent
20031 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20032
20033 @node MiniDebugInfo
20034 @section Debugging information in a special section
20035 @cindex separate debug sections
20036 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20037
20038 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20039 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20040 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20041 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20042
20043 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20044 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20045 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20046 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20047 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20048 debugging information might be included in the section.
20049
20050 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20051 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20052 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20053
20054 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20055 standard utilities:
20056
20057 @smallexample
20058 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20059 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20060 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20061 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20062
20063 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20064 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20065 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20066 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20067 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20068 | sort > funcsyms
20069
20070 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20071 # table.
20072 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20073
20074 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20075 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20076
20077 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20078 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20079 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20080 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20081
20082 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20083 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20084
20085 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20086 # original binary.
20087 xz mini_debuginfo
20088 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20089 @end smallexample
20090
20091 @node Index Files
20092 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20093 @cindex index files
20094 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20095
20096 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20097 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20098 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20099 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20100 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20101 startup.
20102
20103 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20104 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20105 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20106
20107 @smallexample
20108 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20109 @end smallexample
20110
20111 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20112
20113 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20114 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20115
20116 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20117 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20118 using @command{objcopy}.
20119
20120 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20121
20122 @table @code
20123 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20124 @kindex save gdb-index
20125 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20126 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20127 default creates it produces a single file
20128 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20129 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20130 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20131 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20132 given @var{directory}.
20133 @end table
20134
20135 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20136 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20137
20138 @smallexample
20139 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20140 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20141 @end smallexample
20142
20143 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20144
20145 @smallexample
20146 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20147 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20148 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20149 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20150 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20151 @end smallexample
20152
20153 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20154 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20155 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20156 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20157 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20158 The default is @code{off}.
20159 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20160 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20161
20162 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20163 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20164
20165 @smallexample
20166 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20167 @end smallexample
20168
20169 Instead you must do, for example,
20170
20171 @smallexample
20172 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20173 @end smallexample
20174
20175 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20176 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20177 currently work for programs using Ada.
20178
20179 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20180
20181 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20182 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20183 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20184 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20185
20186 @table @code
20187
20188 @item set index-cache on
20189 @itemx set index-cache off
20190 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20191
20192 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20193 @itemx show index-cache directory
20194 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20195
20196 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20197 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20198 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20199 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20200 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20201 differ according to local convention.
20202
20203 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20204 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20205
20206 @item show index-cache stats
20207 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20208
20209 @end table
20210
20211 @node Symbol Errors
20212 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20213
20214 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20215 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20216 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20217 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20218 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20219 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20220 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20221 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20222 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20223 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20224 Messages}).
20225
20226 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20227
20228 @table @code
20229 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20230
20231 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20232 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20233 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20234 in its outer scope blocks.
20235
20236 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20237 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20238 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20239 function.
20240
20241 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20242
20243 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20244 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20245 do so.
20246
20247 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20248 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20249 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20250 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20251 Messages}.)
20252
20253 @item bad block start address patched
20254
20255 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20256 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20257 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20258
20259 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20260 starting on the previous source line.
20261
20262 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20263
20264 @cindex foo
20265 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20266 larger than the size of the string table.
20267
20268 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20269 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20270 with this name.
20271
20272 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20273
20274 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20275 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20276 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20277
20278 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20279 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20280 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20281 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20282 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20283 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20284
20285 @item stub type has NULL name
20286
20287 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20288
20289 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20290 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20291 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20292 it.
20293
20294 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20295
20296 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20297
20298 @end table
20299
20300 @node Data Files
20301 @section GDB Data Files
20302
20303 @cindex prefix for data files
20304 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20305 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20306
20307 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20308 is currently using.
20309
20310 @table @code
20311 @kindex set data-directory
20312 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20313 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20314 to @var{directory}.
20315
20316 @kindex show data-directory
20317 @item show data-directory
20318 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20319 @end table
20320
20321 @cindex default data directory
20322 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20323 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20324 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20325 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20326 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20327 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20328 location.
20329
20330 The data directory may also be specified with the
20331 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20332 @xref{Mode Options}.
20333
20334 @node Targets
20335 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20336
20337 @cindex debugging target
20338 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20339
20340 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20341 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20342 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20343 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20344 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20345 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20346 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20347 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20348
20349 @cindex target architecture
20350 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20351 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20352 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20353 command.
20354
20355 @table @code
20356 @kindex set architecture
20357 @kindex show architecture
20358 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20359 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20360 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20361 supported architectures.
20362
20363 @item show architecture
20364 Show the current target architecture.
20365
20366 @item set processor
20367 @itemx processor
20368 @kindex set processor
20369 @kindex show processor
20370 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20371 and @code{show architecture}.
20372 @end table
20373
20374 @menu
20375 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20376 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20377 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20378 @end menu
20379
20380 @node Active Targets
20381 @section Active Targets
20382
20383 @cindex stacking targets
20384 @cindex active targets
20385 @cindex multiple targets
20386
20387 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20388 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20389 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20390 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20391 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20392 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20393 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20394 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20395 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20396
20397 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20398 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20399 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20400 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20401
20402 @node Target Commands
20403 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20404
20405 @table @code
20406 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20407 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20408 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20409 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20410 protocol of the target machine.
20411
20412 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20413 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20414 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20415
20416 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20417 after executing the command.
20418
20419 @kindex help target
20420 @item help target
20421 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20422 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20423 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20424
20425 @item help target @var{name}
20426 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20427 select it.
20428
20429 @kindex set gnutarget
20430 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20431 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20432 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20433 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20434 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20435 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20436
20437 @quotation
20438 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20439 you must know the actual BFD name.
20440 @end quotation
20441
20442 @noindent
20443 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20444
20445 @kindex show gnutarget
20446 @item show gnutarget
20447 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20448 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20449 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20450 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20451 @end table
20452
20453 @cindex common targets
20454 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20455 configuration):
20456
20457 @table @code
20458 @kindex target
20459 @item target exec @var{program}
20460 @cindex executable file target
20461 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20462 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20463
20464 @item target core @var{filename}
20465 @cindex core dump file target
20466 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20467 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20468
20469 @item target remote @var{medium}
20470 @cindex remote target
20471 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20472 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20473 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20474
20475 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20476 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20477
20478 @smallexample
20479 target remote /dev/ttya
20480 @end smallexample
20481
20482 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20483 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20484 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20485 clobbered by the download.
20486
20487 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20488 @cindex built-in simulator target
20489 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20490 In general,
20491 @smallexample
20492 target sim
20493 load
20494 run
20495 @end smallexample
20496 @noindent
20497 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20498 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20499 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20500 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20501 Processors}.
20502
20503 @item target native
20504 @cindex native target
20505 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20506 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20507 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20508 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20509
20510 @end table
20511
20512 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20513 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20514
20515 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20516 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20517 various aspects of this process.
20518
20519 @table @code
20520
20521 @item set hash
20522 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20523 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20524 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20525 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20526 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20527 monitor.
20528
20529 @item show hash
20530 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20531 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20532
20533 @item set debug monitor
20534 @kindex set debug monitor
20535 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20536 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20537 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20538
20539 @item show debug monitor
20540 @kindex show debug monitor
20541 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20542 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20543 @end table
20544
20545 @table @code
20546
20547 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20548 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20549 @anchor{load}
20550 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20551 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20552 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20553 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20554 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20555 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20556
20557 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20558 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20559 target is @dots{}}''
20560
20561 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20562 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20563 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20564 specifies a fixed address.
20565 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20566
20567 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20568 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20569 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20570
20571 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20572 load programs into flash memory.
20573
20574 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20575 @end table
20576
20577 @table @code
20578
20579 @kindex flash-erase
20580 @item flash-erase
20581 @anchor{flash-erase}
20582
20583 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20584
20585 @end table
20586
20587 @node Byte Order
20588 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20589
20590 @cindex choosing target byte order
20591 @cindex target byte order
20592
20593 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20594 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20595 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20596 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20597 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20598 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20599
20600 @table @code
20601 @kindex set endian
20602 @item set endian big
20603 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20604
20605 @item set endian little
20606 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20607
20608 @item set endian auto
20609 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20610 executable.
20611
20612 @item show endian
20613 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20614
20615 @end table
20616
20617 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20618 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20619 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20620 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20621 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20622 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20623 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20624 and @code{big} otherwise.
20625
20626 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20627 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20628 target system.
20629
20630
20631 @node Remote Debugging
20632 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20633 @cindex remote debugging
20634
20635 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20636 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20637 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20638 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20639 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20640
20641 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20642 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20643 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20644 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20645 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20646 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20647
20648 Other remote targets may be available in your
20649 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20650
20651 @menu
20652 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20653 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20654 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20655 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20656 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20657 @end menu
20658
20659 @node Connecting
20660 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20661 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20662 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20663 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20664 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20665 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20666 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20667
20668 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20669 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20670 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20671 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20672
20673 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20674
20675 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20676 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20677 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20678 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20679
20680 @table @asis
20681
20682 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20683 @item Result of detach or program exit
20684 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20685 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20686 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20687
20688 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20689 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20690 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20691 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20692
20693 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20694 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20695 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20696 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20697
20698 @item Specifying the program to debug
20699 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20700 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20701 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20702 target.
20703
20704 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20705 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20706 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20707
20708 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20709 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20710 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20711 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20712
20713 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20714 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20715 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20716 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20717 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20718 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20719 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20720 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20721 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20722
20723 @item The @code{run} command
20724 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20725 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20726 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20727 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20728 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20729
20730 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20731 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20732 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20733 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20734 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20735
20736 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20737 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20738 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20739 @code{target remote} mode.
20740
20741 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20742 @item Attaching
20743 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20744 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20745 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20746
20747 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20748 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20749 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20750 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20751 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20752
20753 @end table
20754
20755 @anchor{Host and target files}
20756 @subsection Host and Target Files
20757 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20758 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20759
20760 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20761 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20762 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20763 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20764 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20765
20766 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20767 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20768 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20769 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20770 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20771
20772 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20773 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20774 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20775 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20776 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20777 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20778 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20779 target libraries.
20780
20781 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20782 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20783 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20784 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20785 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20786 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20787 programs.
20788
20789 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20790 @cindex remote connection commands
20791 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
20792 local Unix domain socket, or
20793 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20794 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20795 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20796 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20797 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20798 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20799
20800 @table @code
20801
20802 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20803 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20804 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20805 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20806 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20807
20808 @smallexample
20809 target remote /dev/ttyb
20810 @end smallexample
20811
20812 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20813 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20814 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20815 @code{target} command.
20816
20817 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
20818 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
20819 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
20820 @cindex Unix domain socket
20821 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
20822 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
20823
20824 @smallexample
20825 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
20826 @end smallexample
20827
20828 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
20829 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
20830 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
20831 of connection.
20832 The above command is identical to the command:
20833
20834 @smallexample
20835 target remote unix::/tmp/gdb-socket1
20836 @end smallexample
20837 @noindent
20838
20839 See below for the explanation of this syntax.
20840
20841 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
20842 Unix domain sockets.
20843
20844 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20845 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20846 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20847 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20848 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20849 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20850 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20851 @itemx target remote @code{unix::@var{local-socket}}
20852 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20853 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20854 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20855 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20856 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20857 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20858 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20859 @itemx target extended-remote @code{unix::@var{local-socket}}
20860 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20861 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}
20862 or using the Unix domain socket @var{local-socket} on the local machine.
20863 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20864 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20865 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20866 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20867 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20868 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20869
20870 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20871 @code{manyfarms}:
20872
20873 @smallexample
20874 target remote manyfarms:2828
20875 @end smallexample
20876
20877 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20878 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20879 square bracket syntax:
20880
20881 @smallexample
20882 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885 @noindent
20886 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20887
20888 @smallexample
20889 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20890 @end smallexample
20891
20892 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20893 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20894 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20895 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20896 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20897 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20898
20899 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20900 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20901 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20902 port 1234 on your local machine:
20903
20904 @smallexample
20905 target remote :1234
20906 @end smallexample
20907 @noindent
20908
20909 Note that the colon is still required here.
20910 Alternatively you can use a Unix domain socket:
20911
20912 @smallexample
20913 target remote unix::/tmp/gdb-socket1
20914 @end smallexample
20915 @noindent
20916
20917 This has the advantage that it'll not fail if the port number is already
20918 in use.
20919
20920
20921 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20922 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20923 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20924 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20925 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20926 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20927 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20928 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20929 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20930 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20931 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20932 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20933 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20934
20935 @smallexample
20936 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20937 @end smallexample
20938
20939 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20940 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20941 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20942 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20943
20944 @item target remote | @var{command}
20945 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20946 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20947 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20948 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20949 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20950 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20951 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20952 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20953 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20954
20955 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20956 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20957 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20958
20959 @end table
20960
20961 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20962 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20963 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20964 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20965 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20966 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20967 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20968
20969 @smallexample
20970 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20971 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20972 @end smallexample
20973
20974 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20975 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20976 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20977 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20978
20979 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20980 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20981
20982 @table @code
20983 @kindex detach (remote)
20984 @item detach
20985 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20986 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20987 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20988 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20989 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20990 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20991 still connected to the target.
20992
20993 @kindex disconnect
20994 @item disconnect
20995 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20996 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20997 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20998 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20999 another target.
21000
21001 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21002 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21003 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21004 @kindex monitor
21005 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21006 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21007 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21008 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21009 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21010 and implement.
21011 @end table
21012
21013 @node File Transfer
21014 @section Sending files to a remote system
21015 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21016 @cindex file transfer
21017 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21018
21019 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21020 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21021 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21022 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21023 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21024 the only way to upload or download files.
21025
21026 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21027
21028 @table @code
21029 @kindex remote put
21030 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21031 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21032 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21033
21034 @kindex remote get
21035 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21036 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21037 on the host system.
21038
21039 @kindex remote delete
21040 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21041 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21042
21043 @end table
21044
21045 @node Server
21046 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21047
21048 @kindex gdbserver
21049 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21050 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21051 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21052 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21053 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21054
21055 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21056 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21057 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21058 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21059 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21060 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21061 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21062 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21063 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21064 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21065 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21066 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21067 choice for debugging.
21068
21069 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21070 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21071 protocol.
21072
21073 @quotation
21074 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21075 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21076 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21077 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21078 @code{gdbserver}.
21079 @end quotation
21080
21081 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21082 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21083 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21084 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21085
21086 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21087 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21088 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21089 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21090 system does all the symbol handling.
21091
21092 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21093 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21094 syntax is:
21095
21096 @smallexample
21097 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21098 @end smallexample
21099
21100 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21101 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21102 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21103 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21104 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21105 @file{/dev/com1}:
21106
21107 @smallexample
21108 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21109 @end smallexample
21110
21111 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21112 with it.
21113
21114 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21115
21116 @smallexample
21117 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21118 @end smallexample
21119
21120 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21121 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21122 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21123 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21124 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21125 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21126 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21127 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21128 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21129 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21130 @code{target remote} command.
21131
21132 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21133 with ssh:
21134
21135 @smallexample
21136 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21137 @end smallexample
21138
21139 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21140 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21141 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21142 You could elide it if you want to.
21143
21144 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21145 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21146 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21147 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21148
21149 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21150 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21151 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21152 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21153
21154 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21155 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21156
21157 @smallexample
21158 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21159 @end smallexample
21160
21161 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21162 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21163
21164 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21165 @value{GDBN} attach command
21166 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21167
21168 @pindex pidof
21169 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21170 @code{pidof} utility:
21171
21172 @smallexample
21173 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21174 @end smallexample
21175
21176 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21177 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21178 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21179
21180 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21181
21182 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21183 port.
21184
21185 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21186 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21187 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21188 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21189 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21190 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21191 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21192 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21193
21194 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21195 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21196 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21197
21198 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21199 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21200 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21201 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21202 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21203 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21204 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21205 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21206 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21207 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21208 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21209 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21210
21211 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21212 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21213
21214 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21215 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21216 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21217 program. For more information,
21218 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21219
21220 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21221 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21222 status information about the debugging process.
21223 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21224 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21225 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21226 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21227
21228 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21229 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21230 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21231 Possible options are:
21232
21233 @table @code
21234 @item none
21235 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21236 @item all
21237 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21238 @item timestamps
21239 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21240 @end table
21241
21242 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21243 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21244
21245 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21246 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21247 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21248 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21249 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21250
21251 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21252 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21253 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21254 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21255
21256 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21257 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21258 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21259 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21260
21261 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21262 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21263 environment:
21264
21265 @smallexample
21266 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21267 @end smallexample
21268
21269 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21270 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21271
21272 @smallexample
21273 $ gdbserver --selftest
21274 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21275 @end smallexample
21276
21277 These tests are disabled in release.
21278 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21279
21280 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21281 @itemize
21282
21283 @item
21284 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21285
21286 @item
21287 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21288 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21289 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21290 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21291 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21292 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21293
21294 @item
21295 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21296 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21297 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21298 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21299 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21300 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21301 program is already on the target.
21302
21303 @end itemize
21304
21305 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21306 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21307 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21308
21309 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21310 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21311 Here are the available commands.
21312
21313 @table @code
21314 @item monitor help
21315 List the available monitor commands.
21316
21317 @item monitor set debug 0
21318 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21319 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21320
21321 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21322 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21323 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21324 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21325
21326 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21327 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21328 Possible options are:
21329
21330 @table @code
21331 @item none
21332 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21333 @item all
21334 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21335 @item timestamps
21336 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21337 @end table
21338
21339 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21340 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21341
21342 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21343 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21344 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21345 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21346 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21347 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21348
21349 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21350 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21351
21352 @item monitor exit
21353 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21354 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21355 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21356 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21357 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21358
21359 @end table
21360
21361 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21362 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21363
21364 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21365 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21366
21367 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21368 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21369 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21370 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21371 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21372 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21373 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21374 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21375 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21376 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21377 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21378 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21379
21380 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21381
21382 @table @code
21383 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21384
21385 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21386 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21387 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21388
21389 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21390
21391 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21392 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21393 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21394 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21395 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21396 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21397
21398 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21399
21400 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21401 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21402 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21403 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21404 command for that. For example:
21405
21406 @smallexample
21407 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21408 @end smallexample
21409
21410 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21411 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21412 @end table
21413
21414 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21415 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21416 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21417 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21418 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21419 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21420 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21421 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21422 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21423 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21424
21425 @smallexample
21426 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21427 @end smallexample
21428
21429 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21430
21431 @smallexample
21432 $ gdb myprogram
21433 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21434 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21435 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21436 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21437 @end smallexample
21438
21439 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21440 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21441 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21442 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21443 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21444 tracing.
21445
21446 @node Remote Configuration
21447 @section Remote Configuration
21448
21449 @kindex set remote
21450 @kindex show remote
21451 This section documents the configuration options available when
21452 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21453 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21454 system-call-allowed}.
21455
21456 @table @code
21457 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21458 @cindex address size for remote targets
21459 @cindex bits in remote address
21460 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21461 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21462 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21463 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21464
21465 @item show remoteaddresssize
21466 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21467
21468 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21469 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21470 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21471 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21472 remote targets.
21473
21474 @item show serial baud
21475 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21476
21477 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21478 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21479 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21480
21481 @item show serial parity
21482 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21483
21484 @item set remotebreak
21485 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21486 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21487 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21488 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21489 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21490 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21491 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21492 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21493
21494 @item show remotebreak
21495 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21496 interrupt the remote program.
21497
21498 @item set remoteflow on
21499 @itemx set remoteflow off
21500 @kindex set remoteflow
21501 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21502 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21503
21504 @item show remoteflow
21505 @kindex show remoteflow
21506 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21507
21508 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21509 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21510 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21511 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21512 @code{ascii}.
21513
21514 @item show remotelogbase
21515 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21516 protocol.
21517
21518 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21519 @cindex record serial communications on file
21520 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21521 default is not to record at all.
21522
21523 @item show remotelogfile.
21524 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21525 serial communications.
21526
21527 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21528 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21529 @cindex remote timeout
21530 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21531 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21532
21533 @item show remotetimeout
21534 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21535 responses.
21536
21537 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21538 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21539 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21540 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21541 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21542 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21543 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21544 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21545 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21546 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21547
21548 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21549 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21550 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21551 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21552
21553 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21554 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21555 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21556 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21557 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21558 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21559 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21560 length.
21561
21562 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21563 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21564 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21565
21566 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21567 @itemx show remote exec-file
21568 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21569 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21570 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21571 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21572 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21573 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21574
21575 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21576 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21577 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21578 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21579 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21580 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21581 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21582 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21583 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21584 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21585
21586 @item show interrupt-sequence
21587 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21588 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21589 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21590 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21591
21592 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21593 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21594 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21595 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21596 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21597 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21598
21599 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21600 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21601 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21602
21603 @kindex set tcp
21604 @kindex show tcp
21605 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21606 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21607 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21608 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21609 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21610 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21611 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21612 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21613 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21614
21615 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21616 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21617
21618 @item show tcp auto-retry
21619 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21620
21621 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21622 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21623 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21624 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21625 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21626 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21627 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21628 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21629 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21630 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21631 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21632
21633 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21634 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21635 @end table
21636
21637 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21638 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21639 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21640 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21641 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21642 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21643 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21644 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21645 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21646
21647 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21648 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21649 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21650 @value{GDBN} developers.
21651
21652 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21653 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21654 are:
21655
21656 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21657 @item Command Name
21658 @tab Remote Packet
21659 @tab Related Features
21660
21661 @item @code{fetch-register}
21662 @tab @code{p}
21663 @tab @code{info registers}
21664
21665 @item @code{set-register}
21666 @tab @code{P}
21667 @tab @code{set}
21668
21669 @item @code{binary-download}
21670 @tab @code{X}
21671 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21672
21673 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21674 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21675 @tab @code{info auxv}
21676
21677 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21678 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21679 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21680
21681 @item @code{attach}
21682 @tab @code{vAttach}
21683 @tab @code{attach}
21684
21685 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21686 @tab @code{vCont}
21687 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21688
21689 @item @code{run}
21690 @tab @code{vRun}
21691 @tab @code{run}
21692
21693 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21694 @tab @code{Z0}
21695 @tab @code{break}
21696
21697 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21698 @tab @code{Z1}
21699 @tab @code{hbreak}
21700
21701 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21702 @tab @code{Z2}
21703 @tab @code{watch}
21704
21705 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21706 @tab @code{Z3}
21707 @tab @code{rwatch}
21708
21709 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21710 @tab @code{Z4}
21711 @tab @code{awatch}
21712
21713 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21714 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21715 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21716
21717 @item @code{target-features}
21718 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21719 @tab @code{set architecture}
21720
21721 @item @code{library-info}
21722 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21723 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21724
21725 @item @code{memory-map}
21726 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21727 @tab @code{info mem}
21728
21729 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21730 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21731 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21732
21733 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21734 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21735 @tab @code{info spu}
21736
21737 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21738 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21739 @tab @code{info spu}
21740
21741 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21742 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21743 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21744
21745 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21746 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21747 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21748
21749 @item @code{threads}
21750 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21751 @tab @code{info threads}
21752
21753 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21754 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21755 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21756
21757 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21758 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21759 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21760
21761 @item @code{search-memory}
21762 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21763 @tab @code{find}
21764
21765 @item @code{supported-packets}
21766 @tab @code{qSupported}
21767 @tab Remote communications parameters
21768
21769 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21770 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21771 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21772
21773 @item @code{pass-signals}
21774 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21775 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21776
21777 @item @code{program-signals}
21778 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21779 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21780
21781 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21782 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21783 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21784
21785 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21786 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21787 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21788
21789 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21790 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21791 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21792
21793 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21794 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21795 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21796
21797 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21798 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21799 @tab @code{remote delete}
21800
21801 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21802 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21803 @tab Host I/O
21804
21805 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21806 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21807 @tab Host I/O
21808
21809 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21810 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21811 @tab Host I/O
21812
21813 @item @code{noack-packet}
21814 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21815 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21816
21817 @item @code{osdata}
21818 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21819 @tab @code{info os}
21820
21821 @item @code{query-attached}
21822 @tab @code{qAttached}
21823 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21824
21825 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21826 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21827 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21828
21829 @item @code{trace-status}
21830 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21831 @tab @code{tstatus}
21832
21833 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21834 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21835 @tab Traceframe info
21836
21837 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21838 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21839 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21840
21841 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21842 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21843 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21844
21845 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21846 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21847 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21848
21849 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21850 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21851 @tab @code{set environment}
21852
21853 @item @code{environment-unset}
21854 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21855 @tab @code{unset environment}
21856
21857 @item @code{environment-reset}
21858 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21859 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21860
21861 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21862 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21863 @tab @code{set cwd}
21864
21865 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21866 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21867 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21868
21869 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21870 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21871 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21872
21873 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21874 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21875 @tab @code{break}
21876
21877 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21878 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21879 @tab @code{hbreak}
21880
21881 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21882 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21883 @tab @code{fork}
21884
21885 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21886 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21887 @tab @code{vfork}
21888
21889 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21890 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21891 @tab @code{exec}
21892
21893 @item @code{thread-events}
21894 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21895 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21896
21897 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21898 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21899 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21900
21901 @end multitable
21902
21903 @node Remote Stub
21904 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21905
21906 @cindex debugging stub, example
21907 @cindex remote stub, example
21908 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21909 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21910 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21911 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21912 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21913 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21914 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21915 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21916
21917 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21918 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21919 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21920 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21921 program, you need:
21922
21923 @enumerate
21924 @item
21925 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21926 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21927 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21928
21929 @item
21930 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21931 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21932
21933 @item
21934 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21935 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21936 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21937 documentation.
21938 @end enumerate
21939
21940 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21941 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21942 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21943
21944 @table @emph
21945 @item On the host,
21946 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21947 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21948 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21949
21950 @item On the target,
21951 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21952 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21953 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21954
21955 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21956 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21957 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21958 @end table
21959
21960 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21961 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21962 @sc{sparc} boards.
21963
21964 @cindex remote serial stub list
21965 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21966
21967 @table @code
21968
21969 @item i386-stub.c
21970 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21971 @cindex Intel
21972 @cindex i386
21973 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21974
21975 @item m68k-stub.c
21976 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21977 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21978 @cindex m680x0
21979 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21980
21981 @item sh-stub.c
21982 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21983 @cindex Renesas
21984 @cindex SH
21985 For Renesas SH architectures.
21986
21987 @item sparc-stub.c
21988 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21989 @cindex Sparc
21990 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21991
21992 @item sparcl-stub.c
21993 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21994 @cindex Fujitsu
21995 @cindex SparcLite
21996 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21997
21998 @end table
21999
22000 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22001 recently added stubs.
22002
22003 @menu
22004 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22005 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22006 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22007 @end menu
22008
22009 @node Stub Contents
22010 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22011
22012 @cindex remote serial stub
22013 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22014 subroutines:
22015
22016 @table @code
22017 @item set_debug_traps
22018 @findex set_debug_traps
22019 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22020 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22021 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22022 program's startup code.
22023
22024 @item handle_exception
22025 @findex handle_exception
22026 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22027 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22028 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22029 run when a trap is triggered.
22030
22031 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22032 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22033 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22034 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22035 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22036 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22037 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22038 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22039 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22040 machine.
22041
22042 @item breakpoint
22043 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22044 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22045 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22046 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22047 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22048 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22049 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22050 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22051 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22052 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22053 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22054
22055 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22056 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22057 start of your debugging session.
22058 @end table
22059
22060 @node Bootstrapping
22061 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22062
22063 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22064 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22065 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22066 debugging target machine.
22067
22068 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22069 serial port.
22070
22071 @table @code
22072 @item int getDebugChar()
22073 @findex getDebugChar
22074 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22075 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22076 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22077
22078 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22079 @findex putDebugChar
22080 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22081 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22082 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22083 @end table
22084
22085 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22086 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22087 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22088 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22089 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22090 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22091 remote system to stop.
22092
22093 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22094 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22095 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22096 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22097
22098 Other routines you need to supply are:
22099
22100 @table @code
22101 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22102 @findex exceptionHandler
22103 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22104 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22105 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22106 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22107 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22108 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22109 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22110 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22111 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22112 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22113 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22114 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22115 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22116
22117 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22118 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22119 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22120 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22121 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22122
22123 @item void flush_i_cache()
22124 @findex flush_i_cache
22125 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22126 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22127 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22128
22129 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22130 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22131 @end table
22132
22133 @noindent
22134 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22135
22136 @table @code
22137 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22138 @findex memset
22139 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22140 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22141 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22142 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22143 @end table
22144
22145 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22146 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22147 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22148 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22149
22150
22151 @node Debug Session
22152 @subsection Putting it All Together
22153
22154 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22155 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22156 steps.
22157
22158 @enumerate
22159 @item
22160 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22161 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22162 @display
22163 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22164 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22165 @end display
22166
22167 @item
22168 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22169 procedure is called:
22170
22171 @smallexample
22172 set_debug_traps();
22173 breakpoint();
22174 @end smallexample
22175
22176 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22177 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22178 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22179 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22180 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22181 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22182 progress.
22183
22184 @item
22185 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22186 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22187
22188 @smallexample
22189 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22190 @end smallexample
22191
22192 @noindent
22193 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22194 function in your program, that function is called when
22195 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22196 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22197 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22198
22199 @item
22200 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22201 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22202
22203 @item
22204 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22205 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22206
22207 @item
22208 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22209 @c document that. FIXME.
22210 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22211 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22212
22213 @item
22214 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22215 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22216
22217 @end enumerate
22218
22219 @node Configurations
22220 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22221
22222 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22223 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22224 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22225
22226 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22227 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22228 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22229 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22230 are quite different from each other.
22231
22232 @menu
22233 * Native::
22234 * Embedded OS::
22235 * Embedded Processors::
22236 * Architectures::
22237 @end menu
22238
22239 @node Native
22240 @section Native
22241
22242 This section describes details specific to particular native
22243 configurations.
22244
22245 @menu
22246 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22247 * Process Information:: Process information
22248 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22249 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22250 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22251 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22252 @end menu
22253
22254 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22255 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22256
22257 @cindex libkvm
22258 @cindex kernel memory image
22259 @cindex kernel crash dump
22260
22261 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22262 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22263 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22264 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22265 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22266 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22267 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22268 @code{kvm} target:
22269
22270 @smallexample
22271 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22272 @end smallexample
22273
22274 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22275 argument:
22276
22277 @smallexample
22278 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22279 @end smallexample
22280
22281 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22282 available:
22283
22284 @table @code
22285 @kindex kvm
22286 @item kvm pcb
22287 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22288
22289 @item kvm proc
22290 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22291 modern FreeBSD systems.
22292 @end table
22293
22294 @node Process Information
22295 @subsection Process Information
22296 @cindex /proc
22297 @cindex examine process image
22298 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22299
22300 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22301 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22302 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22303 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22304 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22305 any process running on your system.
22306
22307 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22308 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22309 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22310 systems.
22311
22312 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22313 information.
22314
22315 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22316 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22317 information available from a live process. Process information is
22318 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22319 systems.
22320
22321 @table @code
22322 @kindex info proc
22323 @cindex process ID
22324 @item info proc
22325 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22326 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22327 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22328 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22329 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22330 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22331 executable file's absolute file name.
22332
22333 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22334 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22335 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22336 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22337 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22338 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22339
22340 @item info proc cmdline
22341 @cindex info proc cmdline
22342 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22343 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22344
22345 @item info proc cwd
22346 @cindex info proc cwd
22347 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22348 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22349
22350 @item info proc exe
22351 @cindex info proc exe
22352 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22353 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22354
22355 @item info proc files
22356 @cindex info proc files
22357 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22358 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22359 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22360 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22361 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22362 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22363 FreeBSD.
22364
22365 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22366 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22367
22368 @smallexample
22369 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22370 process 22136
22371 Open files:
22372
22373 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22374 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22375 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22376 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22377 root dir - r-------- /
22378 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22379 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22380 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22381 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22382 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22383 @end smallexample
22384
22385 @item info proc mappings
22386 @cindex memory address space mappings
22387 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22388 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22389 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22390 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22391 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22392
22393 @item info proc stat
22394 @itemx info proc status
22395 @cindex process detailed status information
22396 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22397 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22398 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22399 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22400 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22401
22402 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22403 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22404
22405 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22406 proc status}.
22407
22408 @item info proc all
22409 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22410 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22411
22412 @ignore
22413 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22414 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22415 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22416 @kindex info proc times
22417 @item info proc times
22418 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22419 its children.
22420
22421 @kindex info proc id
22422 @item info proc id
22423 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22424 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22425 @end ignore
22426
22427 @item set procfs-trace
22428 @kindex set procfs-trace
22429 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22430 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22431
22432 @item show procfs-trace
22433 @kindex show procfs-trace
22434 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22435
22436 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22437 @kindex set procfs-file
22438 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22439 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22440 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22441 standard output.
22442
22443 @item show procfs-file
22444 @kindex show procfs-file
22445 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22446
22447 @item proc-trace-entry
22448 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22449 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22450 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22451 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22452 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22453 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22454 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22455 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22456 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22457
22458 @item info pidlist
22459 @kindex info pidlist
22460 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22461 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22462 processes and all the threads within each process.
22463
22464 @item info meminfo
22465 @kindex info meminfo
22466 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22467 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22468 @end table
22469
22470 @node DJGPP Native
22471 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22472 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22473 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22474 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22475
22476 @cindex DPMI
22477 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22478 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22479 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22480 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22481
22482 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22483 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22484 subsection describes those commands.
22485
22486 @table @code
22487 @kindex info dos
22488 @item info dos
22489 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22490 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22491
22492 @kindex sysinfo
22493 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22494 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22495 @item info dos sysinfo
22496 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22497 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22498 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22499
22500 @cindex GDT
22501 @cindex LDT
22502 @cindex IDT
22503 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22504 @cindex descriptor tables display
22505 @item info dos gdt
22506 @itemx info dos ldt
22507 @itemx info dos idt
22508 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22509 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22510 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22511 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22512 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22513 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22514 rights.
22515
22516 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22517 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22518 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22519 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22520 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22521
22522 @cindex garbled pointers
22523 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22524 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22525 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22526 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22527 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22528 debugged program's data segment:
22529
22530 @smallexample
22531 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22532 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22533 @end smallexample
22534
22535 @noindent
22536 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22537 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22538
22539 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22540 @item info dos pde
22541 @itemx info dos pte
22542 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22543 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22544 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22545 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22546 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22547 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22548 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22549 that is currently in use.
22550
22551 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22552 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22553 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22554 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22555 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22556 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22557 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22558
22559 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22560 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22561 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22562 controller.
22563
22564 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22565
22566 @cindex physical address from linear address
22567 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22568 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22569 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22570 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22571 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22572 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22573 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22574
22575 @smallexample
22576 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22577 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22578 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22579 @end smallexample
22580
22581 @noindent
22582 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22583 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22584 attributes of that page.
22585
22586 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22587 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22588 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22589 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22590 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22591 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22592
22593 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22594 transfer buffer:
22595
22596 @smallexample
22597 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22598 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22599 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22600 @end smallexample
22601
22602 @noindent
22603 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22604 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22605 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22606 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22607 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22608
22609 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22610 @end table
22611
22612 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22613 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22614 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22615 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22616
22617 @table @code
22618 @kindex set com1base
22619 @kindex set com1irq
22620 @kindex set com2base
22621 @kindex set com2irq
22622 @kindex set com3base
22623 @kindex set com3irq
22624 @kindex set com4base
22625 @kindex set com4irq
22626 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22627 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22628 port.
22629
22630 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22631 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22632 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22633
22634 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22635 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22636 other 3 COM ports.
22637
22638 @kindex show com1base
22639 @kindex show com1irq
22640 @kindex show com2base
22641 @kindex show com2irq
22642 @kindex show com3base
22643 @kindex show com3irq
22644 @kindex show com4base
22645 @kindex show com4irq
22646 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22647 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22648 lines used by the COM ports.
22649
22650 @item info serial
22651 @kindex info serial
22652 @cindex DOS serial port status
22653 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22654 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22655 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22656 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22657 @end table
22658
22659
22660 @node Cygwin Native
22661 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22662 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22663 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22664 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22665
22666 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22667 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22668
22669 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22670 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22671 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22672 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22673 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22674 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22675 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22676 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22677
22678 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22679 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22680 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22681
22682 @table @code
22683 @kindex info w32
22684 @item info w32
22685 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22686 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22687
22688 @item info w32 selector
22689 This command displays information returned by
22690 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22691 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22692 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22693 Without argument, this command displays information
22694 about the six segment registers.
22695
22696 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22697 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22698 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22699 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22700
22701 @kindex signal-event
22702 @item signal-event @var{id}
22703 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22704 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22705
22706 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22707 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22708 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22709 (for x86_64 versions):
22710
22711 @itemize @minus
22712 @item
22713 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22714 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22715 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22716
22717 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22718 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22719 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22720 to attach.
22721
22722 @item
22723 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22724 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22725 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22726 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22727 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22728 @end itemize
22729
22730 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22731 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22732 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22733 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22734 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22735 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22736 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22737 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22738 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22739 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22740 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22741
22742 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22743 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22744 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22745 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22746
22747 @kindex set new-console
22748 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22749 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22750 be started in a new console on next start.
22751 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22752 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22753
22754 @kindex show new-console
22755 @item show new-console
22756 Displays whether a new console is used
22757 when the debuggee is started.
22758
22759 @kindex set new-group
22760 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22761 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22762 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22763 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22764 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22765
22766 @kindex show new-group
22767 @item show new-group
22768 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22769
22770 @kindex set debugevents
22771 @item set debugevents
22772 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22773 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22774 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22775 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22776 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22777
22778 @kindex set debugexec
22779 @item set debugexec
22780 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22781 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22782
22783 @kindex set debugexceptions
22784 @item set debugexceptions
22785 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22786 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22787
22788 @kindex set debugmemory
22789 @item set debugmemory
22790 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22791 and writes by the debugger.
22792
22793 @kindex set shell
22794 @item set shell
22795 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22796 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22797
22798 @kindex show shell
22799 @item show shell
22800 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22801
22802 @end table
22803
22804 @menu
22805 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22806 @end menu
22807
22808 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22809 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22810 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22811 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22812
22813 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22814 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22815 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22816 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22817 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22818 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22819 ``minimal symbols''.
22820
22821 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22822 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22823 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22824 program run once to completion.
22825
22826 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22827
22828 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22829 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22830 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22831 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22832 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22833 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22834 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22835 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22836 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22837
22838 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22839 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22840 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22841 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22842 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22843 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22844
22845 @smallexample
22846 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22847 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22848
22849 Non-debugging symbols:
22850 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22851 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22852 @end smallexample
22853
22854 @smallexample
22855 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22856 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22857
22858 Non-debugging symbols:
22859 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22860 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22861 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22862 [etc...]
22863 @end smallexample
22864
22865 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22866
22867 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22868 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22869 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22870 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22871 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22872 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22873 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22874
22875 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22876 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22877 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22878 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22879 problem:
22880
22881 @smallexample
22882 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22883 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22884 @end smallexample
22885
22886 @smallexample
22887 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22888 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22889 @end smallexample
22890
22891 And two possible solutions:
22892
22893 @smallexample
22894 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22895 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22896 @end smallexample
22897
22898 @smallexample
22899 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22900 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22901 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22902 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22903 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22904 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22905 @end smallexample
22906
22907 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22908 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22909 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22910 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22911 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22912
22913 @smallexample
22914 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22915 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22916 @end smallexample
22917
22918 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22919 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22920 safe.
22921
22922 @node Hurd Native
22923 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22924 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22925
22926 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22927 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22928
22929 @table @code
22930 @item set signals
22931 @itemx set sigs
22932 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22933 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22934 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22935 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22936 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22937 @code{signals}.
22938
22939 @item show signals
22940 @itemx show sigs
22941 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22942 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22943 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22944
22945 @item set signal-thread
22946 @itemx set sigthread
22947 @kindex set signal-thread
22948 @kindex set sigthread
22949 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22950 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22951 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22952 signal-thread}.
22953
22954 @item show signal-thread
22955 @itemx show sigthread
22956 @kindex show signal-thread
22957 @kindex show sigthread
22958 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22959 delivered a signal.
22960
22961 @item set stopped
22962 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22963 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22964 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22965 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22966
22967 @item show stopped
22968 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22969 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22970 stopped.
22971
22972 @item set exceptions
22973 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22974 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22975 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22976 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22977 trapping on.
22978
22979 @item show exceptions
22980 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22981 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22982
22983 @item set task pause
22984 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22985 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22986 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22987 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22988 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22989 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22990 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22991 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22992 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22993
22994 @item show task pause
22995 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22996 Show the current state of task suspension.
22997
22998 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22999 @cindex task suspend count
23000 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23001 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23002 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23003
23004 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23005 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23006
23007 @item set task exception-port
23008 @itemx set task excp
23009 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23010 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23011 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23012 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23013
23014 @item set noninvasive
23015 @cindex noninvasive task options
23016 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23017 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23018 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23019 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23020
23021 @item info send-rights
23022 @itemx info receive-rights
23023 @itemx info port-rights
23024 @itemx info port-sets
23025 @itemx info dead-names
23026 @itemx info ports
23027 @itemx info psets
23028 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23029 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23030 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23031 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23032 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23033 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23034 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23035 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23036 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23037
23038 @item set thread pause
23039 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23040 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23041 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23042 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23043 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23044 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23045 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23046 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23047 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23048 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23049 only the current thread.
23050
23051 @item show thread pause
23052 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23053 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23054
23055 @item set thread run
23056 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23057
23058 @item show thread run
23059 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23060
23061 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23062 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23063 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23064 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23065 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23066 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23067 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23068
23069 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23070 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23071 detaching.
23072
23073 @item set thread exception-port
23074 @itemx set thread excp
23075 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23076 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23077 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23078
23079 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23080 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23081 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23082 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23083
23084 @item set thread default
23085 @itemx show thread default
23086 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23087 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23088 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23089 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23090 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23091 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23092 the non-default commands.
23093 @end table
23094
23095 @node Darwin
23096 @subsection Darwin
23097 @cindex Darwin
23098
23099 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23100
23101 @table @code
23102 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23103 @kindex set debug darwin
23104 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23105 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23106
23107 @item show debug darwin
23108 @kindex show debug darwin
23109 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23110
23111 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23112 @kindex set debug mach-o
23113 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23114 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23115 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23116 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23117 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23118 usage.
23119
23120 @item show debug mach-o
23121 @kindex show debug mach-o
23122 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23123
23124 @item set mach-exceptions on
23125 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23126 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23127 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23128 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23129 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23130 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23131
23132 @item show mach-exceptions
23133 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23134 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23135 @end table
23136
23137
23138 @node Embedded OS
23139 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23140
23141 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23142 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23143 architectures.
23144
23145 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23146 various real-time operating systems.
23147
23148 @node Embedded Processors
23149 @section Embedded Processors
23150
23151 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23152 configurations.
23153
23154 @cindex send command to simulator
23155 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23156 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23157
23158 @table @code
23159 @item sim @var{command}
23160 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23161 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23162 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23163 acceptable commands.
23164 @end table
23165
23166
23167 @menu
23168 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23169 * ARM:: ARM
23170 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23171 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23172 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23173 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23174 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23175 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23176 * CRIS:: CRIS
23177 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23178 @end menu
23179
23180 @node ARC
23181 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23182 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23183 @cindex ARC specific commands
23184 @cindex ARC600
23185 @cindex ARC700
23186 @cindex ARC EM
23187 @cindex ARC HS
23188
23189 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23190
23191 @table @code
23192 @item set debug arc
23193 @kindex set debug arc
23194 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23195 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23196
23197 @item show debug arc
23198 @kindex show debug arc
23199 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23200
23201 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23202 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23203 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23204
23205 @end table
23206
23207 @node ARM
23208 @subsection ARM
23209
23210 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23211
23212 @table @code
23213 @item set arm disassembler
23214 @kindex set arm
23215 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23216 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23217
23218 @item show arm disassembler
23219 @kindex show arm
23220 Show the current disassembly style.
23221
23222 @item set arm apcs32
23223 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23224 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23225
23226 @item show arm apcs32
23227 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23228
23229 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23230 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23231 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23232
23233 @table @code
23234 @item auto
23235 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23236 @item softfpa
23237 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23238 processors.
23239 @item fpa
23240 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23241 @item softvfp
23242 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23243 @item vfp
23244 VFP co-processor.
23245 @end table
23246
23247 @item show arm fpu
23248 Show the current type of the FPU.
23249
23250 @item set arm abi
23251 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23252
23253 @item show arm abi
23254 Show the currently used ABI.
23255
23256 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23257 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23258 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23259 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23260 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23261 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23262 register).
23263
23264 @item show arm fallback-mode
23265 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23266
23267 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23268 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23269 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23270 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23271 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23272
23273 @item show arm force-mode
23274 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23275
23276 @item set debug arm
23277 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23278 target support subsystem.
23279
23280 @item show debug arm
23281 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23282 @end table
23283
23284 @table @code
23285 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23286 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23287
23288 @table @code
23289 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23290 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23291 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23292 The default value is @code{all}.
23293
23294 @table @code
23295 @item none
23296 @item demon
23297 @item angel
23298 @item redboot
23299 @item all
23300 @end table
23301 @end table
23302 @end table
23303
23304 @node M68K
23305 @subsection M68k
23306
23307 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23308
23309 @node MicroBlaze
23310 @subsection MicroBlaze
23311 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23312 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23313
23314 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23315 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23316 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23317 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23318 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23319 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23320 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23321 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23322 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23323 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23324 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23325
23326 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23327
23328 @table @code
23329 @item target remote :1234
23330 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23331 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23332
23333 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23334 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23335 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23336
23337 @item load
23338 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23339
23340 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23341 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23342
23343 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23344 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23345 @end table
23346
23347 @node MIPS Embedded
23348 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23349
23350 @noindent
23351 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23352
23353 @table @code
23354 @item set mipsfpu double
23355 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23356 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23357 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23358 @itemx show mipsfpu
23359 @kindex set mipsfpu
23360 @kindex show mipsfpu
23361 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23362 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23363 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23364 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23365 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23366 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23367 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23368 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23369 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23370 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23371 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23372 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23373 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23374
23375 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23376 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23377 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23378
23379 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23380 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23381 @end table
23382
23383 @node OpenRISC 1000
23384 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23385 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23386
23387 @noindent
23388 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23389 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23390 FPGA's.
23391
23392 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23393 a target:
23394
23395 @table @code
23396
23397 @kindex target sim
23398 @item target sim
23399
23400 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23401 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23402 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23403 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23404
23405 Example: @code{target sim}
23406
23407 @item set debug or1k
23408 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23409 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23410
23411 @item show debug or1k
23412 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23413 @end table
23414
23415 @node PowerPC Embedded
23416 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23417
23418 @cindex DVC register
23419 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23420 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23421
23422 @smallexample
23423 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23424 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23425 @end smallexample
23426
23427 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23428 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23429 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23430 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23431 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23432 or newer.
23433
23434 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23435 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23436 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23437 watching variables of scalar types.
23438
23439 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23440 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23441
23442 @smallexample
23443 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23444 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23445 @end smallexample
23446
23447 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23448 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23449
23450 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23451 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23452 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23453 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23454 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23455 use the @code{break-range} command.
23456
23457 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23458
23459 @table @code
23460 @kindex break-range
23461 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23462 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23463 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23464 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23465 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23466 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23467 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23468 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23469 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23470
23471 @kindex set powerpc
23472 @item set powerpc soft-float
23473 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23474 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23475 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23476 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23477
23478 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23479 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23480 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23481 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23482 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23483 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23484 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23485 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23486
23487 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23488 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23489 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23490 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23491 address of its first byte.
23492
23493 @end table
23494
23495 @node AVR
23496 @subsection Atmel AVR
23497 @cindex AVR
23498
23499 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23500 following AVR-specific commands:
23501
23502 @table @code
23503 @item info io_registers
23504 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23505 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23506 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23507 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23508 @end table
23509
23510 @node CRIS
23511 @subsection CRIS
23512 @cindex CRIS
23513
23514 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23515 following CRIS-specific commands:
23516
23517 @table @code
23518 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23519 @cindex CRIS version
23520 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23521 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23522 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23523
23524 @item show cris-version
23525 Show the current CRIS version.
23526
23527 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23528 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23529 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23530 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23531 @code{R59}.
23532
23533 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23534 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23535
23536 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23537 @cindex CRIS mode
23538 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23539 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23540 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23541
23542 @item show cris-mode
23543 Show the current CRIS mode.
23544 @end table
23545
23546 @node Super-H
23547 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23548 @cindex Super-H
23549
23550 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23551 commands:
23552
23553 @table @code
23554 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23555 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23556 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23557 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23558 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23559 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23560 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23561 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23562 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23563 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23564 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23565 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23566
23567 @item show sh calling-convention
23568 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23569 Show the current calling convention setting.
23570
23571 @end table
23572
23573
23574 @node Architectures
23575 @section Architectures
23576
23577 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23578 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23579
23580 @menu
23581 * AArch64::
23582 * i386::
23583 * Alpha::
23584 * MIPS::
23585 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23586 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23587 * PowerPC::
23588 * Nios II::
23589 * Sparc64::
23590 @end menu
23591
23592 @node AArch64
23593 @subsection AArch64
23594 @cindex AArch64 support
23595
23596 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23597 following special commands:
23598
23599 @table @code
23600 @item set debug aarch64
23601 @kindex set debug aarch64
23602 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23603 messages are to be displayed.
23604
23605 @item show debug aarch64
23606 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23607
23608 @end table
23609
23610 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23611 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23612
23613 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23614 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23615 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23616 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23617 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23618 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23619
23620 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23621 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23622 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23623 target process.
23624
23625
23626 @node i386
23627 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23628
23629 @table @code
23630 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23631 @kindex set struct-convention
23632 @cindex struct return convention
23633 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23634 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23635 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23636 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23637 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23638 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23639 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23640 be returned in a register.
23641
23642 @item show struct-convention
23643 @kindex show struct-convention
23644 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23645 from functions.
23646 @end table
23647
23648
23649 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23650 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23651
23652 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23653 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23654 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23655 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23656 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23657 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23658 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23659
23660 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23661 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23662 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23663 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23664 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23665 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23666
23667 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23668 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23669 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23670
23671 @smallexample
23672 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23673 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23674 @end smallexample
23675
23676 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23677 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23678 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23679 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23680 the pointer.
23681
23682 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23683 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23684 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23685 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23686 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23687
23688 @table @code
23689 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23690 @kindex show mpx bound
23691 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23692
23693 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23694 @kindex set mpx bound
23695 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23696 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23697 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23698 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23699 @end table
23700
23701 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23702 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23703 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23704 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23705
23706 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23707 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23708 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23709 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23710 function.
23711
23712 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23713 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23714 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23715 continuing the execution. For example:
23716
23717 @smallexample
23718 $ break *upper
23719 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23720 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23721 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23722 $ print $bnd0
23723 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23724 @end smallexample
23725
23726 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23727 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23728 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23729
23730 @node Alpha
23731 @subsection Alpha
23732
23733 See the following section.
23734
23735 @node MIPS
23736 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23737
23738 @cindex stack on Alpha
23739 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23740 @cindex Alpha stack
23741 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23742 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23743 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23744 find the beginning of a function.
23745
23746 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23747 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23748 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23749 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23750 commands:
23751
23752 @table @code
23753 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23754 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23755 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23756 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23757 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23758 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23759 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23760 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23761
23762 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23763 Display the current limit.
23764 @end table
23765
23766 @noindent
23767 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23768 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23769
23770 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23771 programs:
23772
23773 @table @code
23774 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23775 @kindex set mips abi
23776 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23777 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23778 values of @var{arg} are:
23779
23780 @table @samp
23781 @item auto
23782 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23783 default).
23784 @item o32
23785 @item o64
23786 @item n32
23787 @item n64
23788 @item eabi32
23789 @item eabi64
23790 @end table
23791
23792 @item show mips abi
23793 @kindex show mips abi
23794 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23795
23796 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23797 @kindex set mips compression
23798 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23799 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23800 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23801 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23802 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23803 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23804 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23805 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23806 provided by the executable.
23807
23808 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23809 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23810 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23811 identified as such.
23812
23813 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23814 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23815 implicitly from an executable.
23816
23817 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23818 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23819 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23820 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23821 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23822
23823 @item show mips compression
23824 @kindex show mips compression
23825 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23826 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23827
23828 @item set mipsfpu
23829 @itemx show mipsfpu
23830 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23831
23832 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23833 @kindex set mips mask-address
23834 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23835 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23836 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23837 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23838 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23839
23840 @item show mips mask-address
23841 @kindex show mips mask-address
23842 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23843 not.
23844
23845 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23846 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23847 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23848 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23849 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23850 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23851
23852 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23853 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23854 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23855
23856 @item set debug mips
23857 @kindex set debug mips
23858 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23859 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23860
23861 @item show debug mips
23862 @kindex show debug mips
23863 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23864 @end table
23865
23866
23867 @node HPPA
23868 @subsection HPPA
23869 @cindex HPPA support
23870
23871 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23872 following special commands:
23873
23874 @table @code
23875 @item set debug hppa
23876 @kindex set debug hppa
23877 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23878 messages are to be displayed.
23879
23880 @item show debug hppa
23881 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23882
23883 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23884 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23885 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23886 given @var{address}.
23887
23888 @end table
23889
23890
23891 @node SPU
23892 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23893 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23894 @cindex SPU
23895
23896 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23897 it provides the following special commands:
23898
23899 @table @code
23900 @item info spu event
23901 @kindex info spu
23902 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23903 and pending event status.
23904
23905 @item info spu signal
23906 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23907 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23908 notification channels.
23909
23910 @item info spu mailbox
23911 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23912 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23913 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23914
23915 @item info spu dma
23916 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23917 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23918 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23919
23920 @item info spu proxydma
23921 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23922 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23923 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23924
23925 @end table
23926
23927 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23928 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23929 special commands:
23930
23931 @table @code
23932 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23933 @kindex set spu
23934 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23935 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23936 function. The default is @code{off}.
23937
23938 @item show spu stop-on-load
23939 @kindex show spu
23940 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23941
23942 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23943 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23944 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23945 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23946 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23947 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23948
23949 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23950 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23951
23952 @end table
23953
23954 @node PowerPC
23955 @subsection PowerPC
23956 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23957
23958 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23959 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23960 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23961 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23962 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23963
23964 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23965 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23966 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23967
23968 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23969 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23970
23971 @node Nios II
23972 @subsection Nios II
23973 @cindex Nios II architecture
23974
23975 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23976 it provides the following special commands:
23977
23978 @table @code
23979
23980 @item set debug nios2
23981 @kindex set debug nios2
23982 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23983 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23984
23985 @item show debug nios2
23986 @kindex show debug nios2
23987 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23988 @end table
23989
23990 @node Sparc64
23991 @subsection Sparc64
23992 @cindex Sparc64 support
23993 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23994 @subsubsection ADI Support
23995
23996 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23997 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23998 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23999 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24000 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24001 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24002 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24003 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24004 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24005 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24006 signal.
24007
24008 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24009 ADI-enabled.
24010
24011 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24012 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24013
24014
24015 @table @code
24016 @kindex adi examine
24017 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24018
24019 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24020 cacheline.
24021
24022 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24023 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24024 block size, to display.
24025
24026 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24027 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24028
24029 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24030
24031 @smallexample
24032 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24033 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24034 @end smallexample
24035
24036 @kindex adi assign
24037 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24038
24039 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24040 to an address.
24041
24042 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24043 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24044 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24045
24046 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24047 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24048
24049 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24050
24051 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24052 variable "shmaddr":
24053
24054 @smallexample
24055 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24056 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24057 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24058 @end smallexample
24059
24060 @end table
24061
24062 @node Controlling GDB
24063 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24064
24065 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24066 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24067 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24068 described here.
24069
24070 @menu
24071 * Prompt:: Prompt
24072 * Editing:: Command editing
24073 * Command History:: Command history
24074 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24075 * Numbers:: Numbers
24076 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24077 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24078 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24079 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24080 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24081 @end menu
24082
24083 @node Prompt
24084 @section Prompt
24085
24086 @cindex prompt
24087
24088 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24089 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24090 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24091 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24092 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24093 which one you are talking to.
24094
24095 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24096 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24097 or a prompt that does not.
24098
24099 @table @code
24100 @kindex set prompt
24101 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24102 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24103
24104 @kindex show prompt
24105 @item show prompt
24106 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24107 @end table
24108
24109 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24110 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24111 are:
24112
24113 @table @code
24114 @kindex set extended-prompt
24115 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24116 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24117 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24118 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24119 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24120 is displayed.
24121
24122 For example:
24123
24124 @smallexample
24125 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24126 @end smallexample
24127
24128 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24129 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24130
24131 @kindex show extended-prompt
24132 @item show extended-prompt
24133 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24134 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24135 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24136 @end table
24137
24138 @node Editing
24139 @section Command Editing
24140 @cindex readline
24141 @cindex command line editing
24142
24143 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24144 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24145 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24146 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24147 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24148 debugging sessions.
24149
24150 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24151 command @code{set}.
24152
24153 @table @code
24154 @kindex set editing
24155 @cindex editing
24156 @item set editing
24157 @itemx set editing on
24158 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24159
24160 @item set editing off
24161 Disable command line editing.
24162
24163 @kindex show editing
24164 @item show editing
24165 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24166 @end table
24167
24168 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24169 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24170 @end ifset
24171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24172 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24173 @end ifclear
24174 for more details about the Readline
24175 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24176 encouraged to read that chapter.
24177
24178 @node Command History
24179 @section Command History
24180 @cindex command history
24181
24182 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24183 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24184 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24185 history facility.
24186
24187 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24188 package, to provide the history facility.
24189 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24190 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24191 @end ifset
24192 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24193 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24194 @end ifclear
24195 for the detailed description of the History library.
24196
24197 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24198 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24199 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24200 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24201 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24202 pressed on a line by itself.
24203
24204 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24205 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24206 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24207 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24208
24209 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24210 history.
24211
24212 @table @code
24213 @cindex history substitution
24214 @cindex history file
24215 @kindex set history filename
24216 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24217 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24218 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24219 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24220 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24221 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24222 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24223 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24224 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24225 is not set.
24226
24227 @cindex save command history
24228 @kindex set history save
24229 @item set history save
24230 @itemx set history save on
24231 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24232 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24233
24234 @item set history save off
24235 Stop recording command history in a file.
24236
24237 @cindex history size
24238 @kindex set history size
24239 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24240 @item set history size @var{size}
24241 @itemx set history size unlimited
24242 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24243 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24244 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24245 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24246 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24247 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24248
24249 @cindex remove duplicate history
24250 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24251 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24252 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24253 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24254 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24255 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24256 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24257 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24258 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24259
24260 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24261 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24262
24263 @end table
24264
24265 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24266 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24267 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24268 @end ifset
24269 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24270 @xref{Event Designators},
24271 @end ifclear
24272 for more details.
24273
24274 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24275 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24276 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24277 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24278 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24279 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24280 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24281 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24282
24283 The commands to control history expansion are:
24284
24285 @table @code
24286 @item set history expansion on
24287 @itemx set history expansion
24288 @kindex set history expansion
24289 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24290
24291 @item set history expansion off
24292 Disable history expansion.
24293
24294 @c @group
24295 @kindex show history
24296 @item show history
24297 @itemx show history filename
24298 @itemx show history save
24299 @itemx show history size
24300 @itemx show history expansion
24301 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24302 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24303 @c @end group
24304 @end table
24305
24306 @table @code
24307 @kindex show commands
24308 @cindex show last commands
24309 @cindex display command history
24310 @item show commands
24311 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24312
24313 @item show commands @var{n}
24314 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24315
24316 @item show commands +
24317 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24318 @end table
24319
24320 @node Screen Size
24321 @section Screen Size
24322 @cindex size of screen
24323 @cindex screen size
24324 @cindex pagination
24325 @cindex page size
24326 @cindex pauses in output
24327
24328 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24329 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24330 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24331 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24332 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24333 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24334 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24335 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24336 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24337 following line.
24338
24339 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24340 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24341 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24342 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24343 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24344 width} commands:
24345
24346 @table @code
24347 @kindex set height
24348 @kindex set width
24349 @kindex show width
24350 @kindex show height
24351 @item set height @var{lpp}
24352 @itemx set height unlimited
24353 @itemx show height
24354 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24355 @itemx set width unlimited
24356 @itemx show width
24357 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24358 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24359 commands display the current settings.
24360
24361 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24362 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24363 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24364 buffer.
24365
24366 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24367 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24368
24369 @item set pagination on
24370 @itemx set pagination off
24371 @kindex set pagination
24372 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24373 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24374 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24375 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24376
24377 @item show pagination
24378 @kindex show pagination
24379 Show the current pagination mode.
24380 @end table
24381
24382 @node Numbers
24383 @section Numbers
24384 @cindex number representation
24385 @cindex entering numbers
24386
24387 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24388 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24389 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24390 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24391 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24392 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24393 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24394 both input and output with the commands described below.
24395
24396 @table @code
24397 @kindex set input-radix
24398 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24399 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24400 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24401 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24402 example, any of
24403
24404 @smallexample
24405 set input-radix 012
24406 set input-radix 10.
24407 set input-radix 0xa
24408 @end smallexample
24409
24410 @noindent
24411 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24412 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24413 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24414 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24415 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24416 change the radix.
24417
24418 @kindex set output-radix
24419 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24420 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24421 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24422 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24423
24424 @kindex show input-radix
24425 @item show input-radix
24426 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24427
24428 @kindex show output-radix
24429 @item show output-radix
24430 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24431
24432 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24433 @itemx show radix
24434 @kindex set radix
24435 @kindex show radix
24436 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24437 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24438 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24439 default value of 10.
24440
24441 @end table
24442
24443 @node ABI
24444 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24445
24446 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24447 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24448 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24449 current ABI.
24450
24451 @cindex OS ABI
24452 @kindex set osabi
24453 @kindex show osabi
24454 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24455
24456 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24457 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24458 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24459 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24460 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24461 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24462 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24463 platform provides.
24464
24465 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24466 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24467 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24468 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24469
24470 @table @code
24471 @item show osabi
24472 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24473
24474 @item set osabi
24475 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24476
24477 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24478 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24479 @end table
24480
24481 @cindex float promotion
24482
24483 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24484 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24485 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24486 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24487 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24488 @code{double} and then passed.
24489
24490 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24491 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24492 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24493
24494 @table @code
24495 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24496 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24497 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24498 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24499 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24500
24501 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24502 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24503 functions.
24504
24505 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24506 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24507 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24508 @end table
24509
24510 @kindex set cp-abi
24511 @kindex show cp-abi
24512 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24513 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24514 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24515 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24516 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24517 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24518 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24519 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24520 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24521 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24522 ``auto''.
24523
24524 @table @code
24525 @item show cp-abi
24526 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24527
24528 @item set cp-abi
24529 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24530
24531 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24532 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24533 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24534 @end table
24535
24536 @node Auto-loading
24537 @section Automatically loading associated files
24538 @cindex auto-loading
24539
24540 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24541 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24542 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24543 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24544 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24545 sources).
24546
24547 @menu
24548 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24549 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24550
24551 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24552 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24553 @end menu
24554
24555 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24556 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24557 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24558
24559 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24560 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24561 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24562
24563 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24564 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24565
24566 @table @code
24567 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24568 @kindex set auto-load off
24569 @item set auto-load off
24570 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24571 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24572 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24573 @smallexample
24574 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24575 @end smallexample
24576
24577 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24578 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24579 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24580 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24581 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24582 @code{set auto-load no}.
24583
24584 @anchor{show auto-load}
24585 @kindex show auto-load
24586 @item show auto-load
24587 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24588 or disabled.
24589
24590 @smallexample
24591 (gdb) show auto-load
24592 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24593 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24594 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24595 is on.
24596 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24597 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24598 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24599 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24600 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24601 @end smallexample
24602
24603 @anchor{info auto-load}
24604 @kindex info auto-load
24605 @item info auto-load
24606 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24607 not.
24608
24609 @smallexample
24610 (gdb) info auto-load
24611 gdb-scripts:
24612 Loaded Script
24613 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24614 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24615 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24616 loaded.
24617 python-scripts:
24618 Loaded Script
24619 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24620 @end smallexample
24621 @end table
24622
24623 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24624
24625 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24626 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24627 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24628 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24629 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24630 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24631 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24632 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24633 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24634 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24635 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24636 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24637 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24638 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24639 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24640 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24641 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24642 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24643 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24644 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24645 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24646 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24647 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24648 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24649 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24650 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24651 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24652 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24653 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24654 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24655 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24656 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24657 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24658 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24659 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24660 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24661 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24662 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24663 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24664 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24665 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24666 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24667 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24668 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24669 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24670 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24671 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24672 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24673 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24674 @end multitable
24675
24676 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24677 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24678 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24679
24680 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24681 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24682 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24683
24684 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24685 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24686
24687 @table @code
24688 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24689 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24690 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24691 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24692 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24693
24694 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24695 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24696 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24697 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24698 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24699
24700 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24701 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24702 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24703 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24704 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24705 @end table
24706
24707 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24708 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24709 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24710
24711 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24712
24713 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24714 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24715
24716 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24717 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24718 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24719 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24720 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24721 library.
24722
24723 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24724 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24725
24726 @table @code
24727 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24728 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24729 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24730 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24731
24732 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24733 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24734 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24735 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24736 enabled or disabled.
24737
24738 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24739 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24740 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24741 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24742 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24743 @end table
24744
24745 @node Auto-loading safe path
24746 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24747 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24748
24749 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24750 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24751 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24752 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24753 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24754
24755 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24756 get loaded:
24757
24758 @smallexample
24759 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24760 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24761 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24762 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24763 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24764 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24765 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24766 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24767 @end smallexample
24768
24769 @noindent
24770 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24771 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24772
24773 @smallexample
24774 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24775 @end smallexample
24776
24777 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24778
24779 @table @code
24780 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24781 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24782 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24783 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24784 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24785 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24786 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24787 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24788 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24789 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24790
24791 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24792 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24793 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24794
24795 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24796 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24797 @item show auto-load safe-path
24798 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24799 scripts.
24800
24801 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24802 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24803 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24804 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24805 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24806 by the host platform path separator in use.
24807 @end table
24808
24809 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24810 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24811 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24812 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24813 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24814
24815 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24816 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24817 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24818 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24819 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24820 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24821 init file in the current directory
24822 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24823
24824 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24825 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24826
24827 @table @asis
24828 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24829 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24830 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24831 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24832
24833 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24834 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24835 @value{GDBN} session.
24836
24837 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24838 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24839 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24840 from trusted sources.
24841
24842 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24843 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24844 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24845 trusted sources.
24846 @end table
24847
24848 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24849 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24850
24851 @table @asis
24852 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24853 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24854
24855 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24856 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24857 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24858 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24859 @end table
24860
24861 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24862 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24863 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24864 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24865 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24866 recommended to be entered.
24867
24868 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24869 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24870 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24871
24872 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24873 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24874 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24875 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24876 be printed.
24877
24878 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24879 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24880 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24881
24882 @smallexample
24883 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24884 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24885 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24886 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24887 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24888 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24889 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24890 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24891 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24892 @end smallexample
24893
24894 @table @code
24895 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24896 @kindex set debug auto-load
24897 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24898 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24899
24900 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24901 @kindex show debug auto-load
24902 @item show debug auto-load
24903 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24904 on or off.
24905 @end table
24906
24907 @node Messages/Warnings
24908 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24909
24910 @cindex verbose operation
24911 @cindex optional warnings
24912 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24913 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24914 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24915 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24916
24917 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24918 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24919 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24920
24921 @table @code
24922 @kindex set verbose
24923 @item set verbose on
24924 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24925
24926 @item set verbose off
24927 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24928
24929 @kindex show verbose
24930 @item show verbose
24931 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24932 @end table
24933
24934 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24935 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24936 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24937 Symbol Files}).
24938
24939 @table @code
24940
24941 @kindex set complaints
24942 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24943 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24944 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24945 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24946 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24947
24948 @kindex show complaints
24949 @item show complaints
24950 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24951
24952 @end table
24953
24954 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24955 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24956 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24957 you try to run a program which is already running:
24958
24959 @smallexample
24960 (@value{GDBP}) run
24961 The program being debugged has been started already.
24962 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24963 @end smallexample
24964
24965 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24966 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24967
24968 @table @code
24969
24970 @kindex set confirm
24971 @cindex flinching
24972 @cindex confirmation
24973 @cindex stupid questions
24974 @item set confirm off
24975 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24976 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24977 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24978
24979 @item set confirm on
24980 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24981
24982 @kindex show confirm
24983 @item show confirm
24984 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24985
24986 @end table
24987
24988 @cindex command tracing
24989 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24990 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24991 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24992 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24993
24994 @table @code
24995 @kindex set trace-commands
24996 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24997 @item set trace-commands on
24998 Enable command tracing.
24999 @item set trace-commands off
25000 Disable command tracing.
25001 @item show trace-commands
25002 Display the current state of command tracing.
25003 @end table
25004
25005 @node Debugging Output
25006 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25007 @cindex optional debugging messages
25008
25009 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25010 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25011 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25012 section documents those commands.
25013
25014 @table @code
25015 @kindex set exec-done-display
25016 @item set exec-done-display
25017 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25018 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25019 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25020 @kindex show exec-done-display
25021 @item show exec-done-display
25022 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25023 notification.
25024 @kindex set debug
25025 @cindex ARM AArch64
25026 @item set debug aarch64
25027 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25028 The default is off.
25029 @kindex show debug
25030 @item show debug aarch64
25031 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25032 ARM AArch64.
25033 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25034 @cindex architecture debugging info
25035 @item set debug arch
25036 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25037 @item show debug arch
25038 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25039 @item set debug aix-solib
25040 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25041 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25042 support module. The default is off.
25043 @item show debug aix-thread
25044 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25045 @item set debug aix-thread
25046 @cindex AIX threads
25047 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25048 module.
25049 @item show debug aix-thread
25050 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25051 @item set debug check-physname
25052 @cindex physname
25053 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25054 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25055 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25056 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25057 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25058 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25059 @item show debug check-physname
25060 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25061 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25062 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25063 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25064 exported symbols. The default is off.
25065 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25066 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25067 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25068 @item set debug dwarf-die
25069 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25070 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25071 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25072 A value of zero turns off the display.
25073 @item show debug dwarf-die
25074 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25075 @item set debug dwarf-line
25076 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25077 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25078 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25079 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25080 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25081 @item show debug dwarf-line
25082 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25083 @item set debug dwarf-read
25084 @cindex DWARF Reading
25085 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25086 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25087 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25088 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25089 @item show debug dwarf-read
25090 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25091 @item set debug displaced
25092 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25093 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25094 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25095 @item show debug displaced
25096 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25097 related to displaced stepping.
25098 @item set debug event
25099 @cindex event debugging info
25100 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25101 default is off.
25102 @item show debug event
25103 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25104 info.
25105 @item set debug expression
25106 @cindex expression debugging info
25107 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25108 expression parsing. The default is off.
25109 @item show debug expression
25110 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25111 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25112 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25113 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25114 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25115 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25116 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25117 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25118 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25119 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25120 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25121 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25122 @item set debug frame
25123 @cindex frame debugging info
25124 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25125 default is off.
25126 @item show debug frame
25127 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25128 info.
25129 @item set debug gnu-nat
25130 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25131 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25132 @item show debug gnu-nat
25133 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25134 @item set debug infrun
25135 @cindex inferior debugging info
25136 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25137 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25138 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25139 @item show debug infrun
25140 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25141 @item set debug jit
25142 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25143 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25144 @item show debug jit
25145 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25146 @item set debug lin-lwp
25147 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25148 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25149 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25150 @item show debug lin-lwp
25151 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25152 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25153 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25154 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25155 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25156 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25157 @item set debug mach-o
25158 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25159 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25160 processing. The default is off.
25161 @item show debug mach-o
25162 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25163 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25164 @item set debug notification
25165 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25166 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25167 The default is off.
25168 @item show debug notification
25169 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25170 @item set debug observer
25171 @cindex observer debugging info
25172 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25173 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25174 @item show debug observer
25175 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25176 @item set debug overload
25177 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25178 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25179 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25180 is off.
25181 @item show debug overload
25182 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25183 debugging info.
25184 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25185 @cindex debug expression parser
25186 @item set debug parser
25187 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25188 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25189 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25190 details. The default is off.
25191 @item show debug parser
25192 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25193 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25194 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25195 @cindex debug remote protocol
25196 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25197 @cindex display remote packets
25198 @item set debug remote
25199 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25200 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25201 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25202 @item show debug remote
25203 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25204
25205 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25206 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25207 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25208 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25209
25210 @item set debug serial
25211 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25212 default is off.
25213 @item show debug serial
25214 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25215 info.
25216 @item set debug solib-frv
25217 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25218 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25219 @item show debug solib-frv
25220 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25221 messages.
25222 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25223 @cindex symbol lookup
25224 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25225 The default is 0 (off).
25226 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25227 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25228 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25229 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25230 @item set debug symfile
25231 @cindex symbol file functions
25232 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25233 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25234 @item show debug symfile
25235 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25236 @item set debug symtab-create
25237 @cindex symbol table creation
25238 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25239 The default is 0 (off).
25240 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25241 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25242 @item show debug symtab-create
25243 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25244 @item set debug target
25245 @cindex target debugging info
25246 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25247 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25248 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25249 value of large memory transfers.
25250 @item show debug target
25251 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25252 info.
25253 @item set debug timestamp
25254 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25255 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25256 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25257 message.
25258 @item show debug timestamp
25259 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25260 debugging info.
25261 @item set debug varobj
25262 @cindex variable object debugging info
25263 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25264 info. The default is off.
25265 @item show debug varobj
25266 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25267 debugging info.
25268 @item set debug xml
25269 @cindex XML parser debugging
25270 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25271 @item show debug xml
25272 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25273 @end table
25274
25275 @node Other Misc Settings
25276 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25277 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25278
25279 @table @code
25280 @kindex set interactive-mode
25281 @item set interactive-mode
25282 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25283 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25284 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25285 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25286 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25287 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25288 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25289 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25290
25291 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25292 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25293 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25294 inside a cygwin window.
25295
25296 @kindex show interactive-mode
25297 @item show interactive-mode
25298 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25299 @end table
25300
25301 @node Extending GDB
25302 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25303 @cindex extending GDB
25304
25305 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25306 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25307 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25308 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25309 being debugged.
25310
25311 @menu
25312 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25313 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25314 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25315 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25316 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25317 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25318 @end menu
25319
25320 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25321 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25322 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25323 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25324 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25325 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25326
25327 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25328 setting:
25329
25330 @table @code
25331 @kindex set script-extension
25332 @kindex show script-extension
25333 @item set script-extension off
25334 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25335
25336 @item set script-extension soft
25337 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25338 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25339 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25340 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25341
25342 @item set script-extension strict
25343 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25344 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25345 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25346
25347 @item show script-extension
25348 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25349
25350 @end table
25351
25352 @node Sequences
25353 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25354
25355 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25356 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25357 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25358 files.
25359
25360 @menu
25361 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25362 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25363 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25364 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25365 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25366 @end menu
25367
25368 @node Define
25369 @subsection User-defined Commands
25370
25371 @cindex user-defined command
25372 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25373 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25374 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25375 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25376 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25377 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25378
25379 @smallexample
25380 define adder
25381 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25382 end
25383 @end smallexample
25384
25385 @noindent
25386 To execute the command use:
25387
25388 @smallexample
25389 adder 1 2 3
25390 @end smallexample
25391
25392 @noindent
25393 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25394 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25395 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25396 functions calls.
25397
25398 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25399 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25400 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25401 been passed.
25402
25403 @smallexample
25404 define adder
25405 if $argc == 2
25406 print $arg0 + $arg1
25407 end
25408 if $argc == 3
25409 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25410 end
25411 end
25412 @end smallexample
25413
25414 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25415 to process a variable number of arguments:
25416
25417 @smallexample
25418 define adder
25419 set $i = 0
25420 set $sum = 0
25421 while $i < $argc
25422 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25423 set $i = $i + 1
25424 end
25425 print $sum
25426 end
25427 @end smallexample
25428
25429 @table @code
25430
25431 @kindex define
25432 @item define @var{commandname}
25433 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25434 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25435 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25436 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25437 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25438 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25439
25440 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25441 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25442 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25443
25444 @kindex document
25445 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25446 @item document @var{commandname}
25447 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25448 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25449 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25450 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25451 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25452 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25453
25454 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25455 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25456 does not change the documentation.
25457
25458 @kindex dont-repeat
25459 @cindex don't repeat command
25460 @item dont-repeat
25461 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25462 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25463 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25464
25465 @kindex help user-defined
25466 @item help user-defined
25467 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25468 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25469 included (if any).
25470
25471 @kindex show user
25472 @item show user
25473 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25474 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25475 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25476 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25477 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25478
25479 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25480 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25481 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25482 @item show max-user-call-depth
25483 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25484 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25485 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25486 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25487 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25488 @end table
25489
25490 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25491 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25492
25493 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25494 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25495 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25496
25497 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25498 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25499 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25500 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25501
25502 @node Hooks
25503 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25504 @cindex command hooks
25505 @cindex hooks, for commands
25506 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25507
25508 @kindex hook
25509 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25510 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25511 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25512 before that command.
25513
25514 @cindex hooks, post-command
25515 @kindex hookpost
25516 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25517 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25518 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25519 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25520 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25521
25522 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25523 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25524
25525 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25526 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25527
25528 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25529 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25530 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25531 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25532 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25533
25534 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25535 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25536 you could define:
25537
25538 @smallexample
25539 define hook-stop
25540 handle SIGALRM nopass
25541 end
25542
25543 define hook-run
25544 handle SIGALRM pass
25545 end
25546
25547 define hook-continue
25548 handle SIGALRM pass
25549 end
25550 @end smallexample
25551
25552 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25553 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25554 you could define:
25555
25556 @smallexample
25557 define hook-echo
25558 echo <<<---
25559 end
25560
25561 define hookpost-echo
25562 echo --->>>\n
25563 end
25564
25565 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25566 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25567 (@value{GDBP})
25568
25569 @end smallexample
25570
25571 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25572 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25573 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25574 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25575 @c or not?
25576 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25577 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25578 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25579
25580 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25581 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25582 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25583
25584 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25585 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25586
25587 @node Command Files
25588 @subsection Command Files
25589
25590 @cindex command files
25591 @cindex scripting commands
25592 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25593 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25594 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25595 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25596 terminal.
25597
25598 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25599 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25600 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25601 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25602 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25603
25604 @table @code
25605 @kindex source
25606 @cindex execute commands from a file
25607 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25608 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25609 @end table
25610
25611 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25612 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25613 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25614 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25615 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25616
25617 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25618 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25619 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25620 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25621 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25622 is not relevant to scripts.
25623
25624 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25625 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25626 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25627 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25628 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25629 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25630 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25631 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25632 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25633 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25634 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25635 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25636 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25637 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25638
25639 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25640 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25641 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25642
25643 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25644 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25645 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25646 when called from command files.
25647
25648 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25649 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25650 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25651 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25652 the next command.
25653
25654 @smallexample
25655 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25656 @end smallexample
25657
25658 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25659 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25660 would be directed to @file{log}.
25661
25662 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25663 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25664 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25665 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25666 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25667 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25668 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25669 conditionally, etc.
25670
25671 @table @code
25672 @kindex if
25673 @kindex else
25674 @item if
25675 @itemx else
25676 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25677 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25678 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25679 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25680 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25681 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25682 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25683
25684 @kindex while
25685 @item while
25686 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25687 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25688 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25689 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25690 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25691 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25692
25693 @kindex loop_break
25694 @item loop_break
25695 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25696 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25697 line.
25698
25699 @kindex loop_continue
25700 @item loop_continue
25701 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25702 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25703 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25704 the controlling expression.
25705
25706 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25707 @item end
25708 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25709 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25710 @end table
25711
25712
25713 @node Output
25714 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25715
25716 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25717 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25718 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25719 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25720 want.
25721
25722 @table @code
25723 @kindex echo
25724 @item echo @var{text}
25725 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25726 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25727 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25728 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25729 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25730 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25731 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25732 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25733 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25734 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25735 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25736
25737 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25738 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25739
25740 @smallexample
25741 echo This is some text\n\
25742 which is continued\n\
25743 onto several lines.\n
25744 @end smallexample
25745
25746 produces the same output as
25747
25748 @smallexample
25749 echo This is some text\n
25750 echo which is continued\n
25751 echo onto several lines.\n
25752 @end smallexample
25753
25754 @kindex output
25755 @item output @var{expression}
25756 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25757 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25758 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25759 on expressions.
25760
25761 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25762 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25763 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25764 Formats}, for more information.
25765
25766 @kindex printf
25767 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25768 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25769 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25770 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25771 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25772 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25773 executing the code below:
25774
25775 @smallexample
25776 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25777 @end smallexample
25778
25779 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25780 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25781 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25782 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25783 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25784 printed.
25785
25786 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25787
25788 @smallexample
25789 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25790 @end smallexample
25791
25792 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25793 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25794 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25795
25796 @itemize @bullet
25797 @item
25798 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25799
25800 @item
25801 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25802 width.
25803
25804 @item
25805 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25806 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25807
25808 @item
25809 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25810 supported.
25811
25812 @item
25813 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25814
25815 @item
25816 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25817 @end itemize
25818
25819 @noindent
25820 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25821 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25822 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25823 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25824
25825 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25826 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25827 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25828 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25829 supported.
25830
25831 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25832 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25833 together with a floating point specifier.
25834 letters:
25835
25836 @itemize @bullet
25837 @item
25838 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25839
25840 @item
25841 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25842
25843 @item
25844 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25845 @end itemize
25846
25847 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25848 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25849 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25850
25851 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25852 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25853
25854 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25855 @smallexample
25856 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25857 @end smallexample
25858
25859 @anchor{eval}
25860 @kindex eval
25861 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25862 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25863 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25864
25865 @end table
25866
25867 @node Auto-loading sequences
25868 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25869 @cindex native script auto-loading
25870
25871 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25872 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25873 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25874 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25875
25876 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25877 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25878
25879 @table @code
25880 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25881 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25882 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25883 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25884
25885 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25886 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25887 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25888 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25889 disabled.
25890
25891 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25892 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25893 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25894 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25895 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25896 auto-loaded.
25897 @end table
25898
25899 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25900 matching names are printed.
25901
25902 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25903 @include python.texi
25904
25905 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25906 @include guile.texi
25907
25908 @node Auto-loading extensions
25909 @section Auto-loading extensions
25910 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25911
25912 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25913 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25914 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25915 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25916 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25917
25918 @menu
25919 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25920 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25921 * Which flavor to choose?::
25922 @end menu
25923
25924 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25925 debugging commands and features.
25926
25927 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25928 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25929 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25930 for more information.
25931 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25932 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25933
25934 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25935 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25936
25937 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25938 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25939 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25940 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25941 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25942
25943 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25944 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25945 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25946 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25947
25948 @table @code
25949 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25950 GDB's own command language
25951 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25952 Python
25953 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25954 Guile
25955 @end table
25956
25957 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25958 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25959 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25960 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25961 script in the specified extension language.
25962
25963 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25964 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25965
25966 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25967 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25968
25969 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25970 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25971 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25972 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25973 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25974 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25975
25976 @table @code
25977 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25978 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25979 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25980 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25981 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25982 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25983
25984 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25985 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25986
25987 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25988 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25989 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25990 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25991
25992 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25993 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25994 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25995 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25996 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25997 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25998 platform.
25999
26000 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26001 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26002 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26003
26004 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26005 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26006 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26007 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26008
26009 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26010 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26011 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26012 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26013 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26014 @end table
26015
26016 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26017 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26018 @var{objfile} is opened.
26019 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26020 is evaluated more than once.
26021
26022 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26023 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26024 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26025
26026 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26027 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26028 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26029 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26030 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26031 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26032 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26033
26034 The following entries are supported:
26035
26036 @table @code
26037 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26038 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26039 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26040 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26041 @end table
26042
26043 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26044
26045 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26046 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26047 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26048 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26049 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26050
26051 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26052 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26053
26054 @example
26055 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26056 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26057 asm("\
26058 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26059 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26060 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26061 .popsection \n\
26062 ");
26063 @end example
26064
26065 @noindent
26066 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26067 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26068
26069 @example
26070 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26071 @end example
26072
26073 The script name may include directories if desired.
26074
26075 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26076 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26077
26078 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26079 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26080 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26081 will remove duplicates.
26082
26083 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26084
26085 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26086 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26087 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26088 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26089 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26090 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26091 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26092 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26093 on its name.
26094
26095 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26096 testsuite.
26097
26098 @example
26099 #include "symcat.h"
26100 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26101 asm(
26102 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26103 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26104 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26105 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26106 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26107 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26108 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26109 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26110 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26111 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26112 ".byte 0\n"
26113 ".popsection\n"
26114 );
26115 @end example
26116
26117 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26118 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26119 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26120 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26121
26122 @node Which flavor to choose?
26123 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26124
26125 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26126 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26127
26128 @noindent
26129 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26130
26131 @itemize @bullet
26132 @item
26133 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26134
26135 @item
26136 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26137
26138 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26139 in the source search path.
26140 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26141 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26142
26143 @item
26144 Doesn't require source code additions.
26145 @end itemize
26146
26147 @noindent
26148 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26149
26150 @itemize @bullet
26151 @item
26152 Works with static linking.
26153
26154 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26155 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26156 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26157 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26158 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26159
26160 @item
26161 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26162
26163 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26164 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26165
26166 @item
26167 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26168
26169 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26170 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26171 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26172 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26173 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26174 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26175 @end itemize
26176
26177 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26178 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26179
26180 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26181 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26182 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26183
26184 @subsection Python comes first
26185
26186 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26187 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26188 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26189 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26190 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26191 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26192 pretty-printed form of a value).
26193 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26194 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26195 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26196
26197 @node Aliases
26198 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26199 @cindex aliases for commands
26200
26201 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26202 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26203 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26204 that involves less typing.
26205
26206 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26207 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26208 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26209
26210 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26211 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26212 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26213
26214 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26215
26216 @table @code
26217
26218 @kindex alias
26219 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26220
26221 @end table
26222
26223 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26224 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26225 underscores.
26226
26227 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26228 that is being aliased.
26229
26230 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26231 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26232 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26233
26234 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26235 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26236
26237 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26238 of a command so that there is less to type.
26239 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26240 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26241 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26242 The following will accomplish this.
26243
26244 @smallexample
26245 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26246 @end smallexample
26247
26248 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26249 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26250 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26251 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26252
26253 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26254 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26255 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26256 of a command.
26257
26258 @smallexample
26259 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26260 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26261 (gdb) set p elms 20
26262 (gdb) show p elms
26263 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26264 @end smallexample
26265
26266 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26267 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26268 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26269
26270 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26271 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26272
26273 @smallexample
26274 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26275 @end smallexample
26276
26277 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26278 alias for a more complex command.
26279 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26280
26281 @smallexample
26282 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26283 (gdb) spe 20
26284 @end smallexample
26285
26286 @node Interpreters
26287 @chapter Command Interpreters
26288 @cindex command interpreters
26289
26290 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26291 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26292 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26293
26294 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26295 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26296 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26297 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26298
26299 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26300 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26301 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26302 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26303
26304 @table @code
26305 @item console
26306 @cindex console interpreter
26307 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26308 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26309 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26310
26311 @item mi
26312 @cindex mi interpreter
26313 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26314 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26315 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26316 Interface}.
26317
26318 @item mi2
26319 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26320 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26321
26322 @item mi1
26323 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26324 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26325
26326 @end table
26327
26328 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26329
26330 @kindex interpreter-exec
26331 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26332 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26333 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26334
26335 @smallexample
26336 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26337 @end smallexample
26338
26339 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26340 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26341
26342 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26343 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26344 permanently.
26345
26346 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26347
26348 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26349 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26350 device (usually a tty).
26351
26352 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26353 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26354 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26355 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26356 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26357 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26358 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26359 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26360 the separate MI interpreter.
26361
26362 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26363 @code{new-ui} command:
26364
26365 @kindex new-ui
26366 @cindex new user interface
26367 @smallexample
26368 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26369 @end smallexample
26370
26371 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26372 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26373 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26374 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26375 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26376 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26377
26378 @smallexample
26379 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26380 @end smallexample
26381
26382 @noindent
26383 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26384
26385 @node TUI
26386 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26387 @cindex TUI
26388 @cindex Text User Interface
26389
26390 @menu
26391 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26392 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26393 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26394 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26395 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26396 @end menu
26397
26398 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26399 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26400 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26401 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26402 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26403 is available.
26404
26405 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26406 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26407 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26408 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26409 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26410 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26411
26412 @node TUI Overview
26413 @section TUI Overview
26414
26415 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26416
26417 @table @emph
26418 @item command
26419 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26420 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26421 managed using readline.
26422
26423 @item source
26424 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26425 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26426
26427 @item assembly
26428 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26429
26430 @item register
26431 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26432 when their values change.
26433 @end table
26434
26435 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26436 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26437 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26438 indicates the breakpoint type:
26439
26440 @table @code
26441 @item B
26442 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26443
26444 @item b
26445 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26446
26447 @item H
26448 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26449
26450 @item h
26451 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26452 @end table
26453
26454 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26455
26456 @table @code
26457 @item +
26458 Breakpoint is enabled.
26459
26460 @item -
26461 Breakpoint is disabled.
26462 @end table
26463
26464 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26465 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26466 changes.
26467
26468 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26469 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26470 layouts:
26471
26472 @itemize @bullet
26473 @item
26474 source only,
26475
26476 @item
26477 assembly only,
26478
26479 @item
26480 source and assembly,
26481
26482 @item
26483 source and registers, or
26484
26485 @item
26486 assembly and registers.
26487 @end itemize
26488
26489 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26490
26491 @table @emph
26492 @item target
26493 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26494 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26495
26496 @item process
26497 Gives the current process or thread number.
26498 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26499
26500 @item function
26501 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26502 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26503 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26504 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26505
26506 @item line
26507 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26508 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26509
26510 @item pc
26511 Indicates the current program counter address.
26512 @end table
26513
26514 @node TUI Keys
26515 @section TUI Key Bindings
26516 @cindex TUI key bindings
26517
26518 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26519 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26520 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26521 @end ifset
26522 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26523 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26524 @end ifclear
26525 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26526 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26527
26528 @table @kbd
26529 @kindex C-x C-a
26530 @item C-x C-a
26531 @kindex C-x a
26532 @itemx C-x a
26533 @kindex C-x A
26534 @itemx C-x A
26535 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26536 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26537 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26538 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26539 The screen is then refreshed.
26540
26541 @kindex C-x 1
26542 @item C-x 1
26543 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26544 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26545 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26546
26547 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26548
26549 @kindex C-x 2
26550 @item C-x 2
26551 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26552 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26553 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26554 previous layout and the new one.
26555
26556 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26557
26558 @kindex C-x o
26559 @item C-x o
26560 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26561 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26562 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26563
26564 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26565
26566 @kindex C-x s
26567 @item C-x s
26568 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26569 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26570 @end table
26571
26572 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26573
26574 @table @asis
26575 @kindex PgUp
26576 @item @key{PgUp}
26577 Scroll the active window one page up.
26578
26579 @kindex PgDn
26580 @item @key{PgDn}
26581 Scroll the active window one page down.
26582
26583 @kindex Up
26584 @item @key{Up}
26585 Scroll the active window one line up.
26586
26587 @kindex Down
26588 @item @key{Down}
26589 Scroll the active window one line down.
26590
26591 @kindex Left
26592 @item @key{Left}
26593 Scroll the active window one column left.
26594
26595 @kindex Right
26596 @item @key{Right}
26597 Scroll the active window one column right.
26598
26599 @kindex C-L
26600 @item @kbd{C-L}
26601 Refresh the screen.
26602 @end table
26603
26604 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26605 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26606 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26607 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26608 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26609
26610 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26611 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26612 @cindex TUI single key mode
26613
26614 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26615 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26616 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26617
26618 @table @kbd
26619 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26620 @item c
26621 continue
26622
26623 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26624 @item d
26625 down
26626
26627 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26628 @item f
26629 finish
26630
26631 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26632 @item n
26633 next
26634
26635 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26636 @item o
26637 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26638
26639 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26640 @item q
26641 exit the SingleKey mode.
26642
26643 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26644 @item r
26645 run
26646
26647 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26648 @item s
26649 step
26650
26651 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26652 @item i
26653 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26654
26655 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26656 @item u
26657 up
26658
26659 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26660 @item v
26661 info locals
26662
26663 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26664 @item w
26665 where
26666 @end table
26667
26668 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26669 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26670 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26671 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26672 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26673 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26674
26675
26676 @node TUI Commands
26677 @section TUI-specific Commands
26678 @cindex TUI commands
26679
26680 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26681 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26682 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26683 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26684
26685 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26686 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26687 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26688 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26689 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26690
26691 @table @code
26692 @item tui enable
26693 @kindex tui enable
26694 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26695 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26696 otherwise a default layout is used.
26697
26698 @item tui disable
26699 @kindex tui disable
26700 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26701
26702 @item info win
26703 @kindex info win
26704 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26705
26706 @item layout @var{name}
26707 @kindex layout
26708 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26709 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26710 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26711
26712 @table @code
26713 @item next
26714 Display the next layout.
26715
26716 @item prev
26717 Display the previous layout.
26718
26719 @item src
26720 Display the source and command windows.
26721
26722 @item asm
26723 Display the assembly and command windows.
26724
26725 @item split
26726 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26727
26728 @item regs
26729 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26730 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26731 register, assembler, and command windows.
26732 @end table
26733
26734 @item focus @var{name}
26735 @kindex focus
26736 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26737 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26738
26739 @table @code
26740 @item next
26741 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26742
26743 @item prev
26744 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26745
26746 @item src
26747 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26748
26749 @item asm
26750 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26751
26752 @item regs
26753 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26754
26755 @item cmd
26756 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26757 @end table
26758
26759 @item refresh
26760 @kindex refresh
26761 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26762
26763 @item tui reg @var{group}
26764 @kindex tui reg
26765 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26766 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26767 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26768 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26769 following groups are available on most targets:
26770 @table @code
26771 @item next
26772 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26773 through all of the available register groups.
26774
26775 @item prev
26776 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26777 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26778 @var{next}.
26779
26780 @item general
26781 Display the general registers.
26782 @item float
26783 Display the floating point registers.
26784 @item system
26785 Display the system registers.
26786 @item vector
26787 Display the vector registers.
26788 @item all
26789 Display all registers.
26790 @end table
26791
26792 @item update
26793 @kindex update
26794 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26795
26796 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26797 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26798 @kindex winheight
26799 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26800 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26801 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26802 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26803 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26804 @end table
26805
26806 @node TUI Configuration
26807 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26808 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26809
26810 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26811
26812 @table @code
26813 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26814 @kindex set tui border-kind
26815 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26816 The possible values are the following:
26817 @table @code
26818 @item space
26819 Use a space character to draw the border.
26820
26821 @item ascii
26822 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26823
26824 @item acs
26825 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26826 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26827 @end table
26828
26829 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26830 @kindex set tui border-mode
26831 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26832 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26833 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26834 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26835 @table @code
26836 @item normal
26837 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26838
26839 @item standout
26840 Use standout mode.
26841
26842 @item reverse
26843 Use reverse video mode.
26844
26845 @item half
26846 Use half bright mode.
26847
26848 @item half-standout
26849 Use half bright and standout mode.
26850
26851 @item bold
26852 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26853
26854 @item bold-standout
26855 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26856 @end table
26857
26858 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
26859 @kindex set tui tab-width
26860 @kindex tabset
26861 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26862 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26863 assembly windows.
26864 @end table
26865
26866 @node Emacs
26867 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26868
26869 @cindex Emacs
26870 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26871 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26872 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26873 @value{GDBN}.
26874
26875 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26876 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26877 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26878 created Emacs buffer.
26879 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26880
26881 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26882 things:
26883
26884 @itemize @bullet
26885 @item
26886 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26887 the GUD buffer.
26888
26889 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26890 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26891
26892 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26893 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26894 in this way.
26895
26896 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26897 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26898 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26899 stop.
26900
26901 @item
26902 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26903
26904 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26905 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26906 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26907 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26908 and the source.
26909
26910 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26911 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26912 @end itemize
26913
26914 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26915 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26916 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26917 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26918
26919 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26920 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26921 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26922 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26923 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26924 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26925 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26926 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26927 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26928
26929 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26930 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26931 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26932 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26933
26934 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26935 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26936 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26937 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26938 one you want.
26939
26940 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26941 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26942
26943 @table @kbd
26944 @item C-h m
26945 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26946
26947 @item C-c C-s
26948 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26949 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26950
26951 @item C-c C-n
26952 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26953 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26954 to show the current file and location.
26955
26956 @item C-c C-i
26957 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26958 display window accordingly.
26959
26960 @item C-c C-f
26961 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26962 @code{finish} command.
26963
26964 @item C-c C-r
26965 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26966 command.
26967
26968 @item C-c <
26969 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26970 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26971 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26972
26973 @item C-c >
26974 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26975 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26976 @end table
26977
26978 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26979 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26980
26981 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26982 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26983 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26984 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26985 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26986 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26987 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26988
26989 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26990 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26991 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26992 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26993 frame.
26994
26995 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26996 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26997 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26998 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26999 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27000 to correspond properly with the code.
27001
27002 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27003 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27004 Emacs Manual}).
27005
27006 @node GDB/MI
27007 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27008
27009 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27010
27011 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27012 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27013 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27014 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27015 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27016 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27017
27018 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27019 in the form of a reference manual.
27020
27021 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27022 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27023 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27024
27025 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27026
27027 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27028 This chapter uses the following notation:
27029
27030 @itemize @bullet
27031 @item
27032 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27033
27034 @item
27035 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27036 it may or may not be given.
27037
27038 @item
27039 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27040 may repeat zero or more times.
27041
27042 @item
27043 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27044 may repeat one or more times.
27045
27046 @item
27047 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27048 @end itemize
27049
27050 @ignore
27051 @heading Dependencies
27052 @end ignore
27053
27054 @menu
27055 * GDB/MI General Design::
27056 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27057 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27058 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27059 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27060 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27061 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27062 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27063 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27064 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27065 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27066 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27067 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27068 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27069 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27070 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27071 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27072 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27073 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27074 @ignore
27075 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27076 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27077 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27078 @end ignore
27079 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27080 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27081 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27082 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27083 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27084 @end menu
27085
27086 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27087 @node GDB/MI General Design
27088 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27089 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27090
27091 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27092 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27093 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27094 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27095 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27096 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27097 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27098 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27099 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27100 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27101
27102 The important examples of notifications are:
27103 @itemize @bullet
27104
27105 @item
27106 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27107 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27108 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27109 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27110 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27111 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27112 command itself was successfully executed.
27113
27114 @item
27115 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27116 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27117 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27118 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27119 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27120 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27121
27122 @item
27123 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27124 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27125 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27126 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27127 orthogonal frontend design.
27128
27129 @end itemize
27130
27131 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27132 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27133 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27134 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27135 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27136 the user interface.
27137
27138
27139 @menu
27140 * Context management::
27141 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27142 * Thread groups::
27143 @end menu
27144
27145 @node Context management
27146 @subsection Context management
27147
27148 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27149
27150 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27151 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27152 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27153 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27154 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27155 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27156 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27157 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27158 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27159
27160 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27161 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27162 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27163 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27164 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27165 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27166 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27167 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27168 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27169 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27170 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27171
27172 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27173 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27174 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27175 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27176 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27177 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27178 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27179 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27180 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27181 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27182
27183 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27184 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27185 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27186 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27187 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27188 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27189 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27190 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27191 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27192 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27193 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27194 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27195 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27196 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27197 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27198 @samp{--frame} options.
27199
27200 @subsubsection Language
27201
27202 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27203 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27204 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27205 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27206 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27207 For instance:
27208
27209 @smallexample
27210 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27211 ^done,value="4"
27212 (gdb)
27213 @end smallexample
27214
27215 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27216 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27217 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27218
27219 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27220 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27221
27222 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27223 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27224 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27225 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27226 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27227 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27228 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27229 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27230 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27231
27232 @table @code
27233 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27234 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27235 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27236
27237 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27238 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27239 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27240
27241 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27242 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27243 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27244 MI commands even while the target is running.
27245
27246 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27247 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27248 @end table
27249
27250 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27251 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27252 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27253 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27254 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27255 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27256
27257 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27258 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27259 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27260 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27261 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27262 are running.
27263
27264 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27265 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27266 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27267 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27268 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27269 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27270 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27271 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27272 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27273 @samp{--thread} option).
27274
27275 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27276 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27277 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27278 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27279
27280 @node Thread groups
27281 @subsection Thread groups
27282 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27283 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27284 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27285 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27286 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27287
27288 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27289 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27290 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27291 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27292 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27293 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27294 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27295 into processes.
27296
27297 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27298 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27299 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27300 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27301 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27302 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27303 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27304 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27305 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27306 the members of specific thread group.
27307
27308 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27309 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27310 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27311 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27312 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27313 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27314 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27315 after attaching to that thread group.
27316
27317 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27318 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27319 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27320 such thread groups.
27321
27322 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27323 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27324 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27325
27326 @menu
27327 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27328 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27329 @end menu
27330
27331 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27332 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27333
27334 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27335 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27336 @table @code
27337 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27338 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27339
27340 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27341 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27342 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27343
27344 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27345 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27346 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27347
27348 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27349 "any sequence of digits"
27350
27351 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27352 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27353
27354 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27355 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27356
27357 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27358 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27359
27360 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27361 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27362 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27363
27364 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27365 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27366
27367 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27368 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27369 @end table
27370
27371 @noindent
27372 Notes:
27373
27374 @itemize @bullet
27375 @item
27376 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27377 output is described below.
27378
27379 @item
27380 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27381 finishes.
27382
27383 @item
27384 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27385 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27386 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27387 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27388 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27389 @end itemize
27390
27391 Pragmatics:
27392
27393 @itemize @bullet
27394 @item
27395 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27396
27397 @item
27398 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27399 @end itemize
27400
27401 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27402 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27403
27404 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27405 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27406 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27407 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27408 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27409 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27410
27411 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27412 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27413 @var{token}.
27414
27415 @table @code
27416 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27417 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27418
27419 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27420 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27421
27422 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27423 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27424
27425 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27426 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27427
27428 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27429 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27430
27431 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27432 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27433
27434 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27435 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27436
27437 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27438 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27439
27440 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27441 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27442
27443 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27444 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27445 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27446
27447 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27448 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27449
27450 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27451 @code{ @var{string} }
27452
27453 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27454 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27455
27456 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27457 @code{@var{c-string}}
27458
27459 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27460 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27461
27462 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27463 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27464 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27465
27466 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27467 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27468
27469 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27470 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27471
27472 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27473 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27474
27475 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27476 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27477
27478 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27479 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27480
27481 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27482 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27483 @end table
27484
27485 @noindent
27486 Notes:
27487
27488 @itemize @bullet
27489 @item
27490 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27491
27492 @item
27493 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27494 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27495 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27496 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27497 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27498 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27499 prior command.
27500
27501 @item
27502 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27503 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27504 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27505 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27506
27507 @item
27508 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27509 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27510 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27511 @samp{*}.
27512
27513 @item
27514 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27515 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27516 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27517 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27518
27519 @item
27520 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27521 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27522 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27523 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27524
27525 @item
27526 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27527 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27528 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27529
27530 @item
27531 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27532 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27533 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27534 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27535
27536 @item
27537 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27538 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27539 @var{values}.
27540
27541
27542 @end itemize
27543
27544 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27545 details about the various output records.
27546
27547 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27548 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27549 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27550
27551 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27552 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27553
27554 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27555 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27556 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27557 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27558 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27559 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27560
27561 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27562 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27563 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27564
27565 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27566 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27567 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27568 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27569
27570 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27571 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27572
27573 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27574 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27575 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27576 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27577 might change.
27578
27579 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27580 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27581 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27582 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27583
27584 @itemize @bullet
27585 @item
27586 New MI commands may be added.
27587
27588 @item
27589 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27590
27591 @item
27592 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27593 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27594
27595 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27596 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27597
27598 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27599 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27600 @end itemize
27601
27602 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27603 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27604 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27605 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27606 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27607
27608 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27609 @c version?
27610
27611 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27612 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27613 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27614 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27615 @cindex mailing lists
27616
27617 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27618 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27619 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27620
27621 @menu
27622 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27623 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27624 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27625 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27626 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27627 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27628 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27629 @end menu
27630
27631 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27632 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27633
27634 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27635 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27636 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27637 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27638
27639 @table @code
27640 @findex ^done
27641 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27642 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27643 values.
27644
27645 @item "^running"
27646 @findex ^running
27647 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27648 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27649 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27650 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27651 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27652 which threads are resumed.
27653
27654 @item "^connected"
27655 @findex ^connected
27656 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27657
27658 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27659 @findex ^error
27660 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27661 the corresponding error message.
27662
27663 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27664 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27665 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27666
27667 @table @samp
27668 @item "undefined-command"
27669 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27670 @end table
27671
27672 @item "^exit"
27673 @findex ^exit
27674 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27675
27676 @end table
27677
27678 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27679 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27680
27681 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27682 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27683 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27684 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27685 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27686
27687 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27688 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27689 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27690 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27691 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27692
27693 @table @code
27694 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27695 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27696 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27697
27698 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27699 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27700 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27701 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27702
27703 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27704 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27705 internals.
27706 @end table
27707
27708 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27709 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27710
27711 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27712 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27713 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27714 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27715 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27716 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27717
27718 The following is the list of possible async records:
27719
27720 @table @code
27721
27722 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27723 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27724 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27725 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27726 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27727 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27728 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27729 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27730 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27731 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27732 it run freely.
27733
27734 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27735 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27736 following values:
27737
27738 @table @code
27739 @item breakpoint-hit
27740 A breakpoint was reached.
27741 @item watchpoint-trigger
27742 A watchpoint was triggered.
27743 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27744 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27745 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27746 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27747 @item function-finished
27748 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27749 @item location-reached
27750 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27751 @item watchpoint-scope
27752 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27753 @item end-stepping-range
27754 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27755 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27756 @item exited-signalled
27757 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27758 @item exited
27759 The inferior exited.
27760 @item exited-normally
27761 The inferior exited normally.
27762 @item signal-received
27763 A signal was received by the inferior.
27764 @item solib-event
27765 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27766 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27767 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27768 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27769 @item fork
27770 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27771 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27772 @item vfork
27773 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27774 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27775 @item syscall-entry
27776 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27777 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27778 @item syscall-return
27779 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27780 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27781 @item exec
27782 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27783 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27784 @end table
27785
27786 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27787 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27788 Depending on whether all-stop
27789 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27790 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27791 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27792 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27793 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27794 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27795 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27796 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27797 if such information is not available.
27798
27799 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27800 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27801 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27802 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27803 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27804 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27805 cannot be used in any way.
27806
27807 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27808 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27809 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27810 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27811 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27812 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27813
27814 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27815 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27816 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27817 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27818 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27819 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27820
27821 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27822 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27823 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27824 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27825 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27826
27827 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27828 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27829 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27830 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27831 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27832 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27833 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27834 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27835 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27836
27837 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27838 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27839
27840 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27841 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27842 that thread.
27843
27844 @item =library-loaded,...
27845 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27846 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27847 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27848 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27849 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27850 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27851 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27852 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27853 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27854 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27855 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27856 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27857 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27858 to this library.
27859
27860 @item =library-unloaded,...
27861 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27862 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27863 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27864 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27865 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27866 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27867 thread groups.
27868
27869 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27870 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27871 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27872 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27873 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27874
27875 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27876 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27877 initial value @var{initial}.
27878
27879 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27880 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27881 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27882 trace state variables are deleted.
27883
27884 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27885 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27886 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27887 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27888 value of trace state variable is known.
27889
27890 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27891 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27892 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27893 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27894 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27895 user.
27896
27897 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27898 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27899 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27900
27901 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27902 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27903
27904 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27905 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27906 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27907 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27908 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27909
27910 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27911 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27912 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27913 for existing method and format values.
27914
27915 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27916 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27917 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27918 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27919 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27920 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27921
27922 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27923 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27924 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27925 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27926 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27927 executable code.
27928 @end table
27929
27930 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27931 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27932
27933 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27934 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27935 following fields:
27936
27937 @table @code
27938 @item number
27939 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27940 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27941 @samp{1.2}.
27942
27943 @item type
27944 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27945 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27946
27947 @item catch-type
27948 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27949 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27950
27951 @item disp
27952 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27953 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27954 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27955
27956 @item enabled
27957 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27958 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27959 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27960
27961 @item addr
27962 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27963 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27964 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27965 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27966 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27967
27968 @item func
27969 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27970 If not known, this field is not present.
27971
27972 @item filename
27973 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27974 If not known, this field is not present.
27975
27976 @item fullname
27977 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27978 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27979
27980 @item line
27981 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27982 If not known, this field is not present.
27983
27984 @item at
27985 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27986 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27987 by a symbol name.
27988
27989 @item pending
27990 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27991 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27992
27993 @item evaluated-by
27994 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27995 @samp{target}.
27996
27997 @item thread
27998 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27999 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28000
28001 @item task
28002 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28003 field will hold the task identifier.
28004
28005 @item cond
28006 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28007
28008 @item ignore
28009 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28010
28011 @item enable
28012 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28013
28014 @item traceframe-usage
28015 FIXME.
28016
28017 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28018 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28019
28020 @item mask
28021 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28022
28023 @item pass
28024 A tracepoint's pass count.
28025
28026 @item original-location
28027 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28028 This field is optional.
28029
28030 @item times
28031 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28032
28033 @item installed
28034 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28035 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28036 is not.
28037
28038 @item what
28039 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28040
28041 @end table
28042
28043 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28044 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28045
28046 @smallexample
28047 -> -break-insert main
28048 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28049 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28050 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28051 times="0"@}
28052 <- (gdb)
28053 @end smallexample
28054
28055 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28056 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28057
28058 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28059 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28060 fields:
28061
28062 @table @code
28063 @item level
28064 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28065 zero. This field is always present.
28066
28067 @item func
28068 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28069 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28070
28071 @item addr
28072 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28073
28074 @item file
28075 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28076 address. This field may be absent.
28077
28078 @item line
28079 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28080 may be absent.
28081
28082 @item from
28083 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28084 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28085
28086 @end table
28087
28088 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28089 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28090
28091 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28092 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28093 stated otherwise.
28094
28095 @table @code
28096 @item id
28097 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28098
28099 @item target-id
28100 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28101
28102 @item details
28103 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28104 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28105 frontend. This field is optional.
28106
28107 @item name
28108 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28109 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28110 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28111 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28112 field is omitted.
28113
28114 @item state
28115 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28116 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28117
28118 @item frame
28119 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28120 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28121 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28122
28123 @item core
28124 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28125 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28126 @end table
28127
28128 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28129 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28130
28131 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28132 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28133 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28134 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28135 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28136 the @code{exception-message} field.
28137
28138 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28139 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28140 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28141 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28142
28143 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28144 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28145 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28146 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28147
28148 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28149 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28150
28151 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28152
28153 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28154 information of the breakpoint.
28155
28156 @smallexample
28157 -> -break-insert main
28158 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28159 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28160 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28161 times="0"@}
28162 <- (gdb)
28163 @end smallexample
28164
28165 @subheading Program Execution
28166
28167 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28168 reason that execution stopped.
28169
28170 @smallexample
28171 -> -exec-run
28172 <- ^running
28173 <- (gdb)
28174 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28175 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28176 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28177 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28178 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28179 <- (gdb)
28180 -> -exec-continue
28181 <- ^running
28182 <- (gdb)
28183 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28184 <- (gdb)
28185 @end smallexample
28186
28187 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28188
28189 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28190
28191 @smallexample
28192 -> (gdb)
28193 <- -gdb-exit
28194 <- ^exit
28195 @end smallexample
28196
28197 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28198 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28199 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28200 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28201 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28202 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28203
28204 @subheading A Bad Command
28205
28206 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28207
28208 @smallexample
28209 -> -rubbish
28210 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28211 <- (gdb)
28212 @end smallexample
28213
28214
28215 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28216 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28217 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28218
28219 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28220 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28221
28222 @subheading Motivation
28223
28224 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28225
28226 @subheading Introduction
28227
28228 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28229
28230 @subheading Commands
28231
28232 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28233
28234 @subsubheading Synopsis
28235
28236 @smallexample
28237 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28238 @end smallexample
28239
28240 @subsubheading Result
28241
28242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28243
28244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28245
28246 @subsubheading Example
28247
28248 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28249 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28250
28251
28252 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28253 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28254 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28255
28256 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28257 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28258 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28259 breakpoints.
28260
28261 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28262 @findex -break-after
28263
28264 @subsubheading Synopsis
28265
28266 @smallexample
28267 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28268 @end smallexample
28269
28270 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28271 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28272 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28273 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28274
28275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28276
28277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28278
28279 @subsubheading Example
28280
28281 @smallexample
28282 (gdb)
28283 -break-insert main
28284 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28285 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28286 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28287 times="0"@}
28288 (gdb)
28289 -break-after 1 3
28290 ~
28291 ^done
28292 (gdb)
28293 -break-list
28294 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28295 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28296 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28297 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28298 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28299 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28300 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28301 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28302 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28303 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28304 (gdb)
28305 @end smallexample
28306
28307 @ignore
28308 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28309 @findex -break-catch
28310 @end ignore
28311
28312 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28313 @findex -break-commands
28314
28315 @subsubheading Synopsis
28316
28317 @smallexample
28318 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28319 @end smallexample
28320
28321 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28322 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28323 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28324 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28325 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28326 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28327
28328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28329
28330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28331
28332 @subsubheading Example
28333
28334 @smallexample
28335 (gdb)
28336 -break-insert main
28337 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28338 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28339 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28340 times="0"@}
28341 (gdb)
28342 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28343 ^done
28344 (gdb)
28345 @end smallexample
28346
28347 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28348 @findex -break-condition
28349
28350 @subsubheading Synopsis
28351
28352 @smallexample
28353 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28354 @end smallexample
28355
28356 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28357 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28358 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28359 command below).
28360
28361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28362
28363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28364
28365 @subsubheading Example
28366
28367 @smallexample
28368 (gdb)
28369 -break-condition 1 1
28370 ^done
28371 (gdb)
28372 -break-list
28373 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28374 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28375 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28376 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28377 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28378 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28379 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28380 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28381 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28382 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28383 (gdb)
28384 @end smallexample
28385
28386 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28387 @findex -break-delete
28388
28389 @subsubheading Synopsis
28390
28391 @smallexample
28392 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28393 @end smallexample
28394
28395 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28396 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28397
28398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28399
28400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28401
28402 @subsubheading Example
28403
28404 @smallexample
28405 (gdb)
28406 -break-delete 1
28407 ^done
28408 (gdb)
28409 -break-list
28410 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28411 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28412 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28413 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28414 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28415 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28416 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28417 body=[]@}
28418 (gdb)
28419 @end smallexample
28420
28421 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28422 @findex -break-disable
28423
28424 @subsubheading Synopsis
28425
28426 @smallexample
28427 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28428 @end smallexample
28429
28430 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28431 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28432
28433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28434
28435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28436
28437 @subsubheading Example
28438
28439 @smallexample
28440 (gdb)
28441 -break-disable 2
28442 ^done
28443 (gdb)
28444 -break-list
28445 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28446 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28447 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28448 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28449 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28450 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28451 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28452 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28453 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28454 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28455 (gdb)
28456 @end smallexample
28457
28458 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28459 @findex -break-enable
28460
28461 @subsubheading Synopsis
28462
28463 @smallexample
28464 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28465 @end smallexample
28466
28467 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28468
28469 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28470
28471 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28472
28473 @subsubheading Example
28474
28475 @smallexample
28476 (gdb)
28477 -break-enable 2
28478 ^done
28479 (gdb)
28480 -break-list
28481 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28482 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28483 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28484 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28485 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28486 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28487 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28488 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28489 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28490 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28491 (gdb)
28492 @end smallexample
28493
28494 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28495 @findex -break-info
28496
28497 @subsubheading Synopsis
28498
28499 @smallexample
28500 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28501 @end smallexample
28502
28503 @c REDUNDANT???
28504 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28505
28506 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28507 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28508 table.
28509
28510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28511
28512 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28513
28514 @subsubheading Example
28515 N.A.
28516
28517 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28518 @findex -break-insert
28519 @anchor{-break-insert}
28520
28521 @subsubheading Synopsis
28522
28523 @smallexample
28524 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28525 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28526 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28527 @end smallexample
28528
28529 @noindent
28530 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28531
28532 @table @var
28533 @item linespec location
28534 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28535
28536 @item explicit location
28537 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28538 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28539 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28540
28541 @table @samp
28542 @item --source @var{filename}
28543 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28544 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28545
28546 @item --function @var{function}
28547 The name of a function or method.
28548
28549 @item --label @var{label}
28550 The name of a label.
28551
28552 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28553 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28554 @end table
28555
28556 @item address location
28557 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28558 @end table
28559
28560 @noindent
28561 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28562
28563 @table @samp
28564 @item -t
28565 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28566 @item -h
28567 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28568 @item -f
28569 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28570 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28571 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28572 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28573 cannot be parsed.
28574 @item -d
28575 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28576 @item -a
28577 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28578 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28579 @item -c @var{condition}
28580 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28581 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28582 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28583 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28584 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28585 @var{thread-id}.
28586 @end table
28587
28588 @subsubheading Result
28589
28590 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28591 resulting breakpoint.
28592
28593 Note: this format is open to change.
28594 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28595
28596 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28597
28598 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28599 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28600
28601 @subsubheading Example
28602
28603 @smallexample
28604 (gdb)
28605 -break-insert main
28606 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28607 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28608 times="0"@}
28609 (gdb)
28610 -break-insert -t foo
28611 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28612 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28613 times="0"@}
28614 (gdb)
28615 -break-list
28616 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28617 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28618 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28619 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28620 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28621 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28622 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28623 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28624 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28625 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28626 times="0"@},
28627 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28628 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28629 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28630 times="0"@}]@}
28631 (gdb)
28632 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28633 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28634 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28635 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28636 @c times="0"@}
28637 @c (gdb)
28638 @end smallexample
28639
28640 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28641 @findex -dprintf-insert
28642
28643 @subsubheading Synopsis
28644
28645 @smallexample
28646 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28647 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28648 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28649 [ @var{argument} ]
28650 @end smallexample
28651
28652 @noindent
28653 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28654 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28655
28656 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28657
28658 @table @samp
28659 @item -t
28660 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28661 @item -f
28662 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28663 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28664 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28665 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28666 cannot be parsed.
28667 @item -d
28668 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28669 @item -c @var{condition}
28670 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28671 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28672 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28673 to @var{ignore-count}.
28674 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28675 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28676 @var{thread-id}.
28677 @end table
28678
28679 @subsubheading Result
28680
28681 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28682 resulting breakpoint.
28683
28684 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28685
28686 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28687
28688 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28689
28690 @subsubheading Example
28691
28692 @smallexample
28693 (gdb)
28694 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28695 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28696 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28697 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28698 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28699 original-location="foo"@}
28700 (gdb)
28701 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28702 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28703 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28704 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28705 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28706 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28707 (gdb)
28708 @end smallexample
28709
28710 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28711 @findex -break-list
28712
28713 @subsubheading Synopsis
28714
28715 @smallexample
28716 -break-list
28717 @end smallexample
28718
28719 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28720
28721 @table @samp
28722 @item Number
28723 number of the breakpoint
28724 @item Type
28725 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28726 @item Disposition
28727 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28728 or @samp{nokeep}
28729 @item Enabled
28730 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28731 @item Address
28732 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28733 @item What
28734 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28735 name, line number
28736 @item Thread-groups
28737 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28738 @item Times
28739 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28740 @end table
28741
28742 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28743 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28744
28745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28746
28747 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28748
28749 @subsubheading Example
28750
28751 @smallexample
28752 (gdb)
28753 -break-list
28754 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28755 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28756 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28757 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28758 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28759 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28760 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28761 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28762 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28763 times="0"@},
28764 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28765 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28766 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28767 (gdb)
28768 @end smallexample
28769
28770 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28771
28772 @smallexample
28773 (gdb)
28774 -break-list
28775 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28776 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28777 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28778 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28779 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28780 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28781 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28782 body=[]@}
28783 (gdb)
28784 @end smallexample
28785
28786 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28787 @findex -break-passcount
28788
28789 @subsubheading Synopsis
28790
28791 @smallexample
28792 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28793 @end smallexample
28794
28795 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28796 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28797 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28798 command @samp{passcount}.
28799
28800 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28801 @findex -break-watch
28802
28803 @subsubheading Synopsis
28804
28805 @smallexample
28806 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28807 @end smallexample
28808
28809 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28810 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28811 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28812 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28813 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28814 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28815 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28816 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28817
28818 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28819 breakpoints inserted.
28820
28821 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28822
28823 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28824 @samp{rwatch}.
28825
28826 @subsubheading Example
28827
28828 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28829
28830 @smallexample
28831 (gdb)
28832 -break-watch x
28833 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28834 (gdb)
28835 -exec-continue
28836 ^running
28837 (gdb)
28838 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28839 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28840 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28841 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28842 (gdb)
28843 @end smallexample
28844
28845 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28846 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28847 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28848
28849 @smallexample
28850 (gdb)
28851 -break-watch C
28852 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28853 (gdb)
28854 -exec-continue
28855 ^running
28856 (gdb)
28857 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28858 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28859 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28860 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28861 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28862 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28863 (gdb)
28864 -exec-continue
28865 ^running
28866 (gdb)
28867 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28868 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28869 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28870 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28871 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28872 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28873 (gdb)
28874 @end smallexample
28875
28876 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28877 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28878 deleted.
28879
28880 @smallexample
28881 (gdb)
28882 -break-watch C
28883 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28884 (gdb)
28885 -break-list
28886 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28887 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28888 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28889 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28890 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28891 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28892 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28893 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28894 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28895 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28896 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28897 times="1"@},
28898 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28899 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28900 (gdb)
28901 -exec-continue
28902 ^running
28903 (gdb)
28904 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28905 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28906 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28907 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28908 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28909 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28910 (gdb)
28911 -break-list
28912 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28913 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28914 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28915 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28916 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28917 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28918 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28919 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28920 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28921 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28922 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28923 times="1"@},
28924 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28925 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28926 (gdb)
28927 -exec-continue
28928 ^running
28929 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28930 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28931 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28932 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28933 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28934 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28935 (gdb)
28936 -break-list
28937 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28938 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28939 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28940 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28941 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28942 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28943 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28944 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28945 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28946 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28947 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28948 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28949 (gdb)
28950 @end smallexample
28951
28952
28953 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28954 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28955 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28956
28957 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28958 catchpoints.
28959
28960 @menu
28961 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28962 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28963 @end menu
28964
28965 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28966 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28967
28968 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28969 @findex -catch-load
28970
28971 @subsubheading Synopsis
28972
28973 @smallexample
28974 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28975 @end smallexample
28976
28977 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28978 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28979 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28980 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28981 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28982
28983
28984 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28985
28986 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28987
28988 @subsubheading Example
28989
28990 @smallexample
28991 -catch-load -t foo.so
28992 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28993 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28994 (gdb)
28995 @end smallexample
28996
28997
28998 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28999 @findex -catch-unload
29000
29001 @subsubheading Synopsis
29002
29003 @smallexample
29004 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29005 @end smallexample
29006
29007 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29008 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29009 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29010 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29011 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29012
29013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29014
29015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29016
29017 @subsubheading Example
29018
29019 @smallexample
29020 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29021 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29022 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29023 (gdb)
29024 @end smallexample
29025
29026 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29027 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29028
29029 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29030 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29031
29032 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29033 @findex -catch-assert
29034
29035 @subsubheading Synopsis
29036
29037 @smallexample
29038 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29039 @end smallexample
29040
29041 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29042
29043 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29044
29045 @table @samp
29046 @item -c @var{condition}
29047 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29048 @item -d
29049 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29050 @item -t
29051 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29052 @end table
29053
29054 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29055
29056 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29057
29058 @subsubheading Example
29059
29060 @smallexample
29061 -catch-assert
29062 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29063 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29064 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29065 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29066 (gdb)
29067 @end smallexample
29068
29069 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29070 @findex -catch-exception
29071
29072 @subsubheading Synopsis
29073
29074 @smallexample
29075 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29076 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29077 @end smallexample
29078
29079 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29080 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29081 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29082 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29083 catchpoints.
29084
29085 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29086
29087 @table @samp
29088 @item -c @var{condition}
29089 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29090 @item -d
29091 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29092 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29093 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29094 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29095 @item -t
29096 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29097 @item -u
29098 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29099 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29100 @end table
29101
29102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29103
29104 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29105 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29106
29107 @subsubheading Example
29108
29109 @smallexample
29110 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29111 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29112 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29113 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29114 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29115 (gdb)
29116 @end smallexample
29117
29118 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29119 @findex -catch-handlers
29120
29121 @subsubheading Synopsis
29122
29123 @smallexample
29124 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29125 [ -t ]
29126 @end smallexample
29127
29128 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29129 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29130 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29131 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29132 catchpoints.
29133
29134 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29135
29136 @table @samp
29137 @item -c @var{condition}
29138 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29139 @item -d
29140 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29141 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29142 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29143 @item -t
29144 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29145 @end table
29146
29147 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29148
29149 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29150
29151 @subsubheading Example
29152
29153 @smallexample
29154 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29155 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29156 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29157 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29158 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29159 (gdb)
29160 @end smallexample
29161
29162 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29163 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29164 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29165
29166 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29167 @findex -exec-arguments
29168
29169
29170 @subsubheading Synopsis
29171
29172 @smallexample
29173 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29174 @end smallexample
29175
29176 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29177 @samp{-exec-run}.
29178
29179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29180
29181 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29182
29183 @subsubheading Example
29184
29185 @smallexample
29186 (gdb)
29187 -exec-arguments -v word
29188 ^done
29189 (gdb)
29190 @end smallexample
29191
29192
29193 @ignore
29194 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29195 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29196
29197 @subsubheading Synopsis
29198
29199 @smallexample
29200 -exec-show-arguments
29201 @end smallexample
29202
29203 Print the arguments of the program.
29204
29205 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29206
29207 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29208
29209 @subsubheading Example
29210 N.A.
29211 @end ignore
29212
29213
29214 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29215 @findex -environment-cd
29216
29217 @subsubheading Synopsis
29218
29219 @smallexample
29220 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29221 @end smallexample
29222
29223 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29224
29225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29226
29227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29228
29229 @subsubheading Example
29230
29231 @smallexample
29232 (gdb)
29233 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29234 ^done
29235 (gdb)
29236 @end smallexample
29237
29238
29239 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29240 @findex -environment-directory
29241
29242 @subsubheading Synopsis
29243
29244 @smallexample
29245 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29246 @end smallexample
29247
29248 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29249 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29250 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29251 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29252 occurs as normal.
29253 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29254 multiple directories in a single command
29255 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29256 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29257 If blanks are needed as
29258 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29259 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29260 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29261 character must not be used
29262 in any directory name.
29263 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29264
29265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29266
29267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29268
29269 @subsubheading Example
29270
29271 @smallexample
29272 (gdb)
29273 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29274 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29275 (gdb)
29276 -environment-directory ""
29277 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29278 (gdb)
29279 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29280 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29281 (gdb)
29282 -environment-directory -r
29283 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29284 (gdb)
29285 @end smallexample
29286
29287
29288 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29289 @findex -environment-path
29290
29291 @subsubheading Synopsis
29292
29293 @smallexample
29294 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29295 @end smallexample
29296
29297 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29298 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29299 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29300 supplied in addition to the
29301 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29302 occurs as normal.
29303 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29304 multiple directories in a single command
29305 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29306 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29307 If blanks are needed as
29308 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29309 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29310 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29311 character must not be used
29312 in any directory name.
29313 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29314
29315
29316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29317
29318 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29319
29320 @subsubheading Example
29321
29322 @smallexample
29323 (gdb)
29324 -environment-path
29325 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29326 (gdb)
29327 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29328 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29329 (gdb)
29330 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29331 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29332 (gdb)
29333 @end smallexample
29334
29335
29336 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29337 @findex -environment-pwd
29338
29339 @subsubheading Synopsis
29340
29341 @smallexample
29342 -environment-pwd
29343 @end smallexample
29344
29345 Show the current working directory.
29346
29347 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29348
29349 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29350
29351 @subsubheading Example
29352
29353 @smallexample
29354 (gdb)
29355 -environment-pwd
29356 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29357 (gdb)
29358 @end smallexample
29359
29360 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29361 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29362 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29363
29364
29365 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29366 @findex -thread-info
29367
29368 @subsubheading Synopsis
29369
29370 @smallexample
29371 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29372 @end smallexample
29373
29374 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29375 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29376 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29377 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29378 current thread.
29379
29380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29381
29382 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29383 about all threads.
29384
29385 @subsubheading Result
29386
29387 The result contains the following attributes:
29388
29389 @table @samp
29390 @item threads
29391 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29392 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29393
29394 @item current-thread-id
29395 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29396 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29397 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29398 the command.
29399
29400 @end table
29401
29402 @subsubheading Example
29403
29404 @smallexample
29405 -thread-info
29406 ^done,threads=[
29407 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29408 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29409 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29410 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29411 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29412 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29413 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29414 state="running"@}],
29415 current-thread-id="1"
29416 (gdb)
29417 @end smallexample
29418
29419 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29420 @findex -thread-list-ids
29421
29422 @subsubheading Synopsis
29423
29424 @smallexample
29425 -thread-list-ids
29426 @end smallexample
29427
29428 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29429 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29430 threads.
29431
29432 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29433 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29434
29435 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29436
29437 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29438
29439 @subsubheading Example
29440
29441 @smallexample
29442 (gdb)
29443 -thread-list-ids
29444 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29445 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29446 (gdb)
29447 @end smallexample
29448
29449
29450 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29451 @findex -thread-select
29452
29453 @subsubheading Synopsis
29454
29455 @smallexample
29456 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29457 @end smallexample
29458
29459 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29460 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29461 topmost frame for that thread.
29462
29463 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29464 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29465
29466 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29467
29468 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29469
29470 @subsubheading Example
29471
29472 @smallexample
29473 (gdb)
29474 -exec-next
29475 ^running
29476 (gdb)
29477 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29478 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29479 (gdb)
29480 -thread-list-ids
29481 ^done,
29482 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29483 number-of-threads="3"
29484 (gdb)
29485 -thread-select 3
29486 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29487 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29488 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29489 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29490 (gdb)
29491 @end smallexample
29492
29493 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29494 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29495 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29496
29497 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29498 @findex -ada-task-info
29499
29500 @subsubheading Synopsis
29501
29502 @smallexample
29503 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29504 @end smallexample
29505
29506 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29507 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29508
29509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29510
29511 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29512 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29513
29514 @subsubheading Result
29515
29516 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29517 defined for each Ada task:
29518
29519 @table @samp
29520 @item current
29521 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29522
29523 @item id
29524 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29525
29526 @item task-id
29527 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29528
29529 @item thread-id
29530 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29531 task.
29532
29533 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29534 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29535 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29536
29537 @item parent-id
29538 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29539 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29540
29541 @item priority
29542 The base priority of the task.
29543
29544 @item state
29545 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29546 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29547
29548 @item name
29549 The name of the task.
29550
29551 @end table
29552
29553 @subsubheading Example
29554
29555 @smallexample
29556 -ada-task-info
29557 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29558 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29559 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29560 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29561 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29562 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29563 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29564 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29565 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29566 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29567 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29568 (gdb)
29569 @end smallexample
29570
29571 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29572 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29573 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29574
29575 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29576 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29577 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29578 other cases.
29579
29580 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29581 @findex -exec-continue
29582
29583 @subsubheading Synopsis
29584
29585 @smallexample
29586 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29587 @end smallexample
29588
29589 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29590 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29591 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29592 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29593 @itemize @bullet
29594 @item
29595 breakpoints or watchpoints
29596 @item
29597 signals or exceptions
29598 @item
29599 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29600 @item
29601 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29602 @end itemize
29603 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29604 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29605 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29606 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29607 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29608 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29609
29610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29611
29612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29613
29614 @subsubheading Example
29615
29616 @smallexample
29617 -exec-continue
29618 ^running
29619 (gdb)
29620 @@Hello world
29621 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29622 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29623 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29624 (gdb)
29625 @end smallexample
29626
29627
29628 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29629 @findex -exec-finish
29630
29631 @subsubheading Synopsis
29632
29633 @smallexample
29634 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29635 @end smallexample
29636
29637 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29638 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29639 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29640 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29641 function was called.
29642
29643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29644
29645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29646
29647 @subsubheading Example
29648
29649 Function returning @code{void}.
29650
29651 @smallexample
29652 -exec-finish
29653 ^running
29654 (gdb)
29655 @@hello from foo
29656 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29657 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29658 (gdb)
29659 @end smallexample
29660
29661 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29662 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29663 value itself.
29664
29665 @smallexample
29666 -exec-finish
29667 ^running
29668 (gdb)
29669 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29670 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29671 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29672 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29673 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29674 (gdb)
29675 @end smallexample
29676
29677
29678 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29679 @findex -exec-interrupt
29680
29681 @subsubheading Synopsis
29682
29683 @smallexample
29684 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29685 @end smallexample
29686
29687 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29688 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29689 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29690 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29691 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29692
29693 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29694 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29695 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29696 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29697
29698 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29699 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29700 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29701 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29702
29703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29704
29705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29706
29707 @subsubheading Example
29708
29709 @smallexample
29710 (gdb)
29711 111-exec-continue
29712 111^running
29713
29714 (gdb)
29715 222-exec-interrupt
29716 222^done
29717 (gdb)
29718 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29719 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29720 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29721 (gdb)
29722
29723 (gdb)
29724 -exec-interrupt
29725 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29726 (gdb)
29727 @end smallexample
29728
29729 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29730 @findex -exec-jump
29731
29732 @subsubheading Synopsis
29733
29734 @smallexample
29735 -exec-jump @var{location}
29736 @end smallexample
29737
29738 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29739 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29740 different forms of @var{location}.
29741
29742 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29743
29744 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29745
29746 @subsubheading Example
29747
29748 @smallexample
29749 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29750 *running,thread-id="all"
29751 ^running
29752 @end smallexample
29753
29754
29755 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29756 @findex -exec-next
29757
29758 @subsubheading Synopsis
29759
29760 @smallexample
29761 -exec-next [--reverse]
29762 @end smallexample
29763
29764 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29765 of the next source line is reached.
29766
29767 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29768 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29769 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29770 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29771 source line where the function was called.
29772
29773
29774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29775
29776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29777
29778 @subsubheading Example
29779
29780 @smallexample
29781 -exec-next
29782 ^running
29783 (gdb)
29784 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29785 (gdb)
29786 @end smallexample
29787
29788
29789 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29790 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29791
29792 @subsubheading Synopsis
29793
29794 @smallexample
29795 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29796 @end smallexample
29797
29798 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29799 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29800 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29801 printed as well.
29802
29803 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29804 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29805 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29806 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29807 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29808
29809 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29810
29811 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29812
29813 @subsubheading Example
29814
29815 @smallexample
29816 (gdb)
29817 -exec-next-instruction
29818 ^running
29819
29820 (gdb)
29821 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29822 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29823 (gdb)
29824 @end smallexample
29825
29826
29827 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29828 @findex -exec-return
29829
29830 @subsubheading Synopsis
29831
29832 @smallexample
29833 -exec-return
29834 @end smallexample
29835
29836 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29837 Displays the new current frame.
29838
29839 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29840
29841 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29842
29843 @subsubheading Example
29844
29845 @smallexample
29846 (gdb)
29847 200-break-insert callee4
29848 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29849 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29850 (gdb)
29851 000-exec-run
29852 000^running
29853 (gdb)
29854 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29855 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29856 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29857 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29858 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29859 (gdb)
29860 205-break-delete
29861 205^done
29862 (gdb)
29863 111-exec-return
29864 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29865 args=[@{name="strarg",
29866 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29867 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29868 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29869 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29870 (gdb)
29871 @end smallexample
29872
29873
29874 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29875 @findex -exec-run
29876
29877 @subsubheading Synopsis
29878
29879 @smallexample
29880 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29881 @end smallexample
29882
29883 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29884 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29885 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29886 the program has exited exceptionally.
29887
29888 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29889 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29890 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29891 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29892 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29893
29894 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29895 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29896 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29897 (@pxref{Starting}).
29898
29899 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29900
29901 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29902
29903 @subsubheading Examples
29904
29905 @smallexample
29906 (gdb)
29907 -break-insert main
29908 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29909 (gdb)
29910 -exec-run
29911 ^running
29912 (gdb)
29913 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29914 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29915 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29916 (gdb)
29917 @end smallexample
29918
29919 @noindent
29920 Program exited normally:
29921
29922 @smallexample
29923 (gdb)
29924 -exec-run
29925 ^running
29926 (gdb)
29927 x = 55
29928 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29929 (gdb)
29930 @end smallexample
29931
29932 @noindent
29933 Program exited exceptionally:
29934
29935 @smallexample
29936 (gdb)
29937 -exec-run
29938 ^running
29939 (gdb)
29940 x = 55
29941 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29942 (gdb)
29943 @end smallexample
29944
29945 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29946 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29947
29948 @smallexample
29949 (gdb)
29950 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29951 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29952 @end smallexample
29953
29954
29955 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29956
29957
29958 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29959 @findex -exec-step
29960
29961 @subsubheading Synopsis
29962
29963 @smallexample
29964 -exec-step [--reverse]
29965 @end smallexample
29966
29967 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29968 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29969 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29970 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29971 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29972 previously executed source line.
29973
29974 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29975
29976 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29977
29978 @subsubheading Example
29979
29980 Stepping into a function:
29981
29982 @smallexample
29983 -exec-step
29984 ^running
29985 (gdb)
29986 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29987 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29988 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29989 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29990 (gdb)
29991 @end smallexample
29992
29993 Regular stepping:
29994
29995 @smallexample
29996 -exec-step
29997 ^running
29998 (gdb)
29999 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30000 (gdb)
30001 @end smallexample
30002
30003
30004 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30005 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30006
30007 @subsubheading Synopsis
30008
30009 @smallexample
30010 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30011 @end smallexample
30012
30013 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30014 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30015 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30016 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30017 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30018 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30019 as well.
30020
30021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30022
30023 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30024
30025 @subsubheading Example
30026
30027 @smallexample
30028 (gdb)
30029 -exec-step-instruction
30030 ^running
30031
30032 (gdb)
30033 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30034 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30035 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30036 (gdb)
30037 -exec-step-instruction
30038 ^running
30039
30040 (gdb)
30041 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30042 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30043 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30044 (gdb)
30045 @end smallexample
30046
30047
30048 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30049 @findex -exec-until
30050
30051 @subsubheading Synopsis
30052
30053 @smallexample
30054 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30055 @end smallexample
30056
30057 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30058 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30059 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30060 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30061
30062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30063
30064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30065
30066 @subsubheading Example
30067
30068 @smallexample
30069 (gdb)
30070 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30071 ^running
30072 (gdb)
30073 x = 55
30074 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30075 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30076 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30077 (gdb)
30078 @end smallexample
30079
30080 @ignore
30081 @subheading -file-clear
30082 Is this going away????
30083 @end ignore
30084
30085 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30086 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30087 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30088
30089 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30090 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30091
30092 @smallexample
30093 -enable-frame-filters
30094 @end smallexample
30095
30096 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30097 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30098 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30099 request that this functionality be enabled.
30100
30101 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30102
30103 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30104 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30105
30106 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30107 @findex -stack-info-frame
30108
30109 @subsubheading Synopsis
30110
30111 @smallexample
30112 -stack-info-frame
30113 @end smallexample
30114
30115 Get info on the selected frame.
30116
30117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30118
30119 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30120 (without arguments).
30121
30122 @subsubheading Example
30123
30124 @smallexample
30125 (gdb)
30126 -stack-info-frame
30127 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30128 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30129 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30130 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30131 (gdb)
30132 @end smallexample
30133
30134 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30135 @findex -stack-info-depth
30136
30137 @subsubheading Synopsis
30138
30139 @smallexample
30140 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30141 @end smallexample
30142
30143 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30144 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30145
30146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30147
30148 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30149
30150 @subsubheading Example
30151
30152 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30153
30154 @smallexample
30155 (gdb)
30156 -stack-info-depth
30157 ^done,depth="12"
30158 (gdb)
30159 -stack-info-depth 4
30160 ^done,depth="4"
30161 (gdb)
30162 -stack-info-depth 12
30163 ^done,depth="12"
30164 (gdb)
30165 -stack-info-depth 11
30166 ^done,depth="11"
30167 (gdb)
30168 -stack-info-depth 13
30169 ^done,depth="12"
30170 (gdb)
30171 @end smallexample
30172
30173 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30174 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30175 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30176
30177 @subsubheading Synopsis
30178
30179 @smallexample
30180 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30181 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30182 @end smallexample
30183
30184 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30185 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30186 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30187 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30188 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30189 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30190 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30191 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30192
30193 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30194 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30195 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30196 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30197 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30198 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30199
30200 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30201 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30202 are still displayed, however.
30203
30204 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30205 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30206
30207 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30208
30209 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30210 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30211 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30212
30213 @subsubheading Example
30214
30215 @smallexample
30216 (gdb)
30217 -stack-list-frames
30218 ^done,
30219 stack=[
30220 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30221 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30222 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30223 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30224 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30225 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30226 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30227 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30228 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30229 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30230 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30231 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30232 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30233 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30234 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30235 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30236 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30237 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30238 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30239 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30240 (gdb)
30241 -stack-list-arguments 0
30242 ^done,
30243 stack-args=[
30244 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30245 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30246 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30247 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30248 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30249 (gdb)
30250 -stack-list-arguments 1
30251 ^done,
30252 stack-args=[
30253 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30254 frame=@{level="1",
30255 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30256 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30257 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30258 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30259 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30260 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30261 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30262 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30263 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30264 (gdb)
30265 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30266 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30267 (gdb)
30268 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30269 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30270 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30271 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30272 (gdb)
30273 @end smallexample
30274
30275 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30276
30277
30278 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30279 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30280 @findex -stack-list-frames
30281
30282 @subsubheading Synopsis
30283
30284 @smallexample
30285 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30286 @end smallexample
30287
30288 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30289 following info:
30290
30291 @table @samp
30292 @item @var{level}
30293 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30294 @item @var{addr}
30295 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30296 @item @var{func}
30297 Function name.
30298 @item @var{file}
30299 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30300 @item @var{fullname}
30301 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30302 @item @var{line}
30303 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30304 @item @var{from}
30305 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30306 if the frame's function is not known.
30307 @item @var{arch}
30308 Frame's architecture.
30309 @end table
30310
30311 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30312 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30313 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30314 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30315 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30316 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30317 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30318 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30319 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30320
30321 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30322
30323 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30324
30325 @subsubheading Example
30326
30327 Full stack backtrace:
30328
30329 @smallexample
30330 (gdb)
30331 -stack-list-frames
30332 ^done,stack=
30333 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30334 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30335 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30336 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30337 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30338 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30339 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30340 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30341 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30342 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30343 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30344 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30345 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30346 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30347 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30348 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30349 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30350 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30351 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30352 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30353 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30354 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30355 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30356 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30357 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30358 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30359 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30360 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30361 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30362 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30363 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30364 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30365 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30366 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30367 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30368 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30369 (gdb)
30370 @end smallexample
30371
30372 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30373
30374 @smallexample
30375 (gdb)
30376 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30377 ^done,stack=
30378 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30379 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30380 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30381 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30382 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30383 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30384 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30385 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30386 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30387 (gdb)
30388 @end smallexample
30389
30390 Show a single frame:
30391
30392 @smallexample
30393 (gdb)
30394 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30395 ^done,stack=
30396 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30397 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30398 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30399 (gdb)
30400 @end smallexample
30401
30402
30403 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30404 @findex -stack-list-locals
30405 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30406
30407 @subsubheading Synopsis
30408
30409 @smallexample
30410 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30411 @end smallexample
30412
30413 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30414 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30415 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30416 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30417 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30418 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30419 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30420 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30421 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30422 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30423
30424 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30425 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30426 variables are still displayed, however.
30427
30428 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30429 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30430
30431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30432
30433 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30434
30435 @subsubheading Example
30436
30437 @smallexample
30438 (gdb)
30439 -stack-list-locals 0
30440 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30441 (gdb)
30442 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30443 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30444 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30445 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30446 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30447 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30448 (gdb)
30449 @end smallexample
30450
30451 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30452 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30453 @findex -stack-list-variables
30454
30455 @subsubheading Synopsis
30456
30457 @smallexample
30458 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30459 @end smallexample
30460
30461 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30462 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30463 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30464 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30465 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30466 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30467 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30468
30469 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30470 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30471 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30472
30473 @subsubheading Example
30474
30475 @smallexample
30476 (gdb)
30477 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30478 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30479 (gdb)
30480 @end smallexample
30481
30482
30483 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30484 @findex -stack-select-frame
30485
30486 @subsubheading Synopsis
30487
30488 @smallexample
30489 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30490 @end smallexample
30491
30492 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30493 the stack.
30494
30495 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30496 option to every command.
30497
30498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30499
30500 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30501 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30502
30503 @subsubheading Example
30504
30505 @smallexample
30506 (gdb)
30507 -stack-select-frame 2
30508 ^done
30509 (gdb)
30510 @end smallexample
30511
30512 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30513 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30514 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30515
30516 @ignore
30517
30518 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30519
30520 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30521 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30522 used by @code{Insight}.
30523
30524 The two main reasons for that are:
30525
30526 @enumerate 1
30527 @item
30528 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30529
30530 @item
30531 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30532 now).
30533 @end enumerate
30534
30535 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30536 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30537 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30538 hints about their use.
30539
30540 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30541 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30542 least, the following operations:
30543
30544 @itemize @bullet
30545 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30546 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30547 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30548 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30549 @end itemize
30550
30551 @end ignore
30552
30553 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30554
30555 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30556
30557 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30558 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30559 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30560 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30561 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30562 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30563 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30564 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30565 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30566 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30567 object, or to change display format.
30568
30569 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30570 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30571 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30572 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30573 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30574 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30575 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30576 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30577 child will be created.
30578
30579 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30580 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30581 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30582 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30583 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30584
30585 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30586 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30587 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30588 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30589 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30590 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30591 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30592 variables that frontend has created.
30593
30594 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30595 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30596 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30597 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30598 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30599 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30600 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30601 implicitly updated.
30602
30603 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30604 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30605 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30606 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30607 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30608 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30609 frame. Consider this example:
30610
30611 @smallexample
30612 void do_work(...)
30613 @{
30614 struct work_state state;
30615
30616 if (...)
30617 do_work(...);
30618 @}
30619 @end smallexample
30620
30621 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30622 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30623 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30624 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30625 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30626
30627 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30628 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30629 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30630 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30631 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30632 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30633
30634 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30635 access this functionality:
30636
30637 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30638 @item @strong{Operation}
30639 @tab @strong{Description}
30640
30641 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30642 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30643 @item @code{-var-create}
30644 @tab create a variable object
30645 @item @code{-var-delete}
30646 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30647 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30648 @tab set the display format of this variable
30649 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30650 @tab show the display format of this variable
30651 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30652 @tab tells how many children this object has
30653 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30654 @tab return a list of the object's children
30655 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30656 @tab show the type of this variable object
30657 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30658 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30659 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30660 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30661 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30662 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30663 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30664 @tab get the value of this variable
30665 @item @code{-var-assign}
30666 @tab set the value of this variable
30667 @item @code{-var-update}
30668 @tab update the variable and its children
30669 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30670 @tab set frozeness attribute
30671 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30672 @tab set range of children to display on update
30673 @end multitable
30674
30675 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30676 how it can be used.
30677
30678 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30679
30680 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30681 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30682
30683 @smallexample
30684 -enable-pretty-printing
30685 @end smallexample
30686
30687 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30688 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30689 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30690 request that this functionality be enabled.
30691
30692 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30693
30694 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30695 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30696
30697 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30698 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30699
30700 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30701 @findex -var-create
30702
30703 @subsubheading Synopsis
30704
30705 @smallexample
30706 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30707 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30708 @end smallexample
30709
30710 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30711 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30712 register.
30713
30714 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30715 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30716 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30717 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30718 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30719
30720 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30721 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30722 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30723 object must be created.
30724
30725 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30726 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30727
30728 @itemize @bullet
30729 @item
30730 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30731
30732 @item
30733 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30734
30735 @item
30736 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30737 @end itemize
30738
30739 @cindex dynamic varobj
30740 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30741 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30742 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30743 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30744 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30745 compatibility for existing clients.
30746
30747 @subsubheading Result
30748
30749 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30750 are:
30751
30752 @table @samp
30753 @item name
30754 The name of the varobj.
30755
30756 @item numchild
30757 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30758 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30759 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30760
30761 @item value
30762 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30763 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30764 will not be interesting.
30765
30766 @item type
30767 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30768 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30769 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30770 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30771 @emph{declared} one.
30772
30773 @item thread-id
30774 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30775 thread's global identifier.
30776
30777 @item has_more
30778 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30779 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30780
30781 @item dynamic
30782 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30783 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30784 then this attribute will not be present.
30785
30786 @item displayhint
30787 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30788 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30789 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30790 @end table
30791
30792 Typical output will look like this:
30793
30794 @smallexample
30795 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30796 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30797 @end smallexample
30798
30799
30800 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30801 @findex -var-delete
30802
30803 @subsubheading Synopsis
30804
30805 @smallexample
30806 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30807 @end smallexample
30808
30809 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30810 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30811
30812 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30813
30814
30815 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30816 @findex -var-set-format
30817
30818 @subsubheading Synopsis
30819
30820 @smallexample
30821 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30822 @end smallexample
30823
30824 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30825 @var{format-spec}.
30826
30827 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30828 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30829
30830 @smallexample
30831 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30832 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30833 @end smallexample
30834
30835 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30836 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30837 for pointers, etc.).
30838
30839 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30840 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30841 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30842 zero-hexadecimal format.
30843
30844 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30845 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30846
30847 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30848 @findex -var-show-format
30849
30850 @subsubheading Synopsis
30851
30852 @smallexample
30853 -var-show-format @var{name}
30854 @end smallexample
30855
30856 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30857
30858 @smallexample
30859 @var{format} @expansion{}
30860 @var{format-spec}
30861 @end smallexample
30862
30863
30864 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30865 @findex -var-info-num-children
30866
30867 @subsubheading Synopsis
30868
30869 @smallexample
30870 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30871 @end smallexample
30872
30873 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30874
30875 @smallexample
30876 numchild=@var{n}
30877 @end smallexample
30878
30879 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30880 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30881 be available.
30882
30883
30884 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30885 @findex -var-list-children
30886
30887 @subsubheading Synopsis
30888
30889 @smallexample
30890 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30891 @end smallexample
30892 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30893
30894 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30895 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30896 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30897 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30898 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30899 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30900 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30901 and unions.
30902
30903 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30904 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30905 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30906 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30907 reported.
30908
30909 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30910 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30911 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30912 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30913 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30914 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30915 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30916 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30917 the visible items.
30918
30919 For each child the following results are returned:
30920
30921 @table @var
30922
30923 @item name
30924 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30925
30926 @item exp
30927 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30928 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30929
30930 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30931 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30932
30933 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30934 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30935 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30936 type and value are not present.
30937
30938 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30939 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30940 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30941
30942 @item numchild
30943 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30944 0.
30945
30946 @item type
30947 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30948 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30949 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30950 @emph{declared} one.
30951
30952 @item value
30953 If values were requested, this is the value.
30954
30955 @item thread-id
30956 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30957 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30958
30959 @item frozen
30960 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30961
30962 @item displayhint
30963 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30964 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30965 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30966
30967 @item dynamic
30968 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30969 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30970 then this attribute will not be present.
30971
30972 @end table
30973
30974 The result may have its own attributes:
30975
30976 @table @samp
30977 @item displayhint
30978 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30979 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30980 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30981
30982 @item has_more
30983 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30984 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30985 @end table
30986
30987 @subsubheading Example
30988
30989 @smallexample
30990 (gdb)
30991 -var-list-children n
30992 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30993 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30994 (gdb)
30995 -var-list-children --all-values n
30996 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30997 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30998 @end smallexample
30999
31000
31001 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31002 @findex -var-info-type
31003
31004 @subsubheading Synopsis
31005
31006 @smallexample
31007 -var-info-type @var{name}
31008 @end smallexample
31009
31010 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31011 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31012 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31013
31014 @smallexample
31015 type=@var{typename}
31016 @end smallexample
31017
31018
31019 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31020 @findex -var-info-expression
31021
31022 @subsubheading Synopsis
31023
31024 @smallexample
31025 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31026 @end smallexample
31027
31028 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31029 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31030 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31031
31032 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31033 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31034
31035 @smallexample
31036 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31037 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31038 @end smallexample
31039
31040 @noindent
31041 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31042 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31043
31044 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31045 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31046 is of limited use.
31047
31048 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31049 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31050
31051 @subsubheading Synopsis
31052
31053 @smallexample
31054 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31055 @end smallexample
31056
31057 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31058 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31059 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31060 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31061 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31062 watchpoint from a variable object.
31063
31064 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31065 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31066
31067 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31068 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31069 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31070 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31071 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31072 @smallexample
31073 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31074 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31075 @end smallexample
31076
31077 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31078 @findex -var-show-attributes
31079
31080 @subsubheading Synopsis
31081
31082 @smallexample
31083 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31084 @end smallexample
31085
31086 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31087
31088 @smallexample
31089 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31090 @end smallexample
31091
31092 @noindent
31093 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31094
31095 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31096 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31097
31098 @subsubheading Synopsis
31099
31100 @smallexample
31101 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31102 @end smallexample
31103
31104 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31105 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31106 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31107 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31108 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31109 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31110 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31111
31112 @smallexample
31113 value=@var{value}
31114 @end smallexample
31115
31116 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31117 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31118
31119 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31120 @findex -var-assign
31121
31122 @subsubheading Synopsis
31123
31124 @smallexample
31125 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31126 @end smallexample
31127
31128 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31129 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31130 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31131 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31132
31133 @subsubheading Example
31134
31135 @smallexample
31136 (gdb)
31137 -var-assign var1 3
31138 ^done,value="3"
31139 (gdb)
31140 -var-update *
31141 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31142 (gdb)
31143 @end smallexample
31144
31145 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31146 @findex -var-update
31147
31148 @subsubheading Synopsis
31149
31150 @smallexample
31151 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31152 @end smallexample
31153
31154 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31155 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31156 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31157 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31158 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31159 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31160 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31161 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31162 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31163 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31164 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31165 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31166 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31167
31168 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31169 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31170 diagnostic.
31171
31172 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31173 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31174
31175 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31176 @samp{changelist}.
31177
31178 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31179
31180 @table @samp
31181 @item name
31182 The name of the varobj.
31183
31184 @item value
31185 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31186 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31187
31188 @item in_scope
31189 @anchor{-var-update}
31190 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31191
31192 @table @code
31193 @item "true"
31194 The variable object's current value is valid.
31195
31196 @item "false"
31197 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31198 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31199 scope.
31200
31201 @item "invalid"
31202 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31203 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31204 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31205 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31206 objects.
31207 @end table
31208
31209 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31210 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31211
31212 @item type_changed
31213 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31214 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31215 be @samp{false}.
31216
31217 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31218 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31219 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31220 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31221 unset.
31222
31223 @item new_type
31224 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31225 hold the new type.
31226
31227 @item new_num_children
31228 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31229 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31230
31231 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31232 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31233 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31234 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31235 children which may be available.
31236
31237 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31238 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31239 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31240 only happen at the end of the update range).
31241
31242 @item displayhint
31243 The display hint, if any.
31244
31245 @item has_more
31246 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31247 available outside the varobj's update range.
31248
31249 @item dynamic
31250 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31251 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31252 then this attribute will not be present.
31253
31254 @item new_children
31255 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31256 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31257 be listed in this attribute.
31258 @end table
31259
31260 @subsubheading Example
31261
31262 @smallexample
31263 (gdb)
31264 -var-assign var1 3
31265 ^done,value="3"
31266 (gdb)
31267 -var-update --all-values var1
31268 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31269 type_changed="false"@}]
31270 (gdb)
31271 @end smallexample
31272
31273 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31274 @findex -var-set-frozen
31275 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31276
31277 @subsubheading Synopsis
31278
31279 @smallexample
31280 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31281 @end smallexample
31282
31283 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31284 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31285 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31286 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31287 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31288 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31289 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31290 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31291 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31292 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31293 @code{-var-update} does.
31294
31295 @subsubheading Example
31296
31297 @smallexample
31298 (gdb)
31299 -var-set-frozen V 1
31300 ^done
31301 (gdb)
31302 @end smallexample
31303
31304 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31305 @findex -var-set-update-range
31306 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31307
31308 @subsubheading Synopsis
31309
31310 @smallexample
31311 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31312 @end smallexample
31313
31314 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31315 @code{-var-update}.
31316
31317 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31318 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31319 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31320 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31321
31322 @subsubheading Example
31323
31324 @smallexample
31325 (gdb)
31326 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31327 ^done
31328 @end smallexample
31329
31330 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31331 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31332 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31333
31334 @subsubheading Synopsis
31335
31336 @smallexample
31337 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31338 @end smallexample
31339
31340 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31341
31342 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31343 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31344
31345 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31346 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31347 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31348 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31349 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31350 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31351 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31352
31353 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31354 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31355 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31356 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31357
31358 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31359 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31360 can be used to check this.
31361
31362 @subsubheading Example
31363
31364 Resetting the visualizer:
31365
31366 @smallexample
31367 (gdb)
31368 -var-set-visualizer V None
31369 ^done
31370 @end smallexample
31371
31372 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31373
31374 @smallexample
31375 (gdb)
31376 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31377 ^done
31378 @end smallexample
31379
31380 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31381 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31382
31383 @smallexample
31384 (gdb)
31385 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31386 ^done
31387 @end smallexample
31388
31389 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31390 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31391 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31392
31393 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31394 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31395 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31396 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31397
31398 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31399 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31400
31401 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31402 @c @subheading -data-assign
31403 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31404 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31405 @c set variable
31406 @c @subsubheading Example
31407 @c N.A.
31408
31409 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31410 @findex -data-disassemble
31411
31412 @subsubheading Synopsis
31413
31414 @smallexample
31415 -data-disassemble
31416 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31417 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31418 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31419 -- @var{mode}
31420 @end smallexample
31421
31422 @noindent
31423 Where:
31424
31425 @table @samp
31426 @item @var{start-addr}
31427 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31428 @item @var{end-addr}
31429 is the end address
31430 @item @var{addr}
31431 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31432 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31433 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31434 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31435 @item @var{filename}
31436 is the name of the file to disassemble
31437 @item @var{linenum}
31438 is the line number to disassemble around
31439 @item @var{lines}
31440 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31441 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31442 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31443 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31444 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31445 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31446 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31447 are displayed.
31448 @item @var{mode}
31449 is one of:
31450 @itemize @bullet
31451 @item 0 disassembly only
31452 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31453 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31454 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31455 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31456 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31457 @end itemize
31458
31459 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31460 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31461 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31462 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31463 @end table
31464
31465 @subsubheading Result
31466
31467 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31468 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31469 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31470
31471 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31472 following fields:
31473
31474 @table @code
31475 @item address
31476 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31477
31478 @item func-name
31479 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31480
31481 @item offset
31482 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31483
31484 @item inst
31485 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31486
31487 @item opcodes
31488 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31489 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31490
31491 @end table
31492
31493 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31494 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31495
31496 @table @code
31497 @item line
31498 The line number within @samp{file}.
31499
31500 @item file
31501 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31502 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31503 used.
31504
31505 @item fullname
31506 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31507 using the source file search path
31508 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31509 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31510
31511 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31512 present in the debug information.
31513
31514 @item line_asm_insn
31515 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31516 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31517 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31518 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31519 @samp{opcodes}.
31520
31521 @end table
31522
31523 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31524 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31525 adjust its format.
31526
31527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31528
31529 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31530
31531 @subsubheading Example
31532
31533 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31534
31535 @smallexample
31536 (gdb)
31537 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31538 ^done,
31539 asm_insns=[
31540 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31541 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31542 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31543 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31544 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31545 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31546 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31547 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31548 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31549 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31550 (gdb)
31551 @end smallexample
31552
31553 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31554 @code{main}.
31555
31556 @smallexample
31557 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31558 ^done,asm_insns=[
31559 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31560 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31561 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31562 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31563 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31564 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31565 [@dots{}]
31566 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31567 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31568 (gdb)
31569 @end smallexample
31570
31571 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31572
31573 @smallexample
31574 (gdb)
31575 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31576 ^done,asm_insns=[
31577 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31578 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31579 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31580 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31581 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31582 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31583 (gdb)
31584 @end smallexample
31585
31586 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31587
31588 @smallexample
31589 (gdb)
31590 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31591 ^done,asm_insns=[
31592 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31593 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31594 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31595 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31596 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31597 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31598 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31599 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31600 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31601 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31602 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31603 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31604 (gdb)
31605 @end smallexample
31606
31607
31608 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31609 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31610
31611 @subsubheading Synopsis
31612
31613 @smallexample
31614 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31615 @end smallexample
31616
31617 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31618 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31619 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31620
31621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31622
31623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31624 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31625 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31626
31627 @subsubheading Example
31628
31629 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31630 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31631 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31632 output.
31633
31634 @smallexample
31635 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31636 211^done,value="1"
31637 (gdb)
31638 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31639 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31640 (gdb)
31641 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31642 411^done,value="4"
31643 (gdb)
31644 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31645 511^done,value="4"
31646 (gdb)
31647 @end smallexample
31648
31649
31650 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31651 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31652
31653 @subsubheading Synopsis
31654
31655 @smallexample
31656 -data-list-changed-registers
31657 @end smallexample
31658
31659 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31660
31661 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31662
31663 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31664 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31665
31666 @subsubheading Example
31667
31668 On a PPC MBX board:
31669
31670 @smallexample
31671 (gdb)
31672 -exec-continue
31673 ^running
31674
31675 (gdb)
31676 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31677 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31678 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31679 (gdb)
31680 -data-list-changed-registers
31681 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31682 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31683 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31684 (gdb)
31685 @end smallexample
31686
31687
31688 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31689 @findex -data-list-register-names
31690
31691 @subsubheading Synopsis
31692
31693 @smallexample
31694 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31695 @end smallexample
31696
31697 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31698 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31699 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31700 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31701 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31702 include empty register names.
31703
31704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31705
31706 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31707 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31708 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31709
31710 @subsubheading Example
31711
31712 For the PPC MBX board:
31713 @smallexample
31714 (gdb)
31715 -data-list-register-names
31716 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31717 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31718 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31719 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31720 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31721 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31722 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31723 (gdb)
31724 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31725 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31726 (gdb)
31727 @end smallexample
31728
31729 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31730 @findex -data-list-register-values
31731
31732 @subsubheading Synopsis
31733
31734 @smallexample
31735 -data-list-register-values
31736 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31737 @end smallexample
31738
31739 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31740 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31741 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31742 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31743 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31744 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31745
31746 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31747
31748 @table @code
31749 @item x
31750 Hexadecimal
31751 @item o
31752 Octal
31753 @item t
31754 Binary
31755 @item d
31756 Decimal
31757 @item r
31758 Raw
31759 @item N
31760 Natural
31761 @end table
31762
31763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31764
31765 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31766 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31767
31768 @subsubheading Example
31769
31770 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31771 don't appear in the actual output):
31772
31773 @smallexample
31774 (gdb)
31775 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31776 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31777 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31778 (gdb)
31779 -data-list-register-values x
31780 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31781 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31782 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31783 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31784 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31785 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31786 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31787 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31788 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31789 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31790 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31791 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31792 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31793 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31794 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31795 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31796 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31797 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31798 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31799 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31800 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31801 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31802 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31803 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31804 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31805 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31806 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31807 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31808 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31809 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31810 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31811 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31812 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31813 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31814 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31815 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31816 (gdb)
31817 @end smallexample
31818
31819
31820 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31821 @findex -data-read-memory
31822
31823 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31824
31825 @subsubheading Synopsis
31826
31827 @smallexample
31828 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31829 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31830 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31831 @end smallexample
31832
31833 @noindent
31834 where:
31835
31836 @table @samp
31837 @item @var{address}
31838 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31839 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31840 quoted using the C convention.
31841
31842 @item @var{word-format}
31843 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31844 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31845 ,Output Formats}).
31846
31847 @item @var{word-size}
31848 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31849
31850 @item @var{nr-rows}
31851 The number of rows in the output table.
31852
31853 @item @var{nr-cols}
31854 The number of columns in the output table.
31855
31856 @item @var{aschar}
31857 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31858 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31859 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31860 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31861
31862 @item @var{byte-offset}
31863 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31864 @end table
31865
31866 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31867 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31868 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31869 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31870 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31871 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31872 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31873 @samp{addr}.
31874
31875 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31876 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31877 @samp{prev-page}.
31878
31879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31880
31881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31882 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31883
31884 @subsubheading Example
31885
31886 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31887 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31888 word. Display each word in hex.
31889
31890 @smallexample
31891 (gdb)
31892 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31893 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31894 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31895 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31896 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31897 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31898 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31899 (gdb)
31900 @end smallexample
31901
31902 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31903 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31904
31905 @smallexample
31906 (gdb)
31907 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31908 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31909 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31910 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31911 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31912 (gdb)
31913 @end smallexample
31914
31915 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31916 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31917 used as the non-printable character.
31918
31919 @smallexample
31920 (gdb)
31921 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31922 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31923 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31924 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31925 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31926 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31927 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31928 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31929 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31930 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31931 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31932 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31933 (gdb)
31934 @end smallexample
31935
31936 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31937 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31938
31939 @subsubheading Synopsis
31940
31941 @smallexample
31942 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31943 @var{address} @var{count}
31944 @end smallexample
31945
31946 @noindent
31947 where:
31948
31949 @table @samp
31950 @item @var{address}
31951 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31952 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31953 quoted using the C convention.
31954
31955 @item @var{count}
31956 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31957 literal.
31958
31959 @item @var{offset}
31960 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31961 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31962 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31963 arithmetics itself.
31964
31965 @end table
31966
31967 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31968 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31969 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31970 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31971 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31972 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31973
31974 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31975 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31976 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31977 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31978 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31979 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31980 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31981 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31982
31983 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31984 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31985 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31986 and has the following fields:
31987
31988 @table @code
31989 @item begin
31990 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31991
31992 @item end
31993 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31994
31995 @item offset
31996 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31997 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31998
31999 @item contents
32000 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32001
32002 @end table
32003
32004
32005
32006 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32007
32008 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32009
32010 @subsubheading Example
32011
32012 @smallexample
32013 (gdb)
32014 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32015 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32016 end="0xbffff15e",
32017 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32018 (gdb)
32019 @end smallexample
32020
32021
32022 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32023 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32024
32025 @subsubheading Synopsis
32026
32027 @smallexample
32028 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32029 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32030 @end smallexample
32031
32032 @noindent
32033 where:
32034
32035 @table @samp
32036 @item @var{address}
32037 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32038 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32039 be quoted using the C convention.
32040
32041 @item @var{contents}
32042 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32043 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32044
32045 @item @var{count}
32046 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32047 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32048 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32049 @var{count} memory units.
32050
32051 @end table
32052
32053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32054
32055 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32056
32057 @subsubheading Example
32058
32059 @smallexample
32060 (gdb)
32061 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32062 ^done
32063 (gdb)
32064 @end smallexample
32065
32066 @smallexample
32067 (gdb)
32068 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32069 ^done
32070 (gdb)
32071 @end smallexample
32072
32073 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32074 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32075 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32076
32077 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32078 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32079
32080 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32081 @findex -trace-find
32082
32083 @subsubheading Synopsis
32084
32085 @smallexample
32086 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32087 @end smallexample
32088
32089 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32090 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32091 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32092
32093 @table @samp
32094
32095 @item none
32096 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32097
32098 @item frame-number
32099 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32100 that index.
32101
32102 @item tracepoint-number
32103 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32104 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32105
32106 @item pc
32107 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32108 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32109 address.
32110
32111 @item pc-inside-range
32112 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32113 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32114 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32115
32116 @item pc-outside-range
32117 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32118 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32119 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32120
32121 @item line
32122 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32123 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32124 the specified location.
32125
32126 @end table
32127
32128 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32129 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32130
32131 @table @samp
32132 @item found
32133 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32134 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32135
32136 @item traceframe
32137 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32138 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32139
32140 @item tracepoint
32141 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32142 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32143
32144 @item frame
32145 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32146 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32147 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32148
32149 @end table
32150
32151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32152
32153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32154
32155 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32156 @findex -trace-define-variable
32157
32158 @subsubheading Synopsis
32159
32160 @smallexample
32161 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32162 @end smallexample
32163
32164 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32165 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32166 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32167 with the @samp{$} character.
32168
32169 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32170
32171 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32172
32173 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32174 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32175
32176 @subsubheading Synopsis
32177
32178 @smallexample
32179 -trace-frame-collected
32180 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32181 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32182 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32183 [--memory-contents]
32184 @end smallexample
32185
32186 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32187 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32188 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32189 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32190 See the output description table below for more details.
32191
32192 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32193 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32194 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32195 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32196 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32197
32198 For instance, if the actions were
32199 @smallexample
32200 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32201 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32202 @end smallexample
32203
32204 @noindent
32205 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32206 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32207 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32208 objects would be computed expressions.
32209
32210 An example output would be:
32211
32212 @smallexample
32213 (gdb)
32214 -trace-frame-collected
32215 ^done,
32216 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32217 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32218 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32219 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32220 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32221 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32222 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32223 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32224 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32225 ...
32226 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32227 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32228 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32229 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32230 (gdb)
32231 @end smallexample
32232
32233 Where:
32234
32235 @table @code
32236 @item explicit-variables
32237 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32238 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32239 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32240 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32241 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32242 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32243 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32244 arrays, structures and unions.
32245
32246 @item computed-expressions
32247 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32248 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32249 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32250 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32251
32252 @item registers
32253 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32254 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32255 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32256 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32257 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32258
32259 @item tvars
32260 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32261 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32262 current value are returned.
32263
32264 @item memory
32265 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32266 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32267 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32268
32269 @table @code
32270 @item address
32271 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32272
32273 @item length
32274 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32275
32276 @item contents
32277 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32278 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32279
32280 @end table
32281
32282 @end table
32283
32284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32285
32286 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32287
32288 @subsubheading Example
32289
32290 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32291 @findex -trace-list-variables
32292
32293 @subsubheading Synopsis
32294
32295 @smallexample
32296 -trace-list-variables
32297 @end smallexample
32298
32299 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32300 table has the following fields:
32301
32302 @table @samp
32303 @item name
32304 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32305
32306 @item initial
32307 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32308 field is always present.
32309
32310 @item current
32311 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32312 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32313 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32314 presently running.
32315
32316 @end table
32317
32318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32319
32320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32321
32322 @subsubheading Example
32323
32324 @smallexample
32325 (gdb)
32326 -trace-list-variables
32327 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32328 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32329 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32330 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32331 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32332 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32333 (gdb)
32334 @end smallexample
32335
32336 @subheading -trace-save
32337 @findex -trace-save
32338
32339 @subsubheading Synopsis
32340
32341 @smallexample
32342 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32343 @end smallexample
32344
32345 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32346 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32347 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32348 to perform the save.
32349
32350 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32351 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32352 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32353
32354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32355
32356 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32357
32358
32359 @subheading -trace-start
32360 @findex -trace-start
32361
32362 @subsubheading Synopsis
32363
32364 @smallexample
32365 -trace-start
32366 @end smallexample
32367
32368 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32369 have any fields.
32370
32371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32372
32373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32374
32375 @subheading -trace-status
32376 @findex -trace-status
32377
32378 @subsubheading Synopsis
32379
32380 @smallexample
32381 -trace-status
32382 @end smallexample
32383
32384 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32385 the following fields:
32386
32387 @table @samp
32388
32389 @item supported
32390 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32391 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32392 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32393 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32394 started. This field is always present.
32395
32396 @item running
32397 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32398 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32399 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32400
32401 @item stop-reason
32402 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32403 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32404 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32405 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32406 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32407 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32408 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32409 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32410 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32411
32412 @item stopping-tracepoint
32413 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32414 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32415 @samp{passcount}.
32416
32417 @item frames
32418 @itemx frames-created
32419 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32420 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32421 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32422 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32423
32424 @item buffer-size
32425 @itemx buffer-free
32426 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32427 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32428
32429 @item circular
32430 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32431 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32432 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32433 and may fill up.
32434
32435 @item disconnected
32436 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32437 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32438 that the trace run will stop.
32439
32440 @item trace-file
32441 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32442 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32443
32444 @end table
32445
32446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32447
32448 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32449
32450 @subheading -trace-stop
32451 @findex -trace-stop
32452
32453 @subsubheading Synopsis
32454
32455 @smallexample
32456 -trace-stop
32457 @end smallexample
32458
32459 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32460 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32461 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32462
32463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32464
32465 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32466
32467
32468 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32469 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32470 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32471
32472
32473 @ignore
32474 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32475 @findex -symbol-info-address
32476
32477 @subsubheading Synopsis
32478
32479 @smallexample
32480 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32481 @end smallexample
32482
32483 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32484
32485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32486
32487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32488
32489 @subsubheading Example
32490 N.A.
32491
32492
32493 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32494 @findex -symbol-info-file
32495
32496 @subsubheading Synopsis
32497
32498 @smallexample
32499 -symbol-info-file
32500 @end smallexample
32501
32502 Show the file for the symbol.
32503
32504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32505
32506 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32507 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32508
32509 @subsubheading Example
32510 N.A.
32511
32512
32513 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32514 @findex -symbol-info-function
32515
32516 @subsubheading Synopsis
32517
32518 @smallexample
32519 -symbol-info-function
32520 @end smallexample
32521
32522 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32523
32524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32525
32526 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32527
32528 @subsubheading Example
32529 N.A.
32530
32531
32532 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32533 @findex -symbol-info-line
32534
32535 @subsubheading Synopsis
32536
32537 @smallexample
32538 -symbol-info-line
32539 @end smallexample
32540
32541 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32542
32543 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32544
32545 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32546 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32547
32548 @subsubheading Example
32549 N.A.
32550
32551
32552 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32553 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32554
32555 @subsubheading Synopsis
32556
32557 @smallexample
32558 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32559 @end smallexample
32560
32561 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32562
32563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32564
32565 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32566
32567 @subsubheading Example
32568 N.A.
32569
32570
32571 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32572 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32573
32574 @subsubheading Synopsis
32575
32576 @smallexample
32577 -symbol-list-functions
32578 @end smallexample
32579
32580 List the functions in the executable.
32581
32582 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32583
32584 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32585 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32586
32587 @subsubheading Example
32588 N.A.
32589 @end ignore
32590
32591
32592 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32593 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32594
32595 @subsubheading Synopsis
32596
32597 @smallexample
32598 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32599 @end smallexample
32600
32601 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32602 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32603 ascending PC order.
32604
32605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32606
32607 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32608
32609 @subsubheading Example
32610 @smallexample
32611 (gdb)
32612 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32613 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32614 (gdb)
32615 @end smallexample
32616
32617
32618 @ignore
32619 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32620 @findex -symbol-list-types
32621
32622 @subsubheading Synopsis
32623
32624 @smallexample
32625 -symbol-list-types
32626 @end smallexample
32627
32628 List all the type names.
32629
32630 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32631
32632 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32633 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32634
32635 @subsubheading Example
32636 N.A.
32637
32638
32639 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32640 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32641
32642 @subsubheading Synopsis
32643
32644 @smallexample
32645 -symbol-list-variables
32646 @end smallexample
32647
32648 List all the global and static variable names.
32649
32650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32651
32652 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32653
32654 @subsubheading Example
32655 N.A.
32656
32657
32658 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32659 @findex -symbol-locate
32660
32661 @subsubheading Synopsis
32662
32663 @smallexample
32664 -symbol-locate
32665 @end smallexample
32666
32667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32668
32669 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32670
32671 @subsubheading Example
32672 N.A.
32673
32674
32675 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32676 @findex -symbol-type
32677
32678 @subsubheading Synopsis
32679
32680 @smallexample
32681 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32682 @end smallexample
32683
32684 Show type of @var{variable}.
32685
32686 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32687
32688 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32689 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32690
32691 @subsubheading Example
32692 N.A.
32693 @end ignore
32694
32695
32696 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32697 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32698 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32699
32700 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32701 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32702
32703 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32704 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32705
32706 @subsubheading Synopsis
32707
32708 @smallexample
32709 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32710 @end smallexample
32711
32712 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32713 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32714 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32715 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32716 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32717 notification.
32718
32719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32720
32721 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32722
32723 @subsubheading Example
32724
32725 @smallexample
32726 (gdb)
32727 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32728 ^done
32729 (gdb)
32730 @end smallexample
32731
32732
32733 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32734 @findex -file-exec-file
32735
32736 @subsubheading Synopsis
32737
32738 @smallexample
32739 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32740 @end smallexample
32741
32742 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32743 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32744 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32745 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32746 notification.
32747
32748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32749
32750 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32751
32752 @subsubheading Example
32753
32754 @smallexample
32755 (gdb)
32756 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32757 ^done
32758 (gdb)
32759 @end smallexample
32760
32761
32762 @ignore
32763 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32764 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32765
32766 @subsubheading Synopsis
32767
32768 @smallexample
32769 -file-list-exec-sections
32770 @end smallexample
32771
32772 List the sections of the current executable file.
32773
32774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32775
32776 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32777 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32778 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32779
32780 @subsubheading Example
32781 N.A.
32782 @end ignore
32783
32784
32785 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32786 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32787
32788 @subsubheading Synopsis
32789
32790 @smallexample
32791 -file-list-exec-source-file
32792 @end smallexample
32793
32794 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32795 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32796 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32797 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32798
32799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32800
32801 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32802
32803 @subsubheading Example
32804
32805 @smallexample
32806 (gdb)
32807 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32808 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32809 (gdb)
32810 @end smallexample
32811
32812
32813 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32814 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32815
32816 @subsubheading Synopsis
32817
32818 @smallexample
32819 -file-list-exec-source-files
32820 @end smallexample
32821
32822 List the source files for the current executable.
32823
32824 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32825 name) of a source file.
32826
32827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32828
32829 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32830 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32831
32832 @subsubheading Example
32833 @smallexample
32834 (gdb)
32835 -file-list-exec-source-files
32836 ^done,files=[
32837 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32838 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32839 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32840 (gdb)
32841 @end smallexample
32842
32843 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32844 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32845
32846 @subsubheading Synopsis
32847
32848 @smallexample
32849 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32850 @end smallexample
32851
32852 List the shared libraries in the program.
32853 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32854 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32855
32856 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32857
32858 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32859 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32860 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32861 library. Each range has the following fields:
32862
32863 @table @samp
32864 @item from
32865 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32866 @item to
32867 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32868 @end table
32869
32870 @subsubheading Example
32871 @smallexample
32872 (gdb)
32873 -file-list-exec-source-files
32874 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32875 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32876 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32877 (gdb)
32878 @end smallexample
32879
32880
32881 @ignore
32882 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32883 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32884
32885 @subsubheading Synopsis
32886
32887 @smallexample
32888 -file-list-symbol-files
32889 @end smallexample
32890
32891 List symbol files.
32892
32893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32894
32895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32896
32897 @subsubheading Example
32898 N.A.
32899 @end ignore
32900
32901
32902 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32903 @findex -file-symbol-file
32904
32905 @subsubheading Synopsis
32906
32907 @smallexample
32908 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32909 @end smallexample
32910
32911 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32912 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32913 produced, except for a completion notification.
32914
32915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32916
32917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32918
32919 @subsubheading Example
32920
32921 @smallexample
32922 (gdb)
32923 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32924 ^done
32925 (gdb)
32926 @end smallexample
32927
32928 @ignore
32929 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32930 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32931 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32932
32933 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32934
32935 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32936
32937 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32938
32939 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32940
32941 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32942
32943 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32944
32945 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32946
32947 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32948
32949 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32950 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32951 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32952
32953 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32954
32955 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32956
32957 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32958
32959 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32960 @end ignore
32961
32962
32963 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32964 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32965 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32966
32967
32968 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32969 @findex -target-attach
32970
32971 @subsubheading Synopsis
32972
32973 @smallexample
32974 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32975 @end smallexample
32976
32977 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32978 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32979 group, the id previously returned by
32980 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32981
32982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32983
32984 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32985
32986 @subsubheading Example
32987 @smallexample
32988 (gdb)
32989 -target-attach 34
32990 =thread-created,id="1"
32991 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32992 ^done
32993 (gdb)
32994 @end smallexample
32995
32996 @ignore
32997 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32998 @findex -target-compare-sections
32999
33000 @subsubheading Synopsis
33001
33002 @smallexample
33003 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33004 @end smallexample
33005
33006 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33007 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33008
33009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33010
33011 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33012
33013 @subsubheading Example
33014 N.A.
33015 @end ignore
33016
33017
33018 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33019 @findex -target-detach
33020
33021 @subsubheading Synopsis
33022
33023 @smallexample
33024 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33025 @end smallexample
33026
33027 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33028 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33029 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33030
33031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33032
33033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33034
33035 @subsubheading Example
33036
33037 @smallexample
33038 (gdb)
33039 -target-detach
33040 ^done
33041 (gdb)
33042 @end smallexample
33043
33044
33045 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33046 @findex -target-disconnect
33047
33048 @subsubheading Synopsis
33049
33050 @smallexample
33051 -target-disconnect
33052 @end smallexample
33053
33054 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33055 generally not resumed.
33056
33057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33058
33059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33060
33061 @subsubheading Example
33062
33063 @smallexample
33064 (gdb)
33065 -target-disconnect
33066 ^done
33067 (gdb)
33068 @end smallexample
33069
33070
33071 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33072 @findex -target-download
33073
33074 @subsubheading Synopsis
33075
33076 @smallexample
33077 -target-download
33078 @end smallexample
33079
33080 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33081 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33082
33083 @table @samp
33084 @item section
33085 The name of the section.
33086 @item section-sent
33087 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33088 @item section-size
33089 The size of the section.
33090 @item total-sent
33091 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33092 @item total-size
33093 The size of the overall executable to download.
33094 @end table
33095
33096 @noindent
33097 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33098 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33099
33100 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33101 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33102
33103 @table @samp
33104 @item section
33105 The name of the section.
33106 @item section-size
33107 The size of the section.
33108 @item total-size
33109 The size of the overall executable to download.
33110 @end table
33111
33112 @noindent
33113 At the end, a summary is printed.
33114
33115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33116
33117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33118
33119 @subsubheading Example
33120
33121 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33122 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33123
33124 @smallexample
33125 (gdb)
33126 -target-download
33127 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33128 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33129 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33130 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33131 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33132 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33133 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33134 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33135 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33136 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33137 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33138 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33139 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33140 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33141 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33142 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33143 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33144 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33145 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33146 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33147 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33148 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33149 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33150 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33151 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33152 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33153 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33154 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33155 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33156 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33157 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33158 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33159 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33160 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33161 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33162 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33163 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33164 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33165 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33166 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33167 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33168 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33169 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33170 write-rate="429"
33171 (gdb)
33172 @end smallexample
33173
33174
33175 @ignore
33176 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33177 @findex -target-exec-status
33178
33179 @subsubheading Synopsis
33180
33181 @smallexample
33182 -target-exec-status
33183 @end smallexample
33184
33185 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33186 not, for instance).
33187
33188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33189
33190 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33191
33192 @subsubheading Example
33193 N.A.
33194
33195
33196 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33197 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33198
33199 @subsubheading Synopsis
33200
33201 @smallexample
33202 -target-list-available-targets
33203 @end smallexample
33204
33205 List the possible targets to connect to.
33206
33207 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33208
33209 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33210
33211 @subsubheading Example
33212 N.A.
33213
33214
33215 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33216 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33217
33218 @subsubheading Synopsis
33219
33220 @smallexample
33221 -target-list-current-targets
33222 @end smallexample
33223
33224 Describe the current target.
33225
33226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33227
33228 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33229 other things).
33230
33231 @subsubheading Example
33232 N.A.
33233
33234
33235 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33236 @findex -target-list-parameters
33237
33238 @subsubheading Synopsis
33239
33240 @smallexample
33241 -target-list-parameters
33242 @end smallexample
33243
33244 @c ????
33245 @end ignore
33246
33247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33248
33249 No equivalent.
33250
33251 @subsubheading Example
33252 N.A.
33253
33254 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33255 @findex -target-flash-erase
33256
33257 @subsubheading Synopsis
33258
33259 @smallexample
33260 -target-flash-erase
33261 @end smallexample
33262
33263 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33264
33265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33266
33267 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33268 addresses and memory region sizes.
33269
33270 @smallexample
33271 (gdb)
33272 -target-flash-erase
33273 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33274 (gdb)
33275 @end smallexample
33276
33277 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33278 @findex -target-select
33279
33280 @subsubheading Synopsis
33281
33282 @smallexample
33283 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33284 @end smallexample
33285
33286 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33287
33288 @table @samp
33289 @item @var{type}
33290 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33291 @item @var{parameters}
33292 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33293 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33294 @end table
33295
33296 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33297 which the target program is, in the following form:
33298
33299 @smallexample
33300 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33301 args=[@var{arg list}]
33302 @end smallexample
33303
33304 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33305
33306 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33307
33308 @subsubheading Example
33309
33310 @smallexample
33311 (gdb)
33312 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33313 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33314 (gdb)
33315 @end smallexample
33316
33317 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33318 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33319 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33320
33321
33322 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33323 @findex -target-file-put
33324
33325 @subsubheading Synopsis
33326
33327 @smallexample
33328 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33329 @end smallexample
33330
33331 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33332 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33333
33334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33335
33336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33337
33338 @subsubheading Example
33339
33340 @smallexample
33341 (gdb)
33342 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33343 ^done
33344 (gdb)
33345 @end smallexample
33346
33347
33348 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33349 @findex -target-file-get
33350
33351 @subsubheading Synopsis
33352
33353 @smallexample
33354 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33355 @end smallexample
33356
33357 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33358 on the host system.
33359
33360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33361
33362 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33363
33364 @subsubheading Example
33365
33366 @smallexample
33367 (gdb)
33368 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33369 ^done
33370 (gdb)
33371 @end smallexample
33372
33373
33374 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33375 @findex -target-file-delete
33376
33377 @subsubheading Synopsis
33378
33379 @smallexample
33380 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33381 @end smallexample
33382
33383 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33384
33385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33386
33387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33388
33389 @subsubheading Example
33390
33391 @smallexample
33392 (gdb)
33393 -target-file-delete remotefile
33394 ^done
33395 (gdb)
33396 @end smallexample
33397
33398
33399 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33400 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33401 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33402
33403 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33404 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33405
33406 @subsubheading Synopsis
33407
33408 @smallexample
33409 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33410 @end smallexample
33411
33412 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33413 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33414 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33415
33416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33417
33418 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33419
33420 @subsubheading Result
33421
33422 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33423 defined for each exception:
33424
33425 @table @samp
33426 @item name
33427 The name of the exception.
33428
33429 @item address
33430 The address of the exception.
33431
33432 @end table
33433
33434 @subsubheading Example
33435
33436 @smallexample
33437 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33438 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33439 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33440 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33441 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33442 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33443 @end smallexample
33444
33445 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33446
33447 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33448 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33449 Catchpoint Commands}.
33450
33451
33452 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33453 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33454 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33455
33456 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33457 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33458 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33459 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33460
33461 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33462 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33463 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33464
33465 @subsubheading Synopsis
33466
33467 @smallexample
33468 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33469 @end smallexample
33470
33471 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33472
33473 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33474 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33475 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33476 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33477 dash.
33478
33479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33480
33481 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33482
33483 @subsubheading Result
33484
33485 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33486
33487 @table @samp
33488 @item exists
33489 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33490 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33491
33492 @end table
33493
33494 @subsubheading Example
33495
33496 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33497
33498 @smallexample
33499 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33500 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33501 @end smallexample
33502
33503 @noindent
33504 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33505 to the debugger:
33506
33507 @smallexample
33508 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33509 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33510 @end smallexample
33511
33512 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33513 @findex -list-features
33514 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33515
33516 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33517 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33518 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33519 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33520 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33521 startup.
33522
33523 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33524 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33525 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33526 is given below.
33527
33528 Example output:
33529
33530 @smallexample
33531 (gdb) -list-features
33532 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33533 @end smallexample
33534
33535 The current list of features is:
33536
33537 @ftable @samp
33538 @item frozen-varobjs
33539 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33540 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33541 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33542 @item pending-breakpoints
33543 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33544 command.
33545 @item python
33546 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33547 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33548 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33549 @item thread-info
33550 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33551 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33552 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33553 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33554 @item breakpoint-notifications
33555 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33556 CLI will be announced via async records.
33557 @item ada-task-info
33558 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33559 @item language-option
33560 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33561 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33562 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33563 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33564 @item undefined-command-error-code
33565 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33566 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33567 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33568 @item exec-run-start-option
33569 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33570 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33571 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33572 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33573 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33574 @end ftable
33575
33576 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33577 @findex -list-target-features
33578
33579 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33580 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33581 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33582 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33583 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33584 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33585 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33586 Example output:
33587
33588 @smallexample
33589 (gdb) -list-target-features
33590 ^done,result=["async"]
33591 @end smallexample
33592
33593 The current list of features is:
33594
33595 @table @samp
33596 @item async
33597 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33598 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33599 while the target is running.
33600
33601 @item reverse
33602 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33603 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33604
33605 @end table
33606
33607 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33608 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33609 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33610
33611 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33612
33613 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33614 @findex -gdb-exit
33615
33616 @subsubheading Synopsis
33617
33618 @smallexample
33619 -gdb-exit
33620 @end smallexample
33621
33622 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33623
33624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33625
33626 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33627
33628 @subsubheading Example
33629
33630 @smallexample
33631 (gdb)
33632 -gdb-exit
33633 ^exit
33634 @end smallexample
33635
33636
33637 @ignore
33638 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33639 @findex -exec-abort
33640
33641 @subsubheading Synopsis
33642
33643 @smallexample
33644 -exec-abort
33645 @end smallexample
33646
33647 Kill the inferior running program.
33648
33649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33650
33651 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33652
33653 @subsubheading Example
33654 N.A.
33655 @end ignore
33656
33657
33658 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33659 @findex -gdb-set
33660
33661 @subsubheading Synopsis
33662
33663 @smallexample
33664 -gdb-set
33665 @end smallexample
33666
33667 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33668 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33669
33670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33671
33672 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33673
33674 @subsubheading Example
33675
33676 @smallexample
33677 (gdb)
33678 -gdb-set $foo=3
33679 ^done
33680 (gdb)
33681 @end smallexample
33682
33683
33684 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33685 @findex -gdb-show
33686
33687 @subsubheading Synopsis
33688
33689 @smallexample
33690 -gdb-show
33691 @end smallexample
33692
33693 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33694
33695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33696
33697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33698
33699 @subsubheading Example
33700
33701 @smallexample
33702 (gdb)
33703 -gdb-show annotate
33704 ^done,value="0"
33705 (gdb)
33706 @end smallexample
33707
33708 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33709
33710
33711 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33712 @findex -gdb-version
33713
33714 @subsubheading Synopsis
33715
33716 @smallexample
33717 -gdb-version
33718 @end smallexample
33719
33720 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33721
33722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33723
33724 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33725 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33726
33727 @subsubheading Example
33728
33729 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33730 @c box in TeX.
33731 @smallexample
33732 (gdb)
33733 -gdb-version
33734 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33735 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33736 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33737 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33738 ~ certain conditions.
33739 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33740 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33741 ~ details.
33742 ~This GDB was configured as
33743 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33744 ^done
33745 (gdb)
33746 @end smallexample
33747
33748 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33749 @findex -list-thread-groups
33750
33751 @subheading Synopsis
33752
33753 @smallexample
33754 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33755 @end smallexample
33756
33757 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33758 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33759 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33760 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33761 top-level thread groups.
33762
33763 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33764 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33765 available on the target.
33766
33767 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33768 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33769 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33770 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33771 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33772 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33773 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33774 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33775
33776 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33777 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33778 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33779 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33780 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33781 @samp{threads} field.
33782
33783 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33784 the following caveats:
33785
33786 @itemize @bullet
33787 @item
33788 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33789 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33790 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33791
33792 @item
33793 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33794 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33795 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33796 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33797 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33798 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33799
33800 @end itemize
33801
33802 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33803 have the following fields:
33804
33805 @table @code
33806 @item id
33807 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33808 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33809 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33810
33811 @item type
33812 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33813 valid type.
33814
33815 @item pid
33816 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33817 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33818
33819 @item exit-code
33820 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33821 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33822 only if the process is not running.
33823
33824 @item num_children
33825 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33826 absent for an available thread group.
33827
33828 @item threads
33829 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33830 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33831 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33832
33833 @item cores
33834 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33835 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33836 such information is not available.
33837
33838 @item executable
33839 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33840 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33841 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33842
33843 @end table
33844
33845 @subheading Example
33846
33847 @smallexample
33848 @value{GDBP}
33849 -list-thread-groups
33850 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33851 -list-thread-groups 17
33852 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33853 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33854 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33855 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33856 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
33857 -list-thread-groups --available
33858 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33859 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33860 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33861 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33862 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33863 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33864 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33865 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33866 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33867 @end smallexample
33868
33869 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33870 @findex -info-os
33871
33872 @subsubheading Synopsis
33873
33874 @smallexample
33875 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33876 @end smallexample
33877
33878 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33879 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33880 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33881 of data of that type.
33882
33883 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33884 system.
33885
33886 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33887
33888 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33889
33890 @subsubheading Example
33891
33892 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33893 like this:
33894
33895 @smallexample
33896 @value{GDBP}
33897 -info-os
33898 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33899 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33900 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33901 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33902 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33903 col2="CPUs"@},
33904 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33905 col2="File descriptors"@},
33906 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33907 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33908 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33909 col2="Message queues"@},
33910 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33911 col2="Processes"@},
33912 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33913 col2="Process groups"@},
33914 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33915 col2="Semaphores"@},
33916 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33917 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33918 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33919 col2="Sockets"@},
33920 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33921 col2="Threads"@}]
33922 @value{GDBP}
33923 -info-os processes
33924 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33925 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33926 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33927 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33928 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33929 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33930 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33931 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33932 ...
33933 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33934 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33935 (gdb)
33936 @end smallexample
33937
33938 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33939 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33940 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33941 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33942 @code{info os} omits it.)
33943
33944 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33945 @findex -add-inferior
33946
33947 @subheading Synopsis
33948
33949 @smallexample
33950 -add-inferior
33951 @end smallexample
33952
33953 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33954 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33955 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33956 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33957 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33958 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33959
33960 @subheading Example
33961
33962 @smallexample
33963 @value{GDBP}
33964 -add-inferior
33965 ^done,inferior="i3"
33966 @end smallexample
33967
33968 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33969 @findex -interpreter-exec
33970
33971 @subheading Synopsis
33972
33973 @smallexample
33974 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33975 @end smallexample
33976 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33977
33978 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33979
33980 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33981
33982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33983
33984 @subheading Example
33985
33986 @smallexample
33987 (gdb)
33988 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33989 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33990 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33991 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33992 ^done
33993 (gdb)
33994 @end smallexample
33995
33996 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33997 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33998
33999 @subheading Synopsis
34000
34001 @smallexample
34002 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34003 @end smallexample
34004
34005 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34006
34007 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34008
34009 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34010
34011 @subheading Example
34012
34013 @smallexample
34014 (gdb)
34015 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34016 ^done
34017 (gdb)
34018 @end smallexample
34019
34020 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34021 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34022
34023 @subheading Synopsis
34024
34025 @smallexample
34026 -inferior-tty-show
34027 @end smallexample
34028
34029 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34030
34031 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34032
34033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34034
34035 @subheading Example
34036
34037 @smallexample
34038 (gdb)
34039 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34040 ^done
34041 (gdb)
34042 -inferior-tty-show
34043 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34044 (gdb)
34045 @end smallexample
34046
34047 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34048 @findex -enable-timings
34049
34050 @subheading Synopsis
34051
34052 @smallexample
34053 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34054 @end smallexample
34055
34056 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34057 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34058 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34059 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34060
34061 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34062
34063 No equivalent.
34064
34065 @subheading Example
34066
34067 @smallexample
34068 (gdb)
34069 -enable-timings
34070 ^done
34071 (gdb)
34072 -break-insert main
34073 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34074 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34075 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34076 times="0"@},
34077 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34078 (gdb)
34079 -enable-timings no
34080 ^done
34081 (gdb)
34082 -exec-run
34083 ^running
34084 (gdb)
34085 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34086 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34087 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34088 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34089 (gdb)
34090 @end smallexample
34091
34092 @node Annotations
34093 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34094
34095 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34096 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34097 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34098 relatively high level.
34099
34100 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34101 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34102
34103 @ignore
34104 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34105 @end ignore
34106
34107 @menu
34108 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34109 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34110 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34111 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34112 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34113 * Annotations for Running::
34114 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34115 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34116 @end menu
34117
34118 @node Annotations Overview
34119 @section What is an Annotation?
34120 @cindex annotations
34121
34122 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34123 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34124 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34125 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34126 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34127 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34128 cannot contain newline characters.
34129
34130 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34131 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34132 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34133 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34134 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34135 means those three characters as output.
34136
34137 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34138 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34139 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34140 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34141 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34142 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34143 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34144 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34145 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34146
34147 @table @code
34148 @kindex set annotate
34149 @item set annotate @var{level}
34150 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34151 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34152
34153 @item show annotate
34154 @kindex show annotate
34155 Show the current annotation level.
34156 @end table
34157
34158 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34159
34160 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34161
34162 @smallexample
34163 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34164 GNU gdb 6.0
34165 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34166 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34167 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34168 under certain conditions.
34169 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34170 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34171 for details.
34172 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34173
34174 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34175 (@value{GDBP})
34176 ^Z^Zprompt
34177 @kbd{quit}
34178
34179 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34180 $
34181 @end smallexample
34182
34183 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34184 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34185 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34186 output from @value{GDBN}.
34187
34188 @node Server Prefix
34189 @section The Server Prefix
34190 @cindex server prefix
34191
34192 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34193 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34194 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34195 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34196 a transparent manner.
34197
34198 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34199 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34200 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34201 @code{print} command.
34202
34203 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34204 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34205
34206 @node Prompting
34207 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34208
34209 @cindex annotations for prompts
34210 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34211 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34212 over, etc.
34213
34214 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34215 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34216 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34217 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34218 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34219 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34220 features the following annotations:
34221
34222 @smallexample
34223 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34224 ^Z^Zprompt
34225 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34226 @end smallexample
34227
34228 The input types are
34229
34230 @table @code
34231 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34232 @findex prompt annotation
34233 @findex post-prompt annotation
34234 @item prompt
34235 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34236
34237 @findex pre-commands annotation
34238 @findex commands annotation
34239 @findex post-commands annotation
34240 @item commands
34241 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34242 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34243
34244 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34245 @findex overload-choice annotation
34246 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34247 @item overload-choice
34248 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34249
34250 @findex pre-query annotation
34251 @findex query annotation
34252 @findex post-query annotation
34253 @item query
34254 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34255
34256 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34257 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34258 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34259 @item prompt-for-continue
34260 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34261 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34262 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34263 presence of annotations.
34264 @end table
34265
34266 @node Errors
34267 @section Errors
34268 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34269
34270 @findex quit annotation
34271 @smallexample
34272 ^Z^Zquit
34273 @end smallexample
34274
34275 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34276
34277 @findex error annotation
34278 @smallexample
34279 ^Z^Zerror
34280 @end smallexample
34281
34282 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34283
34284 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34285 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34286 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34287 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34288 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34289 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34290 to the top level.
34291
34292 @findex error-begin annotation
34293 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34294
34295 @smallexample
34296 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34297 @end smallexample
34298
34299 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34300 message.
34301
34302 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34303 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34304 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34305
34306 @node Invalidation
34307 @section Invalidation Notices
34308
34309 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34310 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34311 changed.
34312
34313 @table @code
34314 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34315 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34316
34317 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34318 have changed.
34319
34320 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34321 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34322
34323 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34324 deleted a breakpoint.
34325 @end table
34326
34327 @node Annotations for Running
34328 @section Running the Program
34329 @cindex annotations for running programs
34330
34331 @findex starting annotation
34332 @findex stopping annotation
34333 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34334 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34335
34336 @smallexample
34337 ^Z^Zstarting
34338 @end smallexample
34339
34340 is output. When the program stops,
34341
34342 @smallexample
34343 ^Z^Zstopped
34344 @end smallexample
34345
34346 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34347 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34348
34349 @table @code
34350 @findex exited annotation
34351 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34352 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34353 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34354
34355 @findex signalled annotation
34356 @findex signal-name annotation
34357 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34358 @findex signal-string annotation
34359 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34360 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34361 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34362 annotation continues:
34363
34364 @smallexample
34365 @var{intro-text}
34366 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34367 @var{name}
34368 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34369 @var{middle-text}
34370 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34371 @var{string}
34372 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34373 @var{end-text}
34374 @end smallexample
34375
34376 @noindent
34377 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34378 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34379 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34380 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34381 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34382
34383 @findex signal annotation
34384 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34385 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34386 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34387 terminated with it.
34388
34389 @findex breakpoint annotation
34390 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34391 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34392
34393 @findex watchpoint annotation
34394 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34395 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34396 @end table
34397
34398 @node Source Annotations
34399 @section Displaying Source
34400 @cindex annotations for source display
34401
34402 @findex source annotation
34403 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34404
34405 @smallexample
34406 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34407 @end smallexample
34408
34409 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34410 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34411 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34412 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34413 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34414 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34415 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34416 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34417 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34418 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34419 depend on the language).
34420
34421 @node JIT Interface
34422 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34423 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34424 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34425
34426 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34427 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34428 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34429 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34430
34431 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34432 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34433 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34434 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34435 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34436 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34437
34438 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34439 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34440 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34441 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34442 LLVM JIT.
34443
34444 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34445 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34446 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34447 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34448 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34449 out about additional code.
34450
34451 @menu
34452 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34453 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34454 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34455 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34456 @end menu
34457
34458 @node Declarations
34459 @section JIT Declarations
34460
34461 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34462 implement the interface:
34463
34464 @smallexample
34465 typedef enum
34466 @{
34467 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34468 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34469 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34470 @} jit_actions_t;
34471
34472 struct jit_code_entry
34473 @{
34474 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34475 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34476 const char *symfile_addr;
34477 uint64_t symfile_size;
34478 @};
34479
34480 struct jit_descriptor
34481 @{
34482 uint32_t version;
34483 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34484 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34485 uint32_t action_flag;
34486 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34487 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34488 @};
34489
34490 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34491 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34492
34493 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34494 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34495 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34496 @end smallexample
34497
34498 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34499 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34500 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34501
34502 @node Registering Code
34503 @section Registering Code
34504
34505 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34506
34507 @itemize @bullet
34508 @item
34509 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34510 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34511
34512 @item
34513 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34514 file.
34515
34516 @item
34517 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34518
34519 @item
34520 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34521
34522 @item
34523 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34524 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34525 @end itemize
34526
34527 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34528 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34529 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34530 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34531
34532 @node Unregistering Code
34533 @section Unregistering Code
34534
34535 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34536
34537 @itemize @bullet
34538 @item
34539 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34540
34541 @item
34542 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34543
34544 @item
34545 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34546 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34547 @end itemize
34548
34549 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34550 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34551
34552 @node Custom Debug Info
34553 @section Custom Debug Info
34554 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34555 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34556
34557 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34558 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34559 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34560 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34561 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34562 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34563 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34564 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34565 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34566
34567 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34568 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34569 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34570 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34571 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34572 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34573 compiler.
34574
34575 @menu
34576 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34577 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34578 @end menu
34579
34580 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34581 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34582 @kindex jit-reader-load
34583 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34584
34585 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34586 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34587
34588 @table @code
34589 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34590 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34591 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34592 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34593 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34594 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34595 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34596
34597 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34598 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34599 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34600 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34601 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34602
34603 @item jit-reader-unload
34604 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34605
34606 @end table
34607
34608 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34609 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34610 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34611
34612 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34613 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34614
34615 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34616 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34617 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34618 the system include directory.
34619
34620 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34621 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34622 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34623
34624 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34625 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34626
34627 @findex gdb_init_reader
34628 @smallexample
34629 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34630 @end smallexample
34631
34632 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34633
34634 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34635 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34636 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34637 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34638 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34639 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34640
34641 @smallexample
34642 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34643 @{
34644 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34645 int reader_version;
34646
34647 /* For use by the reader. */
34648 void *priv_data;
34649
34650 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34651 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34652 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34653 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34654 @};
34655 @end smallexample
34656
34657 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34658 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34659
34660 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34661 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34662 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34663 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34664 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34665 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34666 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34667 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34668 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34669 target's address space.
34670
34671 @node In-Process Agent
34672 @chapter In-Process Agent
34673 @cindex debugging agent
34674 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34675 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34676 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34677 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34678 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34679 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34680 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34681 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34682 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34683 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34684 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34685 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34686 behavior without interrupting it.
34687
34688 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34689 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34690 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34691 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34692 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34693 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34694 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34695 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34696 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34697
34698 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34699 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34700 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34701 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34702
34703 @anchor{Control Agent}
34704 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34705 debugging with the following commands:
34706
34707 @table @code
34708 @kindex set agent on
34709 @item set agent on
34710 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34711 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34712 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34713 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34714 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34715 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34716
34717 @kindex set agent off
34718 @item set agent off
34719 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34720 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34721
34722 @kindex show agent
34723 @item show agent
34724 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34725 the in-process agent.
34726 @end table
34727
34728 @menu
34729 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34730 @end menu
34731
34732 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34733 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34734 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34735
34736 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34737 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34738 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34739 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34740 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34741 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34742 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34743 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34744 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34745
34746 @menu
34747 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34748 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34749 @end menu
34750
34751 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34752 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34753 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34754
34755 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34756 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34757
34758 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34759 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34760 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34761 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34762
34763 @enumerate
34764 @item
34765 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34766 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34767 @item
34768 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34769 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34770 the other one.
34771 @end enumerate
34772
34773 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34774
34775 @enumerate
34776 @item
34777 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34778 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34779 @anchor{agent expression object}
34780 @item
34781 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34782 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34783 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34784 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34785 @item
34786 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34787 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34788
34789 @end enumerate
34790
34791 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34792 object:
34793
34794 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34795 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34796 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34797 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34798 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34799 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34800 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34801 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34802 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34803 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34804 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34805 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34806 memory address for collecting.
34807 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34808 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34809 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34810 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34811 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34812 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34813 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34814 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34815 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34816 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34817 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34818 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34819 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34820 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34821 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34822 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34823 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34824 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34825 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34826 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34827 @ref{agent expression object}
34828 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34829 @ref{agent expression object}
34830 @item actions @tab variable
34831 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34832 @end multitable
34833
34834 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34835 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34836 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34837
34838 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34839 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34840
34841 @table @samp
34842
34843 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34844 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34845 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34846 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34847 in IPA finally.
34848
34849 Replies:
34850 @table @samp
34851 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34852 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34853 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34854 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34855 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34856 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34857 @item E @var{NN}
34858 for an error
34859
34860 @end table
34861
34862 @item close
34863 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34864 is about to kill inferiors.
34865
34866 @item qTfSTM
34867 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34868 @item qTsSTM
34869 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34870 @item qTSTMat
34871 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34872 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34873 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34874
34875 Replies:
34876 @table @samp
34877 @item E @var{NN}
34878 for an error
34879 @end table
34880 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34881 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34882 @end table
34883
34884 @node GDB Bugs
34885 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34886 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34887 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34888
34889 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34890
34891 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34892 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34893 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34894 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34895
34896 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34897 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34898
34899 @menu
34900 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34901 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34902 @end menu
34903
34904 @node Bug Criteria
34905 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34906 @cindex bug criteria
34907
34908 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34909
34910 @itemize @bullet
34911 @cindex fatal signal
34912 @cindex debugger crash
34913 @cindex crash of debugger
34914 @item
34915 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34916 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34917
34918 @cindex error on valid input
34919 @item
34920 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34921 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34922 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34923
34924 @cindex invalid input
34925 @item
34926 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34927 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34928 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34929 for traditional practice''.
34930
34931 @item
34932 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34933 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34934 @end itemize
34935
34936 @node Bug Reporting
34937 @section How to Report Bugs
34938 @cindex bug reports
34939 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34940
34941 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34942 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34943 contact that organization first.
34944
34945 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34946 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34947 distribution.
34948 @c should add a web page ref...
34949
34950 @ifset BUGURL
34951 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34952 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34953 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34954 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34955 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34956 be used.
34957
34958 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34959 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34960 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34961 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34962
34963 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34964 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34965 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34966 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34967 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34968 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34969 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34970 bug reports to the mailing list.
34971 @end ifset
34972 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34973 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34974 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34975 @end ifclear
34976 @end ifset
34977
34978 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34979 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34980 fact or leave it out, state it!
34981
34982 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34983 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34984 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34985 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34986 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34987 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34988 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34989 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34990 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34991
34992 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34993 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34994 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34995 self-contained.
34996
34997 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34998 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34999 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35000 bugs properly.
35001
35002 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35003
35004 @itemize @bullet
35005 @item
35006 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35007 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35008 version}.
35009
35010 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35011 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35012
35013 @item
35014 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35015 version number.
35016
35017 @item
35018 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35019 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35020 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35021 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35022
35023 @item
35024 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35025 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35026
35027 @item
35028 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35029 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35030 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35031 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35032 those compilers.
35033
35034 @item
35035 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35036 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35037 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35038 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35039
35040 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35041 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35042
35043 @item
35044 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35045 reproduce the bug.
35046
35047 @item
35048 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35049 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35050
35051 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35052 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35053 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35054 a chance to make a mistake.
35055
35056 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35057 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35058 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35059 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35060 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35061 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35062 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35063 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35064
35065 @pindex script
35066 @cindex recording a session script
35067 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35068 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35069 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35070 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35071
35072 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35073 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35074
35075 @item
35076 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35077 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35078 it by context, not by line number.
35079
35080 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35081 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35082
35083 @end itemize
35084
35085 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35086
35087 @itemize @bullet
35088 @item
35089 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35090
35091 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35092 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35093 changes will not affect it.
35094
35095 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35096 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35097 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35098 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35099
35100 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35101 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35102 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35103 less time, and so on.
35104
35105 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35106 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35107
35108 @item
35109 A patch for the bug.
35110
35111 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35112 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35113 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35114 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35115
35116 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35117 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35118 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35119 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35120
35121 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35122 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35123 help us to understand.
35124
35125 @item
35126 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35127
35128 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35129 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35130 @end itemize
35131
35132 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35133 @c and consists of the two following files:
35134 @c rluser.texi
35135 @c hsuser.texi
35136 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35137 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35138 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35139 @include rluser.texi
35140 @include hsuser.texi
35141 @end ifclear
35142
35143 @node In Memoriam
35144 @appendix In Memoriam
35145
35146 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35147 contributors:
35148
35149 @table @code
35150 @item Fred Fish
35151 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35152 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35153 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35154
35155 @item Michael Snyder
35156 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35157 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35158 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35159 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35160 @end table
35161
35162 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35163 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35164
35165 @node Formatting Documentation
35166 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35167
35168 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35169 @cindex reference card
35170 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35171 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35172 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35173 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35174 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35175 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35176
35177 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35178 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35179
35180 @smallexample
35181 make refcard.dvi
35182 @end smallexample
35183
35184 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35185 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35186 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35187 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35188 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35189
35190 @cindex documentation
35191
35192 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35193 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35194 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35195 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35196 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35197 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35198
35199 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35200 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35201 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35202 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35203 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35204 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35205 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35206 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35207
35208 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35209 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35210 @code{makeinfo}.
35211
35212 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35213 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35214 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35215
35216 @smallexample
35217 cd gdb
35218 make gdb.info
35219 @end smallexample
35220
35221 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35222 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35223 Texinfo definitions file.
35224
35225 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35226 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35227 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35228 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35229 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35230 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35231 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35232
35233 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35234 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35235 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35236 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35237 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35238 directory.
35239
35240 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35241 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35242 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35243 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35244
35245 @smallexample
35246 make gdb.dvi
35247 @end smallexample
35248
35249 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35250
35251 @node Installing GDB
35252 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35253 @cindex installation
35254
35255 @menu
35256 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35257 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35258 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35259 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35260 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35261 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35262 @end menu
35263
35264 @node Requirements
35265 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35266 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35267
35268 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35269 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35270
35271 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35272 @table @asis
35273 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35274 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35275 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35276
35277 @item GNU make
35278 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35279 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35280 @end table
35281
35282 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35283 @table @asis
35284 @item Expat
35285 @anchor{Expat}
35286 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35287 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35288 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35289 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35290 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35291 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35292
35293 Expat is used for:
35294
35295 @itemize @bullet
35296 @item
35297 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35298 @item
35299 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35300 @item
35301 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35302 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35303 @item
35304 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35305 @item
35306 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35307 @item
35308 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35309 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35310 @end itemize
35311
35312 @item Guile
35313 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35314 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35315 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35316 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35317 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35318 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35319
35320 @item iconv
35321 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35322 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35323 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35324 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35325
35326 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35327 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35328 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35329 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35330 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35331
35332 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35333 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35334 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35335 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35336 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35337
35338 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35339 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35340 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35341 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35342 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35343 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35344 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35345 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35346 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35347
35348 @item lzma
35349 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35350 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35351 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35352 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35353 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35354 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35355 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35356
35357 @item MPFR
35358 @anchor{MPFR}
35359 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35360 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35361 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35362 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35363 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35364 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35365 option to specify its location.
35366
35367 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35368 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35369 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35370 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35371
35372 @item Python
35373 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35374 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35375 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35376 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35377 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35378 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35379 installation of Python.
35380
35381 @item zlib
35382 @cindex compressed debug sections
35383 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35384 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35385 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35386 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35387 information in such binaries.
35388
35389 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35390 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35391 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35392 @end table
35393
35394 @node Running Configure
35395 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35396 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35397 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35398 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35399 build the @code{gdb} program.
35400 @iftex
35401 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35402 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35403 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35404 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35405 @end iftex
35406
35407 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35408 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35409 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35410
35411 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35412 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35413
35414 @table @code
35415 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35416 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35417
35418 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35419 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35420
35421 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35422 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35423
35424 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35425 @sc{gnu} include files
35426
35427 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35428 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35429
35430 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35431 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35432
35433 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35434 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35435 @end table
35436
35437 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35438
35439 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35440 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35441 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35442
35443 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35444 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35445 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35446 argument.
35447
35448 For example:
35449
35450 @smallexample
35451 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35452 ./configure
35453 make
35454 @end smallexample
35455
35456 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35457 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35458 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35459 directories.
35460
35461 @need 750
35462 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35463 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35464 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35465
35466 @smallexample
35467 sh configure
35468 @end smallexample
35469
35470 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35471 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35472 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35473 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35474 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35475 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35476 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35477 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35478 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35479
35480 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35481 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35482 install it with @code{make install}.
35483
35484 @node Separate Objdir
35485 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35486
35487 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35488 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35489 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35490 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35491 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35492 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35493 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35494 program specified there.
35495
35496 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35497 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35498 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35499 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35500 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35501 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35502
35503 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35504 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35505
35506 @smallexample
35507 @group
35508 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35509 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35510 cd ../gdb-sun4
35511 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35512 make
35513 @end group
35514 @end smallexample
35515
35516 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35517 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35518 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35519 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35520 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35521 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35522
35523 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35524 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35525 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35526 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35527 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35528
35529 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35530 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35531 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35532 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35533 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35534 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35535
35536 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35537 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35538 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35539
35540 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35541 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35542 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35543 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35544 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35545
35546 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35547 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35548 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35549 with each other.
35550
35551 @node Config Names
35552 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35553
35554 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35555 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35556 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35557 of information in the following pattern:
35558
35559 @smallexample
35560 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35561 @end smallexample
35562
35563 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35564 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35565 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35566
35567 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35568 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35569 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35570 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35571 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35572 abbreviations---for example:
35573
35574 @smallexample
35575 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35576 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35577 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35578 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35579 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35580 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35581 % sh config.sub sun4
35582 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35583 % sh config.sub sun3
35584 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35585 % sh config.sub i986v
35586 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35587 @end smallexample
35588
35589 @noindent
35590 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35591 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35592
35593 @node Configure Options
35594 @section @file{configure} Options
35595
35596 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35597 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35598 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35599 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35600 explanation of @file{configure}.
35601
35602 @smallexample
35603 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35604 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35605 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35606 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35607 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35608 @end smallexample
35609
35610 @noindent
35611 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35612 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35613 @samp{--}.
35614
35615 @table @code
35616 @item --help
35617 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35618
35619 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35620 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35621 @file{@var{dir}}.
35622
35623 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35624 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35625 @file{@var{dir}}.
35626
35627 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35628 @need 2000
35629 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35630 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35631 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35632 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35633 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35634 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35635 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35636 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35637 @var{dirname}.
35638
35639 @item --target=@var{target}
35640 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35641 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35642 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35643
35644 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35645 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35646 @end table
35647
35648 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35649 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35650 options not described here.
35651
35652 @table @code
35653 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
35654 @itemx --enable-targets=all
35655 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
35656 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
35657 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
35658
35659 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
35660 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
35661 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
35662 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
35663 @code{--datadir}).
35664
35665 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
35666 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
35667 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
35668 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
35669 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
35670 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
35671 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
35672 after it is built.
35673
35674 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
35675 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
35676
35677 @item --disable-gdbmi
35678 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
35679 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35680
35681 @item --enable-tui
35682 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
35683 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
35684 supported).
35685
35686 @item --with-curses
35687 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
35688 terminal operations.
35689
35690 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
35691 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
35692 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
35693 details.
35694
35695 @item --with-system-readline
35696 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
35697 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35698
35699 @item --with-system-zlib
35700 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
35701 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35702
35703 @item --with-expat
35704 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
35705 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
35706 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
35707 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
35708 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
35709 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
35710 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
35711 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
35712
35713 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
35714
35715 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
35716 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
35717 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
35718 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
35719 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
35720
35721 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
35722 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
35723
35724 @item --with-lzma
35725 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
35726 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
35727 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
35728 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
35729 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
35730 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
35731
35732 @item --with-mpfr
35733 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
35734 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
35735 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
35736 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
35737 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
35738 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
35739 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
35740 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
35741 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
35742
35743 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
35744 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
35745 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
35746 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
35747 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
35748 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
35749 of Python supported by GDB is 2.4. The optional argument @var{python}
35750 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
35751 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
35752 Python is installed.
35753
35754 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
35755 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
35756 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
35757 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
35758 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
35759 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
35760 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
35761 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
35762 compile and link against Guile.
35763
35764 @item --without-included-regex
35765 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
35766 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
35767 the GNU C library.
35768
35769 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
35770 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
35771 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
35772 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
35773 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
35774 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
35775 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
35776 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
35777
35778 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35779 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
35780 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
35781 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
35782 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
35783 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
35784
35785 @item --enable-build-warnings
35786 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
35787 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
35788 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
35789 compiler you are using.
35790
35791 @item --enable-werror
35792 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
35793 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
35794 outputs any warning messages.
35795
35796 @item --enable-ubsan
35797 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
35798 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
35799 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
35800 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
35801 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
35802 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
35803 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
35804 @end table
35805
35806 @node System-wide configuration
35807 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35808 @cindex system-wide init file
35809
35810 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35811 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35812 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35813
35814 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35815
35816 @table @code
35817 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35818 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35819 @var{file}.
35820 @end table
35821
35822 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35823 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35824
35825 @itemize @bullet
35826 @item
35827 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35828 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35829 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35830 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35831 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35832 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35833
35834 @item
35835 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35836 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35837 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35838 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35839 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35840 @end itemize
35841
35842 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35843 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35844 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35845 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35846 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35847 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35848 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35849 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35850 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35851 reread.
35852
35853 @menu
35854 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35855 @end menu
35856
35857 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35858 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35859 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35860
35861 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35862 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35863 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35864 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35865 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35866 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35867
35868 The following scripts are currently available:
35869 @itemize @bullet
35870
35871 @item @file{elinos.py}
35872 @pindex elinos.py
35873 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35874 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35875 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35876 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35877 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35878 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35879
35880 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35881 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35882 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35883 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35884 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35885 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35886
35887 @end itemize
35888
35889 @node Maintenance Commands
35890 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35891 @cindex maintenance commands
35892 @cindex internal commands
35893
35894 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35895 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35896 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35897 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35898 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35899
35900 @table @code
35901 @kindex maint agent
35902 @kindex maint agent-eval
35903 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35904 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35905 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35906 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35907 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35908 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35909 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35910 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35911 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35912 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35913 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35914 addition and return the sum.
35915 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35916 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35917
35918 @kindex maint agent-printf
35919 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35920 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35921 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35922 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35923 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35924
35925 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35926 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35927 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35928 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35929 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35930 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35931 is shown:
35932
35933 @table @code
35934 @item breakpoint
35935 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35936
35937 @item watchpoint
35938 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35939
35940 @item longjmp
35941 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35942 @code{longjmp} calls.
35943
35944 @item longjmp resume
35945 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35946
35947 @item until
35948 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35949
35950 @item finish
35951 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35952
35953 @item shlib events
35954 Shared library events.
35955
35956 @end table
35957
35958 @kindex maint info btrace
35959 @item maint info btrace
35960 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
35961
35962 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
35963 @item maint btrace packet-history
35964 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
35965 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
35966 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
35967 recording format.
35968
35969 @table @code
35970 @item bts
35971 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
35972 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
35973
35974 @table @asis
35975 @item Block number
35976 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
35977 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
35978 @item Highest @samp{PC}
35979 @end table
35980
35981 @item pt
35982 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
35983 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
35984 information is printed:
35985
35986 @table @asis
35987 @item Packet number
35988 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
35989 @item Trace offset
35990 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
35991 @item Packet opcode and payload
35992 @end table
35993 @end table
35994
35995 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
35996 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
35997 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
35998 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
35999 needed.
36000
36001 @kindex maint btrace clear
36002 @item maint btrace clear
36003 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36004 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36005
36006 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36007 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36008 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36009 buffer.
36010
36011 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36012 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36013 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36014 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36015 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36016 packet history.
36017
36018 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36019 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36020 @cindex displaced stepping support
36021 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36022 @item set displaced-stepping
36023 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36024 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36025 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36026 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36027 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36028 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36029
36030 @table @code
36031 @item set displaced-stepping on
36032 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36033 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36034
36035 @item set displaced-stepping off
36036 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36037 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36038
36039 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36040 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36041 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36042 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36043 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36044 @end table
36045
36046 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36047 @item maint check-psymtabs
36048 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36049 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36050
36051 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36052 @item maint check-symtabs
36053 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36054
36055 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36056 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36057 Expand symbol tables.
36058 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36059 names matching @var{regexp}.
36060
36061 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36062 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36063 @cindex demangler crashes
36064 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36065 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36066 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36067 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36068 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36069 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36070 option to terminate the current session.
36071
36072 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36073 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36074 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36075
36076 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36077 @item maint cplus namespace
36078 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36079
36080 @kindex maint deprecate
36081 @kindex maint undeprecate
36082 @cindex deprecated commands
36083 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36084 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36085 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36086 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36087 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36088 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36089 the replacement as part of the warning.
36090
36091 @kindex maint dump-me
36092 @item maint dump-me
36093 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36094 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36095 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36096 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36097
36098 @kindex maint internal-error
36099 @kindex maint internal-warning
36100 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36101 @cindex demangler crashes
36102 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36103 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36104 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36105
36106 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36107 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36108 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36109 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36110 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36111 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36112 @value{GDBN} session.
36113
36114 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36115 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36116
36117 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36118
36119 @smallexample
36120 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36121 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36122 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36123 debugging may prove unreliable.
36124 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36125 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36126 (@value{GDBP})
36127 @end smallexample
36128
36129 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36130 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36131 @cindex demangler crashes
36132
36133 @kindex maint set internal-error
36134 @kindex maint show internal-error
36135 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36136 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36137 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36138 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36139 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36140 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36141 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36142 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36143 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36144 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36145 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36146 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36147 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36148 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36149 described in the table below.
36150
36151 @table @samp
36152 @item quit
36153 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36154 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36155
36156 @item corefile
36157 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36158 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36159 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36160 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36161 disabled.
36162 @end table
36163
36164 @kindex maint packet
36165 @item maint packet @var{text}
36166 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36167 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36168 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36169 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36170 checksum.
36171
36172 @kindex maint print architecture
36173 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36174 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36175 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36176
36177 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36178 @item maint print c-tdesc
36179 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36180 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36181 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36182 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36183 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36184 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36185 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36186 modify XML target descriptions.
36187
36188 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36189 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36190 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36191 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36192
36193 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36194 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36195 @item maint check libthread-db
36196 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36197 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36198 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36199 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36200 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36201 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36202
36203 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36204 @item maint print dummy-frames
36205 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36206
36207 @smallexample
36208 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36209 @dots{}
36210 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36211 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36212 58 return (a + b);
36213 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36214 @dots{}
36215 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36216 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36217 (@value{GDBP})
36218 @end smallexample
36219
36220 Takes an optional file parameter.
36221
36222 @kindex maint print registers
36223 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36224 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36225 @kindex maint print register-groups
36226 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36227 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36228 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36229 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36230 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36231 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36232 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36233
36234 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36235 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36236 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36237 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36238 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36239 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36240 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36241 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36242
36243 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36244 write the information.
36245
36246 @kindex maint print reggroups
36247 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36248 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36249 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36250 information.
36251
36252 The register groups info looks like this:
36253
36254 @smallexample
36255 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36256 Group Type
36257 general user
36258 float user
36259 all user
36260 vector user
36261 system user
36262 save internal
36263 restore internal
36264 @end smallexample
36265
36266 @kindex flushregs
36267 @item flushregs
36268 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36269
36270 @kindex maint print objfiles
36271 @cindex info for known object files
36272 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36273 Print a dump of all known object files.
36274 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36275 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36276 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36277
36278 @kindex maint print user-registers
36279 @cindex user registers
36280 @item maint print user-registers
36281 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36282 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36283 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36284 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36285 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36286 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36287 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36288
36289 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36290 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36291 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36292 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36293 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36294 matching @var{regexp}.
36295 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36296 and the full path if known.
36297 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36298
36299 @kindex maint print statistics
36300 @cindex bcache statistics
36301 @item maint print statistics
36302 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36303 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36304 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36305 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36306 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36307 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36308 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36309 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36310 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36311 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36312 lengths.
36313
36314 @kindex maint print target-stack
36315 @cindex target stack description
36316 @item maint print target-stack
36317 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36318 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36319 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36320 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36321 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36322 address.
36323
36324 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36325 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36326
36327 @kindex maint print type
36328 @cindex type chain of a data type
36329 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36330 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36331 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36332 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36333 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36334 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36335
36336 @kindex maint selftest
36337 @cindex self tests
36338 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36339 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36340 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36341 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36342 name will by ran.
36343
36344 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36345 @cindex self tests
36346 @item maint info selftests
36347 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36348
36349 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36350 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36351 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36352 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36353 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36354 information.
36355
36356 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36357 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36358 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36359 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36360 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36361 always see the disassembly form.
36362
36363 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36364
36365 @smallexample
36366 (gdb) info addr argc
36367 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36368 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36369 @end smallexample
36370
36371 For more information on these expressions, see
36372 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36373
36374 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36375 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36376 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36377 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36378 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36379
36380 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36381 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36382 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36383 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36384 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36385 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36386 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36387 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36388 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36389
36390 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36391 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36392 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36393 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36394 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36395
36396 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36397 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36398 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36399 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36400 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36401 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36402
36403 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36404 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36405 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36406
36407 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36408 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36409 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36410 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36411
36412 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36413 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36414 @kindex maint set profile
36415 @kindex maint show profile
36416 @cindex profiling GDB
36417 @item maint set profile
36418 @itemx maint show profile
36419 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36420
36421 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36422 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36423 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36424 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36425 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36426 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36427 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36428
36429 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36430 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36431
36432 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36433 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36434 @cindex hardware debug registers
36435 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36436 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36437 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36438 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36439 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36440 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36441 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36442
36443 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36444 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36445 @item maint set show-all-tib
36446 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36447 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36448 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36449 command.
36450
36451 @kindex maint set target-async
36452 @kindex maint show target-async
36453 @item maint set target-async
36454 @itemx maint show target-async
36455 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36456 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36457 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36458 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36459
36460 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36461 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36462 @item maint set target-non-stop
36463 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36464
36465 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36466 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36467 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36468 if supported by the target.
36469
36470 @table @code
36471 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36472 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36473 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36474
36475 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36476 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36477 does not indicate support.
36478
36479 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36480 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36481 target supports it.
36482 @end table
36483
36484 @kindex maint set per-command
36485 @kindex maint show per-command
36486 @item maint set per-command
36487 @itemx maint show per-command
36488 @cindex resources used by commands
36489
36490 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36491 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36492
36493 @table @code
36494 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36495 @itemx maint show per-command space
36496 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36497 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36498 took, following the command's own output.
36499 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36500 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36501
36502 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36503 @itemx maint show per-command time
36504 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36505 for each command.
36506 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36507 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36508 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36509 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36510 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36511 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36512 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36513 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36514 spent by the program been debugged.
36515 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36516 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36517
36518 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36519 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36520 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36521 for each command.
36522 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36523
36524 @enumerate a
36525 @item
36526 number of symbol tables
36527 @item
36528 number of primary symbol tables
36529 @item
36530 number of blocks in the blockvector
36531 @end enumerate
36532 @end table
36533
36534 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36535 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36536 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36537 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36538 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36539 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36540 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36541 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36542 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36543 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36544
36545 @kindex maint space
36546 @cindex memory used by commands
36547 @item maint space @var{value}
36548 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36549 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36550
36551 @kindex maint time
36552 @cindex time of command execution
36553 @item maint time @var{value}
36554 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36555 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36556
36557 @kindex maint translate-address
36558 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36559 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36560 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36561 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36562 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36563 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36564 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36565
36566 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36567 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36568 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36569
36570 @end table
36571
36572 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36573 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36574
36575 @table @code
36576 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36577 @kindex set watchdog
36578 @cindex watchdog timer
36579 @cindex timeout for commands
36580 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36581 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36582 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36583
36584 @item show watchdog
36585 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36586 @end table
36587
36588 @node Remote Protocol
36589 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36590
36591 @menu
36592 * Overview::
36593 * Packets::
36594 * Stop Reply Packets::
36595 * General Query Packets::
36596 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36597 * Tracepoint Packets::
36598 * Host I/O Packets::
36599 * Interrupts::
36600 * Notification Packets::
36601 * Remote Non-Stop::
36602 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36603 * Examples::
36604 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36605 * Library List Format::
36606 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36607 * Memory Map Format::
36608 * Thread List Format::
36609 * Traceframe Info Format::
36610 * Branch Trace Format::
36611 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36612 @end menu
36613
36614 @node Overview
36615 @section Overview
36616
36617 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36618 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36619 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36620 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36621
36622 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36623 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36624
36625 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36626 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36627 @cindex remote serial protocol
36628 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36629 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36630 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36631 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36632 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36633
36634 @smallexample
36635 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36636 @end smallexample
36637 @noindent
36638
36639 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36640 @noindent
36641 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36642 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36643 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36644
36645 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36646 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36647
36648 @smallexample
36649 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36650 @end smallexample
36651
36652 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36653 @noindent
36654 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36655 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36656 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36657
36658 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36659 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36660 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36661 retransmission):
36662
36663 @smallexample
36664 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36665 <- @code{+}
36666 @end smallexample
36667 @noindent
36668
36669 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36670 once a connection is established.
36671 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36672
36673 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36674 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36675 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36676 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36677 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36678 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36679 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36680
36681 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36682 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36683 exceptions).
36684
36685 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36686 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36687 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36688 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36689
36690 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36691 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36692 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36693
36694 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36695 @anchor{Binary Data}
36696 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36697 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36698 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36699 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36700 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36701 binary data.
36702
36703 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36704 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36705 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36706 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36707 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36708 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36709 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36710 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36711 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36712 (described next).
36713
36714 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36715 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36716 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36717 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36718 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36719 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36720 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36721 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36722 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36723 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36724 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36725 3}} more times.
36726
36727 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36728 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36729 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36730 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36731 @samp{0*"00}.
36732
36733 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36734 error number. That number is not well defined.
36735
36736 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36737 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36738 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36739 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36740 on that response.
36741
36742 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36743 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36744 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36745 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36746 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36747 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36748
36749 @node Packets
36750 @section Packets
36751
36752 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36753 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36754 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36755 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36756
36757 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36758 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36759 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36760 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36761 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36762 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36763 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36764 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36765 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36766 @var{baz}.
36767
36768 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36769 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36770 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36771 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36772 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36773 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36774 pick any thread.
36775
36776 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36777 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36778 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36779 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36780 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36781 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36782 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36783 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36784 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36785 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36786 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36787 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36788 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36789
36790 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36791 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36792 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36793 more information.
36794
36795 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36796 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36797
36798 Here are the packet descriptions.
36799
36800 @table @samp
36801
36802 @item !
36803 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36804 @anchor{extended mode}
36805 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36806 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36807 debugged.
36808
36809 Reply:
36810 @table @samp
36811 @item OK
36812 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36813 @end table
36814
36815 @item ?
36816 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36817 @anchor{? packet}
36818 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36819 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36820 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36821
36822 Reply:
36823 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36824
36825 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36826 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36827 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36828 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36829 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36830
36831 Reply:
36832 @table @samp
36833 @item OK
36834 The arguments were set.
36835 @item E @var{NN}
36836 An error occurred.
36837 @end table
36838
36839 @item b @var{baud}
36840 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36841 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36842 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36843
36844 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36845 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36846 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36847
36848 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36849 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36850 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36851 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36852 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36853
36854 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36855 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36856 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36857 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36858
36859 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36860 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36861
36862 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36863 @anchor{bc}
36864 @item bc
36865 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36866 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36867
36868 Reply:
36869 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36870
36871 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36872 @anchor{bs}
36873 @item bs
36874 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36875 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36876
36877 Reply:
36878 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36879
36880 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36881 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36882 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36883 is omitted, resume at current address.
36884
36885 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36886 packet}.
36887
36888 Reply:
36889 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36890
36891 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36892 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36893 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36894 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36895
36896 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36897 packet}.
36898
36899 Reply:
36900 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36901
36902 @item d
36903 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36904 Toggle debug flag.
36905
36906 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36907 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36908
36909 @item D
36910 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36911 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36912 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36913 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36914 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36915
36916 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36917 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36918 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36919 big-endian hex string.
36920
36921 Reply:
36922 @table @samp
36923 @item OK
36924 for success
36925 @item E @var{NN}
36926 for an error
36927 @end table
36928
36929 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36930 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36931 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36932 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36933 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36934
36935 @item g
36936 @anchor{read registers packet}
36937 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36938 Read general registers.
36939
36940 Reply:
36941 @table @samp
36942 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36943 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36944 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36945 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36946 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36947 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36948
36949 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36950 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36951 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36952 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36953 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36954 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36955 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
36956 have been collected, and both have zero value:
36957
36958 @smallexample
36959 -> @code{g}
36960 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
36961 @end smallexample
36962
36963 @item E @var{NN}
36964 for an error.
36965 @end table
36966
36967 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
36968 @cindex @samp{G} packet
36969 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
36970 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
36971
36972 Reply:
36973 @table @samp
36974 @item OK
36975 for success
36976 @item E @var{NN}
36977 for an error
36978 @end table
36979
36980 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
36981 @cindex @samp{H} packet
36982 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
36983 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
36984 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
36985 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
36986 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
36987 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
36988 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36989
36990 Reply:
36991 @table @samp
36992 @item OK
36993 for success
36994 @item E @var{NN}
36995 for an error
36996 @end table
36997
36998 @c FIXME: JTC:
36999 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37000 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37001 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37002 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37003 @c described. For example:
37004 @c
37005 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37006 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37007 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37008 @c
37009 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37010 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37011 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37012
37013 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37014 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37015 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37016 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37017 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37018 step starting at that address.
37019
37020 @item I
37021 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37022 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37023 step packet}.
37024
37025 @item k
37026 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37027 Kill request.
37028
37029 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37030
37031 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37032 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37033
37034 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37035
37036 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37037 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37038 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37039
37040 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37041 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37042 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37043
37044 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37045 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37046 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37047 (@pxref{? packet}).
37048
37049 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37050 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37051 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37052 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37053 any particular boundary.
37054
37055 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37056 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37057 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37058 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37059 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37060 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37061 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37062 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37063
37064 Reply:
37065 @table @samp
37066 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37067 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37068 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37069 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37070 @item E @var{NN}
37071 @var{NN} is errno
37072 @end table
37073
37074 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37075 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37076 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37077 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37078 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37079
37080 Reply:
37081 @table @samp
37082 @item OK
37083 for success
37084 @item E @var{NN}
37085 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37086 written).
37087 @end table
37088
37089 @item p @var{n}
37090 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37091 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37092 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37093 register value is encoded.
37094
37095 Reply:
37096 @table @samp
37097 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37098 the register's value
37099 @item E @var{NN}
37100 for an error
37101 @item @w{}
37102 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37103 @end table
37104
37105 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37106 @anchor{write register packet}
37107 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37108 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37109 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37110 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37111
37112 Reply:
37113 @table @samp
37114 @item OK
37115 for success
37116 @item E @var{NN}
37117 for an error
37118 @end table
37119
37120 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37121 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37122 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37123 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37124 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37125 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37126
37127 @item r
37128 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37129 Reset the entire system.
37130
37131 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37132
37133 @item R @var{XX}
37134 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37135 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37136 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37137
37138 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37139
37140 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37141 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37142 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37143 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37144
37145 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37146 packet}.
37147
37148 Reply:
37149 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37150
37151 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37152 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37153 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37154 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37155 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37156
37157 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37158 packet}.
37159
37160 Reply:
37161 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37162
37163 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37164 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37165 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37166 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37167 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37168
37169 @item T @var{thread-id}
37170 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37171 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37172
37173 Reply:
37174 @table @samp
37175 @item OK
37176 thread is still alive
37177 @item E @var{NN}
37178 thread is dead
37179 @end table
37180
37181 @item v
37182 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37183 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37184
37185 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37186 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37187 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37188 The process ID is a
37189 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37190 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37191 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37192
37193 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37194 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37195 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37196 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37197 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37198 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37199 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37200 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37201
37202 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37203
37204 Reply:
37205 @table @samp
37206 @item E @var{nn}
37207 for an error
37208 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37209 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37210 @item OK
37211 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37212 @end table
37213
37214 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37215 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37216 @anchor{vCont packet}
37217 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37218
37219 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37220 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37221 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37222 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37223 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37224 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37225 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37226 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37227 error.
37228
37229 Currently supported actions are:
37230
37231 @table @samp
37232 @item c
37233 Continue.
37234 @item C @var{sig}
37235 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37236 @item s
37237 Step.
37238 @item S @var{sig}
37239 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37240 @item t
37241 Stop.
37242 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37243 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37244 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37245 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37246 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37247 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37248
37249 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37250 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37251 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37252 jumps to @var{start}).
37253
37254 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37255 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37256 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37257
37258 @end table
37259
37260 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37261 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37262 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37263
37264 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37265 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37266 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37267 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37268 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37269 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37270 as an implementation detail.
37271
37272 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37273 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37274 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37275 stopped.
37276
37277 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37278 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37279 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37280
37281 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37282 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37283
37284 Reply:
37285 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37286
37287 @item vCont?
37288 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37289 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37290
37291 Reply:
37292 @table @samp
37293 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37294 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37295 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37296 @item @w{}
37297 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37298 @end table
37299
37300 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37301 @item vCtrlC
37302 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37303 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37304 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37305 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37306 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37307 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37308 variant.
37309
37310 Reply:
37311 @table @samp
37312 @item E @var{nn}
37313 for an error
37314 @item OK
37315 for success
37316 @end table
37317
37318 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37319 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37320 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37321 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37322
37323 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37324 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37325 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37326 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37327 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37328 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37329 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37330 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37331 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37332 packet is received.
37333
37334 Reply:
37335 @table @samp
37336 @item OK
37337 for success
37338 @item E @var{NN}
37339 for an error
37340 @end table
37341
37342 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37343 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37344 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37345 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37346 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37347 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37348 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37349 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37350 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37351 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37352 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37353 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37354
37355
37356 Reply:
37357 @table @samp
37358 @item OK
37359 for success
37360 @item E.memtype
37361 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37362 @item E @var{NN}
37363 for an error
37364 @end table
37365
37366 @item vFlashDone
37367 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37368 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37369 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37370 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37371 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37372 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37373 request is completed.
37374
37375 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37376 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37377 @anchor{vKill packet}
37378 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37379 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37380 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37381 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37382
37383 Reply:
37384 @table @samp
37385 @item E @var{nn}
37386 for an error
37387 @item OK
37388 for success
37389 @end table
37390
37391 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37392 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37393 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37394 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37395 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37396
37397 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37398 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37399 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37400 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37401 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37402 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37403
37404 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37405 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37406 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37407 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37408 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37409 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37410 state.
37411
37412 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37413
37414 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37415
37416 Reply:
37417 @table @samp
37418 @item E @var{nn}
37419 for an error
37420 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37421 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37422 @end table
37423
37424 @item vStopped
37425 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37426 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37427
37428 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37429 @anchor{X packet}
37430 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37431 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37432 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37433 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37434 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37435
37436 Reply:
37437 @table @samp
37438 @item OK
37439 for success
37440 @item E @var{NN}
37441 for an error
37442 @end table
37443
37444 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37445 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37446 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37447 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37448 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37449 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37450 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37451
37452 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37453 separately.
37454
37455 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37456 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37457 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37458 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37459 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37460 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37461
37462 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37463 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37464 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37465 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37466 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37467 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37468
37469 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37470 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37471 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37472 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37473 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37474 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37475 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37476 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37477 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37478 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37479 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37480 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37481 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37482
37483 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37484 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37485
37486 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37487 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37488
37489 @table @samp
37490
37491 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37492 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37493 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37494
37495 @end table
37496
37497 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37498 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37499 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37500 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37501 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37502 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37503 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37504
37505 @table @samp
37506
37507 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37508 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37509 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37510
37511 @end table
37512
37513 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37514 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37515 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37516 target, is not defined.}
37517
37518 Reply:
37519 @table @samp
37520 @item OK
37521 success
37522 @item @w{}
37523 not supported
37524 @item E @var{NN}
37525 for an error
37526 @end table
37527
37528 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37529 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37530 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37531 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37532 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37533 address @var{addr}.
37534
37535 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37536 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37537 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37538 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37539
37540 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37541 movement.}
37542
37543 Reply:
37544 @table @samp
37545 @item OK
37546 success
37547 @item @w{}
37548 not supported
37549 @item E @var{NN}
37550 for an error
37551 @end table
37552
37553 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37554 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37555 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37556 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37557 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37558 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37559
37560 Reply:
37561 @table @samp
37562 @item OK
37563 success
37564 @item @w{}
37565 not supported
37566 @item E @var{NN}
37567 for an error
37568 @end table
37569
37570 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37571 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37572 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37573 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37574 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37575 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37576
37577 Reply:
37578 @table @samp
37579 @item OK
37580 success
37581 @item @w{}
37582 not supported
37583 @item E @var{NN}
37584 for an error
37585 @end table
37586
37587 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37588 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37589 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37590 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37591 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37592 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37593
37594 Reply:
37595 @table @samp
37596 @item OK
37597 success
37598 @item @w{}
37599 not supported
37600 @item E @var{NN}
37601 for an error
37602 @end table
37603
37604 @end table
37605
37606 @node Stop Reply Packets
37607 @section Stop Reply Packets
37608 @cindex stop reply packets
37609
37610 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37611 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37612 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37613 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37614 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37615 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37616 @value{GDBN} source code.
37617
37618 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37619 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37620 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37621
37622 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37623 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37624 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37625 components.
37626
37627 @table @samp
37628
37629 @item S @var{AA}
37630 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37631 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37632 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37633
37634 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37635 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37636 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37637 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37638 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37639 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37640 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37641 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37642
37643 @itemize @bullet
37644 @item
37645 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37646 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37647 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37648 two-digit hex number.
37649
37650 @item
37651 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37652 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37653
37654 @item
37655 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37656 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37657
37658 @item
37659 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37660 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37661 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37662 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37663
37664 @item
37665 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37666 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37667 future.
37668 @end itemize
37669
37670 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37671
37672 @table @samp
37673 @item watch
37674 @itemx rwatch
37675 @itemx awatch
37676 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37677 hex.
37678
37679 @item syscall_entry
37680 @itemx syscall_return
37681 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37682 syscall number, in hex.
37683
37684 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37685 @item library
37686 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37687 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37688 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37689
37690 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37691 @item replaylog
37692 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37693 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37694 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37695 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37696 for more information.
37697
37698 @item swbreak
37699 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37700 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37701 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37702 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37703 part must be left empty.
37704
37705 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37706 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37707 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37708 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37709 address.
37710
37711 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37712 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37713 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37714 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37715 indicating support.
37716
37717 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37718
37719 @item hwbreak
37720 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37721 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37722
37723 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37724 apply.
37725
37726 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37727 @item fork
37728 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37729 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37730 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37731 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37732 fork events.
37733
37734 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37735 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37736 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37737 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37738 indicating support.
37739
37740 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37741 @item vfork
37742 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37743 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37744 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37745 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37746 vfork events.
37747
37748 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37749 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37750 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37751 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37752 indicating support.
37753
37754 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37755 @item vforkdone
37756 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37757 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37758 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37759 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37760 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37761
37762 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37763 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37764 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37765 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37766 indicating support.
37767
37768 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37769 @item exec
37770 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37771 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37772 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37773
37774 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37775 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37776 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37777 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37778 indicating support.
37779
37780 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37781 @anchor{thread create event}
37782 @item create
37783 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37784 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37785 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37786 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37787 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37788 @var{r} part is ignored.
37789
37790 @end table
37791
37792 @item W @var{AA}
37793 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37794 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37795 applicable to certain targets.
37796
37797 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37798 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37799 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37800 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37801 hex strings.
37802
37803 @item X @var{AA}
37804 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37805 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37806
37807 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37808 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37809 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37810 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37811 hex strings.
37812
37813 @anchor{thread exit event}
37814 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37815 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37816
37817 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37818 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37819 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37820 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37821
37822 @item N
37823 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37824 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37825 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37826 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37827 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37828 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37829 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37830 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37831 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37832 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37833 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37834 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37835 support.
37836
37837 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37838 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37839 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37840 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37841 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37842
37843 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37844 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37845 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37846 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37847 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37848 system calls.
37849
37850 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37851 this very system call.
37852
37853 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37854 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37855 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37856 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37857 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37858 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37859
37860 @end table
37861
37862 @node General Query Packets
37863 @section General Query Packets
37864 @cindex remote query requests
37865
37866 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37867 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37868 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37869 sending information to and from the stub.
37870
37871 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37872 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37873 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37874 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37875 conventions:
37876
37877 @itemize @bullet
37878 @item
37879 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37880 @item
37881 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37882 letter.
37883 @item
37884 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37885 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37886 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37887 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37888 @end itemize
37889
37890 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37891 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37892 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37893 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37894 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37895 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37896 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37897 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37898 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37899 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37900 packet.}.
37901
37902 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37903 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37904 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37905 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37906 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37907
37908 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37909
37910 @table @samp
37911
37912 @item QAgent:1
37913 @itemx QAgent:0
37914 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37915 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37916
37917 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37918 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37919 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37920 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37921 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37922 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37923 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37924 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37925 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37926 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37927 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37928
37929 @item qC
37930 @cindex current thread, remote request
37931 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37932 Return the current thread ID.
37933
37934 Reply:
37935 @table @samp
37936 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37937 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37938 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37939 @item @r{(anything else)}
37940 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37941 @end table
37942
37943 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37944 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37945 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37946 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37947 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37948 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37949 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37950 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37951
37952 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37953 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37954 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37955 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
37956 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
37957 detect trailing zeros.
37958
37959 Reply:
37960 @table @samp
37961 @item E @var{NN}
37962 An error (such as memory fault)
37963 @item C @var{crc32}
37964 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
37965 @end table
37966
37967 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
37968 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
37969 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
37970 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
37971 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
37972 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
37973 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
37974 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
37975 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
37976 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
37977 randomization.
37978
37979 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37980
37981 Reply:
37982 @table @samp
37983 @item OK
37984 The request succeeded.
37985
37986 @item E @var{nn}
37987 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37988
37989 @item @w{}
37990 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
37991 by the stub.
37992 @end table
37993
37994 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37995 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37996 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
37997 address space randomization.
37998
37999 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38000 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38001 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38002 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38003 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38004 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38005 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38006 inferior using a shell or not.
38007
38008 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38009 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38010 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38011 values are considered an error.
38012
38013 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38014 mode}).
38015
38016 Reply:
38017 @table @samp
38018 @item OK
38019 The request succeeded.
38020
38021 @item E @var{nn}
38022 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38023 @end table
38024
38025 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38026 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38027 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38028 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38029
38030 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38031 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38032
38033 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38034 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38035 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38036 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38037 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38038 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38039 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38040 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38041 environment}).
38042
38043 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38044 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38045 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38046 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38047 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38048 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38049 not be present.
38050
38051 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38052 mode}).
38053
38054 Reply:
38055 @table @samp
38056 @item OK
38057 The request succeeded.
38058 @end table
38059
38060 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38061 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38062 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38063 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38064 inferior.
38065
38066 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38067 @pxref{set environment}.
38068
38069 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38070 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38071 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38072 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38073 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38074 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38075 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38076 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38077
38078 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38079 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38080
38081 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38082 mode}).
38083
38084 Reply:
38085 @table @samp
38086 @item OK
38087 The request succeeded.
38088 @end table
38089
38090 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38091 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38092 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38093 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38094 inferior.
38095
38096 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38097 @pxref{unset environment}.
38098
38099 @item QEnvironmentReset
38100 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38101 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38102 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38103 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38104 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38105 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38106 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38107 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38108 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38109 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38110 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38111
38112 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38113 mode}).
38114
38115 Reply:
38116 @table @samp
38117 @item OK
38118 The request succeeded.
38119 @end table
38120
38121 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38122 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38123 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38124 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38125 inferior.
38126
38127 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38128 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38129 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38130 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38131 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38132 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38133
38134 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38135 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38136 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38137 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38138 directory to its original, empty value.
38139
38140 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38141 mode}).
38142
38143 Reply:
38144 @table @samp
38145 @item OK
38146 The request succeeded.
38147 @end table
38148
38149 @item qfThreadInfo
38150 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38151 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38152 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38153 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38154 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38155 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38156 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38157 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38158 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38159 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38160
38161 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38162
38163 Reply:
38164 @table @samp
38165 @item m @var{thread-id}
38166 A single thread ID
38167 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38168 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38169 @item l
38170 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38171 @end table
38172
38173 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38174 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38175 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38176 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38177 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38178 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38179 fields.
38180
38181 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38182 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38183 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38184 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38185 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38186
38187 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38188 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38189 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38190 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38191 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38192
38193 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38194 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38195
38196 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38197 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38198 information associated with the variable.)
38199
38200 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38201 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38202 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38203 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38204 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38205 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38206
38207 Reply:
38208 @table @samp
38209 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38210 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38211 local storage requested.
38212
38213 @item E @var{nn}
38214 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38215
38216 @item @w{}
38217 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38218 @end table
38219
38220 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38221 @cindex get thread information block address
38222 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38223 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38224
38225 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38226
38227 Reply:
38228 @table @samp
38229 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38230 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38231 thread information block.
38232
38233 @item E @var{nn}
38234 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38235 address could not be retrieved.
38236
38237 @item @w{}
38238 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38239 @end table
38240
38241 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38242 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38243 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38244 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38245 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38246 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38247 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38248
38249 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38250
38251 Reply:
38252 @table @samp
38253 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38254 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38255 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38256 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38257 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38258 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38259 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38260 @end table
38261
38262 @item qOffsets
38263 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38264 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38265 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38266 image.
38267
38268 Reply:
38269 @table @samp
38270 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38271 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38272 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38273 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38274 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38275 segments by the supplied offsets.
38276
38277 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38278 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38279 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38280
38281 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38282 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38283 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38284 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38285 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38286 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38287 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38288 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38289 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38290 @end table
38291
38292 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38293 @cindex thread information, remote request
38294 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38295 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38296 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38297 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38298
38299 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38300 (see below).
38301
38302 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38303
38304 @item QNonStop:1
38305 @itemx QNonStop:0
38306 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38307 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38308 @anchor{QNonStop}
38309 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38310 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38311
38312 Reply:
38313 @table @samp
38314 @item OK
38315 The request succeeded.
38316
38317 @item E @var{nn}
38318 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38319
38320 @item @w{}
38321 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38322 the stub.
38323 @end table
38324
38325 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38326 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38327 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38328 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38329
38330 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38331 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38332 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38333 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38334 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38335 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38336 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38337
38338 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38339 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38340 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38341
38342 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38343 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38344 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38345 report the requested syscalls.
38346
38347 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38348 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38349
38350 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38351 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38352 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38353 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38354
38355 Reply:
38356 @table @samp
38357 @item OK
38358 The request succeeded.
38359
38360 @item E @var{nn}
38361 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38362
38363 @item @w{}
38364 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38365 the stub.
38366 @end table
38367
38368 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38369 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38370 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38371 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38372
38373 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38374 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38375 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38376 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38377 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38378 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38379 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38380 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38381 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38382 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38383 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38384 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38385 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38386
38387 Reply:
38388 @table @samp
38389 @item OK
38390 The request succeeded.
38391
38392 @item E @var{nn}
38393 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38394
38395 @item @w{}
38396 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38397 the stub.
38398 @end table
38399
38400 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38401 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38402 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38403 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38404
38405 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38406 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38407 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38408 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38409 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38410 Others should be silently discarded.
38411
38412 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38413 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38414 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38415 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38416 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38417 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38418 signals.
38419
38420 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38421 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38422
38423 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38424 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38425 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38426 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38427 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38428
38429 Reply:
38430 @table @samp
38431 @item OK
38432 The request succeeded.
38433
38434 @item E @var{nn}
38435 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38436
38437 @item @w{}
38438 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38439 by the stub.
38440 @end table
38441
38442 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38443 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38444 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38445 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38446
38447 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38448 @item QThreadEvents:1
38449 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38450 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38451 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38452
38453 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38454 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38455 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38456 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38457 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38458 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38459 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38460 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38461 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38462 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38463
38464 Reply:
38465 @table @samp
38466 @item OK
38467 The request succeeded.
38468
38469 @item E @var{nn}
38470 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38471
38472 @item @w{}
38473 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38474 the stub.
38475 @end table
38476
38477 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38478 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38479
38480 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38481 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38482 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38483 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38484 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38485 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38486 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38487 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38488 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38489
38490 Reply:
38491 @table @samp
38492 @item OK
38493 A command response with no output.
38494 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38495 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38496 @item E @var{NN}
38497 Indicate a badly formed request.
38498 @item @w{}
38499 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38500 @end table
38501
38502 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38503 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38504 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38505 packets.)
38506
38507 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38508 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38509 @ifnotinfo
38510 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38511 @end ifnotinfo
38512 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38513 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38514 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38515 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38516 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38517
38518 Reply:
38519 @table @samp
38520 @item 0
38521 The pattern was not found.
38522 @item 1,address
38523 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38524 @item E @var{NN}
38525 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38526 @item @w{}
38527 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38528 @end table
38529
38530 @item QStartNoAckMode
38531 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38532 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38533 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38534 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38535
38536 Reply:
38537 @table @samp
38538 @item OK
38539 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38540 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38541 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38542 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38543 @item @w{}
38544 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38545 @end table
38546
38547 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38548 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38549 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38550 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38551 @anchor{qSupported}
38552 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38553 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38554 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38555 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38556 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38557 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38558 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38559 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38560 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38561 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38562 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38563 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38564 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38565 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38566
38567 Reply:
38568 @table @samp
38569 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38570 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38571 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38572 possible forms).
38573 @item @w{}
38574 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38575 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38576 @end table
38577
38578 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38579 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38580 are:
38581
38582 @table @samp
38583 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38584 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38585 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38586 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38587 @item @var{name}+
38588 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38589 need an associated value.
38590 @item @var{name}-
38591 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38592 @item @var{name}?
38593 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38594 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38595 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38596 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38597 @end table
38598
38599 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38600 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38601 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38602 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38603 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38604
38605 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38606 are defined:
38607
38608 @table @samp
38609 @item multiprocess
38610 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38611 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38612 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38613 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38614 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38615
38616 @item xmlRegisters
38617 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38618 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38619 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38620 description.
38621
38622 @item qRelocInsn
38623 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38624 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38625 instruction reply packet}).
38626
38627 @item swbreak
38628 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38629 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38630
38631 @item hwbreak
38632 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38633 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38634
38635 @item fork-events
38636 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38637 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38638 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38639 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38640
38641 @item vfork-events
38642 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38643 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38644 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38645 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38646
38647 @item exec-events
38648 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38649 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38650 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38651 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38652
38653 @item vContSupported
38654 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38655 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38656 @end table
38657
38658 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38659 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38660 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38661 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38662 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38663 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38664 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38665 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38666 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38667 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38668 all the features it supports.
38669
38670 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38671 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38672
38673 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38674 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38675 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38676 form response.
38677
38678 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38679 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38680 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38681 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38682
38683 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38684 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38685 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38686 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38687 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38688
38689 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38690
38691 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38692 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38693 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38694 @item Feature Name
38695 @tab Value Required
38696 @tab Default
38697 @tab Probe Allowed
38698
38699 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38700 @tab Yes
38701 @tab @samp{-}
38702 @tab No
38703
38704 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38705 @tab No
38706 @tab @samp{-}
38707 @tab Yes
38708
38709 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38710 @tab No
38711 @tab @samp{-}
38712 @tab Yes
38713
38714 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38715 @tab No
38716 @tab @samp{-}
38717 @tab Yes
38718
38719 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38720 @tab No
38721 @tab @samp{-}
38722 @tab Yes
38723
38724 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38725 @tab No
38726 @tab @samp{-}
38727 @tab Yes
38728
38729 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38730 @tab No
38731 @tab @samp{-}
38732 @tab Yes
38733
38734 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38735 @tab No
38736 @tab @samp{-}
38737 @tab Yes
38738
38739 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38740 @tab No
38741 @tab @samp{-}
38742 @tab No
38743
38744 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38745 @tab No
38746 @tab @samp{-}
38747 @tab Yes
38748
38749 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38750 @tab No
38751 @tab @samp{-}
38752 @tab Yes
38753
38754 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38755 @tab No
38756 @tab @samp{-}
38757 @tab Yes
38758
38759 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38760 @tab No
38761 @tab @samp{-}
38762 @tab Yes
38763
38764 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38765 @tab No
38766 @tab @samp{-}
38767 @tab Yes
38768
38769 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38770 @tab No
38771 @tab @samp{-}
38772 @tab Yes
38773
38774 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38775 @tab No
38776 @tab @samp{-}
38777 @tab Yes
38778
38779 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38780 @tab No
38781 @tab @samp{-}
38782 @tab Yes
38783
38784 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38785 @tab No
38786 @tab @samp{-}
38787 @tab Yes
38788
38789 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38790 @tab No
38791 @tab @samp{-}
38792 @tab Yes
38793
38794 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38795 @tab Yes
38796 @tab @samp{-}
38797 @tab Yes
38798
38799 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38800 @tab Yes
38801 @tab @samp{-}
38802 @tab Yes
38803
38804 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38805 @tab Yes
38806 @tab @samp{-}
38807 @tab Yes
38808
38809 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38810 @tab Yes
38811 @tab @samp{-}
38812 @tab Yes
38813
38814 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38815 @tab Yes
38816 @tab @samp{-}
38817 @tab Yes
38818
38819 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38820 @tab No
38821 @tab @samp{-}
38822 @tab Yes
38823
38824 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38825 @tab No
38826 @tab @samp{-}
38827 @tab Yes
38828
38829 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38830 @tab No
38831 @tab @samp{-}
38832 @tab Yes
38833
38834 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38835 @tab No
38836 @tab @samp{-}
38837 @tab Yes
38838
38839 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38840 @tab No
38841 @tab @samp{-}
38842 @tab No
38843
38844 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38845 @tab No
38846 @tab @samp{-}
38847 @tab No
38848
38849 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38850 @tab No
38851 @tab @samp{-}
38852 @tab No
38853
38854 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38855 @tab No
38856 @tab @samp{-}
38857 @tab No
38858
38859 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38860 @tab No
38861 @tab @samp{-}
38862 @tab No
38863
38864 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38865 @tab No
38866 @tab @samp{-}
38867 @tab No
38868
38869 @item @samp{QAgent}
38870 @tab No
38871 @tab @samp{-}
38872 @tab No
38873
38874 @item @samp{QAllow}
38875 @tab No
38876 @tab @samp{-}
38877 @tab No
38878
38879 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38880 @tab No
38881 @tab @samp{-}
38882 @tab No
38883
38884 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38885 @tab No
38886 @tab @samp{-}
38887 @tab No
38888
38889 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38890 @tab No
38891 @tab @samp{-}
38892 @tab No
38893
38894 @item @samp{tracenz}
38895 @tab No
38896 @tab @samp{-}
38897 @tab No
38898
38899 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38900 @tab No
38901 @tab @samp{-}
38902 @tab No
38903
38904 @item @samp{swbreak}
38905 @tab No
38906 @tab @samp{-}
38907 @tab No
38908
38909 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38910 @tab No
38911 @tab @samp{-}
38912 @tab No
38913
38914 @item @samp{fork-events}
38915 @tab No
38916 @tab @samp{-}
38917 @tab No
38918
38919 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38920 @tab No
38921 @tab @samp{-}
38922 @tab No
38923
38924 @item @samp{exec-events}
38925 @tab No
38926 @tab @samp{-}
38927 @tab No
38928
38929 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38930 @tab No
38931 @tab @samp{-}
38932 @tab No
38933
38934 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38935 @tab No
38936 @tab @samp{-}
38937 @tab No
38938
38939 @end multitable
38940
38941 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38942
38943 @table @samp
38944 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38945 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38946 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38947 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38948 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38949 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38950 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38951 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38952 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38953 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38954
38955 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38956 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38957 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38958
38959 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38960 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38961 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38962
38963 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
38964 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38965 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
38966
38967 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
38968 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
38969 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
38970
38971 @item qXfer:features:read
38972 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38973 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38974
38975 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38976 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38977 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38978
38979 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38980 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38981 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38982
38983 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
38984 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
38985 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38986 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38987
38988 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38989 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38990 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38991
38992 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38993 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38994 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38995
38996 @item qXfer:spu:read
38997 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38998 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38999
39000 @item qXfer:spu:write
39001 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39002 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39003
39004 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39005 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39006 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39007
39008 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39009 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39010 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39011
39012 @item qXfer:threads:read
39013 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39014 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39015
39016 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39017 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39018 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39019
39020 @item qXfer:uib:read
39021 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39022 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39023
39024 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39025 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39026 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39027
39028 @item QNonStop
39029 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39030 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39031
39032 @item QCatchSyscalls
39033 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39034 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39035
39036 @item QPassSignals
39037 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39038 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39039
39040 @item QStartNoAckMode
39041 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39042 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39043
39044 @item multiprocess
39045 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39046 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39047 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39048 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39049 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39050 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39051 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39052 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39053 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39054 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39055 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39056
39057 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39058 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39059 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39060
39061 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39062 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39063 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39064 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39065
39066 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39067 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39068 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39069
39070 @item ReverseContinue
39071 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39072 (@pxref{bc}).
39073
39074 @item ReverseStep
39075 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39076 (@pxref{bs}).
39077
39078 @item TracepointSource
39079 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39080 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39081
39082 @item QAgent
39083 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39084
39085 @item QAllow
39086 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39087
39088 @item QDisableRandomization
39089 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39090
39091 @item StaticTracepoint
39092 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39093 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39094
39095 @item InstallInTrace
39096 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39097 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39098
39099 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39100 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39101 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39102 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39103
39104 @item QTBuffer:size
39105 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39106 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39107
39108 @item tracenz
39109 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39110 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39111 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39112
39113 @item BreakpointCommands
39114 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39115 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39116 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39117
39118 @item Qbtrace:off
39119 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39120
39121 @item Qbtrace:bts
39122 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39123
39124 @item Qbtrace:pt
39125 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39126
39127 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39128 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39129
39130 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39131 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39132
39133 @item swbreak
39134 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39135 breakpoints.
39136
39137 @item hwbreak
39138 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39139 breakpoints.
39140
39141 @item fork-events
39142 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39143
39144 @item vfork-events
39145 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39146 and vforkdone events.
39147
39148 @item exec-events
39149 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39150
39151 @item vContSupported
39152 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39153 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39154
39155 @item QThreadEvents
39156 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39157
39158 @item no-resumed
39159 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39160
39161 @end table
39162
39163 @item qSymbol::
39164 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39165 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39166 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39167 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39168
39169 Reply:
39170 @table @samp
39171 @item OK
39172 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39173 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39174 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39175 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39176 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39177 below.
39178 @end table
39179
39180 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39181 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39182
39183 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39184 target has previously requested.
39185
39186 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39187 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39188 will be empty.
39189
39190 Reply:
39191 @table @samp
39192 @item OK
39193 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39194 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39195 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39196 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39197 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39198 @end table
39199
39200 @item qTBuffer
39201 @itemx QTBuffer
39202 @itemx QTDisconnected
39203 @itemx QTDP
39204 @itemx QTDPsrc
39205 @itemx QTDV
39206 @itemx qTfP
39207 @itemx qTfV
39208 @itemx QTFrame
39209 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39210
39211 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39212
39213 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39214 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39215 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39216 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39217 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39218 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39219 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39220 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39221 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39222 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39223 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39224
39225 Reply:
39226 @table @samp
39227 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39228 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39229 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39230 the thread's attributes.
39231 @end table
39232
39233 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39234 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39235 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39236 packets.)
39237
39238 @item QTNotes
39239 @itemx qTP
39240 @itemx QTSave
39241 @itemx qTsP
39242 @itemx qTsV
39243 @itemx QTStart
39244 @itemx QTStop
39245 @itemx QTEnable
39246 @itemx QTDisable
39247 @itemx QTinit
39248 @itemx QTro
39249 @itemx qTStatus
39250 @itemx qTV
39251 @itemx qTfSTM
39252 @itemx qTsSTM
39253 @itemx qTSTMat
39254 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39255
39256 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39257 @cindex read special object, remote request
39258 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39259 @anchor{qXfer read}
39260 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39261 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39262 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39263 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39264 additional details about what data to access.
39265
39266 Reply:
39267 @table @samp
39268 @item m @var{data}
39269 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39270 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39271 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39272 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39273 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39274 request.
39275
39276 @item l @var{data}
39277 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39278 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39279 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39280
39281 @item l
39282 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39283 There is no more data to be read.
39284
39285 @item E00
39286 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39287
39288 @item E @var{nn}
39289 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39290 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39291
39292 @item @w{}
39293 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39294 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39295 @end table
39296
39297 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39298 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39299 formats, listed above.
39300
39301 @table @samp
39302 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39303 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39304 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39305 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39306
39307 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39308 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39309
39310 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39311 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39312
39313 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39314 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39315 packet may have one of the following values:
39316
39317 @table @code
39318 @item all
39319 Returns all available branch trace.
39320
39321 @item new
39322 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39323 the last read request.
39324
39325 @item delta
39326 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39327 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39328 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39329 used to stitch traces together.
39330
39331 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39332 @end table
39333
39334 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39335 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39336
39337 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39338 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39339
39340 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39341 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39342
39343 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39344 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39345
39346 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39347 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39348 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39349 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39350 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39351 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39352 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39353
39354 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39355 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39356
39357 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39358 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39359 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39360 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39361 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39362
39363 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39364 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39365
39366 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39367 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39368 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39369 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39370 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39371
39372 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39373 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39374 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39375
39376 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39377 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39378
39379 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39380 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39381 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39382 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39383 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39384 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39385 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39386 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39387
39388 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39389 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39390
39391 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39392 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39393
39394 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39395 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39396 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39397 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39398
39399 @table @code
39400 @item start=@var{address}
39401 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39402 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39403 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39404 chosen as the starting point.
39405
39406 @item prev=@var{address}
39407 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39408 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39409 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39410 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39411 exists prior to the starting point.
39412
39413 @end table
39414
39415 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39416 ignored.
39417
39418 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39419 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39420 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39421 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39422 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39423
39424 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39425 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39426
39427 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39428 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39429
39430 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39431 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39432 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39433 Action Lists}.
39434
39435 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39436 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39437 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39438
39439 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39440 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39441 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39442 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39443 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39444
39445 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39446 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39447 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39448
39449 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39450 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39451 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39452 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39453 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39454 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39455 in that context to be accessed.
39456
39457 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39458 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39459 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39460
39461 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39462 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39463 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39464 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39465 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39466
39467 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39468 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39469
39470 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39471 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39472
39473 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39474 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39475 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39476
39477 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39478 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39479
39480 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39481 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39482
39483 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39484 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39485
39486 This packet is not probed by default.
39487
39488 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39489 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39490 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39491 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39492 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39493
39494 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39495 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39496
39497 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39498 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39499 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39500 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39501
39502 @end table
39503
39504 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39505 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39506 @anchor{qXfer write}
39507 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39508 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39509 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39510 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39511 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39512 to access.
39513
39514 Reply:
39515 @table @samp
39516 @item @var{nn}
39517 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39518 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39519
39520 @item E00
39521 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39522
39523 @item E @var{nn}
39524 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39525 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39526
39527 @item @w{}
39528 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39529 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39530 @end table
39531
39532 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39533 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39534 formats, listed above.
39535
39536 @table @samp
39537 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39538 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39539 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39540 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39541 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39542
39543 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39544 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39545 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39546
39547 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39548 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39549 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39550 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39551 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39552 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39553 in that context to be accessed.
39554
39555 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39556 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39557 @end table
39558
39559 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39560 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39561 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39562 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39563 must respond with an empty packet.
39564
39565 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39566 @cindex query attached, remote request
39567 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39568 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39569 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39570 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39571 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39572 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39573 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39574
39575 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39576 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39577 the @code{quit} command.
39578
39579 Reply:
39580 @table @samp
39581 @item 1
39582 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39583 @item 0
39584 The remote server created a new process.
39585 @item E @var{NN}
39586 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39587 @end table
39588
39589 @item Qbtrace:bts
39590 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39591
39592 Reply:
39593 @table @samp
39594 @item OK
39595 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39596 @item E.errtext
39597 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39598 @end table
39599
39600 @item Qbtrace:pt
39601 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39602
39603 Reply:
39604 @table @samp
39605 @item OK
39606 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39607 @item E.errtext
39608 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39609 @end table
39610
39611 @item Qbtrace:off
39612 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39613
39614 Reply:
39615 @table @samp
39616 @item OK
39617 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39618 @item E.errtext
39619 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39620 @end table
39621
39622 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39623 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39624 btrace recording method in bts format.
39625
39626 Reply:
39627 @table @samp
39628 @item OK
39629 The ring buffer size has been set.
39630 @item E.errtext
39631 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39632 @end table
39633
39634 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39635 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39636 btrace recording method in pt format.
39637
39638 Reply:
39639 @table @samp
39640 @item OK
39641 The ring buffer size has been set.
39642 @item E.errtext
39643 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39644 @end table
39645
39646 @end table
39647
39648 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39649 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39650
39651 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39652 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39653 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39654
39655 @menu
39656 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39657 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39658 @end menu
39659
39660 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39661 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39662
39663 @menu
39664 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39665 @end menu
39666
39667 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39668 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39669 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39670
39671 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39672
39673 @table @r
39674
39675 @item 2
39676 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39677
39678 @item 3
39679 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39680
39681 @item 4
39682 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39683
39684 @end table
39685
39686 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39687 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39688
39689 @menu
39690 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39691 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39692 @end menu
39693
39694 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39695 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39696 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39697
39698 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39699 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39700 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39701 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39702 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39703 most-significant -- least-significant.
39704
39705 @table @r
39706
39707 @item MIPS32
39708 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39709 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39710 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39711
39712 @item MIPS64
39713 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39714 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39715 as @code{MIPS32}.
39716
39717 @end table
39718
39719 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39720 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39721 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39722
39723 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39724
39725 @table @r
39726
39727 @item 2
39728 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39729
39730 @item 3
39731 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39732
39733 @item 4
39734 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39735
39736 @item 5
39737 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39738
39739 @end table
39740
39741 @node Tracepoint Packets
39742 @section Tracepoint Packets
39743 @cindex tracepoint packets
39744 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39745
39746 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39747 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39748
39749 @table @samp
39750
39751 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39752 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39753 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39754 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39755 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39756 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39757 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39758 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39759 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39760 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39761 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39762 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39763 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39764 actions.
39765
39766 Replies:
39767 @table @samp
39768 @item OK
39769 The packet was understood and carried out.
39770 @item qRelocInsn
39771 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39772 @item @w{}
39773 The packet was not recognized.
39774 @end table
39775
39776 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39777 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39778 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39779 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39780 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39781 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39782 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39783
39784 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39785 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39786 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39787 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39788 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39789 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39790 tracepoint actions.
39791
39792 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39793 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39794 following forms:
39795
39796 @table @samp
39797
39798 @item R @var{mask}
39799 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39800 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39801 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39802 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39803 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39804
39805 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39806 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39807 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39808 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39809 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39810 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39811 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39812
39813 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39814 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39815 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39816 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39817 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39818 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39819 packet).
39820
39821 @end table
39822
39823 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39824 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39825 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39826 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39827 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39828 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39829 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39830 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39831
39832 Replies:
39833 @table @samp
39834 @item OK
39835 The packet was understood and carried out.
39836 @item qRelocInsn
39837 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39838 @item @w{}
39839 The packet was not recognized.
39840 @end table
39841
39842 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39843 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39844 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39845 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39846 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39847 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39848 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39849 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39850
39851 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39852 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39853 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39854 fit in a single packet.
39855 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39856 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39857
39858 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39859 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39860 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39861 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39862
39863 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39864 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39865 query packets.
39866
39867 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39868 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39869 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39870 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39871 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39872 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39873 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39874 be found.
39875
39876 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39877 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39878 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39879 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39880 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39881 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39882 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39883 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39884 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39885 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39886 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39887 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39888 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39889 variable.
39890
39891 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39892 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39893 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39894 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39895 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39896
39897 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39898 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39899 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39900 one of the following forms:
39901
39902 @table @samp
39903 @item F @var{f}
39904 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39905 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39906 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39907
39908 @item T @var{t}
39909 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39910 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39911
39912 @end table
39913
39914 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39915 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39916 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39917 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39918
39919 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39920 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39921 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39922 is a hexadecimal number.
39923
39924 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39925 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39926 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39927 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39928 numbers.
39929
39930 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39931 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39932 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39933
39934 @item qTMinFTPILen
39935 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39936 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39937 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39938 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39939 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39940 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39941 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39942 arrange for that.
39943
39944 Replies:
39945
39946 @table @samp
39947 @item 0
39948 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39949 @item @var{length}
39950 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39951 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39952 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39953 regardless of size.
39954 @item E
39955 An error has occurred.
39956 @item @w{}
39957 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39958 @end table
39959
39960 @item QTStart
39961 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39962 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39963 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39964 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39965 instruction reply packet}).
39966
39967 @item QTStop
39968 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39969 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39970
39971 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39972 @anchor{QTEnable}
39973 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39974 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39975 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39976 of data from it will resume.
39977
39978 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39979 @anchor{QTDisable}
39980 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39981 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39982 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39983 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39984
39985 @item QTinit
39986 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39987 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39988
39989 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39990 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39991 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39992 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39993 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39994
39995 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39996 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39997 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39998 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39999
40000 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40001 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40002 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40003 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40004 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40005 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40006
40007 @item qTStatus
40008 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40009 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40010
40011 The reply has the form:
40012
40013 @table @samp
40014
40015 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40016 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40017 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40018 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40019
40020 @end table
40021
40022 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40023 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40024
40025 @table @samp
40026
40027 @item tnotrun:0
40028 No trace has been run yet.
40029
40030 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40031 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40032 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40033 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40034 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40035
40036 @item tfull:0
40037 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40038
40039 @item tdisconnected:0
40040 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40041
40042 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40043 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40044
40045 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40046 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40047 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40048 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40049 is hex encoded.
40050
40051 @item tunknown:0
40052 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40053
40054 @end table
40055
40056 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40057 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40058 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40059 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40060 trace.
40061
40062 @table @samp
40063
40064 @item tframes:@var{n}
40065 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40066
40067 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40068 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40069 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40070
40071 @item tsize:@var{n}
40072 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40073
40074 @item tfree:@var{n}
40075 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40076
40077 @item circular:@var{n}
40078 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40079 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40080 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40081 and may fill up.
40082
40083 @item disconn:@var{n}
40084 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40085 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40086 that the trace run will stop.
40087
40088 @end table
40089
40090 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40091 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40092 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40093 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40094 address @var{addr}.
40095
40096 Replies:
40097 @table @samp
40098 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40099 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40100 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40101 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40102 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40103
40104 @end table
40105
40106 @item qTV:@var{var}
40107 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40108 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40109 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40110
40111 Replies:
40112 @table @samp
40113 @item V@var{value}
40114 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40115 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40116 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40117 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40118 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40119 program is running.
40120
40121 @item U
40122 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40123 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40124 was not collected.
40125 @end table
40126
40127 @item qTfP
40128 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40129 @itemx qTsP
40130 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40131 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40132 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40133 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40134 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40135 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40136
40137 @item qTfV
40138 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40139 @itemx qTsV
40140 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40141 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40142 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40143 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40144 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40145 trace state variables.
40146
40147 @item qTfSTM
40148 @itemx qTsSTM
40149 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40150 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40151 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40152 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40153 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40154 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40155 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40156 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40157
40158 Reply:
40159 @table @samp
40160 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40161 A single marker
40162 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40163 a comma-separated list of markers
40164 @item l
40165 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40166 @item E @var{nn}
40167 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40168 @item @w{}
40169 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40170 stub.
40171 @end table
40172
40173 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40174 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40175
40176 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40177 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40178 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40179 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40180 @dfn{last}).
40181
40182 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40183 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40184 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40185 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40186 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40187 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40188 tracepoint markers.
40189
40190 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40191 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40192 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40193 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40194 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40195 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40196
40197 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40198 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40199 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40200 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40201 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40202 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40203 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40204 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40205 available.
40206
40207 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40208 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40209 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40210
40211 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40212 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40213 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40214 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40215 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40216 use whatever size it prefers.
40217
40218 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40219 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40220 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40221 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40222 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40223
40224 @end table
40225
40226 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40227 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40228 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40229 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40230 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40231 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40232 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40233 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40234 it had executed in the original location.
40235
40236 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40237 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40238 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40239 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40240 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40241 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40242 format of the request is:
40243
40244 @table @samp
40245 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40246
40247 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40248 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40249 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40250 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40251 memory starting at @var{to}.
40252 @end table
40253
40254 Replies:
40255 @table @samp
40256 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40257 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40258 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40259 @item E @var{NN}
40260 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40261 relocating the instruction.
40262 @end table
40263
40264 @node Host I/O Packets
40265 @section Host I/O Packets
40266 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40267 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40268
40269 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40270 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40271 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40272 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40273 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40274 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40275 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40276 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40277 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40278 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40279
40280 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40281 its arguments. They have this format:
40282
40283 @table @samp
40284
40285 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40286 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40287 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40288 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40289 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40290 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40291 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40292 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40293 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40294
40295 @end table
40296
40297 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40298
40299 @table @samp
40300
40301 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40302 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40303 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40304 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40305 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40306 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40307 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40308 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40309 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40310 @var{attachment}.
40311
40312 @item @w{}
40313 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40314
40315 @end table
40316
40317 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40318
40319 @table @samp
40320 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40321 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40322 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40323 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40324 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40325 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40326 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40327
40328 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40329 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40330 -1 if an error occurs.
40331
40332 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40333 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40334 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40335 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40336 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40337 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40338 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40339 @var{count} was zero.
40340
40341 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40342 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40343 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40344 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40345 some characters were escaped.
40346
40347 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40348 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40349 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40350 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40351 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40352 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40353 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40354 error occurred.
40355
40356 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40357 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40358 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40359 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40360 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40361 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40362
40363 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40364 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40365 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40366
40367 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40368 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40369 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40370
40371 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40372 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40373 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40374 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40375 some characters were escaped.
40376
40377 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40378 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40379 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40380 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40381 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40382 inferior(s).
40383
40384 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40385 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40386 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40387 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40388 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40389 operation.
40390
40391 @end table
40392
40393 @node Interrupts
40394 @section Interrupts
40395 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40396 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40397
40398 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40399 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40400 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40401 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40402
40403 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40404 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40405 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40406 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40407 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40408
40409 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40410 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40411 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40412 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40413 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40414 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40415 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40416 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40417
40418 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40419 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40420 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40421
40422 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40423 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40424 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40425 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40426 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40427 @code{0x03}.
40428
40429 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40430 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40431 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40432 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40433 currently-executing threads and processes.
40434 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40435 running program, it should send one of the stop
40436 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40437 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40438 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40439 Interrupts received while the
40440 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40441 it is resumed next time.
40442
40443 @node Notification Packets
40444 @section Notification Packets
40445 @cindex notification packets
40446 @cindex packets, notification
40447
40448 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40449 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40450 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40451 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40452 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40453 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40454 is not a problem.
40455
40456 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40457 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40458 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40459 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40460 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40461 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40462 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40463
40464 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40465 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40466
40467 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40468 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40469 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40470 not they understand it.
40471
40472 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40473 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40474 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40475 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40476 recipients.
40477
40478 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40479 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40480 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40481 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40482 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40483
40484 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40485 @table @samp
40486 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40487 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40488 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40489 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40490 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40491 @item @var{ack}
40492 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40493 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40494 @end table
40495
40496 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40497 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40498
40499 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40500 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40501 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40502 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40503 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40504 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40505 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40506 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40507 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40508 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40509
40510 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40511 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40512 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40513 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40514 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40515 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40516
40517 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40518 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40519 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40520 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40521 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40522
40523 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40524 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40525 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40526 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40527 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40528 normally.
40529
40530 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40531 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40532 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40533 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40534 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40535 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40536 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40537 the process shall be repeated.
40538
40539 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40540 following example:
40541 @smallexample
40542 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40543 @code{...}
40544 -> @code{vStopped}
40545 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40546 -> @code{vStopped}
40547 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40548 -> @code{vStopped}
40549 <- @code{OK}
40550 @end smallexample
40551
40552 The following notifications are defined:
40553 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40554
40555 @item Notification
40556 @tab Ack
40557 @tab Event
40558 @tab Description
40559
40560 @item Stop
40561 @tab vStopped
40562 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40563 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40564 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40565 @value{GDBN}.
40566 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40567
40568 @end multitable
40569
40570 @node Remote Non-Stop
40571 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40572
40573 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40574 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40575 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40576 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40577
40578 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40579 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40580 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40581 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40582 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40583 probe the target state after a mode change.
40584
40585 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40586 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40587 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40588 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40589 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40590 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40591 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40592 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40593 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40594 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40595 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40596
40597 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40598 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40599 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40600 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40601 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40602 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40603 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40604 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40605 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40606 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40607 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40608 @samp{OK}.
40609
40610 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40611 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40612 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40613 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40614 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40615 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40616 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40617 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40618 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40619 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40620 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40621 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40622 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40623
40624 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40625 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40626
40627 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40628 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40629 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40630 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40631 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40632 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40633 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40634
40635 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40636 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40637 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40638 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40639 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40640
40641 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40642 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40643 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40644 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40645
40646 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40647 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40648 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40649 @pxref{qSupported}.
40650 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40651 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40652 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40653 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40654 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40655 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40656 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40657
40658 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40659 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40660 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40661 connection.
40662 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40663 new connection is established,
40664 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40665 for the current connection, once disabled.
40666
40667 @node Examples
40668 @section Examples
40669
40670 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40671 does not get any direct output:
40672
40673 @smallexample
40674 -> @code{R00}
40675 <- @code{+}
40676 @emph{target restarts}
40677 -> @code{?}
40678 <- @code{+}
40679 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40680 -> @code{+}
40681 @end smallexample
40682
40683 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40684
40685 @smallexample
40686 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40687 <- @code{+}
40688 -> @code{s}
40689 <- @code{+}
40690 @emph{time passes}
40691 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40692 -> @code{+}
40693 -> @code{g}
40694 <- @code{+}
40695 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40696 -> @code{+}
40697 @end smallexample
40698
40699 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40700 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40701 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40702
40703 @menu
40704 * File-I/O Overview::
40705 * Protocol Basics::
40706 * The F Request Packet::
40707 * The F Reply Packet::
40708 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40709 * Console I/O::
40710 * List of Supported Calls::
40711 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40712 * Constants::
40713 * File-I/O Examples::
40714 @end menu
40715
40716 @node File-I/O Overview
40717 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40718 @cindex file-i/o overview
40719
40720 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40721 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40722 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40723 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40724 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40725 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40726
40727 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40728 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40729 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40730 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40731 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40732
40733 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40734 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40735 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40736 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40737 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40738 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40739 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40740
40741 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40742 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40743 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40744 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40745 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40746
40747 @smallexample
40748 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40749 <- target requests 'system call X'
40750 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40751 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40752 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40753 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40754 @end smallexample
40755
40756 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40757 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40758 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40759 system are not supported by this protocol.
40760
40761 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40762
40763 @node Protocol Basics
40764 @subsection Protocol Basics
40765 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40766
40767 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40768 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40769 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40770 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40771 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40772 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40773 to call the appropriate host system call:
40774
40775 @itemize @bullet
40776 @item
40777 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40778
40779 @item
40780 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40781 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40782 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40783 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40784
40785 @end itemize
40786
40787 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40788
40789 @itemize @bullet
40790 @item
40791 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40792 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40793 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40794 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40795 packet.
40796
40797 @item
40798 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40799 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40800
40801 @item
40802 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40803
40804 @item
40805 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40806
40807 @item
40808 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40809 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40810 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40811 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40812 packet.
40813
40814 @end itemize
40815
40816 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40817 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40818
40819 @itemize @bullet
40820 @item
40821 Return value.
40822
40823 @item
40824 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40825
40826 @item
40827 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40828
40829 @end itemize
40830
40831 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40832 the latest continue or step action.
40833
40834 @node The F Request Packet
40835 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40836 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40837 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40838
40839 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40840
40841 @table @samp
40842 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40843
40844 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40845 This is just the name of the function.
40846
40847 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40848 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40849 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40850 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40851 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40852 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40853 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40854
40855 @end table
40856
40857
40858
40859 @node The F Reply Packet
40860 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40861 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40862 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40863
40864 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40865
40866 @table @samp
40867
40868 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40869
40870 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40871
40872 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40873 representation.
40874 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40875
40876 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40877 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40878 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40879
40880 @smallexample
40881 F0,0,C
40882 @end smallexample
40883
40884 @noindent
40885 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40886
40887 @smallexample
40888 F-1,4,C
40889 @end smallexample
40890
40891 @noindent
40892 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40893
40894 @end table
40895
40896
40897 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40898 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40899 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40900
40901 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40902 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40903 the target should behave as if it had
40904 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40905 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40906 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40907 packet.
40908
40909 It's important for the target to know in which
40910 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40911
40912 @itemize @bullet
40913 @item
40914 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40915
40916 @item
40917 The system call on the host has been finished.
40918
40919 @end itemize
40920
40921 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40922 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40923 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40924 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40925 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40926 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40927
40928 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40929 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40930 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40931 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40932 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40933 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40934 or the full action has been completed.
40935
40936 @node Console I/O
40937 @subsection Console I/O
40938 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40939
40940 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40941 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40942 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40943 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40944 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40945 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40946 conditions is met:
40947
40948 @itemize @bullet
40949 @item
40950 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40951 @code{read}
40952 system call is treated as finished.
40953
40954 @item
40955 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40956 newline.
40957
40958 @item
40959 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40960 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40961
40962 @end itemize
40963
40964 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40965 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40966 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40967 is stopped at the user's request.
40968
40969
40970 @node List of Supported Calls
40971 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40972 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40973
40974 @menu
40975 * open::
40976 * close::
40977 * read::
40978 * write::
40979 * lseek::
40980 * rename::
40981 * unlink::
40982 * stat/fstat::
40983 * gettimeofday::
40984 * isatty::
40985 * system::
40986 @end menu
40987
40988 @node open
40989 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40990 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40991
40992 @table @asis
40993 @item Synopsis:
40994 @smallexample
40995 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40996 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40997 @end smallexample
40998
40999 @item Request:
41000 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41001
41002 @noindent
41003 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41004
41005 @table @code
41006 @item O_CREAT
41007 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41008 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41009 are concerned.
41010
41011 @item O_EXCL
41012 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41013 an error and open() fails.
41014
41015 @item O_TRUNC
41016 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41017 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41018 truncated to zero length.
41019
41020 @item O_APPEND
41021 The file is opened in append mode.
41022
41023 @item O_RDONLY
41024 The file is opened for reading only.
41025
41026 @item O_WRONLY
41027 The file is opened for writing only.
41028
41029 @item O_RDWR
41030 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41031 @end table
41032
41033 @noindent
41034 Other bits are silently ignored.
41035
41036
41037 @noindent
41038 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41039
41040 @table @code
41041 @item S_IRUSR
41042 User has read permission.
41043
41044 @item S_IWUSR
41045 User has write permission.
41046
41047 @item S_IRGRP
41048 Group has read permission.
41049
41050 @item S_IWGRP
41051 Group has write permission.
41052
41053 @item S_IROTH
41054 Others have read permission.
41055
41056 @item S_IWOTH
41057 Others have write permission.
41058 @end table
41059
41060 @noindent
41061 Other bits are silently ignored.
41062
41063
41064 @item Return value:
41065 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41066 occurred.
41067
41068 @item Errors:
41069
41070 @table @code
41071 @item EEXIST
41072 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41073
41074 @item EISDIR
41075 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41076
41077 @item EACCES
41078 The requested access is not allowed.
41079
41080 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41081 @var{pathname} was too long.
41082
41083 @item ENOENT
41084 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41085
41086 @item ENODEV
41087 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41088
41089 @item EROFS
41090 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41091 write access was requested.
41092
41093 @item EFAULT
41094 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41095
41096 @item ENOSPC
41097 No space on device to create the file.
41098
41099 @item EMFILE
41100 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41101
41102 @item ENFILE
41103 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41104 has been reached.
41105
41106 @item EINTR
41107 The call was interrupted by the user.
41108 @end table
41109
41110 @end table
41111
41112 @node close
41113 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41114 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41115
41116 @table @asis
41117 @item Synopsis:
41118 @smallexample
41119 int close(int fd);
41120 @end smallexample
41121
41122 @item Request:
41123 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41124
41125 @item Return value:
41126 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41127
41128 @item Errors:
41129
41130 @table @code
41131 @item EBADF
41132 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41133
41134 @item EINTR
41135 The call was interrupted by the user.
41136 @end table
41137
41138 @end table
41139
41140 @node read
41141 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41142 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41143
41144 @table @asis
41145 @item Synopsis:
41146 @smallexample
41147 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41148 @end smallexample
41149
41150 @item Request:
41151 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41152
41153 @item Return value:
41154 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41155 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41156 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41157
41158 @item Errors:
41159
41160 @table @code
41161 @item EBADF
41162 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41163 reading.
41164
41165 @item EFAULT
41166 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41167
41168 @item EINTR
41169 The call was interrupted by the user.
41170 @end table
41171
41172 @end table
41173
41174 @node write
41175 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41176 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41177
41178 @table @asis
41179 @item Synopsis:
41180 @smallexample
41181 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41182 @end smallexample
41183
41184 @item Request:
41185 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41186
41187 @item Return value:
41188 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41189 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41190 is returned.
41191
41192 @item Errors:
41193
41194 @table @code
41195 @item EBADF
41196 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41197 writing.
41198
41199 @item EFAULT
41200 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41201
41202 @item EFBIG
41203 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41204 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41205
41206 @item ENOSPC
41207 No space on device to write the data.
41208
41209 @item EINTR
41210 The call was interrupted by the user.
41211 @end table
41212
41213 @end table
41214
41215 @node lseek
41216 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41217 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41218
41219 @table @asis
41220 @item Synopsis:
41221 @smallexample
41222 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41223 @end smallexample
41224
41225 @item Request:
41226 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41227
41228 @var{flag} is one of:
41229
41230 @table @code
41231 @item SEEK_SET
41232 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41233
41234 @item SEEK_CUR
41235 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41236 bytes.
41237
41238 @item SEEK_END
41239 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41240 bytes.
41241 @end table
41242
41243 @item Return value:
41244 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41245 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41246 value of -1 is returned.
41247
41248 @item Errors:
41249
41250 @table @code
41251 @item EBADF
41252 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41253
41254 @item ESPIPE
41255 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41256
41257 @item EINVAL
41258 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41259
41260 @item EINTR
41261 The call was interrupted by the user.
41262 @end table
41263
41264 @end table
41265
41266 @node rename
41267 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41268 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41269
41270 @table @asis
41271 @item Synopsis:
41272 @smallexample
41273 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41274 @end smallexample
41275
41276 @item Request:
41277 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41278
41279 @item Return value:
41280 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41281
41282 @item Errors:
41283
41284 @table @code
41285 @item EISDIR
41286 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41287 directory.
41288
41289 @item EEXIST
41290 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41291
41292 @item EBUSY
41293 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41294 process.
41295
41296 @item EINVAL
41297 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41298 of itself.
41299
41300 @item ENOTDIR
41301 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41302 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41303 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41304
41305 @item EFAULT
41306 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41307
41308 @item EACCES
41309 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41310
41311 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41312
41313 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41314
41315 @item ENOENT
41316 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41317
41318 @item EROFS
41319 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41320
41321 @item ENOSPC
41322 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41323 directory entry.
41324
41325 @item EINTR
41326 The call was interrupted by the user.
41327 @end table
41328
41329 @end table
41330
41331 @node unlink
41332 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41333 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41334
41335 @table @asis
41336 @item Synopsis:
41337 @smallexample
41338 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41339 @end smallexample
41340
41341 @item Request:
41342 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41343
41344 @item Return value:
41345 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41346
41347 @item Errors:
41348
41349 @table @code
41350 @item EACCES
41351 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41352
41353 @item EPERM
41354 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41355
41356 @item EBUSY
41357 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41358 being used by another process.
41359
41360 @item EFAULT
41361 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41362
41363 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41364 @var{pathname} was too long.
41365
41366 @item ENOENT
41367 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41368
41369 @item ENOTDIR
41370 A component of the path is not a directory.
41371
41372 @item EROFS
41373 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41374
41375 @item EINTR
41376 The call was interrupted by the user.
41377 @end table
41378
41379 @end table
41380
41381 @node stat/fstat
41382 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41383 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41384 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41385
41386 @table @asis
41387 @item Synopsis:
41388 @smallexample
41389 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41390 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41391 @end smallexample
41392
41393 @item Request:
41394 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41395 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41396
41397 @item Return value:
41398 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41399
41400 @item Errors:
41401
41402 @table @code
41403 @item EBADF
41404 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41405
41406 @item ENOENT
41407 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41408 path is an empty string.
41409
41410 @item ENOTDIR
41411 A component of the path is not a directory.
41412
41413 @item EFAULT
41414 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41415
41416 @item EACCES
41417 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41418
41419 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41420 @var{pathname} was too long.
41421
41422 @item EINTR
41423 The call was interrupted by the user.
41424 @end table
41425
41426 @end table
41427
41428 @node gettimeofday
41429 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41430 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41431
41432 @table @asis
41433 @item Synopsis:
41434 @smallexample
41435 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41436 @end smallexample
41437
41438 @item Request:
41439 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41440
41441 @item Return value:
41442 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41443
41444 @item Errors:
41445
41446 @table @code
41447 @item EINVAL
41448 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41449
41450 @item EFAULT
41451 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41452 @end table
41453
41454 @end table
41455
41456 @node isatty
41457 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41458 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41459
41460 @table @asis
41461 @item Synopsis:
41462 @smallexample
41463 int isatty(int fd);
41464 @end smallexample
41465
41466 @item Request:
41467 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41468
41469 @item Return value:
41470 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41471
41472 @item Errors:
41473
41474 @table @code
41475 @item EINTR
41476 The call was interrupted by the user.
41477 @end table
41478
41479 @end table
41480
41481 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41482 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41483 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41484 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41485 needed.
41486
41487
41488 @node system
41489 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41490 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41491
41492 @table @asis
41493 @item Synopsis:
41494 @smallexample
41495 int system(const char *command);
41496 @end smallexample
41497
41498 @item Request:
41499 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41500
41501 @item Return value:
41502 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41503 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41504 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41505 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41506 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41507 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41508 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41509
41510 @item Errors:
41511
41512 @table @code
41513 @item EINTR
41514 The call was interrupted by the user.
41515 @end table
41516
41517 @end table
41518
41519 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41520 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41521 the host is simplified before it's returned
41522 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41523 is discarded, and the return value consists
41524 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41525
41526 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41527 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41528 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41529
41530 @table @code
41531 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41532 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41533 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41534 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41535
41536 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41537 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41538 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41539 protocol.
41540 @end table
41541
41542 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41543 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41544 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41545
41546 @menu
41547 * Integral Datatypes::
41548 * Pointer Values::
41549 * Memory Transfer::
41550 * struct stat::
41551 * struct timeval::
41552 @end menu
41553
41554 @node Integral Datatypes
41555 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41556 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41557
41558 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41559 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41560 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41561
41562 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41563 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41564
41565 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41566
41567 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41568 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41569
41570 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41571
41572 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41573 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41574 byte order.
41575
41576 @node Pointer Values
41577 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41578 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41579
41580 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41581 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41582 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41583 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41584
41585 @smallexample
41586 @code{1aaf/12}
41587 @end smallexample
41588
41589 @noindent
41590 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41591 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41592 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41593 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41594
41595 @smallexample
41596 @code{123456/d}
41597 @end smallexample
41598
41599 @node Memory Transfer
41600 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41601 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41602
41603 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41604 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41605 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41606 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41607 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41608 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41609 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41610
41611
41612 @node struct stat
41613 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41614 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41615
41616 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41617 is defined as follows:
41618
41619 @smallexample
41620 struct stat @{
41621 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41622 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41623 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41624 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41625 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41626 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41627 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41628 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41629 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41630 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41631 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41632 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41633 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41634 @};
41635 @end smallexample
41636
41637 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41638 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41639 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41640
41641 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41642 range of values.
41643
41644 @table @code
41645
41646 @item st_dev
41647 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41648
41649 @item st_ino
41650 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41651
41652 @item st_mode
41653 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41654 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41655
41656 @item st_uid
41657 @itemx st_gid
41658 @itemx st_rdev
41659 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41660
41661 @item st_atime
41662 @itemx st_mtime
41663 @itemx st_ctime
41664 These values have a host and file system dependent
41665 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41666 support exact timing values.
41667 @end table
41668
41669 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41670 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41671 continuing.
41672
41673 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41674 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41675 get truncated on the target.
41676
41677 @node struct timeval
41678 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41679 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41680
41681 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41682 is defined as follows:
41683
41684 @smallexample
41685 struct timeval @{
41686 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41687 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41688 @};
41689 @end smallexample
41690
41691 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41692 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41693 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41694
41695 @node Constants
41696 @subsection Constants
41697 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41698
41699 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41700 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41701 values before and after the call as needed.
41702
41703 @menu
41704 * Open Flags::
41705 * mode_t Values::
41706 * Errno Values::
41707 * Lseek Flags::
41708 * Limits::
41709 @end menu
41710
41711 @node Open Flags
41712 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41713 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41714
41715 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41716
41717 @smallexample
41718 O_RDONLY 0x0
41719 O_WRONLY 0x1
41720 O_RDWR 0x2
41721 O_APPEND 0x8
41722 O_CREAT 0x200
41723 O_TRUNC 0x400
41724 O_EXCL 0x800
41725 @end smallexample
41726
41727 @node mode_t Values
41728 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41729 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41730
41731 All values are given in octal representation.
41732
41733 @smallexample
41734 S_IFREG 0100000
41735 S_IFDIR 040000
41736 S_IRUSR 0400
41737 S_IWUSR 0200
41738 S_IXUSR 0100
41739 S_IRGRP 040
41740 S_IWGRP 020
41741 S_IXGRP 010
41742 S_IROTH 04
41743 S_IWOTH 02
41744 S_IXOTH 01
41745 @end smallexample
41746
41747 @node Errno Values
41748 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41749 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41750
41751 All values are given in decimal representation.
41752
41753 @smallexample
41754 EPERM 1
41755 ENOENT 2
41756 EINTR 4
41757 EBADF 9
41758 EACCES 13
41759 EFAULT 14
41760 EBUSY 16
41761 EEXIST 17
41762 ENODEV 19
41763 ENOTDIR 20
41764 EISDIR 21
41765 EINVAL 22
41766 ENFILE 23
41767 EMFILE 24
41768 EFBIG 27
41769 ENOSPC 28
41770 ESPIPE 29
41771 EROFS 30
41772 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41773 EUNKNOWN 9999
41774 @end smallexample
41775
41776 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41777 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41778
41779 @node Lseek Flags
41780 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41781 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41782
41783 @smallexample
41784 SEEK_SET 0
41785 SEEK_CUR 1
41786 SEEK_END 2
41787 @end smallexample
41788
41789 @node Limits
41790 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41791 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41792
41793 All values are given in decimal representation.
41794
41795 @smallexample
41796 INT_MIN -2147483648
41797 INT_MAX 2147483647
41798 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41799 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41800 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41801 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41802 @end smallexample
41803
41804 @node File-I/O Examples
41805 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41806 @cindex file-i/o examples
41807
41808 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41809 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41810
41811 @smallexample
41812 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41813 @emph{request memory read from target}
41814 -> @code{m1234,6}
41815 <- XXXXXX
41816 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41817 -> @code{F6}
41818 @end smallexample
41819
41820 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41821 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41822
41823 @smallexample
41824 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41825 @emph{request memory write to target}
41826 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41827 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41828 -> @code{F6}
41829 @end smallexample
41830
41831 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41832 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41833
41834 @smallexample
41835 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41836 -> @code{F-1,9}
41837 @end smallexample
41838
41839 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41840 host is called:
41841
41842 @smallexample
41843 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41844 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41845 <- @code{T02}
41846 @end smallexample
41847
41848 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41849 host is called:
41850
41851 @smallexample
41852 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41853 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41854 <- @code{T02}
41855 @end smallexample
41856
41857 @node Library List Format
41858 @section Library List Format
41859 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41860
41861 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41862 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41863 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41864 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41865 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41866 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41867 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41868 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41869 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41870 are loaded.
41871
41872 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41873 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41874 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41875 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41876
41877 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41878 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41879 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41880 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41881 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41882 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41883
41884 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41885 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41886
41887 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41888 offset, looks like this:
41889
41890 @smallexample
41891 <library-list>
41892 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41893 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41894 </library>
41895 </library-list>
41896 @end smallexample
41897
41898 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41899 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41900
41901 @smallexample
41902 <library-list>
41903 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41904 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41905 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41906 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41907 </library>
41908 </library-list>
41909 @end smallexample
41910
41911 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41912
41913 @smallexample
41914 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41915 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41916 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41917 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41918 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41919 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41920 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41921 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41922 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41923 @end smallexample
41924
41925 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41926 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41927 section for each library.
41928
41929 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41930 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41931 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41932
41933 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41934 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41935 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41936 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41937
41938 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41939 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41940 target, the following parameters are reported:
41941
41942 @itemize @minus
41943 @item
41944 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41945 @code{struct link_map}.
41946 @item
41947 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41948 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41949 @item
41950 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41951 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41952 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41953 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41954 @item
41955 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41956 @end itemize
41957
41958 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41959 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41960 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41961
41962 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41963 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41964
41965 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41966 looks like this:
41967
41968 @smallexample
41969 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41970 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41971 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
41972 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41973 l_ld="0x152350"/>
41974 </library-list-svr>
41975 @end smallexample
41976
41977 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41978
41979 @smallexample
41980 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41981 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41982 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41983 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41984 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41985 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41986 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41987 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41988 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41989 @end smallexample
41990
41991 @node Memory Map Format
41992 @section Memory Map Format
41993 @cindex memory map format
41994
41995 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41996 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41997 memory map.
41998
41999 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42000 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42001 lists memory regions.
42002
42003 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42004 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42005
42006 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42007
42008 @smallexample
42009 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42010 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42011 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42012 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42013 <memory-map>
42014 region...
42015 </memory-map>
42016 @end smallexample
42017
42018 Each region can be either:
42019
42020 @itemize
42021
42022 @item
42023 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42024 bytes from there:
42025
42026 @smallexample
42027 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42028 @end smallexample
42029
42030
42031 @item
42032 A region of read-only memory:
42033
42034 @smallexample
42035 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42036 @end smallexample
42037
42038
42039 @item
42040 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42041 bytes in length:
42042
42043 @smallexample
42044 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42045 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42046 </memory>
42047 @end smallexample
42048
42049 @end itemize
42050
42051 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42052 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42053 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42054
42055 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42056
42057 @smallexample
42058 <!-- ................................................... -->
42059 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42060 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42061 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42062 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42063 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42064 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42065 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42066 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42067 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42068 and its type, or device. -->
42069 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42070 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42071 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42072 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42073 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42074 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42075 @end smallexample
42076
42077 @node Thread List Format
42078 @section Thread List Format
42079 @cindex thread list format
42080
42081 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42082 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42083 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42084 the following structure:
42085
42086 @smallexample
42087 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42088 <threads>
42089 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42090 ... description ...
42091 </thread>
42092 </threads>
42093 @end smallexample
42094
42095 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42096 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42097 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42098 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42099 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42100 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42101 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42102 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42103
42104
42105 @node Traceframe Info Format
42106 @section Traceframe Info Format
42107 @cindex traceframe info format
42108
42109 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42110 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42111 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42112 collected in a traceframe.
42113
42114 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42115 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42116
42117 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42118 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42119
42120 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42121
42122 @smallexample
42123 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42124 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42125 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42126 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42127 <traceframe-info>
42128 block...
42129 </traceframe-info>
42130 @end smallexample
42131
42132 Each traceframe block can be either:
42133
42134 @itemize
42135
42136 @item
42137 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42138 @var{length} bytes from there:
42139
42140 @smallexample
42141 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42142 @end smallexample
42143
42144 @item
42145 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42146 collected:
42147
42148 @smallexample
42149 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42150 @end smallexample
42151
42152 @end itemize
42153
42154 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42155
42156 @smallexample
42157 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42158 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42159
42160 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42161 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42162 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42163 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42164 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42165 @end smallexample
42166
42167 @node Branch Trace Format
42168 @section Branch Trace Format
42169 @cindex branch trace format
42170
42171 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42172 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42173 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42174 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42175
42176 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42177 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42178
42179 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42180 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42181
42182 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42183
42184 @smallexample
42185 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42186 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42187 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42188 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42189 <btrace>
42190 block...
42191 </btrace>
42192 @end smallexample
42193
42194 @itemize
42195
42196 @item
42197 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42198 and ending at @var{end}:
42199
42200 @smallexample
42201 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42202 @end smallexample
42203
42204 @end itemize
42205
42206 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42207
42208 @smallexample
42209 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42210 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42211
42212 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42213 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42214 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42215
42216 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42217
42218 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42219
42220 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42221 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42222 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42223 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42224 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42225
42226 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42227 @end smallexample
42228
42229 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42230 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42231 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42232
42233 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42234 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42235 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42236
42237 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42238 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42239
42240 @table @code
42241 @item bts
42242 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42243 @table @code
42244 @item size
42245 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42246 @end table
42247 @item pt
42248 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42249 PT}) format.
42250 @table @code
42251 @item size
42252 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42253 @end table
42254 @end table
42255
42256 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42257 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42258
42259 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42260
42261 @smallexample
42262 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42263 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42264
42265 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42266 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42267
42268 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42269 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42270 @end smallexample
42271
42272 @include agentexpr.texi
42273
42274 @node Target Descriptions
42275 @appendix Target Descriptions
42276 @cindex target descriptions
42277
42278 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42279 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42280 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42281 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42282 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42283 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42284 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42285
42286 @itemize @bullet
42287 @item
42288 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42289 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42290 @item
42291 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42292 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42293 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42294 @item
42295 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42296 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42297 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42298 @end itemize
42299
42300 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42301 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42302 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42303 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42304 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42305
42306 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42307 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42308
42309 @menu
42310 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42311 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42312 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42313 descriptions.
42314 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42315 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42316 @end menu
42317
42318 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42319 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42320
42321 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42322 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42323 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42324 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42325 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42326 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42327 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42328 Format}.
42329
42330 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42331 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42332 specify a file are:
42333
42334 @table @code
42335 @cindex set tdesc filename
42336 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42337 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42338
42339 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42340 @item unset tdesc filename
42341 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42342 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42343
42344 @cindex show tdesc filename
42345 @item show tdesc filename
42346 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42347 @end table
42348
42349
42350 @node Target Description Format
42351 @section Target Description Format
42352 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42353
42354 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42355 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42356 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42357 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42358 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42359 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42360 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42361
42362 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42363 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42364 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42365 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42366 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42367
42368 Here is a simple target description:
42369
42370 @smallexample
42371 <target version="1.0">
42372 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42373 </target>
42374 @end smallexample
42375
42376 @noindent
42377 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42378 the x86-64 architecture.
42379
42380 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42381 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42382 are explained further below.
42383
42384 @smallexample
42385 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42386 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42387 <target version="1.0">
42388 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42389 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42390 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42391 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42392 </target>
42393 @end smallexample
42394
42395 @noindent
42396 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42397 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42398 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42399 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42400 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42401 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42402 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42403 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42404 the version mismatch.
42405
42406 @subsection Inclusion
42407 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42408 @cindex XInclude
42409 @ifnotinfo
42410 @cindex <xi:include>
42411 @end ifnotinfo
42412
42413 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42414 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42415 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42416 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42417 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42418
42419 @smallexample
42420 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42421 @end smallexample
42422
42423 @noindent
42424 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42425 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42426 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42427 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42428 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42429 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42430 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42431 original description.
42432
42433 @subsection Architecture
42434 @cindex <architecture>
42435
42436 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42437
42438 @smallexample
42439 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42440 @end smallexample
42441
42442 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42443 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42444
42445 @subsection OS ABI
42446 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42447
42448 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42449 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42450
42451 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42452
42453 @smallexample
42454 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42455 @end smallexample
42456
42457 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42458 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42459
42460 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42461 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42462
42463 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42464 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42465
42466 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42467
42468 @smallexample
42469 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42470 @end smallexample
42471
42472 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42473 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42474
42475 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42476 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42477 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42478 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42479 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42480 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42481 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42482
42483 @smallexample
42484 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42485 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42486 @end smallexample
42487
42488 @subsection Features
42489 @cindex <feature>
42490
42491 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42492 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42493 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42494 has this form:
42495
42496 @smallexample
42497 <feature name="@var{name}">
42498 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42499 @var{reg}@dots{}
42500 </feature>
42501 @end smallexample
42502
42503 @noindent
42504 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42505 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42506 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42507 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42508
42509 @subsection Types
42510
42511 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42512 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42513 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42514 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42515 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42516 and enum types.
42517
42518 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42519 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42520 Types must be defined before they are used.
42521
42522 @cindex <vector>
42523 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42524 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42525 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42526 @var{count}:
42527
42528 @smallexample
42529 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42530 @end smallexample
42531
42532 @cindex <union>
42533 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42534 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42535 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42536 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42537
42538 @smallexample
42539 <union id="@var{id}">
42540 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42541 @dots{}
42542 </union>
42543 @end smallexample
42544
42545 @cindex <struct>
42546 @cindex <flags>
42547 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42548 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42549 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42550 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42551 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42552 specified.
42553
42554 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42555
42556 @smallexample
42557 <struct id="@var{id}">
42558 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42559 @dots{}
42560 </struct>
42561 @end smallexample
42562
42563 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42564 No implicit padding is added.
42565
42566 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42567
42568 @smallexample
42569 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42570 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42571 @dots{}
42572 </struct>
42573 @end smallexample
42574
42575 @smallexample
42576 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42577 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42578 @dots{}
42579 </flags>
42580 @end smallexample
42581
42582 The @var{name} value is required.
42583 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42584 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42585 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42586
42587 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42588 is optional.
42589 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42590 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42591
42592 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42593 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42594
42595 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42596
42597 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42598 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42599
42600 @itemize @bullet
42601 @item
42602 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42603 @item
42604 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42605 @end itemize
42606
42607 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42608 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42609
42610 @itemize @bullet
42611 @item
42612 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42613
42614 @smallexample
42615 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42616 $1 = 42
42617 @end smallexample
42618
42619 @end itemize
42620
42621 @subsection Registers
42622 @cindex <reg>
42623
42624 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42625
42626 @smallexample
42627 <reg name="@var{name}"
42628 bitsize="@var{size}"
42629 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42630 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42631 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42632 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42633 @end smallexample
42634
42635 @noindent
42636 The components are as follows:
42637
42638 @table @var
42639
42640 @item name
42641 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42642
42643 @item bitsize
42644 The register's size, in bits.
42645
42646 @item regnum
42647 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42648 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42649 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42650 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42651 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42652 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42653 in order of increasing register number.
42654
42655 @item save-restore
42656 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42657 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42658 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42659 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42660 ABI.
42661
42662 @item type
42663 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42664 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42665 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42666 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42667 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42668 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42669
42670 @item group
42671 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42672 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42673 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42674 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42675 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42676 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42677 @code{info registers}.
42678
42679 @end table
42680
42681 @node Predefined Target Types
42682 @section Predefined Target Types
42683 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42684
42685 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42686 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42687 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42688 types. The currently supported types are:
42689
42690 @table @code
42691
42692 @item bool
42693 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42694
42695 @item int8
42696 @itemx int16
42697 @itemx int24
42698 @itemx int32
42699 @itemx int64
42700 @itemx int128
42701 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42702
42703 @item uint8
42704 @itemx uint16
42705 @itemx uint24
42706 @itemx uint32
42707 @itemx uint64
42708 @itemx uint128
42709 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42710
42711 @item code_ptr
42712 @itemx data_ptr
42713 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42714 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42715 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42716 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42717 may be marked as data pointers.
42718
42719 @item ieee_single
42720 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42721
42722 @item ieee_double
42723 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42724
42725 @item arm_fpa_ext
42726 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42727
42728 @item i387_ext
42729 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42730
42731 @item i386_eflags
42732 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42733
42734 @item i386_mxcsr
42735 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42736
42737 @end table
42738
42739 @node Enum Target Types
42740 @section Enum Target Types
42741 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42742
42743 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42744 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42745
42746 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42747
42748 @smallexample
42749 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42750 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42751 @dots{}
42752 </enum>
42753 @end smallexample
42754
42755 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42756
42757 @smallexample
42758 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42759 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42760 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42761 </enum>
42762 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42763 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42764 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42765 </flags>
42766 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42767 @end smallexample
42768
42769 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42770 would be printed as:
42771
42772 @smallexample
42773 (gdb) info register flags
42774 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42775 @end smallexample
42776
42777 @node Standard Target Features
42778 @section Standard Target Features
42779 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42780
42781 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42782 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42783 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42784 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42785 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42786 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42787 can recognize them.
42788
42789 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42790 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42791 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42792 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42793 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42794 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42795 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42796 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42797
42798 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42799 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42800 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42801
42802 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42803 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42804 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42805 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42806
42807 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42808 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42809 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42810
42811 @menu
42812 * AArch64 Features::
42813 * ARC Features::
42814 * ARM Features::
42815 * i386 Features::
42816 * MicroBlaze Features::
42817 * MIPS Features::
42818 * M68K Features::
42819 * NDS32 Features::
42820 * Nios II Features::
42821 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42822 * PowerPC Features::
42823 * S/390 and System z Features::
42824 * Sparc Features::
42825 * TIC6x Features::
42826 @end menu
42827
42828
42829 @node AArch64 Features
42830 @subsection AArch64 Features
42831 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42832
42833 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42834 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42835 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42836
42837 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42838 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42839 and @samp{fpcr}.
42840
42841 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42842 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42843 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42844
42845 @node ARC Features
42846 @subsection ARC Features
42847 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42848
42849 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42850 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42851 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42852 that one of the core registers features is present.
42853 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42854
42855 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42856 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42857 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42858 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42859 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42860 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42861 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42862
42863 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42864 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42865 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42866 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42867 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42868 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42869
42870 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42871 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42872 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42873 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42874 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42875 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42876 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42877 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42878 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42879 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42880
42881 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42882 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42883
42884 @node ARM Features
42885 @subsection ARM Features
42886 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42887
42888 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42889 ARM targets.
42890 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42891 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42892
42893 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42894 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42895 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42896 and @samp{xpsr}.
42897
42898 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42899 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42900
42901 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42902 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42903 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42904 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42905
42906 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42907 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42908 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42909 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42910 halves of the double-precision registers.
42911
42912 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42913 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42914 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42915 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42916 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42917 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42918
42919 @node i386 Features
42920 @subsection i386 Features
42921 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42922
42923 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42924 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42925
42926 @itemize @minus
42927 @item
42928 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42929 @item
42930 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42931 @item
42932 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42933 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42934 @item
42935 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42936 @item
42937 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42938 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42939 @end itemize
42940
42941 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42942
42943 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42944 describe registers:
42945
42946 @itemize @minus
42947 @item
42948 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42949 @item
42950 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42951 @item
42952 @samp{mxcsr}
42953 @end itemize
42954
42955 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42956 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42957 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42958
42959 @itemize @minus
42960 @item
42961 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42962 @item
42963 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42964 @end itemize
42965
42966 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
42967 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
42968
42969 @itemize @minus
42970 @item
42971 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
42972 @item
42973 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
42974 @end itemize
42975
42976 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42977 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42978
42979 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
42980 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
42981
42982 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
42983 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
42984 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
42985
42986 @itemize @minus
42987 @item
42988 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42989 @end itemize
42990
42991 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
42992
42993 @itemize @minus
42994 @item
42995 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42996 @end itemize
42997
42998 It should
42999 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43000
43001 @itemize @minus
43002 @item
43003 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43004 @item
43005 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43006 @end itemize
43007
43008 It should
43009 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43010
43011 @itemize @minus
43012 @item
43013 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43014 @end itemize
43015
43016 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43017 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43018 valid for i386 and amd64.
43019
43020 @node MicroBlaze Features
43021 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43022 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43023
43024 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43025 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43026 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43027 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43028 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43029
43030 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43031 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43032
43033 @node MIPS Features
43034 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43035 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43036
43037 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43038 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43039 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43040 on the target.
43041
43042 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43043 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43044 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43045
43046 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43047 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43048 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43049 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43050
43051 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43052 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43053 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43054 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43055
43056 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43057 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43058 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43059
43060 @node M68K Features
43061 @subsection M68K Features
43062 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43063
43064 @table @code
43065 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43066 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43067 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43068 One of those features must be always present.
43069 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43070 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43071 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43072 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43073
43074 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43075 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43076 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43077 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43078 @end table
43079
43080 @node NDS32 Features
43081 @subsection NDS32 Features
43082 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43083
43084 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43085 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43086 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43087 and @samp{pc}.
43088
43089 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43090 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43091 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43092 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43093
43094 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43095 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43096 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43097 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43098 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43099 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43100 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43101
43102 @node Nios II Features
43103 @subsection Nios II Features
43104 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43105
43106 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43107 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43108 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43109 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43110 @samp{mpuacc}).
43111
43112 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43113 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43114 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43115
43116 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43117 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43118 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43119
43120 @node PowerPC Features
43121 @subsection PowerPC Features
43122 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43123
43124 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43125 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43126 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43127 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43128
43129 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43130 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43131
43132 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43133 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
43134 and @samp{vrsave}.
43135
43136 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43137 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43138 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
43139 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
43140 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
43141 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
43142
43143 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43144 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43145 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43146 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43147 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43148 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43149 user.
43150
43151 @node S/390 and System z Features
43152 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43153 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43154 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43155
43156 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43157 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43158 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43159 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43160 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43161 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43162 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43163 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43164 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43165
43166 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43167 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43168 @samp{fpc}.
43169
43170 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43171 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43172
43173 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43174 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43175 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43176 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43177 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43178 32-bit wide.
43179
43180 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43181 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43182 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43183
43184 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43185 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43186 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43187 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43188 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43189 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43190 @samp{v31}.
43191
43192 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43193 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43194 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43195
43196 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43197 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43198 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43199
43200 @node Sparc Features
43201 @subsection Sparc Features
43202 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43203 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43204 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43205 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43206
43207 @itemize @minus
43208 @item
43209 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43210 @item
43211 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43212 @item
43213 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43214 @item
43215 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43216 @end itemize
43217
43218 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43219
43220 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43221 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43222
43223 @itemize @minus
43224 @item
43225 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43226 @item
43227 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43228 @end itemize
43229
43230 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43231 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43232
43233 @itemize @minus
43234 @item
43235 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43236 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43237 @item
43238 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43239 for sparc64
43240 @end itemize
43241
43242 @node TIC6x Features
43243 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43244 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43245 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43247 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43248 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43249
43250 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43251 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43252 through @samp{B31}.
43253
43254 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43255 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43256
43257 @node Operating System Information
43258 @appendix Operating System Information
43259 @cindex operating system information
43260
43261 @menu
43262 * Process list::
43263 @end menu
43264
43265 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43266 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43267 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43268 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43269 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43270 on a different aspect of target.
43271
43272 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43273 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43274 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43275 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43276
43277 @node Process list
43278 @appendixsection Process list
43279 @cindex operating system information, process list
43280
43281 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43282 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43283 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43284 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43285
43286 An example document is:
43287
43288 @smallexample
43289 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43290 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43291 <osdata type="processes">
43292 <item>
43293 <column name="pid">1</column>
43294 <column name="user">root</column>
43295 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43296 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43297 </item>
43298 </osdata>
43299 @end smallexample
43300
43301 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43302 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43303 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43304 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43305 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43306 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43307 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43308
43309 @node Trace File Format
43310 @appendix Trace File Format
43311 @cindex trace file format
43312
43313 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43314 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43315
43316 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43317 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43318 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43319 in the future.
43320
43321 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43322 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43323 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43324 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43325 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43326 of this section.
43327
43328 @table @code
43329 @item R @var{size}
43330 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43331 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43332 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43333 a single trace file.
43334
43335 @item status @var{status}
43336 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43337 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43338 file.
43339
43340 @item tp @var{payload}
43341 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43342 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43343 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43344 reply packets.
43345
43346 @item tsv @var{payload}
43347 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43348 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43349 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43350 reply packets.
43351
43352 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43353 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43354 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43355 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43356 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43357 file. Includes are not allowed.
43358
43359 @end table
43360
43361 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43362 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43363 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43364 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43365 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43366 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43367 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43368 endianness.
43369
43370 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43371
43372 @table @code
43373 @item R @var{bytes}
43374 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43375 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43376 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43377
43378 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43379 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43380 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43381 @var{length} bytes.
43382
43383 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43384 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43385 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43386
43387 @end table
43388
43389 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43390 of blocks.
43391
43392 @node Index Section Format
43393 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43394 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43395 @cindex index section format
43396
43397 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43398 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43399 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43400 description.
43401
43402 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43403 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43404 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43405 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43406 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43407 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43408
43409 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43410
43411 @enumerate
43412 @item
43413 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43414 unless otherwise noted:
43415
43416 @enumerate
43417 @item
43418 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43419 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43420 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43421 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43422 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43423 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43424 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43425
43426 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43427 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43428 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43429 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43430
43431 @item
43432 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43433
43434 @item
43435 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43436 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43437 to the next offset.
43438
43439 @item
43440 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43441
43442 @item
43443 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43444
43445 @item
43446 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43447 @end enumerate
43448
43449 @item
43450 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43451 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43452 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43453 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43454 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43455 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43456 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43457 CU indices.
43458
43459 @item
43460 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43461 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43462 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43463 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43464
43465 @item
43466 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43467 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43468
43469 @enumerate
43470 @item
43471 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43472
43473 @item
43474 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43475 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43476
43477 @item
43478 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43479 @end enumerate
43480
43481 @item
43482 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43483 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43484
43485 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43486 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43487 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43488 constant pool.
43489
43490 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43491 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43492 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43493
43494 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43495 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43496 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43497 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43498 index version:
43499
43500 @table @asis
43501 @item Version 4
43502 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43503
43504 @item Versions 5 to 7
43505 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43506 @end table
43507
43508 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43509
43510 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43511 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43512 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43513 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43514 collision.
43515
43516 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43517 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43518 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43519 the code.
43520
43521 @item
43522 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43523 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43524 strings.
43525
43526 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43527 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43528 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43529 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43530 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43531 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43532
43533 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43534 @end enumerate
43535
43536 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43537 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43538 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43539
43540 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43541 (bit 0 = LSB):
43542
43543 @table @asis
43544
43545 @item Bits 0-23
43546 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43547 @item Bits 24-27
43548 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43549 @item Bits 28-30
43550 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43551
43552 @table @asis
43553 @item 0
43554 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43555 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43556 with previous versions of the index.
43557 @item 1
43558 The symbol is a type.
43559 @item 2
43560 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43561 @item 3
43562 The symbol is a function.
43563 @item 4
43564 Any other kind of symbol.
43565 @item 5,6,7
43566 These values are reserved.
43567 @end table
43568
43569 @item Bit 31
43570 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43571
43572 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43573 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43574 @value{GDBN} sources.
43575
43576 @end table
43577
43578 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43579 global/static attributes in the index.
43580
43581 @smallexample
43582 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43583 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43584 switch (die->tag)
43585 @{
43586 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43587 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43588 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43589 kind = TYPE;
43590 is_static = 1;
43591 break;
43592 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43593 kind = VARIABLE;
43594 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43595 break;
43596 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43597 kind = FUNCTION;
43598 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43599 break;
43600 case DW_TAG_constant:
43601 kind = VARIABLE;
43602 is_static = ! is_external;
43603 break;
43604 case DW_TAG_variable:
43605 kind = VARIABLE;
43606 is_static = ! is_external;
43607 break;
43608 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43609 kind = TYPE;
43610 is_static = 0;
43611 break;
43612 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43613 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43614 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43615 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43616 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43617 kind = TYPE;
43618 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43619 break;
43620 default:
43621 assert (0);
43622 @}
43623 @end smallexample
43624
43625 @node Man Pages
43626 @appendix Manual pages
43627 @cindex Man pages
43628
43629 @menu
43630 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43631 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43632 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43633 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43634 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43635 @end menu
43636
43637 @node gdb man
43638 @heading gdb man
43639
43640 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43641
43642 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43643 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43644 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43645 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43646 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43647 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43648 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43649 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43650 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43651 @c man end
43652
43653 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43654 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43655 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43656 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43657
43658 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43659 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43660
43661 @itemize @bullet
43662 @item
43663 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43664
43665 @item
43666 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43667
43668 @item
43669 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43670
43671 @item
43672 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43673 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43674 @end itemize
43675
43676 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43677 Modula-2.
43678
43679 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43680 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43681 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43682 by using the command @code{help}.
43683
43684 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43685 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43686 executable program as the argument:
43687
43688 @smallexample
43689 gdb program
43690 @end smallexample
43691
43692 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43693
43694 @smallexample
43695 gdb program core
43696 @end smallexample
43697
43698 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43699 to debug a running process:
43700
43701 @smallexample
43702 gdb program 1234
43703 gdb -p 1234
43704 @end smallexample
43705
43706 @noindent
43707 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43708 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43709 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43710
43711 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43712
43713 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43714 @table @env
43715 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43716 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43717
43718 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43719 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43720
43721 @item bt
43722 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43723
43724 @item print @var{expr}
43725 Display the value of an expression.
43726
43727 @item c
43728 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43729
43730 @item next
43731 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43732 function calls in the line.
43733
43734 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43735 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43736
43737 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43738 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43739
43740 @item step
43741 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43742 function calls in the line.
43743
43744 @item help [@var{name}]
43745 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43746 about using @value{GDBN}.
43747
43748 @item quit
43749 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43750 @end table
43751
43752 @ifset man
43753 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43754 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43755 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43756 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43757 @end ifset
43758 @c man end
43759
43760 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43761 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43762 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43763 encountered with no
43764 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43765 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43766 Many options have
43767 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43768 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43769 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43770 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43771 more usual convention.)
43772
43773 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43774 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43775 option is used.
43776
43777 @table @env
43778 @item -help
43779 @itemx -h
43780 List all options, with brief explanations.
43781
43782 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43783 @itemx -s @var{file}
43784 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43785
43786 @item -write
43787 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43788
43789 @item -exec=@var{file}
43790 @itemx -e @var{file}
43791 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43792 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43793 dump.
43794
43795 @item -se=@var{file}
43796 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43797 file.
43798
43799 @item -core=@var{file}
43800 @itemx -c @var{file}
43801 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43802
43803 @item -command=@var{file}
43804 @itemx -x @var{file}
43805 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43806
43807 @item -ex @var{command}
43808 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43809
43810 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43811 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43812 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43813
43814 @item -nh
43815 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43816
43817 @item -nx
43818 @itemx -n
43819 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43820
43821 @item -quiet
43822 @itemx -q
43823 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43824 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43825
43826 @item -batch
43827 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43828 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43829 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43830 commands in the command files.
43831
43832 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43833 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43834 more useful, the message
43835
43836 @smallexample
43837 Program exited normally.
43838 @end smallexample
43839
43840 @noindent
43841 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43842 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43843
43844 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43845 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43846 instead of the current directory.
43847
43848 @item -fullname
43849 @itemx -f
43850 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43851 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43852 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43853 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43854 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43855 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43856 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43857 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43858
43859 @item -b @var{bps}
43860 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43861 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43862
43863 @item -tty=@var{device}
43864 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43865 @end table
43866 @c man end
43867
43868 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43869 @ifset man
43870 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43871 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43872 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43873
43874 @smallexample
43875 info gdb
43876 @end smallexample
43877
43878 @noindent
43879 should give you access to the complete manual.
43880
43881 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43882 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43883 @end ifset
43884 @c man end
43885
43886 @node gdbserver man
43887 @heading gdbserver man
43888
43889 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43890 @format
43891 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43892 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43893
43894 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43895
43896 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43897 @c man end
43898 @end format
43899
43900 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43901 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43902 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43903
43904 @ifclear man
43905 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43906 @end ifclear
43907 @ifset man
43908 Usage (server (target) side):
43909 @end ifset
43910
43911 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43912 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43913 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43914 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43915
43916 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43917 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43918 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43919
43920 @smallexample
43921 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43922 @end smallexample
43923
43924 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43925
43926 @smallexample
43927 @ifset man
43928 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43929 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43930 @end ifset
43931 @ifclear man
43932 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43933 @end ifclear
43934 @end smallexample
43935
43936 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43937 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43938 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43939
43940 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43941
43942 @smallexample
43943 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43944 @end smallexample
43945
43946 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43947 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43948 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43949 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43950 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43951 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43952 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43953 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43954 print an error message and exit.
43955
43956 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43957 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43958
43959 @smallexample
43960 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43961 @end smallexample
43962
43963 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43964 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43965
43966 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43967 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43968 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43969 the program you want to debug.
43970
43971 @smallexample
43972 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43973 @end smallexample
43974
43975 @ifclear man
43976 @subheading Usage (host side)
43977 @end ifclear
43978 @ifset man
43979 Usage (host side):
43980 @end ifset
43981
43982 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43983 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43984 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43985 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43986 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43987 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43988 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43989 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43990 descriptor. For example:
43991
43992 @smallexample
43993 @ifset man
43994 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43995 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43996 @end ifset
43997 @ifclear man
43998 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43999 @end ifclear
44000 @end smallexample
44001
44002 @noindent
44003 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44004
44005 @smallexample
44006 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44007 @end smallexample
44008
44009 @noindent
44010 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44011 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44012 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44013 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44014 `Connection refused'.
44015
44016 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44017 described in
44018 @ifset man
44019 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44020 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44021 @end ifset
44022 @ifclear man
44023 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44024 @end ifclear
44025 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44026
44027 @smallexample
44028 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44029 @end smallexample
44030
44031 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44032 case.
44033 @c man end
44034
44035 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44036 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44037
44038 @itemize @bullet
44039
44040 @item
44041 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44042
44043 @smallexample
44044 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44045 @end smallexample
44046
44047 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44048 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44049 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44050 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44051 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44052 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44053 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44054
44055 @item
44056 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44057 program:
44058
44059 @smallexample
44060 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44061 @end smallexample
44062
44063 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44064 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44065 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44066 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44067
44068 @item
44069 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44070
44071 @smallexample
44072 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44073 @end smallexample
44074
44075 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44076 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44077 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44078 debug several processes in the same session.
44079 @end itemize
44080
44081 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44082
44083 @table @env
44084
44085 @item --help
44086 List all options, with brief explanations.
44087
44088 @item --version
44089 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44090
44091 @item --attach
44092 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44093
44094 @smallexample
44095 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44096 @end smallexample
44097
44098 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44099 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44100
44101 @item --multi
44102 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44103 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44104 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44105 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44106
44107 @smallexample
44108 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44109 @end smallexample
44110
44111 @item --debug
44112 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44113 process.
44114 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44115 the developers.
44116
44117 @item --remote-debug
44118 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44119 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44120 the developers.
44121
44122 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44123 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44124 of debugging output.
44125 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44126
44127 @item --wrapper
44128 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44129 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44130 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44131 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44132
44133 @item --once
44134 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44135 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44136 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44137 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44138
44139 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44140
44141 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44142 @c QDisableRandomization.
44143
44144 @end table
44145 @c man end
44146
44147 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44148 @ifset man
44149 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44150 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44151 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44152
44153 @smallexample
44154 info gdb
44155 @end smallexample
44156
44157 should give you access to the complete manual.
44158
44159 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44160 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44161 @end ifset
44162 @c man end
44163
44164 @node gcore man
44165 @heading gcore
44166
44167 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44168
44169 @format
44170 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44171 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44172 @c man end
44173 @end format
44174
44175 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44176 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44177 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44178 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44179 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44180 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44181 its job the program remains running without any change.
44182 @c man end
44183
44184 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44185 @table @env
44186 @item -a
44187 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44188 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44189 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44190 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44191 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44192
44193 @item -o @var{prefix}
44194 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44195 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44196 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44197 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44198 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44199 @end table
44200 @c man end
44201
44202 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44203 @ifset man
44204 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44205 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44206 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44207
44208 @smallexample
44209 info gdb
44210 @end smallexample
44211
44212 @noindent
44213 should give you access to the complete manual.
44214
44215 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44216 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44217 @end ifset
44218 @c man end
44219
44220 @node gdbinit man
44221 @heading gdbinit
44222
44223 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44224
44225 @format
44226 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44227 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44228 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44229 @end ifset
44230
44231 ~/.gdbinit
44232
44233 ./.gdbinit
44234 @c man end
44235 @end format
44236
44237 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44238 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44239 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44240 described in
44241 @ifset man
44242 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44243 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44244 @end ifset
44245 @ifclear man
44246 @ref{Sequences}.
44247 @end ifclear
44248
44249 Please read more in
44250 @ifset man
44251 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44252 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44253 @end ifset
44254 @ifclear man
44255 @ref{Startup}.
44256 @end ifclear
44257
44258 @table @env
44259 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44260 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44261 @end ifset
44262 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44263 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44264 @end ifclear
44265 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44266 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44267 See more in
44268 @ifset man
44269 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44270 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44271 @end ifset
44272 @ifclear man
44273 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44274 @end ifclear
44275
44276 @item ~/.gdbinit
44277 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44278 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44279
44280 @item ./.gdbinit
44281 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44282 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44283 See more in
44284 @ifset man
44285 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44286 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44287 @end ifset
44288 @ifclear man
44289 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44290 @end ifclear
44291 @end table
44292 @c man end
44293
44294 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44295 @ifset man
44296 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44297
44298 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44299 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44300 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44301
44302 @smallexample
44303 info gdb
44304 @end smallexample
44305
44306 should give you access to the complete manual.
44307
44308 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44309 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44310 @end ifset
44311 @c man end
44312
44313 @node gdb-add-index man
44314 @heading gdb-add-index
44315 @pindex gdb-add-index
44316 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44317
44318 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44319
44320 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44321 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44322 @c man end
44323
44324 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44325 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44326 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44327 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44328 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44329 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44330
44331 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44332 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44333 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44334 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44335 named @code{.debug_*}).
44336
44337 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44338 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44339 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44340 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44341
44342 See more in
44343 @ifset man
44344 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44345 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44346 @end ifset
44347 @ifclear man
44348 @ref{Index Files}.
44349 @end ifclear
44350 @c man end
44351
44352 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44353 @ifset man
44354 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44355 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44356 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44357
44358 @smallexample
44359 info gdb
44360 @end smallexample
44361
44362 should give you access to the complete manual.
44363
44364 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44365 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44366 @end ifset
44367 @c man end
44368
44369 @include gpl.texi
44370
44371 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44372 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44373 @include fdl.texi
44374
44375 @node Concept Index
44376 @unnumbered Concept Index
44377
44378 @printindex cp
44379
44380 @node Command and Variable Index
44381 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44382
44383 @printindex fn
44384
44385 @tex
44386 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44387 % meantime:
44388 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44389 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44390 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44391 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44392 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44393 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44394 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44395 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44396 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44397 \page\colophon
44398 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44399 @end tex
44400
44401 @bye
This page took 0.954738 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.